clicking here - Lincoln Aquatics
Transcription
clicking here - Lincoln Aquatics
Commercial Swimming Pool Equipment ( 800 ) 223-5450 www.lincolnaquatics.com 2051 Commerce Avenue, Concord, CA 94520 USA ph (800) 223-5450 / fax (888) 680-2825 int’l (925) 687-9500 / fax (925) 680-2825 catalog 62 lincoln AQUATICS C omme rc ial Sw imming Pool Equipme nt C a talog Useful Data Welcome to Lincoln! SWIMMING POOL CALCULATIONS WEIGHTS AND MEASURES One cubic foot of water contains 7.48 gallons. One cubic foot of water weighs 62.2 pounds. One gallon of water weighs 8.32 pounds. One gallon equals four quarts. One part per million (ppm) represents 8.32 pounds of chemical per million gallons of water. One pound psi equals 2.31 feet of head. One inch of mercury equals 1.13 feet of head. We appreciate the opportunity to serve you by meeting your commercial swimming pool equipment and aquatic supply needs. We are very aware there is one reason why we are one of the largest swimming pool equipment distributors in the country, and that reason is you. Since 1954, Lincoln has served commercial swimming pool operators like you. For over 60 years, our reputation has been built by our knowledgeable staff, by providing customers with prompt personal service, and by carrying the highest quality products available. In addition, it remains our goal to offer those products at the best prices anywhere, delivering you the best value available. METRIC EQUIVALENTS 1 meter = 39.37 inches 3.2808 feet 1.0936 yards 1 foot = .3048 meters 1 yard = .9144 meters 1 gallon = 3.785 liters 1 liter = .2642 gallons HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS — 15 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE POOLS Volume = Length x Width x Average Depth x 7.48 RAPID SAND FILTERS — 3 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. ROUND POOLS Volume = r2 x π (3.14) x Average Depth x 7.48 TO DETERMINE SQUARE FOOTAGE OF FILTER AREA REQUIRED: Pool gallonage ÷ 60 minutes ÷ Pool turnover rate (number of hours) ÷ Filtration rate (gpm per square foot of filter area) = Square foot filter area required. Customer satisfaction remains our top priority. Our knowledgeable staff is available to serve you and answer any questions you may have. We appreciate your business and pledge to do our best to meet your needs and exceed your expectations. IDEAL POOL CHEMICAL CONTROL CONTROL MIN. PPM IDEAL MAX. PPM Chlorine, Free Chlorine 1.0 1.5 3.0 1.5 2.0 4.0 Bromine 1.5 2.5 5.0 Sincerely, SATURATION INDEX = pH + TF + CF + AF - 12.1 TF CALCIUM HARDNESS EXPRESSED AS PPM CaC03 32 0.0 37 0.1 TEMP ºF pH 7.2 7.5 7.8 Total Alkalinity 60 120 200 Calcium Hardness 50 150 500 Cyanuric Acid 15 30 100 Dissolved Solids 0 200-1,000 1,500 NOTE: Check with your local Health Department for their water chemistry requirements in your area. NUMERICAL VALUES FOR FORMULA $8.00 WATER CHEMISTRY Chlorine with Cyanuric Acid We look forward to being your supplier now and in the future! Federal Supply Schedule Contract No. GS-07F-9449G Length x Width x Inches of water lost x .625 = Gallons of water PRE-COAT Continuous feed — .1 pounds per square foot of filter area. Non-continuous feed — .15 pounds per square foot of filter area. MAXIMUM COAT OF D.E. — Seven times the amount of pre-coat (for pressure D.E. filter). Call Toll Free (800 ) 223-5450 FAX ( 888 ) 680-2825 www.lincolnaquatics.com WATER LOSS DIATOMACEOUS EARTH FILTERS FILTER CYCLE — Add 2.5 pounds of D.E. per turnover for 100,000 gallon pool (continuous feed). Charles R. Luecker President & CEO AREA OF A CIRCLE Area = π r2 Area = 3.14 x r2 POOL GALLONAGES DIATOMACEOUS EARTH FILTERS — With continuous feed of D.E., 2.0 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. Due to space limitations and the technical nature of many of our products, it is not possible to have them all listed in this catalog. Please contact us for any specific products you desire. We will be happy to provide you with detailed literature and parts lists for each of the products we carry. AREA OF A SQUARE OR RECTANGLE Area = Length x Width FILTER SIZING CARTRIDGE FILTERS — .375 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. Our catalog contains the most comprehensive selection of high quality swimming pool equipment and aquatic supplies available in the industry today. We have organized our catalog in an easy-to-use format that will help you quickly locate the products you want. The Lincoln name is recognized around the world for providing customers with quality products and superior service at competitive prices. POOL SURFACE AREA CF TOTAL ALKALINITY EXPRESSED AS PPM CaC03 AF 5 0.3 5 0.7 25 1.0 25 1.4 PARTS PER MILLION CALCULATION 46 0.2 50 1.3 50 1.7 53 0.3 75 1.5 75 1.9 60 0.4 100 1.6 100 2.0 66 0.5 150 1.8 150 2.2 76 0.6 200 1.9 200 2.3 84 0.7 300 2.1 300 2.5 94 0.8 400 2.2 400 2.6 105 0.9 800 2.5 800 2.9 128 1.0 1,000 2.6 1,000 3.0 FOR 100% CHEMICAL STRENGTH Pool Volume (gallons) x 8.32 pounds per gallon 1,000,000 = Pounds for 1 ppm FOR LESS THAN 100% CHEMICAL STRENGTH P 1 pound of chlorine gas 1 gallon of liquid chlorine (sodium hypochlorite) 1.54 pounds of dry chlorine (calcium hypochlorite) 1.8 pounds of S.D.I.C. (sodium dichlor) SUPER CHLORINATION Super chlorination = 10 times the weight of the chloramines. SODA ASH — To maintain pH, add continuously 1.25 to 1.50 pounds of soda ash for each pound of chlorine gas used. Ideal soda ash solution is 3-6%, with a maximum solution of 12%. SOLUTION TANK FORMULA — Soda ash tank gallons x 8.32 Ibs. per gallon x desired soda ash solution percentage = pounds of soda ash for solution. INFORMATION RESOURCES Centers for Disease Control (CDC) — www.cdc.gov Model Aquatic Health Code (MAHC) www.cdc.gov/healthywater/swimming/pools/mahc National Swimming Pool Foundation — www.nspf.org TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 California Dept. of Environmental Health www.cdph.ca.gov California Swimming Pool Regulations http://www.cdph.ca.gov/HealthInfo/EnvironHealth/Water/ Pages/CaliforniaPublicSwimmingPoolRequirements.aspx Catalog 62 TERMS AND CONDITIONS PRICES: Prices are subject to change without notice. Please call us to confirm pricing before ordering. All prices are F.O.B. shipping point, unless otherwise stated. MINIMUM ORDER: $50.00 ($5.00 minimum order charge for orders less than minimum, excluding freight and taxes.) TERMS: Net 30 days. CREDIT POLICY: Credit accounts will be extended with an approved credit application. New accounts without prior credit approval will be shipped C.O.D. or on a cash-before-order basis. For your convenience we also accept credit cards. Custom orders are noncancellable and may require a deposit. All past due invoices will carry a service charge of 11⁄2% per month (18%) per annum. Any past-due account will be turned over to a third party for collection, in which case the purchaser agrees to be responsible for all costs of collection and reasonable attorney’s fees. TAXES: All sales are subject to state and local taxes, where applicable. TRANSPORTATION: All orders are shipped via the best possible carrier. Air freight or other special handling for rush shipments is available upon request. TRANSPORTATION CLAIMS: If any merchandise is damaged or lost in transit the purchaser must file a claim with UPS or the common carrier. Claims must be filed within the time limit and according to the regulations allowed by the carrier. HANDLING CHARGE: Handling charge of $3.95 is added to each order, to offset costs associated with order processing, packaging, shipping, returns, and exchanges. RETURNED GOODS: Merchandise returned for credit must be mailed with a returned goods authorization number clearly marked on the outside of the package. You will be given a number when you call us to arrange a return. All merchandise must be returned freight prepaid. Authorized returns must be in original condition and are subject to a 25% restocking fee. A higher fee may be charged on products where the supplier restocking fee is greater. Custom ordered merchandise and chemicals are nonreturnable. All returns must be made within 30 days. CONTENTS CHEMICALS ..............................................................................................................................4-9 CHEMICAL FEED SYSTEMS ...............................................................................................10-28 Chemical Controllers ...................................................................................................10-12 Chlorinators .................................................................................................................13-16 Ultraviolet Systems......................................................................................................17-18 Carbon Dioxide Systems.................................................................................................. 19 Chemical Feed Pumps & Accessories........................................................................20-26 Chemical Storage........................................................................................................27-28 MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT .................................................................................................29-54 Pumps & Strainers ......................................................................................................30-35 Filter Systems & Accessories ......................................................................................36-42 Flow Meters & Flow Control ........................................................................................43-44 Valves & Plumbing Fittings..........................................................................................45-46 Main Drains, Fittings & Skimmers................................................................................47-51 Heating Systems & Energy Efficiency.........................................................................52-55 GUTTERS & GRATING SYSTEMS .......................................................................................56-57 TEST KITS AND REAGENTS ...............................................................................................58-62 CLEANING EQUIPMENT ......................................................................................................63-75 Pool Vacuums & Accessories .....................................................................................63-71 UNDERWATER LIGHTS & ELECTRICAL ACCESSORIES .................................................76-78 DECK EQUIPMENT ..............................................................................................................79-91 Diving Stands & Diving Boards...................................................................................79-83 Ladders & Handrails....................................................................................................84-86 Guard Chairs & Stands................................................................................................87-91 LIFEGUARD, RESCUE & SAFETY ....................................................................................92-111 Lifeguard Apparel........................................................................................................92-93 Lifeguard Supplies......................................................................................................94-97 Life Vests & Life Jackets .................................................................................................. 98 Rope, Floats & Anchors.................................................................................................... 99 Signs .......................................................................................................................100-104 Rescue Equipment ..................................................................................................105-108 Safety Equipment ....................................................................................................109-111 COMPETITIVE EQUIPMENT & SWIM TRAINING ............................................................112-135 Racing Lanes & Storage Reels ...............................................................................112-116 Starting Platforms & Accessories............................................................................117-120 Pennants & Stanchions .................................................................................................. 121 Bulkheads ...................................................................................................................... 122 Swim Training & Training Aids ................................................................................123-130 Stopwatches, Pace Clocks, Starting Systems & Timing Systems ...........................131-135 WATER POLO ...................................................................................................................136-139 GAMES & WATER PLAY ..................................................................................................140-154 Games .....................................................................................................................140-144 Tubes, Noodles & Foam Toys.................................................................................145-147 Inflatable Structures ................................................................................................148-149 Water Sports, Paddle Boards & Climbing Walls......................................................150-151 Water Slides & Interactive Play................................................................................152-154 SWIMMING POOL COATINGS & COMPOUNDS .............................................................155-157 LOCKERS & LOCKER ROOM SUPPLIES .......................................................................158-165 OUTDOOR FURNITURE & SITE FURNISHINGS .............................................................166-178 Outdoor Furniture ....................................................................................................166-169 Tables, Benches & Bleachers .................................................................................170-173 Umbrellas & Shade Structures ................................................................................174-176 Outdoor Accessories...................................................................................................... 177 Trash Containers ............................................................................................................ 178 Specialty Equipment................................................................................................179-181 AQUATIC ACCESSIBILITY ...............................................................................................182-187 Pool Lifts ..................................................................................................................182-185 Therapy Ladders ............................................................................................................ 186 Wheelchairs.................................................................................................................... 187 WATER EXERCISE EQUIPMENT & GEAR ......................................................................188-192 ADAPTED AQUATICS ............................................................................................................. 193 POOL COVERS & STORAGE REELS .............................................................................194-197 INDEX ................................................................................................................................198-200 USEFUL DATA ........................................................................................... INSIDE BACK COVER © 2016 Lincoln Aquatics No reproduction of any or all of this catalog is allowed, without the written permission of Lincoln Aquatics. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 1 Committed to your pool. Lincoln Aquatics is the leading national distributor of commercial swimming pool equipment, chemicals and supplies. For over 60 years, it has been both our philosophy and our mission to deliver the best quality products and provide the highest level of service to each and every customer. Our reputation depends on our ability to provide prompt, knowledgeable and friendly customer service and to get products to our customers the way you want it, when you need it. Whatever your pool equipment and supply needs may be, our knowledgeable Lincoln staff is ready to serve you! (800) 223-5450 www.lincolnaquatics.com Products You Want. With over 6,500 products available, you’ll find what you want. Our products are detailed in our extensive catalog and are available to you 24/7/365 on our website. uWe understand what you’re looking for. u Hard-to-find items, no problem. u Extensive inventory and access to over 400 manufacturer’s products. u View and download our full-line catalog, current product special flyers, or contact us for your own printed copies. u We’re here when you want us! Service You Need. Knowledgeable, friendly customer service staff and our national network of sales representatives, help you get the products and information you need. The right products for your pool, the first time, when you need them. uWe don’t just sell the products you purchase from us, we service them too. u Get answers to your specific questions. u Request and receive quotes online. u Review and print product information, parts lists, MSDS sheets, and more. u Review your account history for orders, invoices, quotes and much more. Easy Ordering. Whether by phone, fax or online, your product order is processed, shipped and delivered securely and quickly. u Most products shipped same day or next day. Online. Anytime. u Expedited shipping to meet any need. u Direct, secure online shopping link to our extensive catalog. u Use your account, or order by credit card on our secure site. u We’re ready when you are! 1-800-223-5450 USA 1-925-687-9500 International 7:00 AM–5:00 PM PST Over 6,500 products for your aquatic needs. 1-888-680-2825 USA 1-925-680-2825 International 24 Hours a Day, 7 Days a Week lincoln AQUATICS 2051 Commerce Avenue, Concord, CA 94520 USA ph (800) 223-5450 / fax (888) 680-2825 int’l (925) 687-9500 / fax (925) 680-2825 sales@lincolnaquatics.com www.lincolnaquatics.com 24 Hours a Day, 7 Days a Week (800 ) 223-5450 www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemicals 1-165 1-114 SANITIZERS SODIUM HYPOCHLORITE — Liquid pool bleach, 12.5% strength. pH 13.0. Plus deposit and drum cleaning charges. 4x1 gallon case 1-020 1-99 cases 1-025 100 or more cases 4x1 gallon case - No deposit 1-027 1-99 cases 1-028 100 or more cases 5 gallon carboy 1-030 1-4 carboys 1-035 5-9 carboys 1-040 10 or more carboys 15 gallon carboy 1-045 1-4 carboys 1-050 5-9 carboys 1-055 10 or more carboys 30 gallon carboy 1-060 1-4 carboys 1-065 5-9 carboys 1-070 10 or more carboys 53 gallon drum 1-086 1-4 drums 1-087 5-9 drums 1-088 10 or more drums 330 gallon tote 1-091 Bulk Delivery - Sodium Hypochlorite 1-090 1-110 PULSAR PLUS BRIQUETTES — A specially blended form of calcium hypochlorite, 65% available chlorine, pH 11.5. Patented Briquettes contain additive to reduce scaling and dissolve uniformly to provide steady chlorination. Available in California, Northern Nevada, Western Washington, and Oregon. CALCIUM HYPOCHLORITE — 65% available chlorine, pH 11.7. 1-100 100 lb. drum granular 1-105 100 lb. drum 1" tablets 4 LITHIUM HYPOCHLORITE — Granular pool sanitizer, 35% available chlorine, totally soluble in water, pH 9.5. 1-171 20 lb. pail 50 lb. drum 1-110 1-8 drums 1-111 9-23 drums 1-112 24 or more drums 100 lb. drum 1-114 1-4 drums 1-115 5-15 drums 1-116 16 or more drums 1-180 8-040 PULSAR PLUS ACID CLEANER — Safely removes scale and residue from Pulsar feeders. 8-040 1 quart 1-205 pH CONTROL SODA ASH — 58% Sodium Oxide, raises pH, granular, light. 50 lb. Bags 1-180 1-19 bags 1-185 20 or more bags BICARBONATE OF SODA — Raises pH and increases total water alkalinity. 11⁄2 lbs. raises alkalinity 10 ppm per 10,000 gallons. 50 lb. Bags 1-205 1-19 bags 1-210 20 or more bags 1-144 1-100 BROMINE — Bromine tablets for use in pools or spas. Sanitizer stays effective even when in combined state. 100% active ingredients. 66.2% Active Bromine, 29.4% Active Chlorine, pH 7.4. 1-165 50 lb. pail, 1" tablets S.D.I.C. — Sodium Dichloro-iso-cyanurate. 95% active ingredients, 56% available chlorine, with conditioner. pH 11.0. Granular, completely soluble in water. 1-119 25 lb. pail 1-120 50 lb. pail TRICHLOR — Trichloro-s-triozinetrione. 95% active ingredients, 90% available chlorine with conditioner, pH 2.8. 1-135 25 lb. pail 1" tablets 1-144 25 lb. pail 3" tablets 1-145 50 lb. pail 3" tablets 1-152 275 lb. drum 3" tablets SODIUM SESQUICARBONATE — 48% soda ash, 36.5% bicarbonate of soda, raises pH and alkalinity. 50 lb. bags. 1-228 1-19 bags 1-229 20 or more bags SODIUM BISULFATE — Dry acid. Lowers pH and reduces total water alkalinity. 21⁄2 lbs. lowers alkalinity 10 ppm per 10,000 gal. of water. 1-356 50 lb. bag CARBON DIOXIDE — CO2 lowers pH by creating Carbonic Acid. 50 lb. cylinder plus cylinder rental and HAZMAT charge. 1-360 1-2 cylinders 1-365 3-9 cylinders 1-370 10 or more cylinders 1-375 Bulk Delivery - Carbon Dioxide www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemicals MURIATIC ACID — 31.5% strength Hydrochloric Acid. Lowers pH and Alkalinity. Can also be used for cleaning surfaces, etching pools prior to painting, and etching concrete decks. Plus deposit and drum cleaning charges. 4x1 gallon case 1-280 1-99 cases 1-285 100 or more cases 4x1 gallon case - No deposit 1-286 1-99 cases 1-287 100 or more cases 5 gallon carboy 1-290 1-4 carboys 1-295 5-9 carboys 1-300 10 or more carboys 15 gallon carboy 1-305 1-4 carboys 1-310 5-9 carboys 1-315 10 or more 30 gallon carboy 1-320 1-4 carboys 1-325 5-9 carboys 1-330 10 or more carboys 53 gallon drum 1-346 1-4 drums 1-347 5-9 drums 1-348 10 or more drums Bulk Delivery - Muriatic Acid 1-351 7% strength 1-350 15% strength 1-352 31.5% strength CAUSTIC SODA — 50% Sodium Hydroxide, raises pH. Plus deposit and drum cleaning charges. 15 gallon carboy 1-245 1-4 carboys 1-250 5-9 carboys 1-255 10 or more carboys 53 gallon drum 1-271 1-4 drums 1-272 5-9 drums 1-273 10 or more drums Bulk Delivery - Caustic Soda 1-275 1-380 FILTER AIDS DIATOMACEOUS EARTH 50 lb. bags 1-380 1-19 bags 1-385 20 or more bags 25 lb. bags 1-387 1-39 bags 1-388 40 or more bags TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 FILTER SAND — #20 Silica Sand. 50 lb. bags. 1-400 1-19 bags 1-407 20 or more bags 1-390 FIBER CLEAR FILTER MEDIA — Cellulose fiber filter media. 1 lb. replaces 8 lbs. of D.E. Non-toxic, biodegradable, and safe. Filters finer particles and is more efficient than diatomaceous earth in D.E. filters. 25 lb. bags. 1-390 1-19 bags 1-395 20 or more bags PEA GRAVEL — 1⁄8" to 1⁄4" water rounded. 50 lb. bags. 1-408 1-19 bags 1-409 20 or more bags POTASSIUM ALUM — Flocculant for rapid and high rate sand filters. Creates gel-like coating on the sand bed surface to help your filter remove smaller particles. Add 2 oz. per sq. ft. for rapid sand filters and 1-2 oz. per sq. ft. for high rate sand filters. pH should be above 7.0 in order for alum to work properly. Granular. 1-413 50 lb. bag 1-398 1-396 1-475 ZEOBRITE™ FILTER MEDIA — Naturally formed Zeolite mineral improves sand filter performance and provides superior water clarity. Lowers total operating costs by reducing backwashing up to 50%. Filters particles down to 3 microns. Absorbs ammonia ions which reduces chloramine formation. Reduces costly pool chemicals required to meet your pool's demand by 30-40%. Contains thousands of micropores which hold 300-400% more dirt than sand. Effective size: .45 mm. 50 lb. bags. 1-396 1-19 bags 1-397 20 or more bags ZEOBRITE™ XTREME FILTER MEDIA — All natural Zeobrite mineral has been enhanced by a Patent Pending process to create a "Dual Charged" media. Zeobrite Xtreme attracts both negative and positive charged particles that are suspended in pool water and can remove over 90% of suspended particles (turbidity) in just one turnover. 50 lb. bags. 1-475 1-19 bags 1-480 20 or more bags VITROCLEAN FILTER MEDIA — Recycled glass filter media is a direct replacement for silica sand. Removes finer particles than sand and improves water clarity. Uses 25% less water to backwash. No hazardous dust or sharp edges, completely safe to handle. Effective size: .40 mm. 80 lbs. = 1 cu. ft. 50 lb. bags. 1-398 1-19 bags 1-399 20 or more bags 1-455 CHLORINE GENERATOR SALT CHLORINE GENERATOR SALT — High quality salt for use in Chlorine Generators. 40 lb. bags. 1-455 1-19 bags 1-460 20+ bags 5 Specialty Chemicals SPECIALTY CHEMICALS CALCIUM CHLORIDE — Raises calcium hardness. 1 lb. raises 10 ppm per 10,000 gal. Correct range 200-275 ppm. 50 lb. bags 1-418 1-19 bags 1-419 20 or more bags BLACK ALGAETRINE — A complex long lasting, non-foaming copper algaecide specially formulated for use in swimming pools. Effective against "black algae." No waiting, can be added at any time. Will control recontamination by algae because its active copper remains in solution for an extended period of time. Initial dosage: 12 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Maintenance dosage: 6 oz. per 10,000 gallons, every 5-7 days. 2-010 1 quart 2-020 1 gallon 2-075 2-078 2-090 SEAKLEAR ALGAE PREVENTION AND REMOVER — Unique low dosage organic copper complex formula is non-staining and non-foaming. Effective against blue-green, black, and mustard algae. Single treatment lasts 3 months. Dosage: 1 quart treats 20,000 gallons for algae kill or bloom. Maintenance dosage: 10 oz. per 20,000 gallons monthly. Lower pH to 7.2 during treatment. 2-070 1 quart 2-075 1 gallon YELLOWTRINE — Granular formula helps eliminate mustard algae on pool walls and in the water. Dissolves quickly and leaves no residue. Initial dosage: 4 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Maintenance dosage: 2-4 oz. per 10,000 gallons. 2-078 3 lb. bottle 2-086 25 lb. pail WINTERTRINE — Long lasting winter algaecide that kills green and mustard algae. Reduces Spring clean-up time. Dosage: 1⁄2 gallon per 10,000 gallons. 2-090 1⁄2 gallon 1-434 CYANURIC ACID — Chlorine stabilizer or conditioner. Reduces chlorine loss due to sunlight. Effective with all types of chlorine. Initial dosage 2 lbs. per 10,000 gal. of water. Granular. 1-434 45 lb. pail 1-435 100 lb. drum SODIUM THIOSULFATE — Reduces high concentrations of Chlorine or Bromine. Reduces shut down time when levels are dangerously high. 1 oz. will neutralize 1 ppm of Chlorine/Bromine per 10,000 gallons. 1-446 2 lb. bottle 1-440 25 lb. pail 1-442 55 lb. bag ALGAECIDES 2-005 DRY ALGAECIDE — Concentrated algaecide with super killing power on black and green algae. Active ingredients: Trichloro-s-Triozinetrione (90% available chlorine). Turn off pump and sprinkle directly on algae. Use 1 lb. per 10,000 gals. of pool water. Granular, pH 2.8. 2-005 50 lb. pail 6 2-096 2-098 2-136 PHOSPHATE REMOVERS 2-010 2-030 2-050 SWIMTRINE PLUS — Completely kills green and mustard algae, prevents regrowth. Initial dosage: 3 oz. per 10,000 gallons for visible algae. Maintenance dosage: 1.5 oz. per 10,000 gallons every other week. Brush daily. 2-030 1 quart 2-040 1 gallon ALGIMYCIN 2000 — Quickly kills green, black and mustard algae. Contains coagulation and filtration ingredients that help clarify and brighten pool water. Prevents new growth by retaining long lasting residual in water. Will not foam or stain, does not contain heavy metals. Initial treatment: 8-12 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Visible algae growth: 16-24 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Black Algae: 16 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Weekly maintenance: 4-8 oz. per 10,000 gallons. 2-050 1 quart 2-060 1 gallon PRO SERIES PHOS PREVENT — Reduces phosphates in swimming pools to help prevent algae growth. Dosage: As required to remove phosphates. Maintenance dosage: 1 oz. per 6,000 gallons of pool water. 2-095 1 quart 2-096 1 gallon SEAKLEAR PHOSPHATE REMOVER — Commercial Strength - Removes phosphates from water that provide food source for algae growth. Nontoxic - 100% safe for patrons and environment. Dosage: 1 quart removes up to 9,000 ppb of orthophosphates in 10,000 gallons of water. 2-091 1 quart 2-092 1 gallon 2-093 5 gallon PHOSPHATE REMOVER CONCENTRATE Highly concentrated solution formulated to react with phosphates. Helps prevent interference with chlorine sanitizing and disinfection. NSF Listed. 2-136 1 quart 2-137 1 gallon 2-138 5 gallon www.lincolnaquatics.com Specialty Chemicals 2-100 SHOCK TREATMENT OXY-BRITE — Non-chlorine shock treatment eliminates eye burn and chlorine odor. Granular oxidizing agent “Burns out” organic material. Dissipates as oxygen. Contains no chlorine or calcium. Ideal for indoor pools that can't reach breakpoint chlorination and for facilities with pool covers where chlorine cannot exceed 1.5 ppm. Initial and weekly dosage: 1 lb. per 10,000 gallons. 2-100 20 lb. bottle 2-108 50 lb. drum 2-110 100 lb. drum 2-141 1-117 PULSAR POWER SHOCK — 78% available chlorine. Extra strength calcium hypochlorite based shock treatment. 1-117 25 lb. pail 2-115 2-125 2-140 PRO SERIES STAIN AND SCALE CONTROL — Stain and scale inhibitor deactivates calcium, iron, copper, and other minerals. Powerful inorganic chelating agent. Phosphate free and safe to bathers. Can be used on any pool surface and sanitizing system. Dosage: 32 oz. per 10,000 gallons. 2-140 1 gallon 2-141 5 gallon 2-155 2-145 SEAKLEAR NATURAL CLARIFIER — Clarifies cloudy water and removes excess oils and lotions. Will improve filter efficiency. Can be used with any sanitizer. Dosage: 1 oz. per 6,000 gallons. 2-145 1 quart 2-155 1 gallon 2-126 SEQUESTERING AGENTS SEQUA-SOL — Protects against stain formation, scale, and rust. Liquid. Initial treatment: 6 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Weekly dosage: 4 oz. per 10,000 gallons. 2-114 1 quart 2-115 1 gallon SUPER SEQUA-SOL — Granular. Prevents rust, stains, scale and corrosion. Initial treatment: 10 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Weekly dosage: 2 oz. per 10,000 gallons 2-125 20 lb. pail SCALE & METAL CONTROL — Award winning, phosphate free, and environmentally friendly. Controls metal staining and carbonate scale. Great for use on pool start-up and to prevent scale and stains on a maintenance basis. NSF Listed. 2-126 1 quart 2-127 1 gallon 2-128 5 gallons TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 3-005 3-025 WATER CLARIFIERS CLEAR BLUE — Highly concentrated water clarifier. Cleans cloudy water by helping the filter remove suspended particles. Reduces organic content of the water so you will use less chlorine. Adds sparkle back to pool water. Initial treatment: 4 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Weekly dosage: 1 oz. per 5,000 gallons. 3-005 1 quart 3-015 1 gallon DROP ’N VAC — Non-alum flocculent that settles floating debris and unfilterable material to pool bottom. Removes dead algae after algaecide treatment and pool opening cleanups. Dosage: 10 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Run pump for 2 hours, shut pump off overnight to let settle, vacuum to waste. 3-025 1 quart 3-260 SEAKLEAR PARTICLE REMOVAL SYSTEM Patented 2 stage Particle Removal System (PRS) enhances filter's ability to remove particles down to .5 microns. EPA approved to effectively trap Cryptosporidium (to 99.9%) and reduce outbreak risk. Also traps E. coli, reduces turbidity, removes oils, and helps clear cloudy pools. Works with sand, zeolite, DE, cellulose, and filter cartridges. Dosage: Stage 1 - add 4 oz. per 20,000 gallons, Stage 2 - add 4 oz. per 20,000 gallons, 6 hours after Stage 1 for best results. 3-255 1 quart kit (2 quarts) 3-260 1 gallon kit (2 gallons) NOTE: See page 22 for Low Dosage Chemical Feed Pumps. 7 Specialty Chemicals 3-053 3-200 POOL FIRST AID — The pool problem solver. Gets rid of scum build-up, waterline ring, cloudy water, clogging filters, and chemical odors. Includes electrolyte polymer clarifier for quick results. Dosage: 2 oz. per 1,000 gallons. 3-053 2 liter bottle (67.6 oz.) SPA CHEMICALS FOAM OUT — A food grade anti-foam agent. Effectively cuts down foam and prevents foam buildup. Dosage: 1⁄2 teaspoon per treatment maximum. Wait 10-15 min. before repeating. 3-200 1 quart 3-210 1 gallon 3-300 PULSAR CRS PULSAR CRYPTO REMOVAL SYSTEM (CRS) Pulsar CRS should be an integral part of your risk management program for preventing recreational water illnesses. Efficiently traps Cryptosporidium by increasing the filter's capacity to capture Crypto oocysts. Additionally, CRS improves water clarity by reducing turbidity in the water. Also reduces fouling of controller probes by removing oils from the water and improves the efficiency of UV Systems. Effectively flocs oils and other debris from pool water, which reduced chlorine demand. Works with all types of filters - sand, Zeolite, DE, cartridge, and cellulose. Dosages are based on bather load and current water conditions. Low dose chemical feed pump is used for continuous feed, ordered separately. Available in California, Northern Nevada, Western Washington, and Oregon. 3-300 5 gallon - Pool 3-305 55 gallon - Pool 10-165 Pool 2000 - 9.6 GPD @ 30 psi ENZYMES NATURAL CLEAR — Natural enzyme scum remover for pools and spas. Digests oils, lotions, and other organic material. Initial treatment: Pool - 16 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Spa - 1 oz. per 500 gallons. Weekly dosage: Pool - 8 oz. per 10,000 gallons. Spa-1 oz./500 gallons. 3-035 1 quart 3-045 1 gallon 8 3-320 3-035 ENZYME WATER CLEANER — 100% natural formula reduces organics to create optimal water clarity. Unique, stabilized liquid enzyme system that effectively digests non-living organic contaminates commonly found in swimming pools and spas. NSF Listed. 3-320 1 quart 3-321 1 gallon 3-322 5 gallon PROTECT PLUS — Dual purpose liquid concentrate which acts as protection against staining and scale formation and as a flocculating/clarifying agent to keep spa water sparkling. Initial treatment: 2 ozs. per 250 gallons. Weekly dosage: 1 oz. per 250 gallons. 3-220 1 gallon SELF-FLOCCING DEFOAMER — Dual action defoamer and chitosan polymer flocculant in one. Eliminates foam and gathers unwanted oils without clogging filter. 3-212 1 quart 3-050 PRO SERIES PRO ZYMES POOL — Natural enzyme based formula powerfully biodegrades organics. Ensures sparkling pool water, lengthens filter cycles, and eliminates waterline and scum deposits. Initial dosage: 1 oz. per 1,000 gallons. Maintenance dosage: based on bather load. Refer to bottle for dosages. 3-050 1 gallon 3-052 5 gallon NOTE: See page 22 for low dosage chemical feed pumps. 3-212 3-250 PRO SERIES PRO ZYMES SPA — Specially formulated for high-use, hot water environments. Patented enzyme formula breaks down and helps remove organic waste. Dramatically improve water and air quality while reducing labor and chemical usage. Dosage: 1 oz. per 100 gallons. 3-248 1 gallon 3-250 5 gallon www.lincolnaquatics.com Specialty Chemicals REMOVIT — Removes and prevents stains caused by iron, copper, cobalt and manganese. Nontoxic. Continued use will protect equipment from scale and rust. Dosage: 1 lb. per 10,000 gallons. Maintenance dosage: 1 lb. per 10,000 gallons every 8 weeks. 3-155 2 lb. bottle STAINLESS STEEL CLEANERS SPECTRA-CLEAN ™ STAINLESS STEEL CLEANERS — Periodic passivation is required to ensure the corrosion resistance of stainless steel products. Available in three stages for weekly maintenance and varying levels of corrosion. Item 3-115 TILE CLEANERS SCUMOFF TILE CLEANER — Thick formula removes dirt, body oil, and suntan lotion from pool tile and waterline areas. 3-106 1 quart 3-108 1 gallon SCALE-B-GON — Removes scale and calcium deposits from tile and vinyl surfaces. Jelly thick formula stays on vertical surfaces. 3-115 1 quart 3-125 1 gallon 3-080 3-240 3-155 CLEAN AND PERFECT — Citrus based enzyme cleaner effectively breaks down organic contaminants such as grease, grime, oils and lotions...allowing dirt to be released. Can be used on decks, tile and patio furniture. 100% non-toxic/biodegradable and will not effect pool chemistry. 3-240 22 oz. spray bottle 3-245 5 gallon 3-100 TLC — Liquid tile cleaner removes, grime, oils, and water line ring in one operation. Works on tile, fiberglass, and acrylic pool surfaces. 3-080 1 quart 3-090 1 gallon THICK TILE AND VINYL CLEANER — Removes oil and scum lines from tile and vinyl surfaces. Cleans grout lines, yet is non-abrasive and cleans down into pores to remove soils. Thick formula stays put on vertical surfaces. 3-100 1 quart FILTER CLEANERS 3-135 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Treatment 3-330 System 1 3-335 System 2 1 gallon 3-340 System 3 1 gallon Weekly Treatment Mid-range corrosion Severe corrosion 3-189 3-182 METAL POLISHING SCRUBS — Remove tarnish and oxidation quickly and easily. Polishes, brightens and protects. Prevents water marks and corrosion. Preserves the high luster of stainless steel and other surfaces. 3-182 Scrubs, 18 towel pack 3-183 Towels, 30 towel dispenser SHEILA SHINE — World's finest stainless steel polish and surface preservative. Removes greasy film and water marks. 3-187 10 oz. aerosol can 3-188 1 quart 3-189 1 gallon CELL PROTECT — Prolongs life of chlorine generator. Prevents scale and buildup on the cells. Formula contains enzymes, clarifiers, and sequestering agents. Initial dosage: 1 liter per 20,000 gallons. Maintenance dosage: 1 liter per 20,000 gallons per month. 3-275 1 liter 3-275 SURFACE CLEANERS COBALT CURE — Removes cobalt spots without draining. Will stop the recurrence of spots when used as a maintenance product. 3-145 2 lb. bottle Size 4 - 22 oz. bottles SPECIALTY CHEMICALS FILTER CLEANSE — Cleans sand filters, D.E. filter grids and filter cartridges. Removes scale, rust and oils. Restores filter efficiency by descaling and degreasing clogged and channeled filters. Dissolve 1 lb. in 5 gallons of water. 3-055 20 lb. pail HCL ADVANTAGE — For acid washing pools. Makes muriatic acid work better by reducing acid fumes. Thickens solution for longer clinging to vertical surfaces. Reduces acid run off and acid consumption. Sequestering ingredient prevents drain and bottom staining. Dosage: mix 1 part Acid to 4 parts water and add 8 oz. to every 21⁄2 gallons of acid solution. 3-135 1 quart Description 3-180 DECK CLEANERS 3-055 FILTERTRINE PRO — Reusable cartridge filter cleaner removes oils. Mixture: 1 part Filtertrine Pro to 4 parts water. Regenerate solution to reuse. Soak cartridges for 12-24 hours. 3-078 5 gallon KOOL DECK COMMERCIAL CLEANER — Two-step system restores original finish by removing dirt, stains, and mineral deposits. Safer than Muriatic Acid. Spot cleaning: 1 cup in 1 gal. water, cleans 90 sq. ft. General cleaning: 1 cup in 5 gal. water, cleans 100 sq. ft./gallon. 3-165 9 lb. pail CITRUS DEGREASER — Environmentally friendly Citrus Degreaser removes oils, grease, tar, and adhesives from any surface. 3-180 1 gallon 9 Chemical Control Systems CHEMTROL PC CONTROLLERS Chemical automation is now recognized as a must for proper treatment of swimming pools and spas. The controller initiates the addition of your sanitizer and pH control chemical based on need and maintains the level you select as your “desired” set point. Costly underfeeding and overfeeding is virtually eliminated. Helps preserve the life of your pool equipment and surfaces. Most facilities see a payback in one or two years. 5-033 5-021 The Chemtrol PC programmable controllers use advanced microprocessorbased technology to introduce a new standard of sophistication in automated water treatment. All the monitoring and control communication functions are incorporated into a single integrated command center. The main screen display enables the operator to supervise all the process functions at a glance and to quickly respond to any changing condition. Chemtrol PC options allow you to expand the parameters of your automation system for additional monitoring capabilities. CHEMTROL PC 6000/7000 CHEMTROL PC 6000/7000 — Incorporates automated control of water chemistry and filtration. Both the Chemtrol PC 6000 and PC 7000 controllers operate as the central command center for total equipment control and monitoring. These controllers add automated filter backwash control with programmable backwash schedules, influent and effluent pressure sensors, and filter cycle with six relays, for sequential filter backwashing of multiple filter tanks. Additionally, the Chemtrol 6000 and 7000 series controllers display ORP, sanitizer/PPM, pH, temperature, Langelier Saturation Index, circulation pump control, water level control, remote telephone/voice communication, and remote computer operation. The PC 7000 has the same features as the PC 6000 and adds true PPM control. Chemtrol PC 7100 has the same features as the PC 7000 except adds Dual PPM control for UV and Chloramine treatment. Includes: PC by-pass assembly and PC sensor cell cabinet. Additional options listed below. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-021 Chemtrol PC 6000 5-050 Chemtrol PC 7000 5-055 Chemtrol PC 7100 CHEMTROL PC 3000/5000 CHEMTROL PC 3000/5000 — Displays ORP, sanitizer/PPM, pH, temperature, and Langelier saturation index. All functions can be easily modified through a series of submenus including probe calibration, automatic probe cleaning, diagnostic probe monitoring, proportional feed, automatic superchlorination, energy saver and water chemistry saver programs and RS-485 communication port for data download capabilities. PC 5000 has same features as PC 3000, except adds true PPM control. Chemtrol PC 5100 has the same features as the PC 5000 except adds Dual PPM control for UV and Chloramine treatment. Includes: PC by-pass line assembly with PC safety flow switch, ORP, pH and temperature probes. Acrylic sensor cell cabinet ordered separately. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-006 Chemtrol PC 3000 5-040 Chemtrol PC 5000 5-045 Chemtrol PC 5100 CHEMTROL PC CONTROLLER OPTIONS Options PPM Control Option PPM Display TDS/Conductivity/Temp. Monitoring Temperature Control Flow Monitoring Water Level Control Influent/Effluent Pressure Monitoring Additional Common Options Ethernet/Internet/Remote 4-20 mA (5 Channels for display outputs) RS-485 Direct Computer Operation 10 7000 6000 5000 3000 2100 incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. 5-345 incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. 5-315 incl. 5-320 5-325 5-330 5-003 incl. 5-014 incl. 5-018 5-016 5-019 5-002 5-004 5-008 5-009 5-023 • • 5-007 5-265 5-290 5-260 5-270 5-295 5-262 5-275 5-300 5-015 5-280 5-305 5-017 5-285 5-310 7000 6000 5000 3000 2100 CHEMTROL PC 2100 CHEMTROL PC 2100 — ORP and pH control, remote alarm and RS-232 communications port for data history download capabilities. Offers new 8 line display with option for true PPM control. Includes flow cell assembly and paddle wheel flow switch. PC Sensor cell cabinet ordered separately. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-036 Chemtrol PC 2100 CHEMTROL 250/255 5-022 CHEMTROL 250/255 — Chemical control system for use on small pools or spas. Maintains ORP and pH. Chemtrol 255 has same features as Chemtrol 250, except offers true PPM control instead of ORP. All front panel adjustments include desired set-points, proportional feed, out-of-range indicating lights and safety feed lock-out. 110 volt. Includes: flow cell assembly and paddle wheel flow switch. By-pass line assembly ordered separately. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-022 Chemtrol 250 5-025 Chemtrol 255 NOTE: See page 11 for Chemtrol by-pass line assemblies and parts. www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemical Control Accessories 5-070 CHEMTROL ACCESSORIES TEK™ CHEMISTRY CONTROL CENTER — Panel mount your chemistry controller, by-pass line assembly and chemical feed pumps or CO2 feed unit on our convenient chemistry control center. Includes: 36"W x 24"H panel, pre-plumbing of by-pass line assembly, electrical prep, and mounting of your chemistry components (ordered separately). Contact us for your individual system needs. Can be used with any brand controller or chemical feed components. 5-230 TEK™ Control Center-Chemtrol 250 5-235 TEK™ Control Center-Chemtrol 2100 5-240 TEK™ Control Center-Chemtrol 3000 5-245 TEK™ Control Center-Custom CHEMTROL BY-PASS LINE ASSEMBLY 5-083 BY-PASS LINE ASSEMBLY — Schedule 80 by-pass line assembly. Complete 1⁄2" package includes: valves, "Y" strainer, in-line flow meter, safety flow switch and acrylic sensor cell. 5-083 By-pass line Assembly 5-080 By-pass line Assembly (2100) CHEMTROL BY-PASS LINE PARTS 5-127 ACRYLIC SENSOR CELL — Acrylic see-thru sensor cell for ORP and pH probes. Available with standard 1⁄2" threads for Chemtrol probes or 3⁄4" threads for use with HP probes. 5-127 Acrylic Senor Cell, 1⁄2" 5-128 HP Acrylic Senor Cell, 3⁄4" BY-PASS LINE ASSEMBLY PARTS — Parts for Chemtrol 1⁄2" by-pass line assembly. 5-095 In-line "Y" strainer 5-100 Replacement "Y" strainer filter 5-105 In-line flow meter, 1⁄2" 5-117 Rotary safety flow switch, 2100 5-118 Rotary safety flow switch, digital 5-119 Rotary safety flow switch, analog 5-120 Blade safety flow switch, analog Item Flow Control Ball Valve Compression Fitting (probe) Union (SOC) 1⁄2" Sample Tap Sch. 40 Sch. 80 92-2622-005 92-2122-005 5-115 5-115 92-457-005 92-1078002 92-897-005 92-1078002 5-081 5-075 5-076 5-077 5-085 CHEMTROL PROBES — Chemtrol probes include a 10' cable and have a 1 Year Warranty. Use with 1⁄2" sensor cell or 1⁄2" probe fitting. 5-070 ORP Probe 5-075 pH Probe 5-076 Temperature Probe 5-077 Temp./TDS Probe 5-085 PPM Probe, new style CHEMTROL PPM PROBE PARTS 5-092 Replacement PPM Membrane 5-093 Replacement PPM Gel CONTROLLER ACCESSORIES CALIBRATION RECORD TAGS — Allows you to have a running record of equipment calibration dates. Size: 51⁄4" x 25⁄8". (Package of 5). 5-141 CHEMTROL PORTA-PROBE — Portable signal tester for testing of Chemtrol unit and probes. Tests ORP, pH, Temperature, and TDS probes. 31/2" LCD digital display. 9 volt battery included. 5-130 9-050 5-150 SOLENOID VALVES 5-082 5-123 SENSOR CELL CABINET — Lockable fiberglass cabinet to protect probes. Includes: acrylic see-thru sensor cell. Houses Chemtrol ORP and pH probes and plumbing fittings. By-pass line assembly ordered separately. 5-123 Sensor cell cabinet 5-124 HP sensor cell cabinet TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 CONTROLLER PROBES CHEMTROL HP PROBES — New heavy duty industrial grade probe with exclusive Chemtrol 2 Year Warranty. HP Probes include a 10' cable. Can be used with existing Chemtrol controllers with addition of an HP Acrylic Sensor Cell. Size: 3⁄4" MPT. 5-081 ORP HP Probe 5-082 pH HP Probe PLASTOMATIC SOLENOID VALVE — Watertight valve for chlorine gas service and installation into vacuum line. 3⁄4" FPT, normally closed. 110 volt. 5-145 EROSION SOLENOID VALVE — Solenoid for water service, normally closed. Use with erosion feeders. 1" FPT with 3⁄4" bushing. 120 volt. 5-150 CO2 SOLENOID VALVE — Use with Automatic Controllers on CO2 systems. 1⁄4" FPT. 110 volt. 9-050 11 Chemical Control Systems Remote Monitoring and Control 5-505 5-500 PROMINENT® DCM2 CONTROLLERS — The DCM2 Series controllers provide the same quality of product as the ProMinent DCM5 Series controllers. The use of the ProMinent controller can be used stand alone or can be fully interactive with Ethernet/IP interface. Allows for true remote monitoring and control of your pool or spa components via network enabled PC, smart phone, iPad (or similar tablet devise) which requires connection through your computer network or individual wireless IP address. The DCM2 controllers feature: 2 line LCD display, pH control, ORP control or PPM control, temperature control, and monitors system flow rates. Additional features include: PID (Proportion Integral Derivative) Pump Control to work with your VFD and Data Logging for record keeping and system performance validation online or via USB port. Inputs/Outputs: 2 x digital inputs, 3 x output/ control relays, 2 x assignable digital outputs. Includes: controller, flow cell assembly with pH, ORP or PPM, and temperature sensors, and HTML server with DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol), which allows the controller be connected to your network and communicate on an IP Network. The controller and flow cell assembly are mounted on a PVC back panel for ease of installation. NEMA 4X controller enclosure.120 v/ 60 Hz with battery backup. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-500 DCM 200 ORP Controller 5-501 DCM 200 PPM Controller PROMINENT® DCM5 CONTROLLERS — The DCM5 Series controllers are the perfect for selection for precision water quality control. The ProMinent DCM5 controller can be used stand alone or can be fully interactive with Ethernet/ IP interface. Allows for true remote monitoring and control of your pool or spa components via network enabled PC, smart phone, iPad (or similar tablet devise) which requires connection through your computer network or individual wireless IP address. The DCM5 controller features 2 line LCD display, pH control, ORP control, temperature control, and monitors system flow rates. Additional features include: PID (Proportion Integral Derivative) Pump Control to work with your VFD and Data Logging for record keeping and system performance validation online or via USB port. Inputs/Outputs: 8 x digital inputs, 5 x output/control relays, 4 x assignable digital outputs. Includes: controller, flow cell assembly with pH, ORP, and temperature sensors, and HTML server with DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol), to communicate on an IP Network. Optional sensors: Free Chlorine, Total Chlorine, Calculated Combined Chlorine, Salt Generated Free Chlorine, Stabilized Free Chlorine, Bromine, Conductivity, Corrosion, Calcification, Flow Rate, and Water Level can be added. System further can monitor/control UV system, enzyme dosing, chemical tank levels, and system pressure. PPM probes for DCM 501 and DCM 502 package controllers are designed to be used on non-stabilized (CYA) water. PPM probe on DCM 503 is designed to be used on stabilized (CYA pools. DCM5 controller and flow cell assembly are mounted on a PVC back panel for ease of installation. NEMA 4X controller enclosure.120 v/ 60 Hz with battery backup. 5 Year Electronics Warranty. 5-505 DCM 500 Controller Package 5-510 DCM 501 Controller Package 5-515 DCM 502 Controller Package 5-525 DCM 503 Controller Package DCM5 SERIES CONTROLLER OPTIONS Options DCM2 with Panel Mount/By-Pass Assembly 12 pH ORP Temperature Free Chlorine PPM Total Chlorine PPM Combined Chlorine Display Controller Package 500 501 502 503 incl. incl. incl. • • incl. incl. incl. incl. • incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. • incl. • • incl. • DCM5 with Panel Mount/By-Pass Assembly 5-600 5-605 PROMINENT SENSORS & ACCESSORIES Item Description pH 5-600 PPM 5-601 ORP 5-605 ORP - Salt/Gold Tip 5-606 Temperature 5-615 Free Chlorine PPM 5-670 5-660 Free Chlorine PPM - Salt/CYA 5-690 Total Chlorine PPM - Indoor 5-665 Total Chlorine PPM - w/CYA Bromine PPM 5-655 Corrosion - Copper 5-675 Corrosion - Cupro Nickel 5-680 Corrosion - Stainless 5-681 Flow Rate - 1/2" - 4" 5-625 Flow Rate - 5" - 8" 5-630 Flow Rate - 10"+ 5-635 Liquid Level Sensor 5-620 3G Wireless Service 5-640 5-645 Wireless Antenna - 10 ft. cord 5-650 Wireless Antenna - 27 ft. cord Control Module 5-695 Wireless Router 5-700 Probe Code pH CLB3 ORP • SGT CLE3 CLO CTE1 CGE2 BRE1 • • • • • • • • • • • • www.lincolnaquatics.com Pulsar Chlorination Systems PULSAR CHLORINATION SYSTEMS PULSAR CHLORINATION SYSTEMS — The New Pulsar Chlorination Systems are simple and easy to use. They utilize Pulsar Plus Calcium Hypochlorite Briquettes to provide consistent, dependable pool water chlorination. The Patented Pulsar Plus chemical formula includes a scale inhibitor to reduce the scale normally associated with calcium hypochlorite and improves filter efficiency. The Pulsar System will give you cleaner, clearer water, less hassle and longer pool and equipment life. TDS buildup with Pulsar Plus is less than half that of bleach. It’s the only sanitation method that chlorinates, removes organics and metals, boosts hardness and shock threats, all in one process. In addition, you’ll need less acid to control pH. It takes two and a half times as much acid to maintain proper pH in a bleach pool due to the caustic stabilizers in bleach. All internal components are easily accessible with external components mounted on front of feeder. New PLC based Control Box, with touch screen interface, controls booster pump for optimal efficiency, with new self cleaning wash down feature. The Patented Pulsar 45, Pulsar 140 and Pulsar 500 feeders are sized for every size pool. Feeders are installed in their own by-pass loop, downstream from pool filters and pool heater. Systems include: fully operational system with feeder, 1 HP booster pump, PLC Control Box, venturi injector, solenoid valve, paddle wheel flow switch, and plumbing kit. NSF Listed. Available in California, Northern Nevada, Western Washington and Oregon. Item Description 8-020 Pulsar 45 Chlorination System 8-025 Pulsar 140 Chlorination System 8-030 Pulsar 500 Chlorination System Briquette Storage Capacity 25 lbs. 100 lbs. 300 lbs. Lid Switch Wash Down Nozzle Grid Screen Spray Manifold High Level Sensor Sealed Junction Box Discharge Valve Assembly Feed Rate/lbs. Min. Max. 3.0 8.0 24.0 58.0 163.0 486.0 PULSAR PLC CONTROL BOX TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 13 Pulsar Parts & Accessories PULSAR 1 PARTS Diagram Number 8-001 PULSAR 1 CHLORINATION SYSTEM — Designed specifically for smaller commercial pools and spas. The Pulsar 1 Feeder provides consistent, dependable water chlorination and is capable of high feed rates. Uses unique "wave" erosion method to dissolve Pulsar Plus Briquettes. Improves your pool/spa water clarity, color, and sparkle. The Pulsar 1 Feeder is installed on the discharge side of your pool/ spa mechanical equipment, to safeguard your pool systems. The feeder holds 27 pounds of Pulsar Plus Briquettes and has the ability to feed up to 25 pounds of available chlorine per day. Minimum feed rate is .5 pounds per day. System includes: Pulsar 1 Chlorinator, 11/2" venturi, and standard installation accessories. Use Automation Kit with controller. Kit includes: solenoid with transformer and 15' cord. 131/2"W x 151/2"D x 31"H. NSF Listed. 8-001 Pulsar 1 Chlorination System 8-015 Pulsar 1 Automation Kit 1 2 3 4 5 6/7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 — Part Number 93-74066 93-74065 93-74068 93-74067 93-74062 93-79804 93-71496 93-71910 93-74059 93-71619 11-060 93-71535 93-71538 93-71540 93-71539 93-71536 93-71537 93-79804 93-71583 93-71890 93-71614 93-71588 93-74060 11-065 93-74061 93-71611 93-71974 93-74145 93-71971 Description P1 Base P1 Hopper P1 Grid P1 Lid P1 Dissolving Cup with Nozzle Assembly Discharge Valve Assembly Emergency Shut Off Valve Assembly - Part 71910 Not Included Rubber Gasket for Emergency Shut Off Valve Parker Fitting W6FE4 Elbow (W6ME6) 3/8" For Feeders 30991 & P3, P1, PL AF300, CCH Poly Tubing, 3/8", per foot Emergency Shut Off Valve with Arm Only Emergency Shut Off Float Plate PVC Nut/Discharge Arm Nut Emergency Shut Off Overflow Float Emergency Shut Off Float Plate Emergency Shut Off Mounting Plate Emergency Shut Off Mounting PVC Screws (1/4 x 20 x 2 1/4) Discharge Valve Float Discharge Valve Locknut Parker Fitting, W8MC8 (also for solenoid) Tube Connector (P8MC4) for P3, PL AF300, CCH 1/2" x 1/2" Female Connector (P8FC8) Flow Indicator - P1 Poly Tubing, 1/2", per foot 1/2" FNPT x 1/2" FNPT PVC Ball Valve 1/2" x close PVC Nipple ORP/Below Grade Installation Kit for Small Feeder (includes venturi) Cleaning Pan for Small Feeder (not pictured) Venturi only for Small Feeder NOTE: The most commonly used parts are listed here inquire for additional parts you require. 3 4 2 3-300 PULSAR CRYPTO REMOVAL SYSTEM (CRS) Pulsar CRS should be an integral part of your risk management program for preventing recreational water illnesses. Efficiently traps Cryptosporidium by increasing the filter's capacity to capture Crypto oocysts. Additionally, CRS improves water clarity by reducing 12 turbidity in the water. Also reduces fouling of controller probes by removing oils from the water and improves the efficiency of UV Systems. Effectively flocs oils and other debris from pool water, which reduced chlorine demand. Works with all types of filters - sand, Zeolite, DE, cartridge, and cellulose. Dosages are based on bather load and current water conditions. Low dose chemical feed pump is used for continuous feed, ordered separately. Available in California, Northern Nevada, Western Washington, and Oregon. 3-300 5 gallon - Pool 3-305 55 gallon - Pool 10-165 Pool 2000 - 9.6 GPD @ 30 psi 17 13 22 25 23 5 24 10 16 25 14 1 23 21 25 9 11 26 27 (not included) 23 15 12 11 28 12 17 11 13 14 19 18 16 8 8 6 18 20 A 14 9 8 7 15 (not included) A 20 14 www.lincolnaquatics.com A 14 19 Detail E 34 33 Pulsar Parts & Accessories Pulsar® 4 Detailed View Detail E PULSAR 3 PARTS 1 34 Diagram Part Number Number 33 3 37 Detail E 34 33 2 1 69 38 2 39 4 3 5 4 37 38 39 37 8 71 38 see Detail A 19 30 18 40 39 6 7 8 6 7 Detail of 25 5 4 64 50 9 36 10 2 ft needed 41 11 77 Detail of 25 7 35 23 see Detail E 20 27 43 Detail of 25 41 74 77 79 78 40 PULSAR 4 PARTS 41 Diagram 77 Part Number Number 1 2 43 3 4 5 6 7 8 11 18 19 23 25 26 27 30 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 43 50 64 68 73 74 77 -- 43 12 79 40 79 Description 74 79 93-71879 Lid for Pulsar 4 Feeder 78 79 93-71880 Shut Off Assembly for Pulsar 4 Screen Assembly for 74 93-71881 Briquette Pulsar 4 79 93-71882 Screw for Pulsar 4 Lid 78 93-71883 Hinge Rod for Pulsar 4 Lid 93-71884 Pulsar 4 Hopper 93-71885 1Hex Nut5 Plastic Screw, /4"-20x /8" 93-71886 Mounting Plate for Spray Tree 93-71889 Lid Switch 93-71896 Electronic Shut Off 93-71897 Deflection Plate 11-060 Poly Tubing, 3/8", per foot 93-79217 Discharge Valve Sub-Assembly 93-71903 Discharge Tank 93-71904 Washdown Mounting Plate 93-71898 Parker Fitting (W8ME8) 93-71535 Emer. Shut Off Valve with Arm 93-71536 Emer. Shut Off Mounting Plate 93-71910 Rubber Gasket for Emergency Shut Off Valve 1 1 93-71749 Plastic Screws ( /4-20) 3 /4" for ESV (for Pulsar 4 only) 93-71539 Emer. Shut Off Float Plate 93-71538 Emer. Shut Off Float Plate PVC/Discharge Arm Nut 93-71540 Emer. Shut Off Overflow Float 93-79810 Discharge Valve Float 93-79806 Discharge Valve Body 93-79805 Discharge Valve Arm 93-71918 Parker Fitting (W10MC8) 11-068 Poly Tubing, 5/8", per foot 93-75860 8 - 32x5/8" PVC Screws (4) 93-72863 Discharge Valve Enh. Adaptor 93-79218 Check Valve (True Union) 93-71576 Discharge Valve Gasket - P4 93-79804 Discharge Valve Assembly TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 13 25 26 14 PULSAR SYSTEM ACCESSORIES Part Number 11 15 Description 8-011 Pulsar Venturi, 1" (P3) 8-012 Pulsar Venturi, 11/2" (P4 + P3) 8-013 Pulsar Venturi, 2" 93-79214 Pulsar 1 HP Booster Pump, (P4 + P3) 11-060 Poly Tubing, 3/8", per foot 11-065 Poly Tubing, 1/2", per foot 11-068 Poly Tubing, 5/8", per foot 93-71894 Pulsar Solenoid Valve, 1/2", 24V (P4 + P3) 8-040 Pulsar Plus Acid Cleaner, quart 49-057 Chemical Scoop NOTE: The most commonly used parts are Feeder Detailed View listedPulsar® here.3 Inquire for additional parts you require or visit our website. 16 17 18 19 20 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2 30 37 38 -- 3 4 Description 93-71608 Hinge Rod w/Set Screw for P3 Hopper 93-71607 Lid for P3 93-71609 Briquette Screen Assembly P3 93-71606 Hopper without Lid for P3 3 93-71619 Elbow (W6ME6) /8" for Feeders 30991 & P3 93-71617 Spray Nozzle for P3 93-79047 Manifold for P3 93-71620 Deflection Plate Assembly 93-71610 Base without Assembled Parts for P3 93-79806 Discharge Valve Body 93-71536 Emergency Shut Off Mounting Plate 93-71535 Emergency Shut Off Valve with Arm Only Emergency Shut Off 93-71537 Mounting PVC Screws (1/4-20x4) 93-71539 Emer. Shut Off Float Plate 93-71538 Emer. Shut Off Float Plate PVC Nut/Dischrge Arm Nut 93-71540 Emer. Shut Off Ovrflow Float 93-71496 Emer. Shut Off Valve Assembly - part 71910 not included 93-71583 Discharge Valve Locknut 93-71613 (4026) O-ring #115-used in plug 93-71612 Plug for Feeder Body for P3 93-79805 Discharge Valve Arm 93-79810 Discharge Valve Float 93-71614 Tube Connector(P8MC4) P3 93-71621 1/2" Ball Valve MM (inlet) 11-065 Poly Tubing, 1/2", per foot 93-71627 1/2" Ball Valve MF (outlet) 1 1 93-71588 (5008) /2"x /2" Female Connector (P8FC8) 93-71611 1/2" x PVC Nipple 93-71910 Rubber Gasket for Emergency Shut Off Valve 93-72864 P3 Enhancement Kit 93-79217 Discharge Valve Sub-Assy. 93-79804 Discharge Valve Assembly 1 24 26 28 25 5 17 7 6 8 9 30 28 26 13 29 28 27 47 37 20 19 48 18 47 38 18 46 15 Venturi & Erosion Feeders 8-050 8-120 VENTURI FEEDERS THE SOLUTION FEED SYSTEM — Sodium hypochlorite venturi feeder eliminates all parts, labor, and hassles associated with chemical feed pumps. The Solution feeder utilizes patented, vacuum induction technology rather than pressure. Venturi mixes chlorine thoroughly in the water, which reduces chloramines by providing continuous breakpoint chlorination. Maintains set point even in the heaviest demand periods. Adjustable feed rate from 0 to 1728 GPD. To be used with automatic chemistry controller. Includes: venturi, flow meter, pressure gauge, solenoid valve, "Y" strainer, isolation valves, clear PVC piping, 12" x 24" PVC mounting board and wall mounting kit. Feeder comes fully assembled and ready for plumbing. Booster pump ordered separately. Overall size: 15"W x 27"H. 120 volt. 2 Year Warranty. NSF Listed. 8-120 8-077 8-076 8-078 HIGH CAPACITY CHLORINE/BROMINE FEEDERS — Commercial grade erosion feeder is designed to be installed permanently with 1" PVC plumbing. High capacity feeders hold 15, 30, or 40 lbs. of Trichlor tablets or Bromine tablets. Tablets dissolve by passing water through the tablet chamber and eroding the tablets. Features include external dial control, drain valve, union connections, and easy access lid for refilling. NSF Listed. Item Capacity 8-076 8-077 8-078 8-085 8-090 15 lb. 30 lb. 40 lb. Maximum Output Rate (lbs./hr.) Chlorine FREE STANDING EROSION FEEDERS Automatic Chlorine/Bromine feeders work on pressure side of pump and are installed downstream of pool equipment. Will feed 3" Trichlor Tablets or smaller sized Trichlor/ Bromine tablets. Spa chamber option limits feed rate on 19" feeder for small bodies of water and holds 1⁄2 lb. of 1" tablets. 29" commercial feeder utilizes 1⁄ 2" tubing for increased waterflow and feed rates of up to 8.05 lbs. in 24 hrs. NSF Listed. Item CHLORINE/BROMINE FEEDERS Bromine 1.22 .57 2.00 1.15 4.15 1.73 Flow Rate Indicator, 1" In-Line Check Valve, 11/2" / 2" 16 Description Tablet Cap. (lbs.) Small Large 19" Feeder 5.5 8.8 8-050 .5 8-055 19" with Spa Chamber 29" Feeder 9.8 12.7 8-060 12.7 8-065 29" Commercial Feeder 9.8 Commercial Flow Indicator, 1/2" 8-080 In-Line Check Valve, 1/2" 8-095 IN-LINE EROSION FEEDERS — Designed for permanent installation into PVC line downstream from pool equipment. Feeders are designed to handle 3" Trichlor tablets or smaller sized Trichlor/Bromine tablets. Includes installation hardware with 2" slip PVC fittings. Spa chamber option limits feed rate for small bodies of water. NSF Listed. Item 8-070 8-075 8-080 8-090 8-125 THE SOLUTION X-2 FEED SYSTEM — Dual purpose feeder is designed to feed either acid for pH/Alkalinity control or sodium hypochlorite for smaller volume pools (less than 50,000 gallons). The Solution X-2 feeder utilizes patented, vacuum induction technology. Maintains desired set points even during the heaviest demand periods. Adjustable feed rate from 0 to 197 GPD. To be used with automatic chemistry controller. Includes: venturi, flow meter, pressure gauge, solenoid valve, "T" strainer, tubing, check valve strainer, isolation valves, PVC housing, and wall mounting kit. Booster pump ordered separately. Overall size: 15"W x 30"H. 120 volt. 1 Year Warranty. NSF Listed. 8-125 8-070 Description Tablet Cap. (lbs.) Small Large In-line Feeder 3.5 4.8 In-line Feeder with .5 Spa Chamber 1 Commercial Flow Indicator, /2" In-Line Check Valve, 11/2" / 2" 8-145 8-150 NOTE: See page 10 and 12 for automatic chemical controllers. FLOATING CHEMICAL DISPENSER — Linear polyethylene construction, foam filled for added buoyancy. Twist lock cap with adjustable chlorinating control ring. Holds six 3" tablets or 3 lbs. of 1" tablets. 36" floating accessory leash with molded anchor plate and pressure sensitive pad ordered separately. 8-145 Floating chemical dispenser 8-150 Floating accessory leash www.lincolnaquatics.com Chlorine Generators & UV Systems 9-485 8-210 9-470 LOW PRESSURE UV DISINFECTION SYSTEMS CHLOR KING CHLORINE GENERATORS Nex-Gen chlorine generators produce liquid chlorine from salt. On-site chlorine production eliminates the need to store large amounts of chlorine and doesn't generate the odors associated with liquid pool bleach. The NexGen unit is a stand alone, on-site chlorine generator capable of producing pH neutral chlorine for use in your pool. Reduces acid consumption by 30 - 50% versus a bleach fed pool. These commercial quality generators use swimming pool water to feed the generator and distribute chlorine to the pool as needed. Uses venturi feed system for supply of chlorine to the pool and can be used with any ORP or PPM swimming pool controller. This system does not put salt into the swimming pool and will not raise TDS levels, like other chlorine generators. Touchscreen display with built in safety sensors for air, water, pressure, and tank level. Max amperage of 24 amps requires installation of 40 amp breaker. Skid mounted for easy installation. Requires plumbing vent line for Hydrogen dissipation. Units available that produce from 20 PPD (equivalent to 20 gallons of 12% pool bleach) in 24 hours to 80 PPD (equivalent to 80 gallons of 12% pool bleach) in 24 hours. Can feed up to five bodies of water from one system with venturis. Multiple units can be use for larger facilities. Available to be used as primary chlorine supply with traditional liquid chlorine or use with calcium hypochlorite feeders as back up. Excellent product to use when you have limited delivery or storage options for chemical supply. 208240v, single phase, 60 Hz. ETL/NSF Listed. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 8-200 CHLOR KING ULTRAVIOLET DISINFECTION SYSTEMS — Designed for commercial pools and spas. Uses low pressure, high output amalgam technology, for better chloramine control and inactivation of chlorine resistant bacteria. Improves water quality and air quality for patrons. Also helps meet new Health Codes related to maximum chloramine levels. Systems pay for themselves through low cost of operation and long lasting performance. System uses UV technology to achieve 4 log reduction for the inactivation of cryptosporidium and other chlorine resistant bacteria. Designed with a patent pending quick disconnect sleeve assembly for install, removal, or repair of the chamber. Units can be installed horizontally or vertically in most pump rooms. Constructed of schedule 80 PVC with 316L interior in U-style or full 316L stainless steel that is electro polished and available in U or Z style flange set up. High output amalgam lamps, built in safety sensors for pressure or flow, with flanged inlet and outlet connections. All units operate on 120v. NSF 50 and UL Listed. Item Item PPD Production 8-200 8-205 8-210 20 PPD 40 PPD 80 PPD Skid Dimensions (L x W x H) Weight (lbs.) 48" x 28" x 68" 950 48" x 28" x 68" 1,000 76" x 32" x 69" 1,250 Model Flow Rate Connection @ 45 mj/ Size cm2 Lamps CHLORINE GENERATORS 2" 9-465 SAG-120-APVC 1 3" 9-470 SAG-240-APVC 2 2" 9-475 SAG-120-A 1 3" 9-480 SAG-240-A 2 4" 9-485 SAG-480-A 4 6" 9-490 SAG-720-A 6 9-491 SAG-960-A 8 6" or 8" 9-492 SAG-1200-A 10 8" or 10" 75 GPM 150 GPM 50 GPM 120 GPM 350 GPM 620 GPM 770 GPM 1140 GPM 17 UV Systems MEDIUM PRESSURE UV DISINFECTION SYSTEMS PROMINENT ULTRAVIOLET DISINFECTION SYSTEMS — Improve water quality at your facility by installing a state-of-the art UV System. The primary action of UV is to initiate photochemical and photo oxidation reactions which destroy chloramines and bacteria. These compounds are responsible for the unpleasant smells in pools and spas. This is particularly important for indoor pools where features such as water slides and wave pools have a greater surface area for the release of chloramines into the air. UV reduces the chloramine load, making the atmosphere safer and more pleasant. Additionally, UV kills bacteria, viruses, and mold spores, reducing the risk of transmission of stomach, skin and respiratory tract infections to bathers. UV is part of the electro-magnetic spectrum, which includes visible light. Concentrated sunlight contains UV, which is a powerful natural disinfectant. Benefits include: • Reduces chloramine levels to well below .2 PPM. • Reduces corrosive atmosphere inside building environment, dramatically improving air quality and virtually eliminates respiratory problems associated with chloramines. • Eliminates 99.9% of all water borne viruses and bacteria, including chlorine resistant Cryptospoidium. Item Model 9-550 9-555 9-560 9-565 9-570 9-575 9-580 9-585 9-590 9-595 1x1A 1x2A 1x3A 1x3A 2x2A 2x2A 2x3A 2x3A 3x3A 3x3A • Reduces the need to superchlorinate or “shock” the pool, and the subsequent downtime required with it. • Reduces operating costs by cutting down on chemical usage through reductions in chemical demand. • Reduces complaints of swimsuit fading, respiratory problems, and stomach discomfort. • Safe, non-hazardous, and environmentally sound; no additional chemicals required. The UV System requires very low maintenance. Once installed, only minor adjustments are made and an annual bulb change is required, which takes only a few minutes to accomplish. The unit is installed directly in the filtered water return line and treats the entire volume of pool water during recirculation. Systems are fully automated to insure correct UV dosage and alarmed for UV tube failure. Systems consist of: 316TL stainless steel Treatment Chamber with quartz UV lamps; Monitor, with process alarm, which provides continuous measurement of UV intensity; and Control Unit with UV intensity meter output indicators, alarms; and UV intensity meter output with real-time LCD display. UL and NSF Listed. Your Lincoln Representative can help size the proper UV System for your facility. Available in California, Nevada, Oregon, Indiana, and Florida. Inquire for availability in other states. Maximum Flow Rate (GPM) Outdoor 400 J/m2 Indoor 600 J/m2 437 765 1,531 1,531 2,041 2,041 3,061 3,061 4,592 4,592 292 510 1,030 1,030 1,360 1,360 2,041 2,041 2,061 2,061 Voltage Phase 208/240 208/240 480 208/240 480 208/240 480 208/240 480 208/240 1 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Lamp Quality Flange Power kW Size 1x1 1x2 1x3 1x3 2x2 2x2 2x3 2x3 3x3 3x3 4" 6" 8" 8" 8" 8" 10" 10" 12" 12" REPLACEMENT LAMPS 9-600 UV Lamp Powerline 1 kW, for UVA and UVS 9-606 UV Lamp Powerline 2 kW, for UVA 9-611 UV Lamp Powerline 3 kW, for UVA 9-650 Lamp Protection Tube, for 1x1A 9-655 Lamp Protection Tube, for 1x2A 9-660 Lamp Protection Tube, for 1x3A, 2x2A, 2x3A, 3x3A 9-635 Wiper Element (2 required per UV lamp), for UVA and UVS 18 www.lincolnaquatics.com Carbon Dioxide Systems 9-045 9-085 9-120 CARBON DIOXIDE DETECTOR ANALOX CARBON DIOXIDE DETECTOR — Monitors storage room for excess carbon dioxide levels. Audible warning alarm and light flashes on both remote indicator unit placed outside of room and main sensor unit mounted inside storage room. Range: 0.1- 5%. 110/240 VAC or 24 VDC. 9-120 CARBON DIOXIDE SYSTEMS TEK™ CARBON DIOXIDE SYSTEMS — CO2 is used to lower the pH in swimming pools. CO2 forms Carbonic Acid to help lower pH levels. CO2 generates a natural bicarbonate buffer that makes the water more stable and prevents the pH from dropping below 6.8. With Total Alkalinity at the proper levels, pH changes are very slow, and the pH is easier to maintain. Safe! Eliminates the use of Muriatic Acid. TEK™ AUTOMATIC SWITCHOVER SYSTEM Includes: wall mounted, automatic switchover regulator with pressure gauges, cylinder hoses, 20' CO2 tubing, and fittings. Pools without automatic chemistry control, require purchase of: TEK™ CO2 feed unit and CO2 diffuser with check valve, plus any additional CO2 tubing required, for each pool to be fed. Pools with automatic chemistry control, require purchase of: TEK™ CO2 solenoid valve or TEK™ CO2 feed unit with solenoid valve, and CO2 diffuser with check valve, plus any additional CO2 tubing required, for each pool to be fed. CO2 in-line heaters (120v) can be added to each cylinder being fed to reduce regulator freeze-up. Specify pool size(s) when ordering. 9-045CO2 system - Auto switchover TEK™ SINGLE TANK SYSTEM — Includes: single tank regulator with pressure gauge, CO2 feed unit with flow meter, CO2 diffuser with check valve, 20' CO2 tubing, and fittings. Pools with automatic chemistry control require purchase of TEK™ CO2 solenoid unit, plus any additional CO2 tubing required. 9-040CO2 system - Single tank 9-040 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 TEK™ CARBON DIOXIDE ACCESSORIES 9-050CO2 solenoid valve, 120 volt, 1⁄4" 9-055CO2 remote flow meter 9-060CO2 diffuser with check valve 9-061CO2 diffuser muffler 9-065CO2 tubing, per ft. 9-070CO2 teflon washers 9-075CO2 in-line heater 9-076CO2 stainless flex line, 24" 9-085 TEK™ CARBON DIOXIDE FEED UNITS — Convenient, wall mounted, Carbon Dioxide Feed Units used with single tank or automatic switchover regulators ordered separately. NEMA 4 fiberglass enclosure houses CO 2 solenoid valve only, CO2 feed unit only, or CO2 feed unit with solenoid valve. Order CO2 diffuser with check valve for each pool to be fed, separately. 120 volt. 9-079CO2 Solenoid Unit 9-080CO2 Feed Unit 9-085CO2 Feed Unit with Solenoid TEK™ CARBON DIOXIDE FEED SYSTEM System includes fiberglass NEMA 4 enclosure with CO 2 flow meter, CO 2 solenoid valve, 3/ 4 HP booster pump, and venturi. Available with cast iron or stainless steel booster pump, mounted on fiberglass base. Must be used with automatic chemical controller. Use one feed system for each pool. CO2 regulator (for each pool) ordered separately. 120 volt. 9-115 CO2 Feed System - cast iron pump 9-116CO2 Feed System - stainless pump 9-102 9-107 BULK STORAGE TANKS CARBON DIOXIDE BULK STORAGE TANKS Replaces need to store high pressure CO2 cylinders. Use of a bulk CO2 tank will do the job of eight or more CO2 cylinders and will require less floor space. Bulk tanks are permanently installed and do not require your employees to do cylinder changes or to move high pressure cylinders. Exterior fill box allows bulk tank to be filled conveniently. Double wall stainless steel vessels with stable 6" welded uni-body legs. Patented Sure-Fill system enables tank filling with no manual venting. Available in 2 sizes: 450 lbs. (20" dia.) and 750 lbs. (26" dia.) Bulk storage tanks include: tank with legs, external tank epoxy coating, easy-to-read gauges for CO2 contents and tank pressure, external remote fill box, and connecting fill/vent hoses. Item Description 9-102 Carbo-Mizer 450 9-107 Carbo-Max 750 Liquid Maximum Storage Continuous Capacity Feed Rate (lbs.) (lbs./Hr.) 453 771 5.5 15 19 Chemical Feed Pumps 10-650 PROMINENT ELECTRONIC SOLENOID PUMPS PROMINENT MOTOR DRIVEN PUMPS PROMINENT MULTIFUNCTION VALVE Back pressure, anti-siphon protection, pressure relief, priming aid, and for draining discharge line. PVDF materials with smooth action rotary knobs. Used with Beta pumps. 10-650 Multifunction valve, 1/2" PROMINENT INJECTION VALVES — For ProMinent series pumps. 10-500 PROMINENT CONCEPT PLUS FEED PUMPS Solenoid metering pumps with capacity range of 0.20 to 3.17 GPH at pressures up to 145 psi. Adjustment of the pump capacity is via the stroke length in the range of 10-100% or can be set at 1 of the 4 stroke frequency settings. This gives an adjustment ratio of 40:1. External control via dry contact pulse (1:1). Acrylic/ PVC liquid end materials. 115 volt, 60 Hz. NSF 50/61 Listed. Item Output 10-500 10-505 10-510 10-515 10-520 13 GPD @ 145 psi 17 GPD @ 145 psi 28 GPD @ 102 psi 51 GPD @ 44 psi 76 GPD @ 29 psi Tube Size 1/4" OD 1/4" OD 1/4" OD 3/8" OD 3/8" OD Spare Parts Kit 10-525 10-530 10-535 10-540 10-545 10-550 PROMINENT BETA FEED PUMPS — Solenoid metering pump capable of flows from 0.16 to 8.45 GPH and pressures to 363 psi. Feed rate is determined by stroke length and stroke frequency. Stroke length is adjusted from 0% to 100% with a 10:1 turndown. Stroke frequency is adjusted in 10% increments from 10-100. External contact input for pulse control with a range from 1:64 – 64:1. 110/230 volt, 60 Hz. NSF 61 Listed. Item Output Tube Size 10-550 120 GPD @ 58 psi 1/2" OD 10-555 109 GPD @ 58 psi 1/2" OD 10-560 203 GPD @ 29 psi 1/2" OD 20 Spare Parts Kit 10-565 10-570 10-525 10-600 Item Pump Series 10-725 10-730 10-735 10-740 10-745 Concept Concept Beta Sigma Sigma Valve Connection Size 1/4" 3/8" 1/2" 3/4" 3/4" PROMINENT SIGMA FEED PUMPS — Mechanically-actuated diaphragm pumps. Pumps are programmable and display comprehensive data for monitoring and recording. Functions include: digital setting of stroke frequency, manual stroke length adjustment, integral variable speed and access codes. Designed to be hard plumbed. 3/4" MPT connections, 115 volt, 60 Hz. NSF 61 Listed. Item Output 13.2 GPH (316.8 GPD) @ 102 psi 26.7 GPH (640.8 GPD) 10-605 @ 58 psi 41 GPH (984 GPD) 10-610 @ 145 psi 69.7 GPH (1,672.8 GPD) 10-615 @ 145 psi 10-600 Spare Parts Kit 10-675 10-620 10-620 10-630 10-635 10-695 PROMINENT ACCESSORIES PROMINENT WALL MOUNTING BRACKETS Two models available: Fiberglass reinforced model for Beta and Concept pumps and Polypro model for Sigma pumps. 10-695 Beta and Concept pumps 10-700 Sigma pumps 10-685 PROMINENT PULSATION DAMPENERS Used to separate air and liquid from chemical feed lines. Single-port model is teed off pump suction or discharge line. Dual-port model is mounted in the pump suction or pump discharge line. Viton materials for sodium hypochlorite and muriatic acid or PVDF/Nordel for sodium hydroxide (caustic) applications. Used with Sigma pumps. 10-675 Single Port Pulsation Dampener 10-680 Dual Port Pulsation Dampener PROMINENT PRESSURE VALVES — 2-Port Backpressure valve to provides constant discharge pressure for protection from siphoning. 3-Port Pressure Relief valve is mounted in discharge line and returns product back into source tank. Used with Concept and Beta pumps. 10-685 2-Port Backpressure valve, 1/2" 10-690 3-Port Pressure Relief valve, 1/2" www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemical Feed Pumps 10-025 10-070 ELECTRONIC CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS PULSATRON E PLUS FEED PUMPS — Electronic solenoid pump with stroke length and stroke speed control. 100:1 turndown ratio for accurate feed control. Clear hinged cover protects controls from moisture. PVC Head. Includes: injection fitting, 16' of tubing, and choice of standard bleed valve, 5 function valve with anti-siphon, or 5 function valve with degas (for sodium hypochlorite) and antisiphon. Specify chemical being used. 120 volt. ETL Listed. Maximum With Bleed With 5 F.V. with PSI Output Valve 5 F.V. Degas 12 GPD 24 GPD 44 GPD 120 GPD 192 GPD 100 100 100 100 50 10-050 10-055 10-060 10-065 10-070 10-051 10-056 10-061 10-066 10-071 10-052 10-057 10-062 10-067 10-072 LMI CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — Solenoid driven pump with variable speed and stroke length. Chemical resistant housing. Includes: 16' tubing, injection fitting, and foot valve. Specify chemical being used. P, A, and B Series pumps listed below use 3⁄8" tubing and C Series pumps use 1⁄2" tubing. 120 volt, 50/60 Hz. 4 Function Valves and AutoPrime Valves ordered separately. 2 Year Warranty. NSF Listed. Item 10-005 10-015 10-018 10-020 10-023 10-025 10-030 Maximum Pump PSI Output Series 10 GPD 110 24 GPD 110 24 GPD 110 48 GPD 50 48 GPD 50 108 GPD 50 192 GPD 60 P A P A P B C 10-290 10-275 PULSATRON A PLUS FEED PUMPS — Electronic solenoid pump with stroke length and speed control. 100:1 turndown ratio. PVC Head. Includes: injection fitting, 16' of tubing, and choice of standard bleed value, 5 function valve with anti-siphon, or 5 function valve with Degas (for sodium hypochloriite) and antisiphon. Specify chemical being used. 120 volt. ETL Listed. Maximum With Bleed With 5 F.V. with PSI Output Valve 5 F.V. Degas 12 GPD 150 24 GPD 100 48 GPD 50 10-245 10-260 10-275 10-250 10-265 10-280 10-255 10-270 10-285 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Priming Valve Not Included Not Included Not Included Not Included Not Included 3FV 3FV 10-040 LMI PRIMING VALVES LMI PRIMING VALVE ASSEMBLIES — Available in three styles. 3 Function Valve provides pressure relief, priming aid and line drain. 4 Function Valve adds anti-siphon protection. Specify pump model number when ordering. Valve Style 1/4" Tubing 3 Function Valve 10-031 4 Function Valve 10-034 3/8" Tubing 10-032 10-035 LMI SD SERIES FEED PUMPS — High output metering pumps with 10:1 turndown ratio. Mechanically actuated diaphragm pumps with manually adjustable stroke length. Totally enclosed 120 volt motor, with urethane coated cast housing. Pump heads have 1/ 4" NPT plumbing connections. 345.6 GPD pump only includes: liquid end kit with 4 function valve, foot valve, and injection check valve. Order pressure relief valve to protect pump separately. Specify chemical being used. NSF Listed. 10-290 10-291 10-292 Maximum Output 345.6 GPD 600 GPD 1200 GPD 10-033 10-040 10-292 MOTOR DRIVEN CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS Item 1/2" Tubing PSI 150 100 100 Pressure Relief Valve 10-283 10-284 10-284 10-300 LMI AUTOPRIME™ VALVES — Allows for constant removal of vapors and gasses inherent with sodium hypochlorite. Valve keeps pump automatically primed and functions as an airgap anti-siphon valve. Retrofitable to older style ball and seal ring pumps as well as new "LiquiPro™" cartridge style pumps. Specify pump model number when ordering. AutoPrime™ Valve Style Acrylic-LiquiPro PVC - LiquiPro PVC - Cartridge 1/4" Tubing 10-295 10-310 10-325 3/8" Tubing 10-300 10-315 10-330 1/2" Tubing 10-305 10-320 10-335 21 Chemical Feed Pumps 10-101 PERISTALTIC CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS STENNER CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — QuickPro Series single head, peristaltic metering pumps with unique control mechanism that allows pump feed rate to be scaled from 5%-100%. Built with three detachable components: motor, feed rate control and pump head. Output is determined by: motor rpm, percentage setting of feed rate control and pump tube size. 120v/60 Hz. 220v models also available. Includes: pump, spare pump tube, connecting nuts, ferrules, 20' suction/discharge tubing, injection fitting, weighted suction line strainer, latches, mounting bracket, and operations manual. Rain Roof for outdoor installation ordered separately. Adjustable models tested to conform to ANSI/NSF STD 50. Single Head Feed Tube Size 10-095 10-096 #2 #5 10-100 10-101 11-139 Maximum Output Total Output 45 M Series .5 - 10 GPD 10 GPD 2.5 - 50 GPD 50 GPD 85 M Series #2 .8 - 17 GPD 17 GPD #5 4.3 - 85 GPD 85 GPD Stenner Rain Roof 10-120 ROLA-CHEM CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — Peristaltic feed pump. Measured feed rate with built-in timing system, heavy-duty gear motor, self priming pumping with quick release cover for fast tubing access, and chemical resistant plastic housing. Includes: feed tube, 66" x 7/16" vinyl discharge tubing, and injection fitting. 120 volt, 60 HZ. NSF Listed. 10-115 12.0 GPD @ 30 psi 10-120 38.0 GPD @ 30 psi 10-125 77.0 GPD @ 30 psi 10-220 BLUE-WHITE CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — Peristaltic pump with new Tube Failure Detection System (TFD). Self priming with precise variable speed output control. Chemical resistant thermoplastic housing that's weather proof (NEMA3R) and heat resistant. Includes: foot valve with ceramic weight, injector fitting, two feed tubes and 10' of 3/8" tubing. Specify chemical being used. ETL/NSF Listed. 10-210 8.0 GPD @ 100 psi 10-215 16.0 GPD @ 100 psi 10-220 24.0 GPD @ 100 psi 10-230 52.5 GPD @ 50 psi 10-240 95.1 GPD @ 50 psi 10-150 LOW DOSAGE PERISTALTIC CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS STENNER ECON-T CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — Compact, easy to program pump for timed applications. Flexibility to schedule up to 24 separate events within a 7 day period. Features a 24 hr. integral clock that has a battery back-up to maintain the time of day. Automatic dosing control for reliable timed dispensing of low volume liquid solutions, such as enzymes or liquid solar blankets. Includes: pump, spare pump tube, 1/4" suction/ discharge tubing, injection fitting, weighted suction line strainer, mounting bracket, and operations manual. Additional output sizes available - inquire. 120v/60 Hz. For indoor use. NSF 61 Listed. Item 10-150 10-151 10-152 10-153 Output GPH .02 .05 .10 .21 Output GPD 0.6 1.3 2.5 5.0 PSI 80 80 25 25 10-110 STENNER CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — QuickPro Series dual head, peristaltic metering pumps. Same as single head pump features described above. 120v/60 Hz. 220v models also available. Includes: pump, spare pump tube, connecting nuts, ferrules, 20' x 3/8" suction/ discharge tubing, injection fitting, weighted suction line strainer, latches, and mounting bracket. Rain Roof for outdoor installation ordered separately. ANSI/NSF STD 50. Dual Head 10-105 10-106 10-109 10-110 11-139 22 Feed Tube Size Maximum Output Total Output 100 MDC Series #2 1.0 - 20 GPD 20 GPD #5 5.0 - 100 GPD 100 GPD 170 MDC Series #2 1.7 - 34.0 GPD 34 GPD #5 8.5 - 170.0 GPD 170 GPD Stenner Rain Roof 10-195 FLEX-PRO™ CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS High output chemical feed pumps by BlueWhite. Ideal pump for large commercial pools and water features. Outputs up to 33.3 GPH (799.2 GPD). Pressure rating to 125 psi, patented tube failure detection, NEMA 4X enclosure, multicolor LCD display, 2,500:1 turndown ratio, self-priming design, and easyto-access electronics with color coded overlays. 3/8" OD x 1/4" ID compression type tubing connections. 115 volt/60HZ. ETL/NSF Listed. Item 10-195 10-200 10-205 10-208 Output GPH .001 - 2.10 .008 - 19.0 .010 - 25.3 .013 - 33.3 Output GPD .024 - 50.4 .192 - 456 .24 - 607.2 .312 - 799.2 PSI 125 110 125 125 10-165 BETA CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS — Peristaltic, self priming chemical feed pumps. Easy to read liquid crystal display screen, allows you to program dose, delay, and lockout feed times. Water and UV resistant enclosure. Available in 2 styles: Pool Shot - for repeated dosage or controller activated cycles. Pool 2000 - low dosage pump with turndown rates as low as 1 second per day. 7 day clock allows programming up to 24 events per day, one day per week, all weekdays, all weekends, or daily events. 1/4" tubing connections. Includes battery back-up to protect dosage cycles. 115 volts. NSF Listed. 2 Year Warranty. 10-160 Pool Shot - 14 GPD @ 30 psi 10-165 Pool 2000 - 9.6 GPD @ 30 psi www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemical Feed Pump Parts & Accessories CHEMICAL FEED PUMP PARTS AND ACCESSORIES 11-010 LMI FEED PUMP PARTS AND ACCESSORIES LMI SPLASH GUARDS — 11-010 B & C Series Splash Guard PULSATRON KOP KITS — Pre-packaged liquid end maintenance kits provides convenient, economically priced package of parts required for routine maintenance. Kits include new valve cartridge, with "O" ring seal, head screws, and washers. Specify pump model number when ordering. 11-205 Kit #K3VTC1, for 12 GPD Pump 11-210 Kit #K4VTC1, 24/44/48 GPD Pump 11-215 Kit #K6VTC3, for 120 GPD Pump 11-220 Kit #K7VTC3, for 190 GPD Pump STENNER FEED TUBE ASSEMBLIES — Replacement feed tubes with 3/8" ends are interchangeable with all Stenner Feed Pumps. Tube #1 to #5 are selected based on desired pump output requirements. Available in packages of 2 tubes or 5 tubes. Tube Assembly #1 #2 #3 #4 #5 Package of 2 11-140 11-150 11-160 11-170 11-180 Package of 5 11-145 11-155 11-165 11-175 11-185 11-UCDBINJ 11-040 11-UCINJ38 11-015 LMI WALL MOUNTING BRACKET — ABS wall mounting bracket with hardware safely secures pump in place. 11-015 A, B, C Series Bracket 11-035 ROLA-CHEM REPLACEMENT FEED TUBE 11-035 ROLA-CHEM SILICONE GEL LUBRICANT 11-040 STENNER INJECTION CHECK VALVE ASSEMBLIES — For use with Stenner chemical feed pumps. 11-UCDBINJ 1/4" Check Valve 11-UCINJ38 3/8" Check Valve 11-UCAK100 Connect Nut, 1/4", pkg. of 10 11-MANUT00 Connecting Nut, 3/8", each 11-MCADPTR Lead Tube Adapter w/nut 3/8", pkg. of 5 11-UCAK200 Ferrule, 1/4", pkg. of 10 11-MCCVDB0 Duckbill, pkg. of 5 11-UCCVDB0 Duckbill, pkg. of 2 11-310 LMI MAINTENANCE KITS — Prepackaged rebuild kits for LMI chemical feed pump liquid ends. RPM Kits include: diaphragm, shaft seal, 4 screws, 3 clamp rings, 3 cartridge valve assemblies, and injection valve rebuild kit with spring. Specify pump model number when ordering. RPM MAINTENANCE KITS Item 11-017 11-018 11-019 11-021 11-022 11-026 11-027 LMI Part # RPM 392/398 RPM 362/368 RPM 312/318 RPM 822 RPM 832 RPM 102 RPM 135 Liquid End # 392, 398 362, 368 312. 318 822 832 SD 43 SD 72, SD 73 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 11-300 BLUE-WHITE FEED TUBES — Replacement chemical feed tubes for A-100N pumps and FlexPro pumps. Item 11-300 11-305 11-310 11-320 11-325 11-330 11-335 Pump Model # A-100N A-100N A-100N FlexPro FlexPro FlexPro FlexPro Tube Diameter 1/4" 3/8" 7/16" 3/4" 1/4" 39/125" 19/50" Vendor Tube Part # A-002N-4T A-002N-6T A-002N-7T A3-SND-T A3-SNH-T A3-SNJ-T A3-SNK-T 11-195 11-AK600 IN-LINE FLOW INDICATORS — In-line solution flow indicators installed on chemical feed pump suction tubing. Float rises as solution is drawn by the chemical feed pump. Blue White 11-190 11-195 Tubing Size 3/8" 1/4" Stenner 11-AK700 11-AK600 23 Chemical Feed Pump Parts STENNER FEED RATE ASSEMBLY PARTS Part Number Description 11-FC5040D Single Head Feed Rate Control with Shaft 11-DM5040D Double Head Feed Rate Control with Shaft Dual Head Dual Control Feed Rate Control 11-DM504DC with Shaft 11-FCS000A FRC Screw "A" 11-FC5N000 Feed Rate Mounting Plate 11-FC5M040 Dial Ring 11-UCFC5H0 Variable Cam, pkg. of 2 11-UCFC5L1 Index Pin Lifter, pkg. of 2 11-FC5L003 Index Pin Holder 11-FC5L005 Index Pin Spring 11-FC5L002 Index Pin 11-FC5K00D Index Spider 11-UCFC5ID Index Plate 11-FC5F000 Roller Clutch 11-FC5E000 O-Ring Seal 3/8" 11-FCS000C Mounting Rivet "C" 11-UCFC5AD Main Shaft for Single Head-Adjustable Rate 11-DM5A00D Main Shaft for Double Head Adjustable Rate Main Shaft for Dual Head Dual Control 11-DM5A0DC Adjustable Rate Feed Rate Housing with Roller Clutch, Seal 11-FC5D0OS and Rivets STENNER FEED RATE ASSEMBLY PARTS STENNER CLASSIC PUMP HEAD PARTS Part Number 11-UCCP400 11-UC3ASYD 11-CP33000 11-CP31RSB 11-CP100CB 11-UCCP100 11-UCCPS0B Description Tube Housing Only Roller Assembly Standard Roller Roller Shaft Bushing Tube Housing Cover Bushing Only Tube Housing Cover with Bushing Cover Screw "B" Package of 10 STENNER CLASSIC (NON-QP) PUMP HEAD PARTS STENNER QUICKPRO PUMP HEAD PARTS Part Number 11-QP251-1 11-QP252-1 11-QP253-1 11-QP254-1 11-QP255-1 11-QP257-1 11-QP400-1 11-QP500-1 11-QP501-3 11-QP100-1 11-QP401-2 24 Description #1 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" #2 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" #3 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" #4 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" #5 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" #7 QuickPro Pump Head with ferrules 1/4" QuickPro Tube Housing w/latches QuickPro Roller Assembly QuickPro Roller Arm Assembly (includes arms, bushings, rollers, screws) QuickPro Tube Housing Cover with bushing QuickPro Latches (2/pkg.) STENNER QUICKPRO PUMP HEAD PARTS www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemical Feed Pump Parts STENNER CLASSIC PUMP HEAD SERVICE KITS STENNER QUICKPRO PUMP HEAD SERVICE KITS STENNER CLASSIC PUMP HEAD SERVICE KITS — Contains parts to rebuild 0-25 psi Stenner Classic pump head. Kit includes: pump tube, roller assembly, 2 x connecting nuts, 3 x ferrules, and 2 x cover screws. 11-PSKL01 #1 Pump Head Service Kit 11-PSKL02 #2 Pump Head Service Kit 11-PSKL03 #3 Pump Head Service Kit 11-PSKL04 #4 Pump Head Service Kit 11-PSKL05 #5 Pump Head Service Kit STENNER QUICKPRO PUMP HEAD SERVICE KITS — For single head 0-25 psi pumps. Includes: pump tube, roller assembly, 2 x connecting nuts, 3 x ferrules, and 2 x latches. 11-QP251K #1 QP Pump Head Service Kit 11-QP252K #2 QP Pump Head Service Kit 11-QP253K #3 QP Pump Head Service Kit 11-QP254K #4 QP Pump Head Service Kit 11-QP255K #5 QP Pump Head Service Kit STENNER MOTOR SERVICE KITS STENNER MOTOR SERVICE KITS — Contains parts to service 120 volt and 220 volt motors. Kit includes: coil, rotor assembly with brackets, tolerance rings, fan, ground screw, 2 x coil screws, and 2 x wire nuts. 11-MSK120 120 volt/60 Hz 11-MSK220 220 volt/60 Hz STENNER FEED RATE CONTROL SERVICE KIT STENNER GEAR CASE SERVICE KITS TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 STENNER FEED RATE CONTROL SERVICE KIT — Service kit for adjustable pumps. Kit contains: lifter, index plate, 1 oz. tube AquaShield grease, 3 x Screw A, and variable cam. 11-FSK100 STENNER GEAR CASE SERVICE KITS — For 45 and 100 Series Stenner pumps. Kit contains: metal reduction gear, 1 oz. tube AquaShield grease, phenolic gear with spacer, motor shaft with gear, 4 x cover screw B, and 2 x gear posts. 11-GSK45A Adjustable 45/100 Series 11-GSK45F Fixed Output 45 Series 25 Chemical Feed Accessories Union Tee 92-P6TU6 92-P8TU6 92-P8TU8 Tube Dia. (O.D.) 3⁄8" x 3⁄8" x 3⁄8" x 1⁄2" x 3⁄8" 1⁄2" x 1⁄2" x 1⁄2" 1⁄2" FAST & TITE REPLACEMENT PARTS Replacement Part Stainless grab ring Buna-N "O" ring Nut & Spacer set REPLACEMENT TUBING 3⁄8" 92-6GR 92-60R 92-P6NS 1⁄2" 92-8GR 92-80R 92-P8NS POLYETHYLENE TUBING O.D. I.D. Wall Black-UV Natural Size Size Thickness Protected 1⁄4" .170" .250" .375" .500" .600" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" 5⁄8" 3⁄4" .040" .062" .062" .062" .075" TYGON TUBING 11-055 11-060 11-065 11-068 11-070 11-051 11-053 11-052 11-054 • Clear O.D. Size I.D. Size Wall Thickness 3⁄8" 1⁄4" 1⁄16" 1⁄4" 9⁄16" 3⁄4" 1⁄8" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" 1⁄16" 3⁄32" 1⁄8" 11-240 11-225 11-230 11-235 TUBING ACCESSORIES SMALL TUBING CUTTER — Spring loaded tubing cutter cuts plastic tubing and hose up to 1⁄2" O.D. Replaceable hardened steel blade. 11-073 11-074 Replacement blade CARBOY DRUM WRENCH 11-100 Drum wrench - 15, 30, 52 gal. 11-105 Drum wrench - 5 gal. 11-115 11-250 CHEMICAL FUME PREVENTER 11-073 11-100 PROMINENT ACID FUME SCRUBBER — Cost effective way to prevent corrosion and equipment damage caused by acid fumes. Captures and neutralizes acid fumes allowing acid tanks to be completely sealed. Refillable media turns from white to pink when it's time to be replaced. Non-metallic module includes: media, vent assembly, and 3/4" male NPT tank connection kit. Wall mounting kit ordered separately. 11-250 Acid Fume Scrubber 11-252 Wall Mounting Kit 11-255 Repl. Acid Fume Scrubber Media SOLUTION TANK LABELS — 14" x 10" pressure sensitive label can be mounted on tank or on most walls. OSHA approved sign. 11-110 Danger Chlorine 11-115 Danger Acid 11-120 Danger Caustic 11-121 Blank 11-135 FAST & TITE TUBE FITTINGS — Installs in seconds without tools. Provides tight, leakproof seal on polyethelene tubing. Black polypropylene. Additional sizes available. Male Connector Tube Dia. (O.D.) MPT 92-P6MC4 92-P6MC6 92-P6MC8 92-P8MC6 92-P8MC8 3⁄8" 1⁄4" Male Elbow 3⁄8" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" 1⁄2" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" Tube Dia. (O.D.) MPT Female Connector Tube Dia. (O.D.) MPT 92-P6ME6 92-P6FC4 92-P6FC8 92-P8FC8 26 3⁄8" 3⁄8" 3⁄8" 1⁄2" 3⁄8" 1⁄4" 1⁄2" 1⁄2" 11-125 CHEMICAL TRANSFER PUMPS 11-095 CHEMICAL HANDLING ACCESSORIES 11-090 DRUM HANDLING TRUCKS — Steel hand truck available in two styles with drum holding clamp. 10" x 21⁄2" ball bearing wheels. 1000 lb. capacity. Makes handling heavy liquid drums easier and safer. Heavy duty hand truck has continuous hand bar and rear wheels that act as a pivot for lifting drums onto raised areas. 11-090 Drum truck 11-095 Heavy duty drum truck DRUM TRANSFER PUMPS — Motor driven chemical transfer pump, up to 30 GPM, with polypropylene suction tube. 27" pump is for 30 gal. carboys and 39" pump is for 52 gal. drums. For use with liquid chlorine, muriatic acid or caustic soda. 115 volt with 16' cord. 11-125 27" Transfer Pump 11-130 39" Transfer Pump PVC HAND TRANSFER PUMP — With Viton seals for acids and caustics. Pumps 1 gallon in 6 strokes and has 2" IPS bung adapter. 11⁄2" dia. x 38" H with 3' discharge hose. 11-135 PLASTIC FUNNEL — Excellent for transferring chemicals. 51⁄ 2" diameter, 32 oz. capacity. Color: Red. 11-137 www.lincolnaquatics.com Chemical Storage 12-214 12-175 12-060 12-020 POLYETHYLENE TANKS POLYETHYLENE SOLUTION TANKS — High density linear polyethylene cylindrical tank with flat bottom. FDA approved resin. Optional cover and tank fittings purchased separately. Item 12-005 12-010 12-015 12-020 12-025 12-030 12-035 12-040 Capacity 30 gallon 55 gallon 100 gallon 150 gallon 200 gallon 275 gallon 360 gallon 500 gallon Dimensions 18" x 281⁄2" H 221⁄2" x 34" H 27" x 421⁄2" H 31" x 48" H 36" x 48" H 42" x 48" H 48" x 48" H 52" x 60" H 12-165 12-180 LMI SOLUTION TANKS LMI SOLUTION TANKS — UV resistant yellow polyethylene tanks. Each tank has capped fill port and suction tube port. 35 gallon tank utilizes flooded suction design with convenient pump mounting location. 50 gallon tank cover has pump and mixer mounting pads. Item 12-165 12-170 12-175 12-180 Capacity 10 gallon 30 gallon 50 gallon 35 gallon flooded suction 12-213 LINCOLN DOUBLE CONTAINMENT TANKS Dual wall tank design with specially molded top for mounting of feed pump, mixer, and liquid level sensor. 8" dia. threaded opening. Available in blue or white - specify. Item Tank Capacity Dimension Basin Capacity 12-213 35 gallon 25" x 283⁄4" H 50 gallon 12-214 65 gallon 28" x 391⁄2" H 90 gallon 12-212 120 gallon 33" x 50" H 160 gallon Dimensions 141⁄2" x 173⁄4" H 23" x 23" H 23" x 423⁄4" H 20" x 32" H TANK COVERS POLYETHYLENE TANK COVERS — Polyethylene cover for solution tanks. 12-045 18" dia. 12-065 36" dia. 12-050221⁄2" dia. 12-070 42" dia. 12-055 27" dia. 12-075 48" dia. 12-060 31" dia. 12-080 52" dia. 12-256 SECONDARY CONTAINMENT 12-222 DOUBLE WALL BULK TANKS DOUBLE WALL BULK STORAGE TANKS — Solve dual containment problems with one tank. Double wall seamless polyethylene construction with 8" man way. Outer tank has over 110% capacity of inner tank. Optional tank fittings purchased separately. Available in natural or black - specify. Capacity 12-230 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 100 gallon 150 gallon 200 gallon 350 gallon 500 gallon 1,000 gallon Dimensions Natural 35" x 39" H 34" x 48" H 41" x 52" H 52" x 56" H 59" x 71" H 74" x 85" H 12-215 12-217 12-220 12-222 12-225 12-230 Black 12-216 12-218 12-221 12-223 12-226 12-231 SECONDARY CONTAINMENT BASINS — Polyethylene secondary containment basin protects against accidental spills, leaks, and overflows. Basins should be selected to contain 110% of the volume of the primary tank. Available in rectangular and round styles. Color: black or natural. Item Capacity Style Dimensions (inches) 47"L x 32"W x 20"H 57"L x 38"W 12-241 140 gal. Rectangular x 24"H 641/2"L x 52"W 12-246 240 gal. Rectangular x 24"H Round 64" Dia. x 33"H 12-249 385 gal. Round 66" Dia. x 46"H 12-256 675 gal. Round 86" Dia. x 38"H 12-262 950 gal. 12-236 80 gal. Rectangular 27 Chemical Storage 12-305 MIXER PARTS PROPELLERS — Stainless steel propeller, used with clamp mount mixers. 4" diameter. 12-300 5⁄16" hub 12-305 1⁄2" hub 12-310 5⁄8" hub 12-400 STORAGE SYSTEMS 12-390 SPILLDECK CONTAINMENT PLATFORMS Polyethylene secondary containment platforms protect against accidental spills and leaks. Available in 1, 2, and 4 drum modules that are easily connected together with bulkhead fittings to create unlimited configurations. Low profile design (53/4" high) with rugged, slip-resistant polyethylene grates. Options include: ramp, bulkhead fitting, "T" strip (26" long-use 2 for long sides), sidewall plugs, and bladder systems for extra sump capacity. Load Capacity: 1 drum (1,500 lbs.), 2 drum (3,000 lbs.), and 4 drum (6,000 lbs.) Item Capacity Sump Dimensions Capacity (inches) HxWxL (gal.) 11 12-385 1 drum 53/4x257/8x257/8 53/4x257/8x52 22 12-390 2 drum 53/4x52x52 44 12-395 4 drum 53/4x24x32 • 12-400 Ramp Bulkhead Fitting 12-405 "T" Strip - 26" 12-410 Sidewall Plugs 12-415 12-416 Bladder System - 1 drum - 77 gallon 12-417 Bladder System - 2 drum - 88 gallon 12-418 Bladder System - 4 drum - 110 gallon 12-350 MIXER SHAFT COUPLINGS — For connecting motor to mixer shaft. 12-340 1⁄2" to 1⁄2" 12-345 1⁄2" to 5⁄8" 12-350 5⁄8" to 5⁄8" 12-355 5⁄8" to 3⁄4" SOLUTION TANK MIXERS HARDTOP STORAGE LOCKERS — Safely store drums outdoors with unique "dual closure" containment locker. All polyethylene construction with "roll top" door and dual "swing out" doors. Polyethylene ramp allows for easy loading/unloading of drums. Available in 2 drum (671/4"W x 411/4"D x 74"H) or 4 drum (641/4"W x 62"D x 79"H) styles. Low profile containment pallet with drain holds 66 gallons (2 drum) or 75 gallons (4 drum). Forkliftable and lockable. Loading ramp 46"L x 28"W x 83/4"H, ordered separately. 12-420 Storage locker 2 drum 12-425 Storage locker 4 drum 12-430 Loading ramp 28 IMPELLERS — Neoprene coates impellers with brass hub. 304 stainless steel impeller for 5⁄8" shaft low speed mixer. 12-315 1⁄2" high x 5⁄16" hub 12-32011⁄4" high x 1⁄2" hub 12-32511⁄4" high x 5⁄8" hub 12-330 2" high x 1⁄2" hub 12-335 2" high x 5⁄8" hub 12-336 3" high x 14" diameter HIGH SPEED MIXERS — For mixing slurry solutions. 1725 RPM TEFC motor with bracket mount. Also available in clamp mount, flange mount, and thread mount styles. Provided with neoprene impellers. Epoxy coating for chlorine and muriatic acid extra. Specify chemical being mixed. 12-270 1⁄20 HP - 5⁄16" x 28" (30, 35, 50 gal.) 12-275 1⁄3 HP - 1⁄2" x 36" shaft (140-200 gal.) 12-280 1⁄2 HP - 1⁄2" x 36" shaft (200-300 gal.) 12-285 1 HP - 5⁄8" x 44" shaft (300-500 gal.) LOW SPEED MIXERS — For DE slurry or light viscosity fluids. Prevents mixer from crushing DE diatoms by mixing at 60 RPM. TEFC motor with bracket mount. Optional clamp mount also available. 12-290 1⁄3 HP - 5⁄8" x 40" shaft (200-400 gal.) 12-295 1⁄2 HP - 5⁄8" x 44" shaft (400 + gal.) See page 26 for solution tank labels and chemical transfer pumps. See pages 102103 for NFPA signs and safety signs. LIQUID LEVEL SENSOR ULTRSONIC LIQUID LEVEL TRANSMITTER — Noncontact liquid level transmitter mounts on top of chemical 12-365 tank and can detect tank levels up to 9'8" deep. Order one level transmitter per tank. USB fob required for sensor programming, Multi-Tank Level Controller (with dual display, which can receive up to 4 tank level inputs), and tank installation fittings - ordered separately. Level transmitter can provide 4-20 mA output to chemical controllers that are designed to accept tank level inputs. 24 VDC. 12-365 Ultrasonic level transmitter 12-370 Ultrasonic USB fob 12-375 Multi-tank level controller INSTALLATION FITTINGS 12-380 2" NPT x 1" NPT - Sch. 80 12-381 2" Socket x 1" NPT - Sch. 80 12-382 1" NPT flange - Sch. 80 12-383 1" NPT bracket, polypropylene www.lincolnaquatics.com Variable Frequency Drives 13-830 13-878 VARIABLE FREQUENCY DRIVES PENTAIR ACU DRIVE XS VFD — By Danfoss. The ACU Drive XS Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) combine the benefits of a frequency converter with the power of a high efficiency motor. The ACU Drive XS frequency converter controls pump speed, torque, and the overall performance of your AC pump motor, by controlling the power input. Significant power savings are achieved by the adjustment of the power supplied to your pump motor, based on your system's needs and demands. System includes both Variable and Constant torque operation. Thermal protection for the drive and motor is built into the ACU Drive XS software, to guard against motor overheating, and requires no additional sensors or wiring. Unique Automatic Energy Optimizer (AEO) function makes it possible to save an additional 5-10% on your energy bill. These functions optimize the current supplied to your motor according to your specific load. Easy-to-use design with digital interface provides full control of the motor. "HARD START" enables start and control of motor speed, "OFF" turns off the motor, and "AUTO START" shifts control to digital inputs and/or serial communication. All HP sizes use same keypad. Keypad can be remotely mounted with easy-to-read display. Options include: Fused By-Pass Assembly, Digital Flow Meter, Battery Back-up, Conformal Circuit Board Coating, and Enclosures (NEMA 1, NEMA 12, NEMA 3R/4X or IP66). Single phase VFD's also available - inquire. Includes: factory start-up and on-site Warranty. With Fused Disconnect Horsepower Amps Frame Enclosure NEMA 12 NEMA 4X Three Phase Drives — 200 - 240 Volt with Fused Disconnect 5 16.7 A5 13-820 13-821 71/2 24.2 B1 13-825 13-826 10 30.8 B1 13-830 13-831 15 46.2 B1 13-835 13-836 20 59.4 B2 13-840 13-841 25 74.8 C1 13-845 13-846 30 88.0 C1 13-850 13-851 Three Phase Drives — 380 - 480 Volt with Fused Disconnect 5 8.2 A5 13-855 13-856 71/2 11.0 A5 13-860 13-861 10 14.5 A5 13-865 13-866 15 21.0 B1 13-870 13-871 20 27.0 B1 13-875 13-876 25 34.0 B1 13-880 13-881 30 40.0 B1 13-885 13-886 Three Phase Drives — 500 - 600 Volt with Fused Disconnect 5 6.1 A5 13-890 13-891 71/2 9.0 A5 13-895 13-896 10 11.0 A5 13-900 13-901 15 18.0 B1 13-905 13-906 20 22.0 B1 13-910 13-911 25 27.0 B1 13-915 13-916 30 34.0 B1 13-920 13-921 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 With Fused By-Pass Enclosure NEMA 1 NEMA 12 13-822 13-827 13-832 13-837 13-842 13-847 13-852 13-823 13-828 13-833 13-838 13-843 13-848 13-853 13-857 13-862 13-867 13-872 13-877 13-882 13-887 13-858 13-863 13-868 13-873 13-878 13-883 13-888 13-892 13-897 13-902 13-907 13-912 13-917 13-922 13-893 13-898 13-903 13-908 13-913 13-918 13-923 19-012 19-009 FLOW METERS SIGNET SMARTPRO TRANSMITTER — Flow meter with large backlit display and dial type bar graph. Accuracy of + .2% with 4-20 mA output. Available in Panel Mount or Field Mounts. Optional Wall Mount Box Kit available for wall mounting of panel mount meter. Order Transmitter and Magmeter Flow Sensor separately. Runs on 12 to 32 VDC power (24 VDC nominal). Installation fittings ordered separately. Specify size and type of pipe when ordering. UL Listed. 19-009 SmartPro Transmitter, field mount 19-012 SmartPro Transmitter, panel mount 19-013 SmartPro Wall Mount Box Kit 19-008 Flow Meter transformer, 24 volt 19-400 Magmeter Flow Sensor, 1/2" to 4" pipe 19-405 Magmeter Flow Sensor, 5" to 8" pipe 19-410 Magmeter Flow Sensor, 10" to 36" pipe See page 43 for Signet installation fittings. 19-013 ACU-DRIVE VFD OPTIONS Extented Warranty 3 Year 5 Year 0 - 10 HP 13-950 13-955 Galvanized Backplates A5 B1 B2 C1 15 - 40 HP 13-951 13-956 15 - 40 HP 13-960 13-965 13-970 13-975 Your Lincoln Representative can recommend the correct VFD for your application. 29 Commercial Pumps 13-005 SELF-PRIMING PUMPS STA-RITE CSP/CCSP SERIES PUMPS — Commercial self-priming pump. Cast iron with bronze impeller. 6" suction x 4" discharge flanged connections. 3450 RPM, 208-230/460 volt, 3 phase. Oversized hair and lint strainer with "O ring" seal and electro-polished stainless steel basket. Strainer ordered separately. Pumps and strainers available without corrosion resistant epoxy coatings (CSP) or with epoxy coatings on all wetted surfaces (CCSP). Also available with single phase/230 volt motors on 71⁄2 HP and 10 HP models. 3 phase/200 volt motors also available. NSF Listed. Size Phase PENTAIR CMK/CHK SERIES PUMPS — Commercial self-priming bronze main circulation pump with integral hair and lint strainer with stainless steel basket. 6" suction x 4" discharge, flanged connections. 3450 rpm, 3 phase, 60/50 HZ, and 208 volt or 220/440 volt motors. Available as high head (CHK) or medium head (CMK) models. Also available with single phase motors on 5 HP, 71⁄2 HP, and 10 HP high head (CH) and medium head (CM) models. NSF Listed. Size HP 3 13-005 13-006 10 HP 3 13-010 13-011 15 HP 3 13-015 13-016 20 HP 3 13-020 13-021 Hair & Lint Strainer Assembly 13-025 13-026 Replacement Stainless Basket 13-027 Replacement Strainer "o"-ring 13-024 STA-RITE CSP 150 20 HPI 50 25 71/2 HPI 100 200 TOTAL HEAD IN FEET 10 HPI 15 HPI 300 400 500 600 700 U.S. GALLONS PER MINUTE 800 BEST EFFICIENCY SIZING 125 100 20 HPI 75 50 25 30 13-250 13-260 13-267 13-256 13-266 13-271 13-276 13-281 13-282 13-285 13-290 Size Phase Weight with Strainer (lbs.) 5 HP 1 189 71⁄2 HP 1 235 10 HP 1 154 5 HP 3 167 71⁄2 HP 3 189 10 HP 3 234 15 HP 3 235 Pentair EQ flange kit - 4" Pentair EQ flange kit - 6" Repl. Hair & Lint Strainer Basket Repl. Strainer "o"-ring 60 CYCLE THREE PHASE 3450 RPM 80 60 CMK-150; 15 HP 40 CMK-100/CM-100; 10 HP 20 0 0 CMK-75/CM-75; 7.5 HP CMK-50/CM-50; 5 HP 100 STA-RITE CCSP 150 0 Item 100 75 0 13-271 PENTAIR EQ SERIES PUMPS — Heavy duty commercial pump specifically designed for large pools, fountains, and water features. Self priming pump is the only non-corrosive, allplastic pump available. Efficient closed impeller design lowers motor load, for longer motor life. Close coupled Noryl pump, with separate hair and lint strainer (included), with clear Lexan lid. Flanged 6" suction x 4" discharge connections. NEMA rated 3450 RPM, TEFC 3 phase, 460/230-208 volt, 60 Hz motors and ODP single phase 230 volt, 60 Hz motors. Order 1 x 4" and 1 x 6" flange kit with gasket and stainless hardware with each pump. NSF Listed. CM/CMK SERIES PUMP 120 100 CH/CHK High Head 1 13-028 13-029 1 13-033 13-034 1 13-037 13-038 3 13-030 13-031 3 13-035 13-036 3 13-040 13-041 3 13-045 13-046 3 • 13-050 Replacement Stainless Basket Replacement Strainer "o"-ring 140 71/2 HPI 100 200 10 HPI 15 HPI 300 400 500 600 700 U.S. GALLONS PER MINUTE 800 200 300 400 500 600 FLOW-RATE IN G.P.M. 700 800 900 1000 PUMP PERFORMANCE CURVE CH/CHK SERIES PUMP 160 TOTAL DYNAMIC HEAD IN FEET OF WATER TOTAL HEAD IN FEET 125 CM/CMK Medium Head PUMP PERFORMANCE CURVE CM/CMK SERIES PUMP 160 BEST EFFICIENCY SIZING Phase 5 HP 71⁄2 HP 10 HP 5 HP 71⁄2 HP 10 HP 15 HP 20 HP 13-051 13-052 CCSP Epoxy Coated TOTAL DYNAMIC HEAD IN FEET OF WATER 71⁄2 CSP Cast Iron 13-035 CH/CHK SERIES PUMP 140 60 CYCLE THREE PHASE 3450 RPM 120 100 80 60 CHK-200; 20 HP 40 CHK-150; 15 HP 20 0 0 CHK-100/CH-100; 10 HP CHK-75; 7.5 HP CHK-50/CH-50; 5 HP 100 200 300 400 500 600 FLOW-RATE IN G.P.M. 700 800 900 1000 www.lincolnaquatics.com Commercial Pumps 13-430 PENTAIR EQ SERIES WATERFALL PUMPS Heavy duty, commercial waterfall pump, for low head and high flow requirements for water features. Self-priming pump uses non-corrosive plastic parts for durability and long life. Close coupled design. Available with or without hair and lint strainer, with clear Lexan lid. Flanged 6" suction x 4" discharge connections. NEMA rated 3450 RPM, TEFC 3 phase motors and ODP single phase motors. Order 1 x 4" and 1 x 6" flange kit with gasket and stainless hardware with each pump with strainer or 1 x 6" kit for pumps without strainer. NSF Listed. Size 3 HP 3 HP 5 HP 5 HP 13-281 13-282 13-283 Voltage Phase With Without Strainer Strainer 13-074 13-225 ITT MARLOW "4 SPC" SERIES PUMPS — 6" suction x 4" discharge, commercial self-priming centrifugal pumps. Ideal for large commercial pools and waterparks. Pumps utilize 1750 RPM motors for quiet operation and extended service life. 10 HP/230 volt, single phase pump also available. Includes oversized pump strainer with stainless steel basket and enclosed bronze impeller for high efficiencies. NSF Listed. Item HP Voltage 10 200-230/460 V 13-225 15 200-230/460 V 13-230 20 200-230/460 V 13-235 13-236 Replacement PVC Basket Phase 3 3 3 115/230 1 13-400 13-420 208-230/460 3 13-405 13-425 230 1 13-410 13-430 208-230/460 3 13-415 13-435 Pentair EQ flange kit, 4" Pentair EQ flange kit, 6" Pentair EQ flange kit, 6", w/o strainer STA-RITE MAX-E-PRO PUMPS — High efficiency, self-priming pool pumps. 2" suction/ discharge ports incorporate external and internal threads. Large see-thru lid with Quick-Lock cover allows easy inspection and cleaning. Three phase motors are TEFC. 230 volt motors also available. NSF Listed. Item HP Voltage GPM@ 60' TDH Phase 115/230 V 1 30 GPM 13-072 1/2 115/230 V 1 55 GPM 13-073 3/4 115/230 V 1 72 GPM 13-074 1 3 95 GPM 13-081 11/2 208-230/460 V 3 115 GPM 13-082 2 208-230/460 V 3 140 GPM 13-083 3 208-230/460 V 13-096 Replacement PVC Basket 3 HP 11/2 HP 1/2 HP 3/4 HP 2 HP 1 HP 13-215 ITT MARLOW "3B" SERIES PUMPS — 4" suction x 3" discharge, commercial selfpriming centrifugal pumps. Includes hair and lint strainer with stainless steel basket. High efficiency design provides maximum performance. 3450 RPM motors available with either 230 volt single phase or 208-230/460 volt three phase models. NSF Listed. Size 5 HP 71⁄2 HP 13-221 Single Phase Three Phase 13-205 13-210 13-215 13-220 Replacement Stainless Basket TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 13-520 PENTAIR WHISPERFLO PUMPS — High efficiency, self priming pool pumps, with large strainer basket and see-thru lid. High efficiency impeller create maximum water flow, while minimizing turbulence and noise. Energy efficient, single speed motors, with commercial grade frame. 2" suction/discharge ports. Available with single phase and TEFC three phase motors. NSF Listed. Item HP 13-500 13-505 13-510 13-540 13-515 13-545 13-520 13-550 13-525 13-555 13-560 1/2 Voltage Phase 115/208-230 V 1 115/208-230 V 1 115/208-230 V 1 1 208-230/460 V 3 208-230 V 1 1 1 /2 208-230/460 V 3 208-230 V 1 2 208-230/460 V 3 208-230 V 1 3 208-230/460 V 3 Replacement PVC Basket 3/4 GPM@ 60' TDH 40 GPM 60 GPM 76 GPM 100 GPM 112 GPM 142 GPM 13-580 PENTAIR WHISPERFLO XF PUMPS — Whisper quiet, self priming pumps with high efficiency performance are ideal for commercial applications. Large capacity hair and lint strainer with see through lid. 2.5"/3" union connections. Available in 208-230 volt/single phase High Efficiency motors or 208-230/460 volt/three phase TEFC motors. NSF Listed. Item HP Voltage Phase GPM@ 60' TDH 208-230 V 1 13-565 2 110 GPM 208-230/460 V 3 13-570 208-230 V 1 13-575 3 152 GPM 208-230/460 V 3 13-580 208-230 V 1 13-585 5 220 GPM 208-230/460 V 3 13-590 13-595 Replacement PVC Basket 31 Commercial Pumps 13-118 FLOODED SUCTION PUMPS INTELLIFLO VS + SVRS PENTAIR INTELLIFLO PUMPS — Available in 2 versions: IntelliFlo VF and IntelliFlo VS+SVRS. These high performance pumps reduce operating costs and are the quietest pumps ever built. IntelliFlo VF pump utilizes a variable drive and can reduce pump operating costs up to 90%. Digital controls allow you to program optimum speed per function. TEFC, permanent magnet motor produces less heat and vibration than traditional induction motors. IntelliFlo VS+SVRS pump utilizes a variable speed motor that provides energy efficiency, with 8 programmable speeds, ranging from 1150 to 3450 RPM. Additionally, this pump includes an integrated Safety Vacuum Release System (SVRS) that provides entrapment protection. Complies with VGB Pool and Spa Safety Act Requirements. Both pumps have 2" suction x 2" discharge connections. 230 volt. NSF Listed. 13-118 IntelliFlo VS+SVRS pump, 3 HP 13-115 IntelliFlo VF pump, 3 HP 13-560 Replacement Basket 13-115 INTELLIFLO VF 13-175 AURORA 340 SERIES COMMERCIAL PUMPS Single stage, end suction centrifugal pumps with flow rates up to 2,500 GPM. Available in 3 styles: horizontal close coupled (341A), vertical close coupled (342A), and horizontal flexible coupled (344A). Cast iron bronze fitted construction. Bronze impellers are vacuum cast, dynamically balanced and key locked to the shaft. Available with Open Drip Proof (ODP) or Totally Enclosed Fan Cooled (TEFC) motors. Contact your Lincoln Representative for a quote on a pump for your specific needs. NSF approved models available. 13-175 Horizontal Close Coupled Pump 13-180 Vertical Close Coupled Pump 13-185 Horizontal Flexible Coupled Pmp 13-180 13-185 PACO MAIN CIRCULATION PUMPS — End suction centrifugal pumps custom designed to meet your pool’s exact flow and head characteristics. Available in cast iron or all bronze and single phase or three phase. Capacities up to 4100 GPM, heads to 800'. Sizes 1" to 10" (discharge) and horsepower 1⁄3 to 125. NSF approved models available. 13-120 13-310 ITT MARLOW "L" SERIES PUMPS — End suction centrifugal pumps. Rugged cast iron construction with high efficiency enclosed bronze impeller. Bronze fitted pumps with open drip proof 1750 RPM, 3 phase, 60 HZ motors. 5 to 10 HP pumps have 208-230/460 volt motors and 15 and 20 HZ pumps have 230/460 volt motors. Capacities to 1250 GPM. Heads to 80' TDH. NSF Listed. Item Size 13-295 13-300 13-305 13-310 13-315 13-320 13-325 13-330 5 HP 71/2 HP 71/2 HP 10 HP 10 HP 15 HP 15 HP 20 HP 13-070 Flanged Connection Size (S x D) 3" x 21⁄2" 4" x 3" 5" x 4" 4" x 3" 5" x 4" 5" x 4" 6" x 5" 6" x 5" 13-100 STA-RITE “CC” SERIES PUMPS — For flooded suction location. High head cast iron pump with bronze impeller. 208-230/460 volt, 3 phase motors. 21/2" suction/2"discharge also available with all bronze construction, medium head models, and 208-230 volt, 1 phase motors. Order hair and lint strainer separately. NSF Listed. 13-100 3 HP, 140 GPM @ 60' TDH 13-105 5 HP, 215 GPM @ 60' TDH 13-065 6" Hair and Lint Strainer, cast iron 13-066 6" Replacement Basket 13-070 8" Hair and Lint Strainer, cast iron 13-071 8" Replacement Basket 13-120 32 www.lincolnaquatics.com Booster Pumps & Air Blowers BOOSTER PUMPS 13-605 BERKELEY SSCX BOOSTER PUMPS — High head performance centrifugal booster pumps with corrosion resistant 304 stainless steel housing shaft and propeller. ODP motors provided. TEFC motors and units with Noryl impellers also available for additional cost inquire. Available with 115/130 volt single phase or 208-230/460 volt three phase motors. Size 3⁄4 HP 1 HP 11⁄2 HP 2 HP 21⁄2 HP Single Phase Three Phase 13-600 13-605 13-610 13-615 13-620 13-625 13-630 13-635 13-640 13-645 13-350 SWIM JET SYSTEMS SPECIALTY PUMPS 13-165 STA-RITE “EDPH” PORTABLE PUMP — Cast iron self-priming pump with 4 cycle gasoline engine. Includes: 6" hair and lint strainer and portable skid base. 2" suction x 2" discharge. Will produce up to 150 GPM. 13-165 3 HP 13-066 6" Replacement Basket BADUJET SWIM JET SYSTEMS — Convert your smaller pool into a lap pool. Suction and discharge housed in the patented one piece nozzle housing. Volume control and on/off button located on face of jet housing. Includes: dual nozzle jet housing, massage hose, 4 HP pump, control box with GFCI. VGB Compliant and UL listed. Specify: round cover or rectangular cover. Specify voltage. 13-350 BaduJet Swim Jet System, 1 phase 13-355 BaduJet Swim Jet System, 3 phase 13-167 PENTAIR STAINLESS SUBMERSIBLE PUMP Utility drainer pumps water down to 13/8" in depth. Stainless steel casing, suction strainer, clog-resistant impeller and shaft, for corrosion resistance. External float switch included. 15 ft. power cord. 115 volt/60 Hz. 13-167 1/2 HP 13-380 13-162 PENTAIR BOOSTER PUMP — High pressure booster pump is made from durable, corrosionproof thermoplastic. 115/230 volt, 1 phase motor. 13-162 3/4 HP TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Blower Size 1 HP 11⁄2 HP 2 HP 3 HP Single Phase 14-005 14-015 14-025 14-035 Three Phase 14-010 14-020 14-030 14-040 17.2” 14.4” 32.0” ≤ 1.9” ~16.0” COMMERCIAL AIR BLOWERS — Heavy duty regenerative air blower. Die-cast aluminum housing, impeller, and cover. TEFC motor with permanently sealed ball bearings. Inlet and outlet internal muffling for quiet operation. Installation requires 12-15' of copper plumbing on discharge side. Available in 115/230 volt. 1 phase and 230/460 volt, 3 phase motors. 44.4” AIR BLOWERS ~10.0” 14-025 BADUJET SWIM JET SYSTEMS — Overthe-wall water swim jet for existing pools. Two piece ABS body houses pump, adjustable water flow jet nozzle, and air regulator controls. Unit includes 4 HP pump and deck mounting hardware. Massage hose ordered separately. VGB Compliant and UL listed. Specify voltage. 13-380 Inspiration System, 1 phase 13-370 Massage hose with Pulsator, 5 ft. 13-375 Massage hose with Pulsator, 15 ft. 16.0” 11.6” 33 Hair & Lint Strainers 14-905 14-053 STAINLESS STEEL HAIR AND LINT STRAINERS STAINLESS STEEL BASKET STRAINERS — Constructed of T304 stainless steel with T304 stainless Van Stone flange connections. Clear acrylic cover with easy open tee handles and stainless basket with "baffle." Lightweight design allows for installation in difficult applications. Designed for pump suction applications. 50 psi maximum working pressure. Available in straight line size styles and eccentric reducing styles. Inquire for additional sizes available. PRO FLO PRO STRAINER — Patented all stainless (304L) basket strainer with dual stainless baskets and stainless Vanstone flanges. Lowest industry footprint allows strainer to fit in most any pump space. Improved basket open area ratios versus other strainers. Includes see-through lid with quick release stainless latches. Available in straight and concentric styles. STAINLESS STRAIGHT STRAINERS Item 14-900 14-905 14-910 Size 4" 6" 8" Item 14-915 14-920 • Size 10" 12" • STAINLESS REDUCING STRAINERS Item 14-940 14-945 14-950 Size 6" x 4" 6" x 5" 8" x 6" Item 14-955 14-960 • Size 14-585 FIBERGLASS REDUCING STRAINERS Item 14-575 14-580 14-585 14-590 Size 4" x 3" 6" x 5" 6" x 4" 6" x 3" Item 14-595 14-600 14-605 14-610 Size 8" x 6" 8" x 5" 10" x 8" 10" x 6" 10" x 8" 12" x 10" • STAINLESS STRAIGHT STRAINERS Item 14-043 14-045 14-053 14-050 Size 3" 4" 5" 6" Item 14-055 14-060 14-065 14-068 Size 8" 10" 12" 14" 14-715 14-410 FIBERGLASS HAIR AND LINT STRAINERS 14-535 STAINLESS REDUCING STRAINERS Item 14-530 14-542 14-540 14-535 34 Size 4" x 3" 6" x 5" 6" x 4" 6" x 3" Item 14-545 14-544 14-555 14-550 Size 8" x 6" 8" x 5" 10" x 8" 10" x 6" FIBERGLASS REINFORCED BASKET STRAINERS — Composite strainer body is constructed of fiberglass reinforced plastic (FRP) and PVC for maximum resistance to corrosion, pressure, and temperature. Clear acrylic cover with easy open tee handles and stainless steel basket. Rated to 50 psi. Flanges are PVC Van Stone style. Available in straight in-line style or eccentric reducing style. Inquire for additional sizes not listed. Also available in offset and angled offset styles. FIBERGLASS STRAIGHT STRAINERS Item 14-395 14-400 14-405 14-410 Size 3" 4" 5" 6" Item 14-415 14-420 14-425 14-430 Size 8" 10" 12" 14" LARGE PORT FIBERGLASS STRAINERS Composite strainer body with fiberglass reinforced plastic (FRP) and PVC material. Same features as our Fiberglass Basket Strainers, but includes large outlet design. Includes clear acrylic cover with easy open tee handles. Available in straight in-line style and eccentric reducing style. Inquire for additional sizes and styles not listed. Rated to 50 psi. LARGE PORT FRP STRAINERS Item 14-700 14-705 14-710 14-715 Size 3" 4" 5" 6" Item 14-720 14-725 14-730 14-735 Size 8" 10" 12" 14" LARGE PORT FRP REDUCING STRAINERS Item 14-750 14-755 14-760 14-765 Size 4" x 3" 6" x 5" 6" x 4" 6" x 3" Item 14-770 14-775 14-780 14-785 Size 8" x 6" 8" x 5" 10" x 8" 10" x 6" www.lincolnaquatics.com Hair & Lint Strainers 14-135 14-205 CAST IRON HAIR AND LINT STRAINERS MUELLER CAST IRON BASKET STRAINER Iron body simplex basket strainer with flanged ends and clamp-type cover. Includes: lid gasket and stainless steel basket. Available with standard iron finish or 8-10 mil Pota-pox epoxy lining, suitable for potable water. NSF 71 Listed. Size 2" 3" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 14-120 14-125 14-130 14-135 14-140 14-145 14-150 14-155 14-160 14-165 14-170 14-175 14-180 14-185 MUELLER STAINLESS STEEL BASKETS Replacement baskets for Mueller #155 M strainers. Item 14-190 14-195 14-200 14-205 Size 2" 3" 4" 6" Item 14-210 14-215 14-220 • Size 8" 10" 12" • MUELLER STRAINER LID GASKETS — Replacement gaskets for Mueller #155 M strainers. Item 14-191 14-196 14-201 14-206 14-450 Standard Iron Finish Epoxy-Lined Size 2" 3" 4" 6" Item 14-211 14-216 14-221 • HAIR AND LINT STRAINER REPLACEMENT PARTS FLUIDTROL STAINLESS STEEL BASKETS — Replacement stainless steel basket for Fluidtrol hair and lint strainers. T304 stainless steel basket with 1⁄8" perforations. Baskets available with and without secondary "baffle" design. Removable baffle extends your time between required cleanings and allows for more consistent flow through the strainer basket. Size Regular 3" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" When ordering give manufacturer and all dimensions as follows: A. Height of tall side — under the lip. B. Height of short side — under the lip. C. Outside diameter of basket. D. Width of basket including lip. Baffle 14-435 14-440 14-445 14-450 14-455 14-460 14-465 14-470 14-044 14-047 14-051 14-052 14-057 14-062 14-067 14-069 REPLACEMENT BASKETS 14-295 PVC baskets 14-300 Neoprene coated baskets 14-305 Custom stainless steel baskets Size 8" 10" 12" • FLUIDTROL STRAINER PARTS Strainer Size 3" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" 14-490 Lid Gasket Acrylic Cover 14-436 14-437 14-441 14-442 14-446 14-447 14-451 14-452 14-456 14-457 14-461 14-462 14-466 14-467 14-471 14-472 Replacement Strainer Lid "T" Handle PENTAIR PS STRAINER PARTS Strainer Size 14-450 14-452 HAIR AND LINT STRAINER REPLACEMENT BASKETS 14-451 14-490 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 6" 8" 10" 14-880 Stainless Basket Lid "O" Ring Acrylic Cover 14-860 14-865 14-870 14-860 14-865 14-870 14-875 14-865 14-870 Replacement Strainer Lid Knob 14-294 14-286 LINE STRAINERS LINE STRAINERS — Thermo-plastic construction with transparent strainer for easy inspection. Pressure rated to 150 psi. Available with or without True-Unions. True-Union design eliminates need for flanges and permits easy installation and repair. Includes: 20 mesh screen. Socket / threaded connections. Size 1⁄2" 3⁄4" 1" 11⁄2" 2" Strainer Without Unions 14-265 14-270 14-275 14-280 14-285 Strainer With Unions Repl. Screen 14-266 14-271 14-276 14-281 14-286 14-290 14-291 14-292 14-293 14-294 35 Commercial Filter Systems FIBERGLASS HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS STARK HORIZONTAL HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS — Filament wound fiberglass filters are designed for simple, fast installations. Filter tanks are designed for maximum operating pressure of 75 psi with a maximum burst safety factor of 4 to 1. Gel coat fiberglass tank lining is filament wound with continuous fiberglass strand. Lighter weight than most comparably sized carbon steel filters. Horizontal design allows tanks to fit thru most doorways. Multi-spray head diverters and full width laterals result in long filtration cycles and maximum backwashing effectiveness. Vessel finished with Paracote UV resistant coating, for added protection. Available in a 36” diameter and 42” diameter single and multiple tank configurations. Stacking and custom designed systems also available. Completely non-corrosive filters withstand the effects of pool water chemistry, electrolysis and corrosion. 15 Year Limited Warranty. NSF Listed. A, B, and C Style Systems include: Side mounted manhole with viewport, Schedule 80 PVC face piping with flanged connections, water actuated backwash valves, semi-automatic multiport valve, influent/effluent pressure gauges, automatic air relief and back wash sight glass. S Style Systems include: Front mounted manhole with viewport, pre-glued Schedule 80 PVC face piping with grooved connections, backwash valves, semi-automatic multiport valve, manual air relief ball valve and media dump port. UL Listed Automatic Backwash Controller (24VAC) is available as an option on both A, B, C Style Systems and on S Style Systems. The S Style Controller Package also includes a flow meter and temperature probe. Para-Pump Booster System, to maintain water pressure to backwash valves, available as an option. A, B, C STYLE SYSTEMS — 42” DIAMETER Model S1-48 S1-72 S1-96 S1-120 S1-144 Tank Size DxL Tank Connection Size Filter Area Sq. Ft. Flow Rate @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 42" x 48" 6" 12.8 192 42" x 72" 6" 20.0 300 42" x 96" 6" 27.0 405 42" x 120" 6" 35.0 525 42" x 144" 6" 41.0 615 Automatic Backwash Controller Para-Pump Booster System S STYLE SYSTEMS — 36 "AND 42" DIAMETER Model Tank Size DxL RS1-60-04 RS1-72-04 SS1-48-04 SS1-72-06 SS1-96-06 36" x 60" 36" x 72" 42" x 48" 42" x 72" 42" x 96" Tank Connection Size 4" 4" 4" 6" 6" Filter Area Sq. Ft. 13.5 17.2 13.5 20.0 27.0 Flow Rate @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 203 258 203 300 405 6 HR. Turnover @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 69,120 108,000 145,800 189,000 221,400 6 HR. Turnover @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 72,900 92,880 72,900 108,000 145,800 Semi Automatic FILAMENT WOUND VESSELS CLEAR MANWAY VIEWPORT Automatic • 15-005 • 15-010 • 15-015 • 15-020 • 15-025 • 15-030 15-032 Semi Automatic Automatic 15-035 15-040 15-045 15-050 15-055 15-060 15-065 15-070 15-075 15-080 CLEAR 3-WAY VALVE NOTE: See page 37 & 38 for Stark Accessories and Parts. 36 www.lincolnaquatics.com Commercial Filter Systems 5-005 AUTOMATIC BACKWASH CONTROL SYSTEMS STARK HORIZONTAL HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS — Filament wound, composite filter tanks with end manway and top connections for ease of assembly and service. 60" diameter tanks are designed for a maximum operating pressure of 75 psi with a maximum burst safety factor of 4 to 1. Gel coat fiberglass tank lining is filament wound with continuous fiberglass strand. Horizontal design maximizes filter area square footage and provides a deeper filter bed depth than other horizontal high rate sand filters. Multi-spray head diverters and full width laterals result in long filtration cycles and maximize backwashing effectiveness. Vessels finished with Paracote UV resistant coating, for added protection. Available in single tank and multiple tank configurations. Completely non-corrosive systems withstand the effects of pool water chemistry, electrolysis, and corrosion. 15 Year Limited Warranty. CHEMTROL 4000 FILTER CONTROLLER — Integrated filter controller for continuous monitoring and/or control of flow rate, influent and effluent pressures, temperature, main circulation pump and filter backwash cycles. Includes: electronic flow meter, electronic temperature sensor, NEMA 4X (rain and splash proof) lockable fiberglass cabinet, memory storage battery, and on-board storage for up to 6 months of data. Additional options available, inquire. 5 Year Warranty. 5-005 5S STYLE SYSTEMS include: Front mounted manhole with viewport, influent/effluent pressure gauges, pre-glued Schedule 80 PVC face piping with flanged connections, water activated backwash valves, semi-automatic multiport backwash valve, manual air relief ball valves, and media dump port. UL Listed Automatic Backwash Controller (24 VAC) is available as an option, in place of semi-automatic backwash valve, and includes flow meter/saddle and temperature probe. Optional Stark Controller Interface allows use of integrated backwash controllers from other manufacturers in place of semi-automatic multiport valve. Para-Pump Booster System, to maintain water pressure to backwash valve also available as an option. NSF Listed. 5S STYLE SYSTEMS – 60" DIAMETER Model 5S1-30 5S1-35 5S1-40 5S1-45 5S1-50 Tank Size DxL Tank Connection Size Filter Area Sq. Ft. Flow Rate @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 60" x 78" 6" 30.0 450 60" x 90" 6" 35.0 525 60" x 102" 6" 40.0 600 60" x 114" 8" 45.0 675 60" x 126" 8" 50.0 750 Automatic Backwash Controller Para-Pump Booster System 6 HR. Turnover @ 15 GPM per sq. ft. 162,000 189,000 216,000 243,000 270,000 Semi Automatic Automatic 15-800 15-900 15-820 15-920 15-840 15-940 15-860 15-960 15-880 15-980 • 15-030 15-032 STARK ACCESSORIES 15-030 AUTOMATIC BACKWASH CONTROLLER TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 15-032 PARA-PUMP BOOSTER SYSTEM 15-720 STARK CS400 BACKWASH CONTROL — Compatible with Stark or Pentair THS filtration systems that utilize diaphragm style backwash valves. Integrated multiport valve can actuate up to 6 filters. Backwash can be initiated in three ways: true semi-automatic backwash at the single touch of a button, via external signal from a master filter room controller, or by a signal from a differential pressure switch. Includes: Fireman's heater time delay, programmable backwash times, alarm, and data logging. 15-720 SEMI-AUTOMATIC MULTIPORT VALVE 37 Commercial Filter Parts 18-080 STARK FILTER PARTS 18-080 Stark Multiport Actuator 18-095 Stark Actuator check valve, 1⁄4" 18-085 Stark polyethylene tubing, 1⁄4" 18-385 18-390 STARK 2-WAY PRIORITY VALVES Size 6" 4" Flanged 18-390 18-395 18-100 Stark sight glass, 6” flanged 18-101 Stark sight glass, 2” Grooved 18-380 18-385 18-106 18-107 18-106 Stark influent pressure gauge 18-107 Stark effluent pressure gauge 18-108 Stark Multiport pressure gauge 18-112 Stark pressure regulator, 1/4", w/fittings 18-101 18-100 STARK FIBERGLASS NUT & BOLT SET — Set includes: 1 nut and 1 bolt. 18-105 18-400 18-405 18-096 18-400 Stark grooved coupling, 6” 18-405 Stark grooved coupling, 4” 18-097 18-104 18-098 18-103 18-099 18-111 STARK TUBE FITTINGS 18-055 STARK GASKETS 18-070 Size 6" 4" 18-055 18-056 Flanged Gasket Grooved Gasket 18-075 18-053 18-076 18-052 Stark manhole gasket Stark sideport seal, 4" 18-096 Stark 1/4" x MPT quick elbow fitting 18-097 Stark 1/4" FPT quick tubing fitting 18-098 Stark union elbow, 3/8" 18-099 Stark 1/4" quick tubing tee 18-104 Stark 1/4" MPT x quick tubing fitting 18-111 Stark 1/4" MPT x brass quick tubing 18-103 Stark air relief strainer only 18-069 18-060 18-071 STARK 3-WAY BACKWASH VALVES Size Flanged Grooved 6" 4" 6" clear 18-071 18-068 18-070 18-072 18-069 18-067 18-172 Stark valve rebuild kit, 6" 18-173 Stark valve rebuild kit, 4" 18-174 Stark valve rebuild kit, 6" clear 38 18-057 18-058 18-059 STARK MANWAY COVER WITH VIEWPORT — Replacement manway cover with viewport allows inspection of sand bed. Rated at 100 psi. Yokes and hardware ordered separately. 18-057 Stark manway cover with viewport 18-058 Stark manway yoke, set of 2 18-059 Stark manway bolt/washer, set of 2 18-060 Stark lateral, 10” 18-061 Stark small/short lateral, 31/2" 18-054 Stark media dump lateral, 1/2" x 6" 18-065 Stark diverters 18-065 www.lincolnaquatics.com Filter Systems 17-065 16-200 COMMERCIAL HIGH RATE SAND FILTER SYSTEMS PENTAIR THS HORIZONTAL HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS — Fiberglass filter vessels eliminate corrosion issues. Filter tanks are ordered individually and can be banked together to handle different size pool applications. Tanks include: 12" x 16" man-way, tank internals, tank drain, and 6" flanged connections. 34" x 61" tanks utilize 4" diaphragm valves with Victaulic connections. Face Piping Kits are available for single tank and dual tank systems and are ordered separately. Diaphragm Valve Kits require automatic or semi-automatic controls and include: flanged diaphragm valves, pre-glued Sch. 80 PVC piping, backwash sight glass, gaskets and hardware. Semi-automatic controls include: multiport valve with gauge panel, pressure regulator and check valve. Automatic Controls include: microprocessor controller with influent/effluent pressure transducers. Manual systems with butterfly valves and systems utilizing more than two tanks also available inquire. 50 psi operating pressure. NSF Listed. THS FILTERS Item Tank Size DxL 72,900 102,600 106,200 125,280 144,000 Single Tank Systems Diaphram Diaphragm Valve Kits - 4" Valve Kits - 6" Dual Tank Systems Diaphram Diaphragm Valve Kits - 4" Valve Kits - 6" Automatic Semi-Automatic MULTIMEDIA FILTERS STA-RITE SYSTEM 3 FILTERS — Dura-Glas tank construction. System offers interchangeability of filter media. Posi-lok clamping system makes maintenance easy. Available in high rate sand, diatomaceous earth and cartridge filter styles. 2" tank port size. Backwash valve and media extra. NSF Listed. Item 17-005 17-010 17-015 17-020 17-025 17-030 Filter Media Sand Sand D.E. D.E. Cartridge Cartridge Sq. Ft. Filter Area 2.4 3.4 37 53 300 450 Tank Diameter 21" 25" 21" 25" 21" 25" PENTAIR TRITON FILTERS — Patented one-piece fiberglass tank with UV protected surface. Top loading with swing-away diffuser for instant access to sand bed. Available with 2" threaded or 3" flanged tank ports. TR 140C / TR 100C commercial models have larger 8" opening, 3" flanged connections, and 2" drain. Tandem plumbing kits and automatic backwash controls available. Backwash valve and media extra. NSF Listed. Item Model 17-050 17-055 17-060 17-065 17-070 17-075 17-080 17-081 17-082 TR 40 TR 50 TR 60 TR 100 TR 140 TR 100C TR 140C TR 100 C-3 TR 140 C-3 Sq. Ft. Tank Tank Filter Color Port Dia. Area Size 1.92 2.46 3.14 4.91 7.06 4.91 7.06 4.91 7.06 19" 21" 24" 30" 36" 30" 36" 30" 36" Almond Almond Almond Almond Almond Almond Almond Black Black 2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 3" 3" Flow 6 Hr. Filter Rate Turnover Area Sq. Ft. @ 15 GPM /Sq. Ft. 16-300 34" x 61" 13.5 203 GPM 16-305 34" x 84" 19.0 285 GPM 16-200 42" x 72" 19.7 295 GPM 16-205 42" x 84" 23.2 348 GPM 16-210 42" x 96" 26.7 400 GPM FACE PIPING KITS/CONTROLS Automatic Semi-Automatic 17-005 16-267 16-265 16-235 16-225 16-280 16-270 16-240 16-230 System 3 Cartridge Filter 17-082 36" x 84" Dual Tank Face Piping Kits Automatic • 16-290 Semi-Automatic • 16-285 AUTOMATIC CONTROL OPTIONS 16-245 Flow Meter Kit — with 6" saddle 16-250 Temperature Probe Kit TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 System 3 DE Filter System 3 Sand Filter 39 Filter Systems & Accessories 17-315 17-300 17-305 16-150 DIATOMACEOUS EARTH FILTER SYSTEMS MER-MADE VACUUM D.E. FILTER — Commercial vacuum D.E. filter system takes up to 1⁄4 of the space required for sand filters of the same capacity. Vacuum D.E. systems are easy to install, take less water to backwash, and provide the highest water quality of any system. Filter leaves are made of highimpact polystyrene and covered with woven polypropylene fabric. Costs for filter system are lower than other systems on the market. Each system is custom designed based on the gallonage of the pool. Stainless steel leaf clamps, hold down bars, manifold support clamps, and filter leaves are provided to install in field fabricated concrete, fiberglass, or metal filter tanks. Bottom outlet style listed, also available in vertical edge outlet style. Contact us to review your pool requirements and to properly design your system. Item Grid Size 16-140 16-145 16-150 16-155 16-160 24" x 45" 30" x 36" 38" x 48" 30" x 60" 48" x 60" Grid Sq. Ft. Filter Area 15 15 25 25 40 MER-MADE FILTER ACCESSORIES — Can be purchased as parts or as components to the filter systems listed above. 16-165 Fiberglass D.E. filter tank 16-175 Leaf clamp assembly 16-180 Manifold support clamp 16-185 Rubber hold-down strip 16-190 Leaf gaskets 16-195 Felt collars PENTAIR QUAD DE FILTERS — DE filter uses four removable DE cartridges for greater dirt trapping capacity. FRP filter tank for long life. Backwash valve ordered separately. NSF Listed. Item Model 17-200 DE 60 17-205 DE 80 17-210 DE 100 Sq. Ft. Tank Tank Filter Port Diameter Area Size 60 80 100 21.5" 21.5" 21.5" 2" 2" 2" 17-310 SPECIALTY VALVES 17-325 PENTAIR FULLFLO XF VALVES — Available in 2-Way, 3-Way, and diverter styles. These valves are ideal for diverting, shutoff, or mixing applications. PTFE coated diverter seal requires no lubrication. Can be operated by hand or used with motorized valve actuator. Chemical resistant CPVC material with 21/2"/3" connection. 17-300 3-Way Diverter valve 17-305 3-Way Solar valve, with drain down 17-310 2-Way Diverter valve 17-315 90 degree 2-Way valve 17-320 Motorized valve actuator, 90 degree 17-321 Motorized valve actuator, 120 degree 17-322 Motorized valve actuator, 180 degree 17-325 Straight body check valve 17-330 90 degree body check valve 17-335 Check valve rebuild kit CARTRIDGE FILTERS PENTAIR CLEAN & CLEAR FILTERS — Durable FRP tank with union connections and coreless cartridge for easy cleaning. 2" tank ports with 1" drain and wash out opening. 151/2" diameter tank, for tight installations. NSF Listed. Item Model Number 17-250 17-255 17-260 17-265 17-270 CC 50 CC 75 CC 100 CC 150 CC 200 Sq. Ft. Tank Filter Diameter Area 50 75 100 150 200 151⁄2" 151⁄2" 151⁄2" 151⁄2" 151⁄2" Tank Port Size 2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 17-175 BACKWASH VALVES 17-170 STA-RITE BACKWASH VALVES 17-170 2" ABS Unitrol valve, D.E. / Sand filters 17-175 2" Multiport Rotary valve, D.E./Sand filters 17-176 2" Multiport Rotary valve, Sys 3 D.E. 17-165 SEPARATION TANKS 16-175 16-180 40 STA-RITE D.E. SEPARATION TANK — For efficient removal of spent D.E. and debris from backwash water. Allows closed loop system which returns backwash water to pool. Eliminates D.E. disposal problems by trapping material. Constructed of fiberglass reinforced thermo-plastic. 2" NPT inlet and 1 1/2" NPT outlet. For D.E. filter tanks up to 60 sq. ft. 17-165 D.E. Separation Tank 17-166 Replacement Separation Tank Bag 17-185 17-180 PENTAIR BACKWASH VALVES 17-180 2" PVC slide valve, D.E. / Sand filters 17-185 2" Multiport valve, D.E. filters 17-190 2" Multiport valve, D.E. / Sand filters 17-191 2" Hi Flow valve, D.E. / Sand filters 17-192 2" Hi Flow valve, D.E. filters 17-083 2" adapter kit, threaded (2 required) www.lincolnaquatics.com Filter Accessories 18-005 18-020 18-010 18-155 18-160 18-161 18-164 18-165 21⁄2" 31⁄2" 41⁄2" 41⁄2" Fiberglass 18-115 18-130 18-136 18-164 18-165 18-170 18-171 18-186 AIR RELIEF VALVES 18-350 18-340 18-345 18-355 0-60 psi 18-110 18-115 18-120 • 18-140 18-145 18-150 0-100 psi 18-125 18-130 18-135 18-136 • • • Gauge Dia. 0-100 psi 0-30" Hg 30" - 30 psi 21⁄2" 31⁄2" 18-335 18-350 18-365 18-370 18-340 18-355 18-145 18-150 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 18-345 18-360 18-377 GAUGE ACCESSORIES 18-140 18-190 AIR RELIEF VALVES 18-180 Automatic, steel 18-186 Automatic, poly/stainless steel 18-190 Manual air relief valve - 1⁄4" (gauge ordered separately) 18-360 LIQUID FILLED GAUGES — 1⁄4" NPT PRESSURE GAUGES - 1⁄4" NPT 21⁄2" 31⁄2" 41⁄2" 41⁄2" Fiberglass 2" Back mount 2" Bottom mount 4" Back mount 30" - 30 psi 18-155 18-160 18-161 18-162 LIQUID FILLED GAUGES DRY GAUGES Gauge Diameter 0-30" Hg 18-120 18-335 18-125 18-170 VACUUM/COMPOUND GAUGES — 1⁄4" NPT Gauge Diameter 18-110 MERCURY SWITCHES MERCURY SWITCHES — Visible calibrated dial with on/off indication and two adjustable set points. Vacuum switch has adjustable operating range of 0-30" Hg and pressure switch has 5-100 psi adjustable operating range. 120 volt, UL listed. 18-175 Vacuum switch 18-176 Pressure switch BACKWASH SIGHT GLASS BACKWASH SIGHT GLASS — Clear sight glass installs into backwash line to inspect discharge water. Available in 11⁄2" MPT brass vertical styles or 11⁄2" FIP and 2" socket ABS horizontal in-line styles. 18-005 11⁄2" brass, 4 bolt style 18-010 11⁄2" brass, center bolt style 18-015 11⁄2" ABS, in-line style 18-020 2" ABS, in-line style 18-175 18-176 18-365 Brass gauge cock, 1⁄4" NPT 18-370 Brass snubber, 1⁄4" NPT 18-375 Brass needle valve, 1⁄4" NPT 18-377 Brass nipple, 1⁄4" NPT 18-375 FILTER ACCESSORIES SACRIFICIAL ANODES — Used as a sacrificial metal to prevent against electrolysis. Reduces pitting of your filters, heaters, and lines. For anode rods, please give make and model of filter and size of anode when new. 18-030 10" anode rod, Swimquip 18-035 Anode rod, Miami HH series 18-040 Anode rod, Miami SFV series 18-045 Anti-electrolysis ball 18-050 MANHOLE GASKETS — Replacement gaskets for around filter inspection ports. Specify filter brand and model number. 18-050 41 Filter Grids & Cartridges FILTER GRID ASSEMBLIES REPLACEMENT CENTER DRAIN GRIDS — Complete grid with polypropylene cover. Specify filter manufacturer when ordering. Spacers, end caps, and thru-rods ordered separately. 18-285 16" diameter Chester 18-290 24 diameter Paddock, 4.125" hub 18-295 24 diameter Paddock, 4.75" hub 18-195 26" dia. Swimquip, without spacer 18-206 Swimquip HBF grid conversion kit 18-207 Universal filter grid spacer REPLACEMENT DOUBLE SIDE OUTLET GRIDS — Complete grid assembly with grid and polypropylene cover. Specify filter manufacturer when ordering. Manifold adapters and element clamps ordered separately. 18-315 30" x 36" 18-325 30" x 60" FILTER CARTRIDGES REPLACEMENT FILTER CARTRIDGES — Replacement polyester cartridges for cartridge filters. Many other sizes available. 18-250 Harmsco 93⁄4" x 23⁄4", 6 sq. ft. 18-251 Harmsco 95⁄8" x 73⁄4", 55 sq. ft. 18-252 Harmsco 191⁄2" x 73⁄4", 105 sq. ft. 18-253 Harmsco 291⁄16" x 73⁄4", 155 sq. ft. FILTER GRID COVERS REPLACEMENT FILTER GRID COVERS — Polypropylene cover with velcro closure for easy-on, easy off field replacement. Zipon covers available but recommended for pressure filters only. Specify outlet location. Grid Cover Size REPLACEMENT BOTTOM OUTLET GRIDS — Complete grid assembly with grid, polypropylene cover, and gasket. Specify filter manufacturer when ordering. Manifold adapters and element clamps ordered separately. 18-210 30" x 36" 18-215 38" x 48" 18-220 30" x 60" 18-221 36" x 60" 24" diameter 26" diameter 24" x 36" 24" x 45" 30" x 36" 38" x 48" 30" x 60" Velcro Closure 18-223 18-225 18-228 18-229 18-230 18-235 18-240 Zipper Closure 18-224 18-226 • • • • • FILTER GRID RECOVERING FILTER GRID RECOVERING SERVICE — Strip off old fabric and send grids to factory to have new polypropylene covers sewn on your existing element. Other sizes available. 18-244 24" diameter 18-245 26" diameter TUBULAR ELEMENT COVERS TUBULAR ELEMENT COVERS — Replacement polypropylene "filter socks" for pressure DE Filters. Specify filter manufacturer when ordering. Other sizes available - inquire. 18-241 3" x 33" 18-242 3" x 37" 18-243 3" x 49" CARTRIDGE FILTER CLEANER REPLACEMENT SIDE OUTLET GRIDS — Complete grid assembly with grid, polypropylene cover, and gasket. Specify filter manufacturer and side outlet location when ordering. Manifold adapters and element clamps ordered separately. 18-300 30" x 36" 18-305 38" x 48" 18-310 30" x 60" 42 18-265 18-270 18-255 Sta-Rite System 3, 100 sq. ft. 18-260 Sta-Rite System 3, 200 sq. ft. 18-265 Sta-Rite System 3, 191 sq. ft. 18-270 Sta-Rite System 3, 259 sq. ft. 18-250 WATER WAND FILTER CLEANER — Hand-held cartridge filter cleaner takes the time, hassle, and mess out of cartridge maintenance. Nozzle fingers opens 8 filter pleats at a time. 8 x 180 degree fan nozzles flush cartridges clean with no splash back. Uses garden hose connection. 18-334 18-332 FILTER CLEANING AIDS SIDE BLASTER ELEMENT WASHER — Side spray pattern cleans grids while in filter. Reduces need for acid washing and damage to grids from handling. Includes: standard 48" pressure washer wand with protective rubber balls and right and left lateral spray nozzles. 2 right and 2 left nozzle models add 4" to wand length. 3 right and 3 left nozzle models add 8" to wand length. Use with your existing pressure washer. 18-330 1 right / 1 left nozzle, 1200 psi 18-331 2 right / 2 left nozzles, 1500 psi 18-332 3 right / 3 left nozzles, 1500 psi ACID PROOF TANK SPRAYER Wide opening and acid resistant valve. Translucent tank with 40" chemical resistant hose. 18-280 2 gallon sprayer www.lincolnaquatics.com Flow Meters 19-012 19-053 FLOW METERS 19-009 SIGNET TRANSMITTERS/MONITOR — Available in two styles digital or analog. Signet SmartPRO Transmitter features a large backlit digital display and dial type bar graph. Accuracy of + .2% with 4-20 mA output. Runs on 12 to 32 VDC power (24 VDC nominal). Signet Sensor Powered Flow Monitor features a balanced-spring meter movement that is powered by the AC output of the Signet 515 Paddlewheel flow sensor. No additional power source is required. Flow sensor and installation fittings ordered separately. UL Listed. 19-009 SmartPro Transmitter, field mount 19-012 SmartPro Transmitter, panel mount 19-013 SmartPro Wall Mount Kit 19-053 Sensor Powered Flow Monitor 19-065 1/2" - 4" 5" - 8" 10" - 36" Signet 515 (Red Cap) 19-065 19-070 19-075 SIGNET MAGMETER FLOW SENSORS — Magmeter is an insertion style magnetic flow sensor without any moving parts and is constructed of corrosion resistant materials for long term reliability. 4-20 mA output can be used for direct input to controllers or for other output needs. Can provide long distance signal output of up to 1,000 ft. Accuracy of +/- 1%. Can be mounted on pipes from 1/2" to 36" diameter. Installation fitting ordered separately. Specify size and type of pipe when ordering. 24 VDC. 19-445 Flow Sensor with Display, 1/2" - 4" pipe 19-450 Flow Sensor with Display, 5" - 8" pipe 19-455 Flow Sensor with Display, 10" - 36" pipe 19-008 Flow meter transformer, 24 volt Signet 2536 (Blue Cap) 19-066 19-071 19-076 19-100 3" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" PVC Clamp Saddle 19-095 19-100 • 19-105 19-110 • • 19-096 19-101 19-103 19-106 19-111 19-116 19-121 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 HORIZONTAL PIPE Item Item 19-245 BLUE-WHITE F1000 DIGITAL FLOW METER Battery operated digital flow meter and flow totalizer. Tamper-proof, ABS, NEMA 4X enclosure. Clear 6 digit LCD display. +/- 2% accuracy. PVDF saddle mount (2"/ 3") or Sch. 80 PVC saddle mount (4"/ 6" / 8"). Operates on 2 AAA batteries, included. Also available, as flow rate only or flow totalizer only meters, inquire. Item Size 19-235 19-240 19-245 GPM Range Item 2" 30-300 19-250 3" 60-600 19-255 4" 100-1,000 • Size 6" 8" • GPM Range 250-2,500 400-4,000 • 19-101 Saddle Fitting 19-133 BLUE-WHITE FLOW METERS — Clear acrylic body, stainless steel float, and easyto-read GPM/LPM scale. Units include: meter, seal, and stainless steel mounting clamps. Available for horizontal pipe and vertical pipe (flow up or flow down). For Sch. 40 PVC pipe installation. Meters for copper tubing mounting also available - inquire. Specify type of pipe. GPM Range Size Item Size GPM Range VERTICAL PIPE SIGNET INSTALLATION FITTINGS Pipe Size 19-140 19-135 11⁄2" 20-100 19-155 4" 125-500 19-140 2" 40-150 19-160 6" 250-1,050 19-145 21⁄2" 60-240 19-165 8" 500-1,900 • • • 19-150 3" 80-300 19-167 Replacement Flow Meter Relief Cap 19-066 SIGNET ROTOR-X FLOW SENSOR — Paddlewheel sensor is simple to install with a highly repeatable output. Can be installed on pipe up to 36". The Signet 515 flow sensor is self-powered and offers an operating range of 1 to 20 ft./sec. The Signet 2536 flow sensor generates an open-collector output and offers an operating range of 0.3 to 20 ft./sec. The 2536 is also a direct replacement for units used with controllers. Transmitter/ monitor and installation fitting are ordered separately. Pipe Size 19-450 19-170 BLUE-WHITE IN-LINE FLOW METERS — Machined acrylic body with stainless float and reinforced FPT adapters for vertical installation. Item Size Flow Range 19-170 19-175 19-180 1⁄2" .5 - 5.0 GPM 1.0 - 10.0 GPM 1.0 - 17.0 GPM 3⁄4" 1" 19-131 19-132 19-133 19-134 Size Flow Direction Flow Range 11/2" 2" Up Down Up Down 20-100 GPM 40-150 GPM 19-215 19-220 PIRO FLOW METERS — Plexiglass meter with engraved calibration is visible from both sides. Can handle pressures up to 250 psi. 1⁄2" IPS polished brass fittings and brass air relief valve. Available in two styles: Horizontal - mounts on top of horizontal pipe and Vertical - which mounts on face of vertical pipe or can be mounted on side of horizontal pipe. Specify type of pipe when ordering. Size 3" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" GPM Range 40-240 100-400 200-600 200-900 400-1,600 500-2,500 700-3,500 Horizontal Vertical 19-185 19-195 19-205 19-215 19-225 19-233 • 19-190 19-200 19-210 19-220 19-230 19-231 19-232 43 Flow Control 20-290 20-005 WATER LEVEL CONTROLS SURGE CHAMBER FLOAT CONTROL — Float actuated multiport pilot control which provides hydraulic on/off operation. Designed for use in open surge tanks. Control operates on minimum level change of 1" and maximum level change of 19". Includes: float control with 2' PVC rod, and wall mounting bracket. Additional 1' PVC rod extensions and brass connectors ordered separately. PVC rod length is 5' maximum unless counter weight is changed. Optional stainless steel float rods and epoxy coated surfaces available. Use with water make up valve, ordered separately. 20-005 Surge chamber float control 20-006 1' rod extension, PVC 20-007 Brass float rod connector 20-001 Repl. surge chamber float only, s.s. LEVOLOR ELECTRONIC WATER LEVEL CONTROLLER — Patented water level control system electronically maintains water level in pools, spas, and fountains. Easy to install on new or existing facilities. Easy-to-read LED display installed in weatherproof enclosure. Remote sensor mounts in stand pipe or static pipe. Includes: level controller (110V), sensor, remote sensor housing, and 1" solenoid valve (24V). Note: Sensor cable must not be spliced. Maximum pressure 125 PSI. Custom length cables available for additional charge. 20-290 Controller with 50 ft. sensor cable 20-300 Controller with 100 ft. sensor cable 20-310 Controller with 200 ft. sensor cable 20-065 FLOAT VALVES LINCOLN VERTICAL FLOAT VALVES — Polypropylene body and disc with dual 8" diameter adjustable plastic floats on stainless steel vertical float rods. For horizontal pipe installation. 80% shut off. 20-050 3" 20-065 8" 20-055 4" 20-070 10" 20-060 6" 20-075 12" 20-132 Replacement float only 20-096 20-030 20-010 WATER MAKE-UP VALVES — Hydraulically operated, globe pattern diaphragm valve with threaded connections. For use with surge chamber float control. Ordered separately. 20-010 1" 20-02521⁄2" 20-030 3" 20-01511⁄2" 20-020 2" 20-045.B 20-045.A 20-045.C WARRICK WATER LEVEL CONTROLLER — Electric control monitors fluid levels and activates water solenoid, when required. Components include: differential level relay mounted in NEMA 4 enclosure, flanged 3 probe holder, and 316 stainless steel probes, 3 required. Components ordered separately to make complete system. Specify probe lengths required. 120 volt solenoid ordered separately. 20-045.A Control w/NEMA 4 enclosure 20-045.B Flanged 3 probe fitting 20-045.C Stainless probes, per ft. 44 WATER SOLENOID VALVES — For use with water level controls to actuate water makeup supply. 24 volt or 120 volt styles. Size 3/4" 1" 11/2" 2" 24 Volt 20- 040 20-041 20-042 20-043 120 Volt 20-046 20-047 20-048 20-049 MERMADE LEVEL CONTROL VALVES — For water level control in open top vacuum DE filters and surge tanks located below water level. Water activated by water pressure from circulation pump. Powerful spring actuator closes butterfly valve, with positive shut off, due to loss of flow 20-175 or power failure. Cast iron body, with nylon coated aluminum bronze disc, and EPDM seat. Pilot valve assembly ordered separately and includes: 1⁄2" in-line strainer, 1⁄2" needle valve, and 0-60 psi pressure gauge. Minimum 20 psi air or water pressure required. 20-170 4" 20-185 10" 20-175 6" 20-190 12" 20-180 8" 20-195 Brass Pilot Valve Assembly LINCOLN MODULATING FLOAT VALVES — Polypropylene body and disc with dual or single 8" diameter adjustable plastic floats on stainless steel float rod. For vertical or horizontal pipe installation. 80% shut off. Size 3" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 20-132 Single Arm Dual Arm 20-080 20-081 20-085 20-086 20-090 20-091 20-095 20-096 20-100 20-101 20-105 20-106 Replacement float only YMCA STYLE FLOAT VALVES — Modulating float valve for use in surge tanks and open top Vacuum D.E. filters. YMCA style encases float valve in PVC pipe, with angled diversion plumbing and flanged connection. Float arm, shaft, and disc are stainless steel, with black plastic float ball. 20-320 4" 20-335 10" 20-325 6" 20-340 12" 20-330 8" www.lincolnaquatics.com Valves & Plumbing Fittings POOL PRO PVC BUTTERFLY VALVES — PVC body, PVC disc, and EPDM materials with 316 stainless steel stem. Seat design eliminates need for mating flange gaskets. Rated at 150 psi (11/2" - 10") and at 100 psi (12") at 70°F. Field mountable accessories include: stem extensions, gear operators, and electric or pneumatic operators - inquire. Size Lever Handle 11⁄2" 2" 21⁄2" 3" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" Gear Operated • • • • • • 92-1728080.G 92-1728100 92-1728120 92-1728015 92-1728020 92-1728025 92-1728030 92-1728040 92-1728060 92-1728080.L • • 92-252311-060 92-2622-020 92-252321-060 92-199-037-002 ALUMINUM BUTTERFLY VALVES CAST ALUMINUM BUTTERFLY VALVES — Cast aluminum valve housing and ductile iron valve disc with Rilsan® coating to provide high resistance to corrosion. EPDM seat with 150 psi pressure rating at 73°F. Hand lever or gear operated valves mount between pipe flanges. Size 2" 21⁄2" 3" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" Hand Lever 92-199-037-000 92-199-037-001 92-199-037-002 92-199-037-003 92-199-037-004 92-199-037-005 92-199-037-006 92-199-037-007 92-199-037-008 Gear Operated 92-199-037-026 92-199-037-027 92-199-037-028 92-199-037-029 92-199-037-030 92-199-037-031 92-199-037-032 92-199-037-033 92-199-037-034 PVC BUTTERFLY VALVES PVC BUTTERFLY VALVES — PVC valves with EPDM seat and Type 316 stainless steel stem. Lever operated valves have high impact polypropylene handle (to 8" size) with built-in lockout capability. Gear operated valves have hand wheel with position indicator. Rated to 150 psi at 73°F. Reversible 180° for either left or right side operation. Size 2" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Gear Operated • 92-252321-040 92-252321-060 92-252321-080 92-252321-100 92-252321-120 PVC BALL VALVES — High quality quarter-turn shut off valve. 150 psi pressure rating at 73°F. EPDM "O" Ring seals and Teflon Ball seats. NSF listed. PVC with SOC connections. Size ⁄2" 3 ⁄4" 1" 11⁄4" 11⁄2" 2" 1 PVC Ball Valves 92-2622-005 92-2622-007 92-2622-010 92-2622-012 92-2622-015 92-2622-020 VALVE EXTENSIONS VALVE EXTENSION HANDLES — Stainless steel valve extension handles allow you to adjust valves remotely. Valve extension, "T" handle, and stainless valve extension anchor ordered separately. Item 92-199-037-031 Lever Handle 92-252311-020 92-252311-040 92-252311-060 92-252311-080 • • PVC BALL VALVES Length Item Length 5' 11' 20-345 20-375 6' 12' 20-350 20-380 7' 13' 20-355 20-385 8' 14' 20-360 20-390 9' 15' 20-365 20-395 10' • • 20-370 20-400 Valve ext. tee handle, 28" x 36" 20-405 Valve ext. anchor with cap PVC TRUE UNION BALL VALVES PVC TRUE UNION BALL VALVES — True union design with double "O" Ring stem seals. PTFE seats with elastomeric backing. 150 psi rating (from 71-120°F). Schedule 80 PVC with SOC connections. NSF Listed. Size ⁄2" 3 ⁄4" 1" 11⁄4" 11⁄2" 2" 1 PVC Ball Valves 92-1640005 92-1640007 92-1640010 92-1640012 92-1640015 92-1640020 45 Valves & Plumbing Fittings 20-270 STAINLESS REDUCER FITTINGS FLANGED REDUCER FITTINGS — Available in concentric and eccentric designs and constructed of T304/T316 stainless steel. ANSI flange connections and includes 2 neoprene flange gaskets. Other sizes available - inquire. Eccentric reducers installed with flat side up. PLUMBING FITTINGS PVC PLUMBING FITTINGS — Available in Schedule 40 and Schedule 80 PVC with solvent weld connections (SOC). Flanges available in Schedule 80 only and are Van Stone style with plastic ring. Size 92-444015 INSTALLATION SADDLES 90° Ell (SOC) Schedule 40 2" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" Tee (SOC) 2" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 92-406-020 92-406-040 92-406-060 92-406-080 92-406-100 92-406-120 Schedule 40 92-401-020 92-401-040 92-401-060 92-401-080 92-401-100 92-401-120 Schedule 80 92-806-020 92-806-040 92-806-060 92-806-080 92-806-100 92-806-120 Schedule 80 CLAMP-IT PVC SADDLES — Heavy duty PVC tapping saddles available with SOC or FPT connections. Other sizes available. Pipe Size 11/2" 2" 92-453015 92-454015 92-456015 92-458015 92-453020 92-454020 92-456020 92-458020 92-443015 92-444015 92-446015 92-448015 92-443020 92-444020 92-446020 92-448020 1" SOC Connection 3" 92-453010 4" 92-454010 6" 92-456010 8" 92-458010 FPT Connection 3" 92-443010 4" 92-444010 6" 92-446010 8" 92-448010 92-801-020 92-801-040 92-801-060 92-801-080 92-801-100 92-801-120 4" x 3" 6" x 3" 6" x 4" 6" x 5" 8" x 4" 8" x 5" 8" x 6" 10" x 5" 10" x 6" Concentric Design Eccentric Design 20-200 20-205 20-210 20-215 20-220 20-225 20-230 20-235 20-240 20-245 20-250 20-255 20-260 20-265 20-270 20-275 20-280 20-285 39-405 WATER STOP FITTINGS WATER STOP FITTINGS — PVC water stop fittings are designed to slip over PVC pipe at wall inlet and floor inlet locations. Eliminates leaking and weeping plumbing by providing a "hydrodynamic" water stop. 39-40011/2" 39-405 2" 20-155 CHECK VALVES Flanges (Van Stone) 2" 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 46 Schedule 80 Gaskets 92-854-020 92-854-040 92-854-060 92-854-080 92-854-100 92-854-120 • 92-PF-400NF8 92-PF-600NF8 92-PF-800NF8 92-PF-1000NF8 92-PF-1200NF8 BUTTERFLY CHECK VALVES — Provides low profile body with extremely quick response to back-flow, without slamming. PVC/CPVC materials with reinforced EPDM seal for long life. Can be mounted in horizontal or vertical positions. 2"-8" valves rated to 150 psi and 10"-12" rated to 100 psi. Available in sizes to 24" - inquire. 20-1352" 20-1558" 20-1403" 20-16010" 20-1454" 20-16512" 20-1506" 39-420 WATER STOP COUPLINGS — PVC/Fiberglass construction fittings are designed for larger connection sizes than the smaller PVC water stop fittings. The couplings stop leaks at surge tanks, equipment room walls, and gutter manifolds. Anywhere your piping must pass through pool shell or facility walls. 39-4103" 39-43010" 39-4154" 39-43512" 39-4206"39-44014" 39-4258" www.lincolnaquatics.com Main Drain Grates 39-721 VIRGINIA GRAEME BAKER POOL AND SPA SAFETY ACT The Virginia Graeme Baker Pool and Spa Safety Act (VGB) was signed into federal law on December 19, 2007 and requires all public swimming pools and spas be compliant by December 19, 2008. Public swimming pools and spas must replace their suction outlet covers with drain covers that meet the ASME/ANSI A112.19.8 performance standard. VGB Compliant drain covers are tested and rated for flow rates relating to body and hair entrapment. Each drain cover is listed with specific flow ratings, based on whether the drains are placed on the floor or on the vertical wall. The VGB Act identifies remedies for pools and spas that have single drains, multiple drains, and exceptions for pools or spas with "unblockable drains" (drains more than 18" x 32" in size, with an open area diagonal of more than 29 inches). The additional remedies include: adding an additional drain (if you have a single drain system), installing a Safety Vacuum Release System (SVRS), installing a suction limiting vent system, installing an automatic pump shut-off system, installing a gravity drainage system, or considering drain disablement or reversal of flow. Be sure to contact your local health department to insure compliance. Additional information is available from the Consumer Product Safety Commission website at www.cpsc.gov or our Lincoln website at www.lincolnaquatics.com FREE-FLO VGB GRATE AND FRAME — 16" x 16" grate: 101 sq. in. open area fits 12" x 12" opening. Floor - 460 GPM @ 1.46 fps or Wall - 445 GPM @ 1.4 fps. 14" x 14" grate: 84 sq. in open area fits 9" x 9" opening. Floor/Wall - 394 GPM @ 1.5 fps. Unit with frame can be used for new installation. All components meet or exceed NSF 50/ASME/ ANSI A112.19.8 performance standards and ASTM G154 UV Testing. 39-721 16" x 16" Grate & retro frame, fits Hayward & Waterway 39-722 16" x 16" Grate, frame, & retro frame, fits Pentair & AquaStar 39-723 14" x 14" Grate & retro frame, fits Hayward & Waterway 39-724 14" x 14" Grate, frame, & retro frame, fits Pentair & AquaStar 39-735 39-835 39-760 39-815 39-860 39-725 AQUASTAR VGB GRATES AQUASTAR VGB GRATES — For Single or Multiple Drain Use (See Installation Instructions). Manufactured from superior UV-resistant engineered polymers. For new construction or retrofit into existing frames. Confirm sump depth requirements. AquaStar grates are to be replaced every 5 years after date of install. All components (cover, frame, screws) meet or exceed NSF 50/ASME/ANSI A112.19.8 performance standard and ASTM G154 UV Testing. AQUASTAR SQUARE VGB GRATES Item 39-705 39-840 39-860 39-712 39-820 39-845 39-725 39-717 39-729 39-716 39-731 39-718 39-730 Size Description Wave Grate w/riser ring & frame MoFlow Grate w/frame, 3/4" MoFlow Grate replacement, 1" Wave Grate w/riser ring & frame 12"x12" MoFlow Grate w/frame, 3/4" MoFlow Grate replacement, 1" Wave Grate w/riser ring & frame 18"x18" Wave Grate retrofit kit Star Grate w/riser ring & frame 18"x18" Star Grate retrofit kit Wave Grate with frame 24"x24" Wave Grate retrofit kit 24"x24" Flat Grate with frame 9"x9" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Open Flow Rate GPM Area (Sq. In.) Floor Wall fps 48.4 36.8 35.8 90.8 71.2 69.1 224 224 172 172 147.3 147.3 361 361 332.9 332.9 323.1 323.1 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.5 1.5 176.8 628 628 1.1 160.8 740 740 1.5 340.8 1,444 1,444 1.3 352.0 1,531 1,531 1.4 AQUASTAR ROUND VGB GRATES Item Size 39-735 8" dia. 39-742 8" dia. 39-835 8" dia. 39-855 8" dia. 39-760 10" dia. 39-815 10" dia. Description Suction outlet cover with riser ring & frame Super Hi Flow grate with riser ring & frame MoFlow Suction outlet cover & frame Retrofit MoFlow Suction outlet cover & frame Star Grate with retrofit adapter & frame MoFlow Suction outlet cover & frame Open Area (Sq. In.) Flow Rate GPM (@1.5 fps) Floor Wall 13.1 61.2 61.2 16.0 75 75 16.6 77.8 77.8 16.1 75.3 75.3 31.5 147.3 147.3 31.3 146.3 146.3 47 Main Drain Grates 39-545 39-500 STAINLESS STEEL VGB GRATES 39-540 39-560 HAYWARD VGB GRATES HAYWARD VGB GRATES — These high quality VGB Compliant grates are designed with a smooth, sloped edge for safety and comfort. Available in: retro-fit style for use on existing Hayward frames or with new frame and grate assembly, for new construction. Grates are to be replaced every 7 years after date of install. Meets ANSI/ASME A112.19.8 performance standard. Item Size Description 39-545 9" x 9" Repl. inner frame & grate 39-550 12" x 12" Repl. inner frame & grate Inner & outer frame 39-555 12" x 12" & grate, pkg. of 2 Inner & outer frame 39-560 18" x 18" & grate, pkg. of 2 39-525 8" dia. Frame & grate, pkg. of 2 39-540 8" dia. Repl. floor cover & screws Open Flow Rate GPM Area Wall (Sq. In.) Floor 23.96 41.07 264 515 224 308 41.07 515 308 92.72 812 732 8.1 8.1 125 125 72 72 STAINLESS STEEL VGB GRATES — VGB Compliant drain covers have gradual sloped sides and a solid top surface for safety. These grates are designed to be placed over the top of your existing grate and sump to fully cover the opening and allow your facility to be compliant. Grates must be grounded. Grates are to be replaced every 20 years and hardware every 10 years after date of install. Meets ANSI/ASME A112.19.8 performance standard. Item Size 39-500 20"x20" 39-505 26"x26" 39-510 32"x32" 39-515 44"x44" Description Stainless cover (fits 12"x12" sump) Stainless cover (fits 18"x18" sump) Stainless cover (fits 24"x24" sump) Stainless cover (fits 36"x36" sump) Open Area (Sq. In.) Floor Wall 73.6 223 • 108.9 495 • 144.3 675 • 209.1 975 • 39-605 SUPERFLOW™ VGB GRATES SUPERFLOW™ VGB GRATES — Domed SuperFlow™ grates have high effective flow rates compared to competitive grates. Raised crossridged profile for safety and foot comfort. Includes frame, grate, and attaching hardware. Available in 3 sizes. Grates are to be replaced every 10 years after date of install. Meets ANSI/ASME performance standard. NSF listed. Item Size Description Frame & grate assembly, set of 2 Frame & grate assembly, 39-605 12" x 12" set of 2 Frame & grate assembly, 39-610 18" x 18" set of 2 39-600 9" x 9" 48 Open Flow Rate GPM Area Wall (Sq. In.) Floor 42.12 261 248 81.3 365 340 183.06 816 712 FIBERGLASS VGB GRATES Flow Rate GPM 39-800 AEGIS FIBERGLASS VGB GRATE — This grate is the only solid fiberglass VGB drain cover available. Requires no grounding to the pool shell and is completely resistant to corrosion. 30" x 30" grate size allows main drain up to 24" x 24" to be covered. Stainless steel sumps with 30" x 30" VGB fiberglass grate available for new construction in two sizes: 18" x 18" x 18" sump (with 6" flanged connection) and 24" x 24" x 24" (with 8" flanged connection). Aegis VGB Grate includes stainless steel mounting hardware. NSF Certified Maximum Flow Rate: Floor - 1432 GPM and Wall - 1120 GPM. Maximum Flow Rate @ 1.5 fps - 600 GPM. Open Area: 128.21 sq. in. Grates are to be replaced every 10 years after date of install. 10 Year Warranty. Meets ANSI/ASME A112.19.8a performance standard and NSF listed. 39-800 Aegis 30" x 30" grate only 39-805 Stainless Steel Sump, 18" x 18" x 18" with grate 39-810 Stainless Steel Sump, 24" x 24" x 24" with grate www.lincolnaquatics.com Main Drain Sumps & Fittings 39-519 STAINLESS STEEL VGB SUMPS STAINLESS STEEL VGB SUMPS — Commercial grade stainless steel sump with upper lip around sump perimeter to accept stainless steel anti-entrapment grate. Constructed from Type 304 stainless steel and includes 2” stainless steel full coupling and stainless steel flange for plumbing connection. These sumps and grates are ASME A.112.19.8M-2007 Approved. Item 39-518 39-519 39-520 39-521 Main Drain Size Flange Flow Rate (L x W x H) Size GPM 12" x 12" x 14" 18" x 18" x 20" 24" x 24" x 25" 36" x 36" x 30" 4" 6" 8" 10" 223 495 675 975 PVC VGB SUMPS 39-630 SUPERSUMP™ — Includes SuperFlow™ VGB Compliant grate that provides exceptional flow rates. Internal plumbing fittings and builtin water stop with two vertical extensions, prevents water from passing over the 39-519 flange. Injection molded design with tapered body, for additional strength, allows for water expansion during freeze periods. ASME-2007 and NSF Listed. UV and strength tested under ASME A.112.19.8M. Item Main Drain Opening Size 39-620 39-625 39-630 9" x 9" 12" x 12" 18" x 18" Flow Rate (@ 1.5 fps) Floor Wall 261 GPM 248 GPM 365 GPM 340 GPM 816 GPM 712 GPM 39-185 HYDROSTATIC RELIEF VALVE HYDROSTATIC RELIEF VALVE ASSEMBLY Relieves ground water pressure from damaging pool. Installed in the main drain, which allows ground water to vent into the pool. Includes: cycolac collection tube, brass noleak flange and brass hydrostatic relief valve. Complete. 39-180 11⁄2" 39-1852" 39-190 39-720 39-635 FIBERGLASS VGB SUMPS SUPERFLOW™ LARGE AREA SUMPS — Fiberglass main drain sumps with flat, “unblockable” PVC SuperFlow™ grates. Can be installed in floor or wall. Includes 2 x 2” female adapters, hydrostatic relief valve and collection tube, and 1 x 10” coupling. Connections can be threaded, flanged, or slip- specify. Additional custom sizes available. Grating available in 2 colors: black or white. Hydrostatic relief value and collection tube ordered separately. ASME-2007 and NSF Listed. UV and strength tested under ASME A.112.19.8M. Item Grate Size 39-635 39-640 39-645 18" x 36" 18" x 54" 18" x 72" Flow Rate Open GPM Area (Sq. In.) Floor Wall 343.44 515.16 686.88 2,080 1,496 4,269 • 4,569 • TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 COMMERCIAL SUMP WITH WAVE OUTLET COVER — 12" deep PVC sump with 12” x 12” “wave” style frame and grate assembly. Grate has 85.2 sq. in. open area and can be mounted on floor or wall. Rated at 400 GPM (@1.5 fps). Two 2 1/2” x 2” S/S bottom ports with 2” FPT inside sump. NSF 50/ASME/ANSI A112.19.82007 national standards and ASTM G154 UV Testing. 39-720 COLLECTION TUBE — Cycolac. 39-19011⁄2" / 2" 39-195 39-200 NO-LEAK FLANGE — Brass. 39-19511⁄2" 39-2002" 39-590 DELUXE SUCTION OUTLETS WITH COVER Dual, 8” diameter suction outlet set, with VGB Compliant domed cover. 2” FPT side and bottom ports. Grate has 8.1 sq. in. open area and can be mounted on floor or wall. Rated at 125 GPM (Floor) and 72 GPM (Wall). Sold as package of 2 only. Meets ANSI/ASME A112.19.82007 national standards. 39-590 39-188 39-205 39-210 HYDROSTATIC RELIEF VALVE 39-20511⁄2" Brass 39-210 2" Brass 39-18811⁄2" / 2" ABS 49 Drains & Fittings 40-037 39-215 WALL INLET FITTINGS GUTTER DRAINS ANGLE GUTTER DRAIN — Chrome-plated bronze. 2" FIP connection. 39-215 25⁄8" x 53⁄8" — complete 39-220 Replacement grill 39-225 39-230 FLUSH GUTTER DRAIN — Chrome-plated bronze. 2" FIP connection. 39-22527⁄16" x 55⁄8" — complete 39-230 Replacement grate 39-23521⁄2" x 39⁄16" — complete 39-240 Replacement grate 39-250 FLUSH GUTTER DRAIN — ABS, 2" FIP / 2" socket connection. 39-25023⁄4" x 47⁄16" — complete 39-255 Replacement grate ADJUSTABLE WALL INLET — Cycolac. 40-037 11/2" FIP X 2" MIP 40-045 40-040 NONADJUSTABLE WALL INLET — CPB. 40-040 11/2" FIP 40-052 Repl. cover plate only ADJUSTABLE WALL INLET — CPB. 40-045 11/2" FIP 40-050 2" FIP 40-052 Repl. cover plate only 40-060 WALL INLET FITTING — Cycolac with adjustable nozzle orifice sizes. 40-05511⁄4" solvent weld 40-06011/2" solvent weld 40-005 FLOOR INLET FITTINGS 40-010 ADJUSTABLE FLOOR INLET — Cycolac fitting with internal threads for pressure testing. Adjustable cover plate with set screw. For floor mounting only. Colors: white, gray, or black. 40-005 11/2" / 2" solvent weld 40-010 Replacement cover plate only 40-012 Replacement set screw only 40-020 40-015 ADJUSTABLE FLOOR INLET — CPB. 40-01511/2" FIP 40-020 Replacement cover plate only 40-035 ADJUSTABLE FLOOR INLET — Cycolac. 40-035 11/2" FIP x 2" MIP 40-301 40-306 40-070 EYEBALL WALL INLET FITTING — Cycolac. 11/2" solvent weld. Variable direction, 3⁄4" return orifice. 40-070 40-300 40-305 VGB EQUALIZER FITTINGS 40-090 40-085 VACUUM FITTINGS 40-075 CYCOLAC VACUUM FITTINGS — Complete. 40-075 11/2" FIP x 2" MIP 40-08011/2" vacuum fitting plug only CPB VACUUM FITTINGS — Complete. 40-085 For 11/2" hose - 2" MIP x 11/2" FIP 40-090 For 2" hose - 21/2" MIP x 11/2" FIP 40-09511/2" CPB plug only 40-100 2" CPB plug only 50 40-065 ADJUSTABLE INLET FITTING — 5" x 5" square inlet is designed for both floor or wall installation. Inlet allows flow adjustment in four directions. Color: white. 40-065 11/2" / 2" VGB SUCTION OUTLET COVERS — Used to retro-fit skimmer equalizer lines. 4" dia. - 5.5 sq. in. open area, rated at 24.4 GPM @ 1.5 fps. 6" dia. - 11.4 sq. in. open area, rated at 53.6 GPM @ 1.5 fps. Includes mounting screws. 2" MPT x 11/2" slip sumpless bulkhead fitting ordered separately. Other fitting sizes available - inquire. Color: white 40-300 4" dia. VGB suction outlet fitting 40-305 6" dia. VGB suction outlet fitting 40-301 4" dia. Bulkhead fitting 40-306 6" dia. Bulkhead fitting www.lincolnaquatics.com Skimmers & Tools SELF-ANCHORING SKIMMER WEIRS — Easy to install. Just position, pull out pins, and it’s done. Stainless steel spring-loaded to ensure against slipping from position. Additional sizes to 16" available - inquire. 40-1956" 40-21083⁄8" 40-2007" 40-2209" 40-2058" 40-22510" Kit Includes: Hand Knob Cylinder 40-155 Hex Bar SURFACE SKIMMERS AUTOMATIC SURFACE SKIMMER — Swimquip U-3 trouble free, efficient skimmer with float for low water pump protection. Removes floating leaves and debris from pool surface. Color: white. NSF listed. 40-155 2" slip connection — complete Anchor Extractor Hardened Stud 40-190 40-230 SKIM-PRO SKIMMER BASKET — Basket tower allows continued water circulation, even as basket fills with debris. Fits Pentair/Swimquip U-3 skimmers and Hayward 1070 Series skimmers. 81⁄4" basket dia. x 13" high tower. 40-190 CIRCULAR SKIMMER WEIR — Convert U-3 skimmer basket to use circular skimmer weir. Weir adapter snaps onto skimmer basket. Basket ordered separately. 40-230 WINTERIZING PLUGS GIZZMO WINTERIZING PLUGS — Designed to absorb expansion in skimmers due to winter freeze-up. Super New Gizzmo fits deep skimmers and Ultra Gizzmo includes built-in blowout tube for winterizing pool lines. Both Gizzmos are 16" long and have 11/2"/2" tapered pipe threads. 40-270 Super New Gizzmo 40-275 Ultra Gizzmo Wing Key 12-24 Tap Castle Nut 5/16 Tap SERVICE TOOLS WINGMASTER SERVICE TOOLS — MultiTool Service Kit contains specially designed tools for removing seized safety cover anchors (pop-up or threaded style). Wingmaster Plus Tool raises and lowers safety cover anchors, removes/installs vacuum fittings, and winterizing plugs. Wing HydroTool is accessory to Wingmaster Plus Tool which allows installation/removal of Hayward hydrostatic relief valves and floor inlet fittings. Wing Jet Key allows installation/removal of spa jet fittings and pool inlet fittings. 40-250 Multi-Tool Service Kit 40-255 Wingmaster Plus Tool 40-260 Wing Hydro Tool 40-265 Wing Jet Key 40-405 SKIMMER ACCESSORIES U-3 SKIMMER PARTS 40-160 Skimmer basket 40-165 Deck lid (white) 40-17083⁄8" weir 40-175 Float valve with diverter and o-ring 40-18011⁄2" spring check valve 40-185 2" spring check valve TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 40-250 40-110 FILL SPOUTS FILL SPOUTS — Available in T304 stainless steel or CPB. 18" wide. 40-105 1" MIP, stainless steel 40-11011⁄2" MIP, stainless steel 40-115 2" MIP, CPB 40-255 PIPE SHEARS — Ratcheting PVC pipe shears with replaceable blades. For Sch. 40 or Sch. 80 pipe. Item Description Pipe Size Repl. Blades 40-400 Pipe Shears 3/4"-1" O.D. 40-415 40-405 Pipe Shears 11/4"-15/8" O.D. 40-420 40-410 Pipe Shears 17/8"-21/2" O.D. 40-425 51 Heating Systems 21-560 LOW NOX POOL HEATERS 21-025 COMMERCIAL POOL HEATERS PENTAIR MEGATHERM HEATERS — Commercial pool heaters are available for indoor or outdoor installation, in either natural gas or propane. Includes: Copper-finned heat exchanger, glass-lined cast iron headers, stainless steel burners, operating gas valve/safety regulator, redundant safety gas valve, automatic temperature control, safety high limit, manual shut off valve, manual pilot valve, pressure relief valve, two temperature gauges, integral pump and energy management control system. Spark ignition standard on natural gas models. Standing pilot with electronic pilot supervision and 1 second shut down, standard on propane models. 82% efficiency. When ordering, specify indoor or outdoor installation location, natural gas or propane, and facility altitude. Vent piping on indoor models not included. Other options available at additional cost include: Bronze headers, cupro-nickel heat exchangers, and other special code options. Units installed over 2,000 feet above sea level, must be derated 4% per 1,000 feet above 2,000 feet. Specify State Code Requirements. Limited availability in California. ASME Certified. BTU/Hr. Input 500,000 600,000 715,000 850,000 1,010,000 1,200,000 1,430,000 1,670,000 1,825,000 2,000,000 2,200,000 2,450,000 2,800,000 3,050,000 3,200,000 3,500,000 3,600,000 4,000,000 4,050,000 4,500,000 5,000,000 Cal Code 52 Indoor Heaters 21-005 21-010 21-015 21-020 21-025 21-030 21-035 21-040 21-045 21-145 • 21-155 • 21-165 • 21-175 • • 21-195 21-205 21-215 21-050 Outdoor Heaters 21-003 21-008 21-013 21-018 21-023 21-028 21-033 21-038 21-043 • 21-150 • 21-160 • 21-170 • 21-180 21-190 • 21-210 • 21-050 21-380 RAYPAK COMMERCIAL POOL HEATERS — These heaters are unmatched for heating efficiency (up to 82% thermal efficiency), operating economy, low cost installation and all-around dependability. Electronic Pilot ignition, bronze headers, cupro-nickel finned tubes, and long lasting polytuf powder coat finish. Unitherm governor (models 514-1223) or By-Pass Pump (models 1287-4001) for temperature control within heater and to avoid condensation and sealing. Dual gas valves for safety and stainless steel burners for corrosion protection. When ordering, specify indoor or outdoor installation location and natural gas or propane. Indoor models require draft hood, not included. Units installed over 2,000 feet above sea level, must be derated 4% per 1,000 feet above 2,000 feet. Specify State Code Requirements. Limited availability in California. ASME Certified. BTU/Hr. Input 511,500 627,000 726,000 825,000 926,000 961,700 1,083,000 1,124.700 1,178,000 1,222,500 1,287,000 1,336,600 1,413,000 1,467,000 1,570,000 1,630,000 1,758,000 1,825,000 2,100,000 2,499,000 3,000,000 3,500,000 4,000,000 Cal Code Indoor Heaters 21-310 21-320 21-330 21-340 • 21-355 • 21-360 • 21-370 • 21-380 • 21-390 • 21-400 • 21-410 21-415 21-420 21-425 21-430 21-435 21-437 Outdoor Heaters 21-315 21-325 21-335 21-345 21-350 • 21-357 • 21-365 • 21-375 • 21-385 • 21-395 • 21-405 • • • • • • 21-437 Your Lincoln Representative can help you size the best heater for your pool based on your pool size and climate conditions. RAYPAK HI DELTA POOL HEATERS — 85% thermal efficiency with sealed combustion chamber and hot surface ignition, with remote sensing. Ultra-low NOx (less than 20 ppm) with bronze headers, cupro-nickel and bronze waterways. Unitherm governor provides condensation free operation. Available in natural gas or propane and can be installed indoors or outdoors, specify. Includes: Cal Code. Easy installation requires only 1" clearance. Units are stackable and require small vent sizes out the top or the back. Vent caps, other options and rack systems also available at additional cost. Contact us for requirements on more than 3,000 feet above sea level. Specify State Code Requirements. ASME Certified. BTU/Hr. Input 300,000 399,000 500,000 650,000 750,000 900,000 990,000 1,260,000 1,530,000 1,800,000 1,999,000 2,070,000 2,340,000 Natural Gas 21-440 21-450 21-460 21-470 21-480 21-490 21-500 21-510 21-520 21-530 21-540 21-550 21-560 Propane 21-445 21-455 21-465 21-475 21-485 21-495 21-505 21-515 21-525 21-535 • 21-555 21-565 21-330 21-420 www.lincolnaquatics.com Heating Systems 21-660 21-720 PENTAIR POWERMAX POOL HEATERS High performance, energy efficient pool heaters specifically designed for commercial pool and water park applications. 85% efficiency, that exceeds Low NOx emission requirements. The advanced features of the PowerMax pool heaters include a built-in automatic mixing system that compensates for low water temperature and prevents formation of problematic, corrosive condensation in the heat exchanger. The mixing system includes: automatic 3-way valve, fast acting electronic actuator, factory mounted pump, and controls that monitor all functions of the system operation. Every PowerMax heater also comes standard with a “Backwash Switch” which allows maintenance staff to prepare the heater for a filter backwash by allowing the pump time delay to complete its cycle before shutting down the heater. The PowerMax automatic bypass and combustion systems are factory preset and no further adjustments are necessary. No orifice or component changes for high altitude installations are required, other than derating performance 2% per 1,000 ft. above sea level. Fan assisted and filtered combustion air, reversible vent and intake air terminals, front panel diagnostics, and reversible gas and water connections allow PowerMax to be installed almost anywhere with minimal effort. Service is simple with quick access panel for igniter replacement, combustion chamber sight glasses on both right and left sides, and dual ignition system. Optional: Cupro-nickel heat exchanger and rack-mounting system, inquire. Specify state code requirements, facility altitude, and whether for indoor or outdoor installation, when ordering. Outdoor heater accessory kits ordered separately. ASME Certified. BTU/Hr. Input 500,000 750,000 1,000,000 1,250,000 1,500,000 1,750,000 2,000,000 Natural Gas 21-700 21-710 21-720 21-730 21-740 21-750 21-760 Propane 21-705 21-715 21-725 21-735 21-745 21-755 21-765 Outdoor Kit 21-706 21-716 21-726 21-736 21-746 21-756 21-766 Your Lincoln Representative can help you properly size your pool/spa heater based on pool size, climatic conditions, altitude, and local codes for emissions. Inquire. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 HIGH EFFICIENCY HEATERS RAYPAK XTHERM POOL HEATERS - Newest generation pool heater from Raypak. Vertical modulating heater offers thermal efficiencies of up to 98%. Installation of an XTherm heater will allow your facility to realize substantial energy savings and will show a short payback time, when compared to your existing heater costs. Ultra low NOx emissions with multiple venting options. XTherm has one of the smallest installed footprints available. Cold water run system protects against condensation in primary heat exchanger. Includes: Cupronickel finned tubes, bronze headers, and electronic diagnostic controls. Venting and Cal Code ignition ordered separately. Contact us for requirements on heaters installed above 5,000 ft. All models are indoor/outdoor certified. Available in natural gas or propane. Specify state code requirements. ASME Certified. 10 Year Limited Warranty. BTU/Hr. Input 1,000,000 1,500,000 2,000,000 Cal Code Natural Gas 21-650 21-660 21-670 21-680 21-614 RAYPAK PROFESSIONAL 84 HEATERS Digital commercial pool heaters with self diagnostic controls. Includes: bronze headers, direct spark ignition, internal by-pass, and stainless steel base. Direct vent capable, top and rear. Cupro-nickel heat exchanger, with 84% efficiency and Low NOx emissions. Can be installed outdoors or indoors with venting. Available in natural gas or propane, with 0-2,000 ft. or 2,000-5,000 ft. altitude units. For installations over 5,000 ft. — inquire. ASME Certified heat exchanger. 3 Year Limited Warranty. BTU/Hr. Input 250,000 399,000 21-618 Elevation Natural Gas Propane 0-2,000 ft. 21-610 21-611 2-5,000 ft. 21-612 21-613 0-2,000 ft. 21-614 21-615 2-5,000 ft. 21-616 21-617 Outdoor horizontal vent cap kit Propane 21-655 21-665 21-675 21-680 21-785 21-641 RAYPAK PROFESSIONAL X94 HEATERS Digital, low NOx, condensing pool heater. 399,00 BTU input that produces 94% efficiency with ASME Stainless Steel Marine Grade Heat Exchanger and Stainless Steel headers. Specially engineered for corrosion resistance. Designed for durability and can be installed indoors or outdoors. Requires Cat IV venting: PVC, CPVC, Dura-Vent Polypro, or stainless steel. 2" PVC inlet/outlet connection with 1/2" PVC drain port. Available in natural gas or propane. 115 V/60 Hz power supply. 3 Year Commercial Warranty. 21-641 399,000 BTU, natural gas 21-642 399,000 BTU, propane STA-RITE MAX-E-THERM POOL HEATERS For indoor and outdoor installations. Lightest weight heater available in its class. Patented, rust proof Dura-Glas heater enclosure, handles the heat and weathers the elements. 84% Efficiency. Includes: top mounted digital heater controls with LED temperature readout, dual thermostat and temperature safety lockout. PMG burner technology requires no outdoor draft hood. Plastic manifold with PVC union connections. Available in natural gas or propane. Units also available with HD cupro-nickel heat exchangers and ASME Certified (400,000 BTU only). All units are certified for Low NOx emissions. 2 Year Limited Warranty. Natural Gas Propane BTU/Hr. Input Standard HD ASME Standard ASME 200,000 21-775 21-777 • • 21-776 333,000 21-780 21-782 • • 21-781 400,000 21-785 21-787 21-790 21-786 21-791 53 Heating Systems & Accessories 21-804 ELECTRIC HEATERS COMPACT ELECTRIC POOL/SPA HEATERS All stainless tank for long life and corrosion resistance. Features include: flow switch, manual reset hi-limit switch, heavy duty contactor, and element and flow switch "on" lights. 11/2" male NPT connections. UL Listed for indoor/outdoor installation. Voltage 240 volt/1 phase 208 volt/3 phase 240 volt/3 phase 480 volt/3 phase 12 KW 21-800 21-803 21-806 21-809 15 KW 18 KW 21-801 21-804 21-807 21-810 21-802 21-805 21-808 21-811 21-925 CORROSION MONITOR PROMINENT LOG R CORROSION MONITOR Single channel corrosion rate monitor that uses Linear Polarization Resistance (LPR) to measure the corrosion rate of metals. Readings are taken every 2.5 minutes giving accurate corrosion rates instantly. Stores up to one year of log data. Includes: monitor, sensor, 3/4" "T" fitting, wall mounting bracket, and 110VAC/24 VDC power adapter. 21-925 Cupro-nickel sensor package 21-930 Copper sensor package 21-935 Admiralty sensor package 21-940 Carbon steel sensor package 21-945 Zinc sensor package 21-125 21-115 21-120 IN-LINE THERMOMETERS IN-LINE THERMOMETERS — 7" aluminum case in-line thermometer that allows you to check circulation line temperatures. Scale range 30-240° F. 31⁄2" separable brass socket allows for removal of thermometer without leakage. Available in vari-angle for quick adjustment to all angles, straight form stationary, or angle form stationary. 21-115 Vari-angle 21-120 Straight form stationary 21-125 Angle form stationary 21-835 COMMERCIAL ELECTRIC POOL/SPA HEATERS — Medium duty pool and spa heaters with built-in flow switch. Operating range: 20-80 GPM. Includes: Incoly heating elements, stainless tank, digital thermostat, manual reset hi-limit switch, flow switch, and element, flow and high temp "on" lights. 24/30 KW units (CPH Series) with 11/2" male NPT connections. 36 KW and higher units (PHS Series) have 2" male NPT connections. UL Listed for indoor/outdoor installation. CPH SERIES Voltage 240 volt/1 phase 208 volt/3 phase 240 volt/3 phase 480 volt/3 phase PHS SERIES Voltage 24 KW 21-820 21-822 21-824 21-826 36 KW 45 KW 240V/1 phase 21-830 21-831 208V/3 phase 21-834 21-835 240V/3 phase 21-838 21-839 480V/3 phase 21-842 21-843 Electric Spa Heater Sizing: 30 KW 54 KW 21-832 21-836 21-840 21-844 57 KW 21-833 21-837 21-841 21-845 KW required = Gallonage x 8.3 lbs./gal. x TEMP rise (in °F/Hr.) 3413 Electric Pool Heater Sizing: KW required = Surface Area x TEMP differential (°F) x 12 3413 Heat Loss Factor: For use in electrical pool heater sizing formula above. 12 = outdoor pool or 10 = indoor pool 54 21-132 21-821 21-823 21-825 21-827 21-131 21-135 WATER THERMOMETERS 21-305 PORTABLE AERATION SYSTEM WATERCANNON AERATION SYSTEMS — Reduces summertime pool water temperature 15-20°. Portable water feature makes your facility fun and relaxing. Improves water quality and safety. Units include: GFCI, 50 ft. cord, safe triple suction assembly, and sprayer arm assembly with chrome/brass adjustable nozzles. Available in: 11/2 HP (115 volt/20 amp/single phase/110 GPM) and 3 HP (230 volt/20 amp/ single phase/160 GPM) models. 50Hz/60Hz. 3 HP unit comes with stainless steel cart. 21-303 Watercannon 1.5 21-305 Watercannon 3 JIM BUOY THERMOMETER — Convertible top allows thermometer to be used as floating unit or tethered with 36" lanyard. 8" injection molded plastic body with shatter proof lens. 21-132 ECONOMY THERMOMETER — 10" long plastic case thermometer with 12" lanyard. 21-131 DELUXE THERMOMETER — 7" long solid brass thermometer with chrome finish, magnifying plastic lens, and 36" lanyard. 21-135 SKIMMER LID THERMOMETER — Round skimmer lid with built-in 3" diameter thermometer. Specify skimmer manufacturer when ordering. 21-140 www.lincolnaquatics.com Energy Conservation 98-110 ENERGY CONTROLLERS TEK™ ENERGY SMART™ CONTROLLERS Commercial pool monitoring and control system gives you unprecedented remote control and access to pool information and conditions at your facility. Allows control and scheduling of swimming pool systems with multiple pumps, heaters, solar arrays, and variable frequency drives (VFD) to maximize energy efficiency. Monitor and control pool parameters on any internet enabled device, including smart phones and tablets. Supports 24/7 e-mail alerts for system conditions based on user definable set points. Standard internal 24V power supply simplifies expanded pool instrumentation. SOLAR ENERGY SYSTEMS SOLAR ENERGY SYSTEMS — Your pool and pool equipment are one of the biggest consumers of energy in your facility and one of the biggest expenses in your budget. New solar and energy efficiency technologies can dramatically reduce your energy consumption and operating costs. Solar and energy efficiency products have the potential to dramatically improve your pool operations and reduce your energy and maintenance expenses. They are complex and require special expertise to optimize their performance, insure proper installation and maximize your savings. Lincoln has a team of professional engineers, consultants, and contractors with extensive experience in the design and installation of complete energy conservation systems for commercial pools. Our team can deliver a turnkey solution for your specific situation. Generous rebates and other incentives are available from the state and your local utility, but applying for them can be complex and requires a trained and certified expert. To receive rebates and incentives for your project an application, energy savings calculations, pay back data and other documentation is required. Lincoln has successfully applied for and been granted numerous rebates and incentives for its customers. Each component of your energy efficiency upgrade project must be installed and configured to operate at peak efficiency. Depending on the scope of your project, many different contractors and experts may be required to complete your installation. Our team of engineers and contractors can manage the project for you. We have many years of experience with commercial swimming pool products so we can insure that the right products are selected and installed to optimize the efficiency at your facility. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 98-100 Our new Eco-Spark Solar Systems allow you to optimize energy efficiency and begin to generate your own heat source for your swimming pool. Extend your swimming season, save money, and reduce your carbon footprint. These solar panels have been designed with a special glazing, significantly increasing the performance of the collector. The glazing creates a greenhouse effect to preserve energy in the collector. Made from 100% UV stabilized polypropylene, using a unique over-molding process, which provides a seamless leak proof unit. The panels polymeric composition allows it to withstand harsh swimming pool chemicals and salt water environments. The multiwall glazing seals the panel and protects it against external water and dust, while stabilizing it from the damaging effects of UV light exposure. Square header design assures tight fastening and mounting of the solar panels. Headers and risers are molded together forming one solid piece, eliminating welds that crack with age and stress. The design preserves water flow with minimum pressure drop across the panel. 12 Year Warranty. 98-100 The Controller is available in 2 versions: Basic Energy Smart™ Controller - Enables monitoring of system performance and tracking of energy use on any internet enabled device. Provides basic control of solar systems, many Pentair variable speed pumps, and Dan Foss VFDs. Programmable PLC logic for custom pool monitoring, including monitoring of up to 4 parameters. Also includes output control of up to 2 devices for solar control, filter pump and VFD scheduling. Expanded Energy Smart™ Controller Features front panel touch screen interface and expanded inputs and outputs. Enables onsite and internet based remote control and automation of complex commercial pool systems. Provides detailed monitoring, control and reporting of energy use/production and pool water conditions/chemistry. Customizable to facilitate local utility mandated load shedding. Monitors up to 8 separate devices and provides up to 8 output relays. Can be optionally configured for Modbus and other industrial control strategies. Flow sensors, installation fittings, and other required pool components ordered separately. Requires hard wired internet connection or can be optionally configured for wifi or with internal internet cell modem. Includes first 6 months of internet hosting and cloud based data logging. 98-105 Energy Smart Controller - Basic 98-110 Energy Smart Controller - Expanded 55 Grating Systems PARALLEL PVC GRATING SYSTEMS LAWSON QUIET-FLOW® PARALLEL GRATING — Designed to capture water quickly and reduce the noise of commercial gutters. Can be fitted to any free-form design. SuperGrip™ non-slip surface. Quiet-Flow® equals faster water for competition pools and reduces gutter width requirements. ASTM Tested for friction and loads. Parallel, 45° and 90° inside or outside corners available in 1" increments (6" - 18") - inquire. Complies with ADA regulations. Standard Colors: white, bone or gray. 10 Year Warranty. Straight Grating Item 22-210 22-245 22-200 22-205 22-210 22-215 22-220 22-225 22-230 Width 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 18" Radius Grating Length 1' 1' 1' 1' 1' 1' 1' Item 22-235 22-240 22-245 22-250 22-255 22-260 22-265 Width Length 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 18" 24" 24" 24" 24" 24" 24" 24" PERPENDICULAR PVC GRATING SYSTEMS LAWSON SUPERGRIP™ PERPENDICULAR GRATING Perpendicular style grating available in widths from 4" to 20". Made from high grade UV-stabilized, outdoor quality PVC, these grates comply with all ASTM load and deflection requirement. SuperGrip™ non-slip pattern design. Completely modular with interlocking stainless steel hardware. Perpendicular, 45° and 90° inside or outside corners available in 1" increments (4" - 20") - inquire. Complies with ADA regulations. Standard Colors: white, bone or gray. 10 Year Warranty. Item 22-245 22-003 22-004 22-006 22-007 22-008 22-009 22-010 22-011 22-012 22-015 Grating Length 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 18" 20" Style Surface Width T T T T T I I I I Custom mitered corners ⁄8" ⁄8" 5 ⁄8" 5 ⁄8" 5 ⁄8" 3 ⁄4" 3 ⁄4" 3 ⁄4" 3 ⁄4" 5 5 PVC GRATING ACCESSORIES STAINLESS STEEL HOLD DOWN CLIPS —Stainless steel hold down clips to safely anchor grating. Fasten grates every 2 ft. alternating sides. Pkg. of 50 clips. 22-013 Perpendicular grate fasteners (per 100 ft.) 22-280 Parallel grate fasteners, straight (per 100 ft.) 22-285 Parallel grate fasteners, radius (per 50 ft.) HAND HOLD BRACKET — Fits PVC grating. Specify color: white or bone. 22-014 22-006 56 HEAVY DUTY CURB ANGLE — For use with PVC grating installations. Available "without tail" when anchored into place or "with tail" when formed into deck. 10' sections. Colors: white or bone. 22-016 Heavy duty curb angle - without tail 22-001 Heavy duty curb angle - with tail www.lincolnaquatics.com Grating Systems 22-035 FIBERGLASS GRATING SYSTEM PVC DECK DRAINING SYSTEM LAWSON DRAIN-THE-DECK™ SYSTEM — A system of PVC components: deck drain, base and sleeves which are designed to offer a generous 25% open space for water flow for the quickest, most efficient handling of excess water flow from rain or deck cleaning. All grates are completely modular and interlocking, making them extremely simple to install or replace, yet strong enough for pedestrians and light vehicle traffic. Drain-the-Deck™ complies with federal ADA regulations. It's the ONLY drain system that can truly radius to any pool or fountain design without cutting or mitering. ASTM Tested for loads and friction. Deck Drain package available in 10 foot lengths and priced per foot. Standard Colors: white, bone or gray. Radius Deck Drains also available, inquire. 10 Year Warranty. Item 22-018 22-075 22-080 22-085 22-090 22-095 22-100 22-105 22-110 Description Deck Drain Package with grate, per ft. Deck Drain 90° inside corner Deck Drain 45° inside corner Deck Drain Down Adapter, 2" connection Deck Drain Down Adapter, 3" connection Deck Drain “T” section Deck Drain End Adapter Deck Drain Custom mitered corners Deck Drain Connector sleeve 22-018 22-095 Base 10' Section End Adaptor with End Outlet End Adaptor TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Down Adaptor 45° Corner FIBERGLASS GRATING SYSTEM — 100% corrosion-resistant grating system that can be used for safety grates over filter pits, sumps, trenches, or gutters. Can also be used as a perimeter trench drain cover. The grating is made of “pultruded” fiberglass, which consists of densely packed glass fibers wrapped by a continuous glass mat. The densely packed core makes the grating stronger than steel in both longitudinal flexible strength and impact strength. The anti-skid top consists of a permanently bonded quartz grit, with UV stabilized polyurethane top coat. Available in 1" thick “T” bar and “I” bar styles. “T” bar grating has 18% open area and “I” bar grating has 40% open area. Available with cross-rods placed 6" or 12" on center. Specify required bearing bar direction. Each panel listed below is 12" x 120". Stainless steel hold down insert clips and socket head bolt assemblies ordered separately. The structure of the grating system allows the panels to be cut and fabricated like a solid sheet. Custom grates to meet your requirements are also available. Color: white. T-1800 “T” Bar Grating 22-035 Cross rods @ 6" 22-040 Cross rods @ 12" 22-042 T-1800 Custom Grating 22-045 T-1800 insert clip 22-050 Bolt assembly I-4000 “I” Bar Grating 22-055 Cross rods @ 6" 22-060 Cross rods @ 12" 22-062 I-4000 Custom Grating 22-065 I-4000 insert clip 22-070 Bolt assembly “T” Section 90° Corner 57 Test Kits Palintest Pooltest 25 Bluetooth 23-101 PALINTEST PHOTOMETER TEST KITS Water testing provides a pivotal role in ensuring that your pool or spa water is kept at its best. The Palintest method of testing is unparalleled in accuracy compared to traditional test kits. Palintest test kits feature photometer technology with digital electronics. The Palintest Photometer is used to measure color formed in the test sample solution. Light from the photometer is passed through the sample, then through an optical filter into a photocell. The photometer will display the test result with a digital readout. Uses Palintest tablet reagents for rapid and reliable results. PALINTEST PROFESSIONAL PHOTOMETERS PALINTEST POOLTEST 25 AND POOLTEST 9 SERIES WATERPROOF PHOTOMETERS Meters are designed for the commercial pool operator looking for a comprehensive collection of the most common water test used in an all-in-one unit. Features include: Bluetooth communication, extended chlorine reading and a direct reading with large backlit display for ease of use and Langelier Saturation Index. Stores test results on its internal memory and you can transfer them to a PC database with USB computer connection. Memory storage: Palintest 25 (1,000 tests) and Palintest 9 (100 tests). Both units include: hard carrying case, glass test tubes and reagents. Check standards help ensure your meter is calibrated and reading accurately. Palintest Pooltest 9 Bluetooth 58 23-116 PALINTEST POOLTEST 25 PHOTOMETER Description Palintest Pooltest 25 Palintest Pooltest 25 Check Stds. Item 23-101 23-102 PALINTEST POOLTEST 9 PHOTOMETER Description Palintest Pooltest 9 Palintest Pooltest 9 Check Stds. Item 23-116 23-110 PALINTEST POOLTEST 25 & 9 TEST RANGES AND REPLACEMENT TABLETS Test Range Replacement Tablets 50 250 tests tests Tests Included Palintest 25 and 9 Kits Free Chlorine 0-5 ppm 25-650 25-655 Total Chlorine 0-5 ppm 25-660 25-665 Ext. Free Chlorine 0-10 ppm 25-810 25-815 Ext. Total Chlorine 0-10 ppm 25-820 25-825 pH 6.8-8.4 25-670 25-675 Cyanuric Acid 2-200 ppm 25-680 25-685 Bromine .04-10 ppm 25-690 25-695 Alkalinity 10-500 ppm 25-700 25-705 Cal. Hardness 5-500 ppm 25-710 25-715 Total Hardness 5-500 ppm 25-800 25-805 Iron LR .01-1 ppm • 25-725 Ozone .01-2 ppm 25-770 25-775 Manganese High .01-5 ppm 25-845 25-850 Range Sulfate 5-200 ppm 25-855 25-860 Hydrogen Peroxide 1-100 ppm 25-865 25-870 Additional Tests Included In Palintest 25 Kit HR Chlorine 1-250 ppm 25-780 25-785 Salt 0-10,000 ppm 25-730 25-735 Chloride 10-500 ppm 25-730 25-735 TDS 0-10,000 ppm by sensor PHMB 2-100 ppm 25-740 25-745 Free Copper .03-5 ppm • 25-755 Total Copper .03-5 ppm 25-760 25-765 Phosphates .03-4 ppm 25-830 • Nitrate .02-20 ppm 25-875 • Aluminum .02-0.5 ppm 25-880 25-885 Ammonia .01-1.0 ppm 25-890 25-895 NOTE: Lincoln is an Authorized Service Center to calibrate your Palintest Photometers and Hand-Held Photometers. 23-135 23-120 PALINTEST HAND-HELD PHOTOMETERS PALINTEST POOLTEST 6 & 3 PHOTOMETERS — The newest in photometric testing packed in a compact hand-held meter. Improved test kit features include: large backlit display screen, enhanced wavelength filters, automatic blank recognition and zero setting, plus extended range chlorine reading. Both units include a hard carrying case. Check standards help ensure your meter is calibrated and reading accurately. PALINTEST POOLTEST 6 PHOTOMETER Description Item Palintest Pooltest 6 Photometer Palintest 6 & 3 Check Standards 23-120 23-146 PALINTEST POOLTEST 3 PHOTOMETER Description Item Palintest Pooltest 3 Photometer Palintest 6 & 3 Check Standards 23-135 23-146 PALINTEST POOLTEST 6 & 3 TEST RANGES AND REPLACEMENT TABLETS Test Range Replacement Tablets 50 250 tests tests Tests Included in Palintest 6 and 3 Kits Ext. Free Chlorine 0-10 ppm 25-810 25-815 Ext. Total Chlorine 0-10 ppm 25-820 25-825 pH 6.8-8.4 25-670 25-675 Cyanuric Acid 2-200 ppm 25-680 25-685 Additional Tests Included In Palintest 6 Kit Bromine .04-10 ppm 25-690 25-695 Alkalinity 10-500 ppm 25-700 25-705 Cal. Hardness 5-500 ppm 25-710 25-715 PALINTEST REPLACEMENT PARTS — For all Palintest photometers. 23-150 Palintest 25 & 9 Glass test tubes, pkg. of 5 23-151 Palintest 6 & 3 Glass test tubes, pkg. of 5 23-155 Dilution tube, plastic 23-160 Crushing/stirring rods, pkg. of 10 www.lincolnaquatics.com Test Kits 23-005 TAYLOR COMPARATOR TEST KITS TAYLOR PROFESSIONAL SERIES TEST KITS — As a series, these test kits are distinguished by the accuracy of liquid-toliquid colorimetric testing. Slide Comparators have 9 liquid color standards for optimum color matching. Professional Series Kits include Water Balance™ Calculator. Chart listed below indicates what test each Taylor Test Kit features. Taylor Professional Complete Test Kit includes: 5 slide comparators (low chlorine/bromine, high chlorine/bromine, pH, copper and iron.) Taylor Professional Test Kit includes: 3 slide comparators (low chlorine/ bromine, high chlorine/bromine & pH) All other tests work with a standard drop method. TAYLOR PROFESSIONAL COMPLETE KITS 23-005 Chlorine Professional Complete 23-010 Bromine Professional Complete TAYLOR PROFESSIONAL KITS 23-015 Chlorine Professional 23-020 Bromine Professional TAYLOR PROFESSIONAL KITS 23-020 23-015 1.0 - 10.0 ppm 0 - 3.0 ppm 1.0 - 10.0 ppm Total Chlorine 0 - 3.0 ppm 2.0 - 10.0 ppm Bromine 0 - 3.0 ppm pH 6.8 - 8.4 Total Alkalinity 1 Drop = 10 ppm Calcium 1 Drop = 10 ppm Hardness Total Hardness 1 Drop = 10 ppm Acid/Base – Demand Cyanuric Acid 20 - 100 ppm Copper 0 - 3.0 ppm Iron 0 - 2.0 ppm Free Chlorine 23-010 Range 23-005 Test • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • 23-025 TAYLOR COMMERCIAL TEST KIT — DPD slide comparator based test kit includes 2 slides: low chlorine (0.0-3.0 ppm) and pH (6.8-8.4). Uses 2 oz. reagents. 23-025 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 23-031 TAYLOR SLIMLITE LAMPS — Source for simulated daylight needed for accurate color matching of results from your test kit. Ideal for indoor pools. Taylor Slimlite Lamp is used with all Taylor Drop test kits. 23-031 Taylor Slimlite Lamp 23-041 TAYLOR TITRATION TEST KITS TAYLOR COMPLETE FAS-DPD TEST KITS Same as the Complete Test Kit except uses a titration based drop test for chlorine or bromine. Eliminates color matching problems associated with color comparators. The Complete Chlorine/Bromine FAS-DPD includes .75 oz. reagents and the Service Complete uses 2 oz. reagents. 23-041 Complete Chlorine FAS-DPD 23-042 Complete Bromine FAS-DPD 23-043 Service Complete Chlorine, FAS-DPD TAYLOR FAS-DPD CALIFORNIA TEST KIT Designed for those who only need to test for sanitizer (chlorine only), pH and cyanuric acid. Uses .75 oz. reagents. 23-044 23-035 TAYLOR DROP TEST KITS TAYLOR COMPLETE TEST KITS — Available with English or Spanish instructions. Tests for free, combined and total chlorine, bromine, pH, acid/base demand, total alkalinity, calcium hardness, and cyanuric acid. Also includes Taylor's Watergram to help determine proper dosage of treatment chemicals. The Complete Test Kit includes .75 oz. reagent bottles and the Service Complete Test Kit includes larger 2 oz. reagent bottles. Description Complete Service Complete English 23-035 23-040 Spanish 23-034 23-039 23-045 TAYLOR STARTER TEST KIT — Basic Starter Test Kit includes: tests for free, combined and total chlorine, and pH with acid/base demand. Uses .75 oz. reagents. 23-045 TAYLOR CALIFORNIA TEST KIT — Test kit designed for health inspectors who only need to test for sanitizer (chlorine or bromine) pH, and cyanuric acid. Uses .75 oz. reagents. 23-047 23-050 TAYLOR FAS-DPD TEST KITS — Sanitizer only titration based test kit provides laboratory accuracy at an economical price. Distinct color change signals end test results. Also helpful when higher levels of sanitizer are present. Available in Chlorine or Bromine Test Kit. Uses .75 oz. or 2 oz. reagents. 23-050 Chlorine FAS-DPD, .75 oz. 23-051 Chlorine FAS-DPD, 2 oz. 23-055 Bromine FAS-DPD, .75 oz. 23-056 Bromine FAS-DPD, 2 oz. 23-065 TAYLOR MONOPERSULFATE TEST KIT Drop test for accurate reading of free and combined chlorine when monopersulfates are being used. With the use of this test kit you will eliminate false readings off of your standard test kit. This test should be used for 18 hours after monopersulfates have been added to your pool. Uses 2 oz. reagents. 23-065 59 Test Kits 23-070 TAYLOR SPECIALITY TEST KITS TAYLOR TOTAL ALKALINITY TEST KIT Drop test kit for total alkalinity. Uses .75 oz. size reagents. 23-070 TAYLOR TOTAL HARDNESS TEST KIT Drop test kit for total hardness. Uses 2 oz. size reagents. 23-075 TAYLOR TDS TEST KIT — Drop test kit helps in determining total dissolved solids that are present in your pool water. Uses 2 oz. reagents. 1 drop = 50 ppm. 23-076 24-100 SPECIALTY TEST KITS 24-016 TOTAL DISSOLVED SOLIDS METER — Used to tell when the accumulated chemicals dissolved in the water will begin to interfere with the overall operation of the equipment and bather comfort. Range: 0-5000 ppm TDS. Reagents sold separately. 24-100 TDS meter, 0-5000 ppm 25-620 Taylor Deionized Water, 2 oz. 25-625 Taylor TDS Solution, 2 oz. 24-019 TAYLOR SALT TEST KITS — Combines Taylor's top selling combination test kits and adds sodium chloride test for monitoring salt levels in the pool, when using a chlorine generator. Measures: free chlorine, total chlorine, pH, alkalinity, calcium hardness, cyanuric acid, and sodium chloride. Available with DPD sanitizer test or FAS-DPD sanitizer test. Uses .75 oz. reagents. 23-057 DPD/Salt, .75 oz. 23-058 FAS-DPD/ Salt, .75 oz. 23-080 CYANURIC ACID TEST KIT — For reading the level of stabilizer or conditioner in pool water by means of a turbidity chart. Range 0 to 100 ppm. Comes with 8 oz. of test reagent. 23-080 25-281 Repl. Cyanuric Acid Reag., 16 oz. 25-282 Repl. Cyanuric Acid Reag., 1 quart Item 24-020 PHOSPHATE TEST KIT — New test kit helps identify phosphate levels present in your pool water. Range 0-1000 ppm. 24-083 LAMOTTE COLORQ PRO TEST KITS — Hand-held photometer measures pool tests directly on a digital display for accurate test results. The ColorQ PRO 7 is available with liquid reagents or easy-to-use test tabs. Includes convenient carrying case. The ColorQ PRO 9 Plus features liquid reagents and easy-to-use test tabs. Includes rugged plastic carrying case for on-site testing. COLORQ PRO TEST KITS Description 24-016 ColorQ PRO 7 Liquid 24-017 ColorQ PRO 7 Test Tabs 24-019 ColorQ PRO 9 Plus LAMOTTE COMPARATOR TEST KITS 24-083 LAMOTTE PHOTOMETER TEST KITS LAMOTTE POOL MANAGER TEST KIT Precise and easy to use with a wide test range for chlorine. Uses LaMotte Test Tablets. Reagent refill is a complete set of reagents identical to those furnished with the original kit. 24-020 Pool Manager Test Kit 24-021 Reagent Refill 24-024 Repl. OctaSlide Test Tube, 10 ml 24-035 OctaSlide2 Viewer 24-050 Chlorine OctaSlide2 (.5-10.0 ppm) 24-051 pH OctaSlide2 (6.6- 8.2 ppm) Reagent Refill 24-026 24-027 24-028 COLORQ PRO TEST KIT RANGES Test Range Free Chlorine 0 - 10 ppm Total Chlorine 0 - 10 ppm Bromine 0 - 22 ppm pH 6.5 - 8.5 ppm Total Alkalinity 0 - 250 ppm Calcium Hardness 0 - 700 ppm Cyanuric Acid 0 - 125 ppm Iron 0 - 3.0 ppm Copper 0 - 4.0 ppm ColorQ ColorQ PRO 7 PRO 9 incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. incl. • incl. • incl. POOL MANAGER TEST KIT RANGES Test 24-091 HAND HELD pH METER — Hand held meter for testing of pH. Includes pH sensor. Must be calibrated for accurate readings before each use. 24-091 24-092 Replacement pH sensor 60 Range Free Chlorine 0.5 - 10.0 ppm Total Chlorine 0.5 - 10.0 ppm pH 6.8 - 8.2 ppm Total Alkalinity 60 - 400 ppm Calcium Hardness 60 - 400 ppm Acid Demand Cyanuric Acid # of Tests 50 50 50 20 20 Calculated • from Alk. Test 0 - 100 ppm 20 24-030 WATERSAFE® TEST KIT WATERSAFE ® BACTERIA TEST KIT — Detects the presence of pseudomonas and E-coli in swimming pools and spas in less than 20 minutes. Includes: 10 one time only tests. 24-030 Watersafe® Bacteria Test Kit www.lincolnaquatics.com Test Kits 24-022 24-023 INSTANT STRIP TEST KITS 24-065 24-075 24-085 LAMOTTE HAND HELD METERS WATERPROOF HAND HELD METERS Microprocessor pocket testers with easy to read LCD display. Auto off and hold features save on battery life. pH range: 1-14 ppm which includes automatic temperature compensation; TDS range: 0 -10,000 ppm; ORP range: -50 to +1050 mV. Salt range: 0-10,000 ppt. pH, TDS and Salt meters require calibration reagents with each use. Batteries included. 24-065 pH waterproof meter 24-070 pH buffer solution. 500 ml 24-075 TDS waterproof meter 24-080 TDS conductivity solution, 500 ml 24-085 ORP waterproof meter 24-086 Salt waterproof meter 24-087 Salt calibration standard, 120 ml LAMOTTE INSTA-TEST STRIPS — Instant reliable results without reagents. 50 strips per bottle. Tester Item Total Chlorine Free Chlorine Bromine Alkalinity pH Cyanuric Acid Total Hardness Insta-Test Insta-Test Insta-Test 6 5 3 24-025 24-022 24-023 0-10 ppm 0-10 ppm • 0-10 ppm 0-10 ppm 0-10 ppm • 0-20 ppm 0-20 ppm 0-240 ppm 0-180 ppm 0-180 ppm 6.2-8.4 6.2-8.4 6.2-8.4 0-250 ppm • • 50-800 ppm 50-800 ppm • 24-116 POOL RECORD LOG BOOKS 24-120 LAMOTTE TRACER POCKET TESTER — Tracer Pocket Tester Kit tests for Chlorine, pH, and ORP. Includes tester with three interchangeable probes, 20 ml sample cup, tablet crusher, 100 Chlorine tablets and case. Bar graph display shows sample temperature when testing Chlorine or pH. Saves calibrations between sensor changes. Also available as individual Tracer Pocket Testers (Chlorine, pH or ORP) which includes Tester with probe, and 20 ml sample cup. Tester Kit Chlorine pH ORP Tracer Pocket Tester 24-120 24-130 24-140 24-150 Repl. Probe Range • • 24-135 0.0 - 10.0 ppm 0.0 - 14.0 24-145 24-155 -999 - 999 mv POCKET TESTER ACCESSORIES 24-160 Sample cup, 20 ml 24-165 Weighted stand w/5 sample cups TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 ALL-WEATHER LOG BOOKS — All-weather log books for essential pool records. Commercial Pool and Spa Log Book is a detailed 6 month record documenting chemical readings, mechanical equipment log, bather load and more. Pool Maintenance Log Book records chemicals added, filter/pump maintenance and chemical readings. 24-116 Pool and Spa Log Book 24-117 Pool Maintenance Log Book TAYLOR PARTS TAYLOR COMPARATOR SLIDES — Optional comparators for Taylor Professional Complete, Professional and Commercial Test Kits. 25-005 Low Chlorine (0.0-3.0 ppm) 25-010 High Chlorine (1.0-10.0 ppm) 25-025 pH (6.8-8.4) 25-030 Copper (0.0-3.0 ppm) 25-035 Iron (0.0-2.0 ppm) ENSLOW BASE — Replacement base for test cells when using the Professional Complete, Professional and Commercial Test Kits. 25-040 25-003 25-002 SAMPLESIZER — Precisely displaces the right amount of water needed for Taylor 25 mL or 10 mL test samples. Anodized aluminum. 25-003 SPEEDSTIR — Compact magnetic stirrer drops intoTaylor test vial for automatic stirring. Requires 4-AA batteries. 25-002 UNIT DOSE DISPENSER — For use with Taylor's DPD Powder. Quickly and neatly dispenses the exact amount of reagent powder needed to perform FAS-DPD titration test. 25-004 25-045 25-065 25-050 MOLDED TEST CELLS 25-045 Low range, 11.5 ml 25-050 High range, .5 ml 25-055 Replacement cap, 11.5 ml 25-060 Replacement cap, .5 ml 25-081 Test cell brush DPD POWDER SPOON 25-257 PIPETTE — Calibrated eye dropper 25-065 .5 ml pipette 25-066 .5 ml / 1.0 ml pipette CYANURIC ACID SAMPLE VIEW TUBE 25-070 CYANURIC ACID DISPENSING BOTTLE 25-075 15 ml MULTIPURPOSE TEST SAMPLE TUBE — FAS-DPD, alkalinity & calcium hardness sample tube. 25-079 25 ml 25-085 25-097 COMPARATOR TEST BLOCKS — For use with Taylor test kits. 25-085 Comparator test block 25-086 FAS-DPD Comparator test block 25-090 Replacement cap, small 25-095 Replacement cap, large WATER BALANCE CALCULATORS — Easy to use Saturation Index calculator for your pool water. Available in new electronic version or re-designed Watergram™ Wheel. 25-097 Electronic Watergram™ 25-099Watergram™ Wheel 61 Test Reagents TAYLOR LIQUID REAGENTS Reagent Taylor # DPD No. 1 DPD No. 2 DPD No. 3 pH Indicator Solution Acid Demand Reagent (ADR) Base Demand Reagent (BDR) Thiosulfate N/10 Total Alkalinity Indicator Sulfuric Acid .12N Calcium Buffer Calcium Indicator Liquid Hardness Reagent Cyanuric Acid Reagent Phenol Red Indicator Chromate Indicator Silver Nitrate FAS-DPD Titrating Chlorine FAS-DPD Titrating Bromine Phosphate Reagent #1 Phosphate Reagent #2 Deox Reagent .75 oz. R-0001 R-0002 R-0003 R-0004 R-0005 R-0006 R-0007 R-0008 R-0009 R-0010 R-0011L R-0012 R-0013 R-1003J R-0630 R-0718 R-0871 R-0872 R-0980 R-0981 R-0867 2 oz. 25-100 25-110 25-120 25-130 25-140 25-150 25-160 25-170 25-180 25-190 25-200 25-220 25-229 25-235 • 25-635 25-259 25-269 25-271 25-272 25-275 16 oz. • • • 25-136 25-146 25-156 25-166 25-176 25-186 25-196 25-206 25-226 25-233 25-245 • • 25-265 • • • • 25-105 25-115 25-125 25-135 25-145 25-155 25-165 25-175 25-185 25-195 25-205 25-225 25-230 25-240 25-630 • 25-260 25-270 • • 25-280 TAYLOR POWDERED REAGENTS Reagent Calcium Indicator Powder DPD Powder Taylor # R-0011P R-0870 10 gram 50 gram 25-210 25-250 25-215 • .25 lb 1 lb. • 25-255 • 25-256 LAMOTTE COLORQ LIQUID REAGENTS Reagent LaMotte # DPD 1A DPD 1B DPD 3 pH Reagent Total Alkalinity Calcium Hardness 1 Calcium Hardness 2 6740 6741 6743 7037 7038 7042 7041 ColorQ PRO 7 Test Kit (Liquid) 30 ml 25-520 25-530 25-540 25-552 25-577 25-562 25-561 ColorQ PRO 9 Test Kit (Liquid) 60 ml 25-525 25-535 25-545 25-553 25-578 25-567 25-568 LAMOTTE COLORQ TABLET REAGENTS Reagent DPD 1 Instrument Grade DPD 3 Instrument Grade pH Instrument Grade Alkalinity Instrument Grade Calcium Hardness Instrument Grade Cyanuric Acid 100 1,000 LaMotte # (Test Tabs) (Test Tabs) 6903A 6197A 3880A 25-636 25-638 25-640 25-637 25-639 25-641 3882A 25-642 25-643 3883A 25-644 6996A 25-487 ColorQ PRO 7 Test Kit (Test Tabs) incl. incl. incl. ColorQ ColorQ PRO7 PRO9 Test Kit Test Kit (Liquid) (Test Tabs) • • • • • • incl. • • 25-645 incl. • • 25-488 incl. incl. incl. LAMOTTE POOL MANAGER TABLET REAGENTS 62 Reagent LaMotte # Chlorine DPD 1R Chlorine DPD 3R Phenol Red pH Alkalinity Calcium Hardness Cyanuric Acid 6999A 6905A 6915A 6920A 6846A 6994A 100 (Test Tabs) 25-335 25-375 25-415 25-435 25-475 25-495 1,000 (Test Tabs) 25-345 25-385 25-425 25-445 25-485 25-505 www.lincolnaquatics.com Battery Operated Vacuums 29-004 26-036 HAMMER-HEAD VACUUMS HAMMER-HEAD VACUUMS — Finally a vacuum that is perfect for quick fixes and efficiently handles your big jobs. Sets up faster than conventional vacuum systems, saving you time and money. No installation or priming required and the unit runs independently of the pool circulation system. Head design provides 30 lb. thrust resulting in 16,000 GPH. Two sizes available: Resort 30 - with 30" wide vacuum head and the Resort 21 - with 21" wide vacuum head. Both units include 60' cord, cart and 2 debris bags. Pole and 12 volt deep cycle marine battery and battery charger not included. 1 Year Warranty. 26-036 Hammer-Head Resort 30 26-037 Hammer-Head Resort 21 26-048 Hammer-Head Smart Charger 29-005 29-051 HAMMER-HEAD DEBRIS BAGS Bag Mesh Tag Extra Short Regular Style Color Large (Fountain) Coarse Purple Standard Red Super Fine Blue Ultra Fine White 26-040 26-043 26-038 26-041 26-039 26-042 • 26-034 • 26-044 • • HAMMER-HEAD REPLACEMENT PARTS Item 26-051 26-052 26-053 26-054 Description Includes 3 Blade Prop Pins (2) Propeller Kit Prop Nut (1) Vacuum Head Bushing (1) Wheel, Large Vacuum Head Bolt (1) Wheel, Small Bushing (1) Cart Wheel, 20" Wheel Bearing (1) BATTERY OPERATED VACUUMS POOL BLASTER VACUUMS — Battery powered hand-held vacuums can attach to a pole for bigger jobs. Pole ordered separately. Switch and go battery insures no job is left undone. Available in three models: PRO 1500, PRO 900 for larger vacuuming requirements and MAX CG for lighter duty needs. POOL BLASTER VACUUMS Features PRO 1500 Item Vacuum Head Width Throat Rechargeable Battery 29-004 19" 2" 2 - 60 min. POOL BLASTER REPLACEMENT FILTER BAGS Description All-Purpose Filter Bag Sand and Silt Filter Bag Xtreme Multi-Layer Micro Filter Bag Micro Filter Bag PRO 1500 29-008 29-009 29-010 • POOL BLASTER REPLACEMENT PARTS Description 26-037 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Battery Motor Box Assembly Charger Wheels Brushes PRO 1500 29-012 29-016 29-011 29-014 (set of 4) 29-007 (set of 6) PRO 900 29-005 15" 2" 2 - 60 min. PRO 900 29-008 29-009 29-010 • PRO 900 29-012 29-016 29-011 29-006 (set of 11) 29-007 (set of 6) MAX CG 29-051 10.5" 1" 1 - 60 min. MAX CG 29-054 • • 29-015 MAX CG 29-059 29-017 29-058 29-052 (set of 5) 29-053 (set of 6) 63 Automatic Vacuums 26-171 DuraMAX Duo Jr. 26-160 DuraMAX Duo AUTOMATIC VACUUMS — With the use of an automatic pool vacuum you will save on labor costs and improve water quality. In many cases an automatic vacuum will pay for itself in less than one year. The vacuum is self-propelled, selfcontained and operates unattended. Removable filter bags rinse clean in minutes. This allows your staff to do other duties while your pool is being cleaned. Because of the ease of use, you will vacuum more frequently and, as a result, you will have a cleaner pool. Demonstration units are available in some areas. DURAMAX AUTOMATIC VACUUMS — The DuraMAX line of commercial pool cleaners are designed to handle any size swimming pool. The roving nature of the DuraMAX removes debris from all areas of your pool. Since the DuraMAX is a selfcontained filter system, collected debris does not pass into your main pool filter, thereby reducing the need for backwashing. The DuraMAX modular components and heavy duty drive system provides extended service and dependable performance. In addition, rugged rubber brushes scrub and scour your pool surface for the best results. All DuraMAX vacuums include remote control, air sensor and user selectable cleaning programs which include: user selectable 1 hour delay start, adjustable cleaning cycle lengths (1-7 hours), or continuous run cycles. The DuraMAX Duo unit adds an additional hydro-scrubbing, power washing, jet feature for increased cleaning performance. DuraMAX vacuums have been engineered to work with VGB main drain covers. 24 volt power supply. DURAMAX AUTOMATIC VACUUMS Feature Item Pool Size Vacuum Width GPH Cord Length Drive Motor Pump Remote Cart Floor/Wall Warranty Infrared Sensor Zero Depth Sensor Weight Filter Bag (fine) Rubber Brushes, blue Rubber Brushes, hard gray Drive Belt Set* Bottom Lid Assembly DuraMAX Duo 26-160 up to 150' 34" 9,600 120' 2 2 4-way UltraKart included yes/yes adjustable 2 year 26-126 included 49 lbs. 94-100 94-200 (pair) 94-215 (pair) 94-300 94-400 DuraMAX Duo Jr. 26-171 over 75' 26" 9,600 120' 2 2 4-way UltraKart Jr. included yes/yes adjustable 2 year 26-126 included 45 lbs. 94-105 94-205 (set of 4) 94-220 (set of 4) 94-300 94-405 Visit www.lincolnaquatics.com for a complete list of vacuum parts. 64 26-173 DuraMAX RC 26-174 DuraMAX Biturbo T-RC DuraMAX RC 26-173 up to 75' 26" 4,800 120' 2 1 4-way UltraKart Jr. included yes/yes adjustable 2 year 26-126 included 37 lbs. 94-105 94-205 (set of 4) 94-220 (set of 4) 94-300 94-405 DuraMax Biturbo T-RC 26-174 up to 75' 26" 9,600 120' 1 2 3-way UltraKart Jr. included yes/yes adjustable 2 year 26-126 included 41 lbs. 94-105 94-210 (pair) 94-225 (pair) 94-300 94-405 www.lincolnaquatics.com Automatic Vacuums 26-180 UltraMAX XL 26-078 AUTOMATIC VACUUM CARTS H Y D R O - VA C ™ C A R T — H e a v y - d u t y powder-coated steel storage cart. Provides a convenient solution for moving your automatic vacuum to where you need it most. Storage for vacuum, cord and transformer box. Rubber wheels provide ease of portability on deck. Fits Aqua Products and Dolphin automatic vacuums. 26-078 26-179 AquaMAX X3 26-178 AquaMAX X2 ULTRAMAX & AQUAMAX AUTOMATIC VACUUMS — The UltraMAX is one of the most technologically advanced, easy to use, commercial pool cleaners available. Operates with wireless remote control to spot clean your pool or let the on-board computer guide the UltraMax to give you the cleanest pool possible. The AquaMAX vacuums are designed for smaller commercial pools and features a smart cleaning system with sensors to make cleaning your pool as easy as the touch of the button. Unique forward and reverse motion eliminates any entanglements in corners and ladders. Heavy duty filtration system filters out all types of debris including algae and other particles down to 2 microns in size. UltraMAX and AquaMAX vacuums have been engineered to work with VGB main drain covers. 24 volt power supply. ULTRAMAX & AQUAMAX AUTOMATIC VACUUMS Feature Item Pool Size Vacuum Width GPH Cord Length Drive Motor Pump Remote Cart Floor/Wall Warranty Infrared Sensor Zero Depth Sensor Weight Filter Bag (fine) Rubber Brushes Drive Belt (each) Bottom Lid Assembly UltraMAX XL 26-180 up to 164' 30" 9,690 150' 2 2 4-way UltraKart included floor only 2 year included included 49 lbs. 94-120 94-230 (set of 4) 94-305 94-410 AquaMAX X3 26-179 up to 75' 20" 4,330 100' 2 1 4-way UltraKart included floor only 2 year N/A included 25 lbs. 94-105 94-235 (set of 4) 94-305 94-415 AquaMAX X2 26-178 up to 75' 15.5" 4,330 100' 2 1 4-way UltraKart Jr. included yes/yes 2 year N/A included 22 lbs. 94-120 94-240 (set of 4) 94-305 94-420 26-080 ULTRAKART/ULTRAKART JUNIOR — UltraKart and UltraKart Junior assist in moving and storage of Aqua Products vacuums. 26-080 UltraKart 26-081 UltraKart Junior 26-086 VACUUM TIMER AUTOMATIC TIMER — 24 hour timer for use with your automatic pool vacuum. Allows the vacuum to work fewer hours and work more efficiently as the debris in the pool water settles to the pool floor. 26-086 LINCOLN is a factory trained Service Center for Aqua Products pool vacuums. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 65 Automatic Vacuums Complete pool scanning To ensure thorough cleaning, your Dolphin cleaner is equipped with built in software that systematically cleans your entire pool regardless of your pool’s shape or surface. Gyro XL scanning Unique gyroscopic system delivers accurate and effective scanning for systematic cleaning along the entire pool. 26-215 CleverCleanTM system The unique CleverClean Scanning system, powered by intelligent software, helps the robot optimize its scanning capabilities by learning the various parameters of the pool and adjusting its patterns accordingly. This guarantees complete coverage of any type of pool during each cleaning cycle, including shaped pools and pools with obstacles. 26-210 Dual-filtration porosity options Covers all pool conditions from rough debris to fine dust particles: Ultra-fine filter collects fine dust particles and net for leaves and rough debris. Top-access The filter cartridges system is accessed from the top of the robot for easy and convenient cleaning (C4 and C3 only). Feature Item Pool Size Vacuum Width Cycle Time GPH Cord Length Drive Motor Pump Digital Power Supply Cable Swivel Remote Cart Floor/Wall/Waterline Warranty Zero Depth Sensor Weight (Shipping) Combined Brush Filtration Type Filter Bag or Cartridge PVC Brush Wonder Brush Ring Bottom Lid Tracks Dolphin C6+ 26-215 up to 110' 30.5" 4,6 or 8 hours 8,466 131' 1 1 LED w/Full Bag Indicator Yes PRO Yes Floor, Wall, Adjustable 2 Year included 89 lbs. included Bag 91-105 91-200 (pair) 91-220 (set of 4) 91-400 91-300 (pair) 26-200 Dolphin C5 26-210 up to 82' 16" 4,6 or 8 hours 4,233 98' 2 1 LED w/Full Bag Indicator Yes PRO Yes Floor, Wall, Adjustable 2 Year included 55 lbs. included Bag 91-105 91-205 (set of 4) 91-220 (set of 4) 91-400 91-300 (pair) 26-205 Dolphin C4 26-205 up to 60' 16" 1.5, 2.5 or 3.5 hours 4,233 78' 2 1 Digital Yes PRO Yes Floor, Wall, Waterline 2 Year included 55 lbs. included Top Load Cartridge 91-110 (pkg. of 4) 91-210 (set of 4) 91-220 (set of 4) • 91-300 (pair) Dolphin C3 26-200 up to 50' 16" 1 or 2.5 hours 4,233 60' 1 1 Digital Yes Basic Yes Floor, Wall, Waterline 2 Year included 55 lbs. included Top Load Cartridge 91-110 (pkg. of 4) 91-215 (pair) 91-220 (set of 4) • 91-300 (pair) LINCOLN is a factory trained service center for Dolphin pool vacuums. 66 www.lincolnaquatics.com Automatic Vacuums Complete pool scanning To ensure thorough cleaning, your Dolphin cleaner is equipped with built in software that systematically cleans your entire pool regardless of your pool’s shape or surface. Gyro XL scanning Unique gyroscopic system delivers accurate and effective scanning for systematic cleaning along the entire pool. 26-255 26-260 26-270 Feature Item Pool Size Vacuum Width Cycle Time GPH Cord Length Drive Motor Pump Digital Power Supply Cable Swivel Remote Cart Floor/Wall/Waterline Warranty Zero Depth Sensor Weight (Shipping) Combined Brush Filtration Type Filter Bag PVC Brush Wonder Brush Ring Bottom Lid Tracks Dolphin 2x2 26-255 up to 110' 30.5" 4,6 or 8 hours 8,466 131' 1 1 LED w/Full Bag Indicator Yes PRO Yes Floor, Wall, Adjustable 1 Year included 85 lbs. included Bag 91-105 91-200 (pair) 91-220 (set of 4) 91-400 91-305 (pair) Dynamic ProX 2 26-260 up to 82' 16" 4,6 or 8 hours 4,233 114' 2 1 LED w/Full Bag Indicator Yes PRO Yes Floor, Wall, Adjustable 1 Year included 59 lbs. included Bag 91-105 91-205 (set of 4) 91-220 (set of 4) 91-400 91-305 (pair) CleverCleanTM system The unique CleverClean Scanning system, powered by intelligent software, helps the robot optimize its scanning capabilities by learning the various parameters of the pool and adjusting its patterns accordingly. This guarantees complete coverage of any type of pool during each cleaning cycle, including shaped pools and pools with obstacles. Dual-filtration porosity options Covers all pool conditions from rough debris to fine dust particles: Ultra-fine filter collects fine dust particles and net for leaves and rough debris. Dolphin 3001 26-270 up to 75' 16" 6 hours 4,233 91' 1 1 LED w/Full Bag Indicator Yes NO Yes Floor, Wall, Waterline 1 Year included 55 lbs. included Bag 91-105 91-200 (pair) 91-220 (set of 4) 91-400 91-305 (pair) LINCOLN is a factory trained service center for Dolphin pool vacuums. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 67 Portable Pool Cleaners 27-009 27-025 PORTABLE VACUUMS 27-100 27-010 LINCOLN PORTABLE VACUUM SYSTEMS — Stainless steel cartridge filter mounted on a easy-to-maneuver powder-coated steel cart. 100' #10-3 wire electric cable with in-line GFCI. Available in electric or gas versions. Includes (2) 11⁄2" and (2) 2" hose connection fittings. Vacuum accessories ordered separately. REPLACEMENT PARTS Filter Max Item HP Sq. Ft. Volts Amps 18-250 6 sq. ft. cartridge 18-252 105 sq. ft. cartridge ELECTRIC 18-253 155 sq. ft. cartridge 1 HP 105 110V 15 27-009 18-272 Antimicrobial 105 sq. ft. cartridge 1 1 ⁄2 HP 155 110V 18.6 27-010 18-273 Antimicrobial 155 sq. ft. cartridge 2 HP 155 110V 19.6 27-015 27-035 Rim gasket 2 HP 155 220V 19.6 27-020 27-040 Strainer basket GAS 27-041 Strainer "O" ring 27-042 Strainer lid 3.5 HP 155 Gas • 27-025 27-129 Replacement vacuum cart wheel 27-055 27-060 27-045 27-050 MAXI-SWEEP PORTABLE VACUUM SYSTEMS — Portable vacuum system saves pool water, chemicals and energy by filtering dirty water and returning clean water to the pool as you vacuum. Includes: 2" x 50' hose, 1 - 8' x 24' telescopic pole and 2 – 8' extension poles. Specify: 30", 36" or 42" vacuum 3-port vacuum head. For electric units, specify 110 volt/30 amp or 220 volt/20 amp. Item ELECTRIC 27-055 27-060 GAS 27-045 27-050 68 HP Filter Cord Sq. Ft. Length GPH 2 HP 2 HP 225 225 50' 100' 8,000 8,000 4 HP 51/2 HP 225 225 • • 8,000 8,000 REPLACEMENT PARTS 27-065 Dacron cartridges (set of 3) 27-070 Strainer basket 27-075 30" vacuum head 27-080 36" vacuum head 27-085 42" vacuum head 27-090 Vacuum head wheel assembly, ea. 27-091 Leaf trap NOTE: See pages 69-72 for vacuum accessories and aluminum poles. LINCOLN PORTABLE PUMP SYSTEM — Allows you to vacuum and discharge debris to waste. System features powder-coated steel cart and rubber wheels, pump with clear-lid strainer basket and vacuum priming “T”. Includes: (2) 1½" and (2) 2" hose connection fittings. Electrical pumps include in-line GFCI and watertight power switch. Pump Overhaul Kit includes: impeller, shaft seal and “o” ring. Item HP ELECTRIC 11/2 HP 27-100 2 HP 27-095 GAS 3 HP 27-120 Volts Cord Length GpH 110 220 100' 100' 6,000 8,200 • • 7,800 27-120 REPLACEMENT PARTS 27-104 Replacement vacuum priming "T" 13-096 Strainer basket 27-110 Strainer lid 27-115 Strainer “O” ring 27-106 Shaft seal w/o copper insert 27-129 Replacement vacuum cart wheel 27-108 Portable pump overhaul kit, 11/2 HP 27-109 Portable pump overhaul kit, 2 HP IMPORTANT: Due to possible electrical danger, portable vacuums must be wired to proper receptacles utilizing G.F.I.’s. It is recommended that a 20 amp service outlet be used on all portable pool vacuums and pumps. www.lincolnaquatics.com Vacuum Heads 28-006 COMMERCIAL VACUUM HEADS 32" TOW VACUUM HEADS — Ideal for large commercial pools. Available in two attachment styles: Rope attaches to vacuum head so two people can work together pulling vacuum across pool or with pole attachment. Body made of chrome, bronze and anodized aluminum. 2" hose connection. 28-005 Tow Vacuum w/rope attachment 28-006 Tow Vacuum w/pole attachment TOW REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-010 Wheel, each 28-015 Axle assembly, each 28-020 31" brush 28-075 18" CPB VACUUM HEAD — Chrome plated brass vacuum head designed especially for rugged commercial use. Includes: adjustable brush and skirt kit and heavy duty handle. Available in 2" or 11⁄2" hose connection. 28-075 18" CPB, 2" 28-080 18" CPB, 11⁄2" CPB REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-085 Wheel and axle kit, each 28-095 Brush kit with hardware 28-100 Skirt kit set 28-101 CPB handle 28-186 COMMERCIAL VACUUM HEAD — Flexible dual manifold vacuum head provides maximum cleaning performance. 24" wide vacuum head features enclosed lead weights. Adjustable ball bearing polyurethane wheels. Fits both 2" or 11⁄2" vacuum hose. 28-186 24" Commercial COMMERCIAL REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-188 Wheel, each 28-165 Axle assembly, each 28-191Handle 28-250 Swivel caster, each 28-255 Stainless retainer clip, each 28-194 Manifold hose assembly 28-150 28-025 28-025 18" HEAVY DUTY VACUUM HEAD — All metal vacuum head designed specifically for commercial use. Housing made of chrome, bronze and anodized aluminum. Handle is all stainless steel. Fits both 2" or 11⁄2" vacuum hose. 28-025 18" Heavy Duty HEAVY DUTY REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-030 Wheel, each 28-035 Axle assembly, each 28-040 18" brush 28-045 18" AND 14" COMMERCIAL VACUUM HEADS — The professional’s choice vacuum. Aluminum body with heavy duty plastic handle, fits 11⁄4" pole. 11⁄2" hose connection. 28-045 18" Commercial, 11⁄2" 28-050 14" Commercial, 11⁄2" COMMERCIAL REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-055 Wheel, each 28-060 Axle assembly, each 28-065 18" brush 28-070 14" brush TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 28-155 28-156 FLEXIBLE VACUUM HEADS LINCOLN PROVAC VACUUM HEADS — Commercial vacuum head with Even-flow design for optimum vacuum suction. Flex strips guide debris into suction chamber. Adjustable ball bearing wheels, lead weights and chrome steerable handle. Fits 2" or 11⁄2" vacuum hose. Available in two models: Lincoln Super ProVac is 41" wide with dual suction ports for increased coverage in cleaning commercial pools. Lincoln ProVac 29" and 14" wide vacuum heads are available with single port suction chamber. 28-150 41" Super ProVac 28-155 29" ProVac 28-153 22" ProVac 28-156 14" ProVac PROVAC REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-188 Wheel, each 28-165 Axle assembly, each 28-241 Adjustment washer 28-170 5' white flex strip, short 28-175 5' blue flex strip, long 28-194 Manifold hose assembly 28-180 Metal swivel handle 28-245 Snap-Adapt handle 28-185 Handle joining assembly 28-230 SWIVEL WHEEL VACUUM HEAD — Commercial grade pool vacuum heads with swivel wheels that allow the vacuum to be moved in any direction for ease in cleaning. Will fit any curvature of the pool. Fully enclosed weights help keep the vacuum head on the pool bottom. Fits both 2" or 11⁄2" vacuum hose. 28-23019" Swivel SWIVEL WHEEL REPLACEMENT PARTS 28-235 Swivel wheel, each 28-189 Swivel axle assembly, each 28-246 Wheel base caster support 28-245Handle 28-250 Swivel caster, each 28-255 Stainless retainer clip, each 69 Vacuum Accessories 27-135 29-120 GROUND FAULT INTERRUPTERS G R O U N D F A U LT I N T E R R U P T E R S Designed to protect your equipment around the pool from power surges. Available in two styles: user attachable GFCI that is wired-in on-site and as in-line plug in style that does not require installation. Rated for 18-12 gauge cords. UL listed. 27-130 In-line GFCI, 120 volt 27-131 In-line GFCI, 240 volt 27-135 User attachable, 120 volt 27-132 User attachable, In-Line GFCI, 110/220 volt VACUUM HOSES POOL KING VACUUM HOSE — Commercial grade crush-proof floating hose. Excellent flexibility makes it easy to handle. UV resistant. Available in 11⁄2" and 2" diameter sizes. Custom lengths available — inquire. 29-040 LEAF CLEANING JANDY LEAF MASTER — Cleans up leaves and twigs faster than any other method. Attaches to any garden hose. Works on the bottom of the pool. Powerful water jets push leaves into large collector bag. Constructed of high impact plastic with 6" throat. 29-040 LEAF MASTER REPLACEMENT PARTS 29-041 Wheel, each 29-045 Vacuum bag 29-050 Fine mesh bag Hose Length 50' 75' 100' 11/2" Dia. 29-100 29-105 29-110 2" Dia. 29-120 • 29-130 29-118 29-115 HYDRO-FLO™ VACUUM HOSE — Professional grade floating hose features I-beam construction providing an interior surface which stays smooth for a clog-free flow and easy handling. Light weight for ease of handling. UV stabilized. Colors: green (11/2") and blue (2"). 29-056 Hose Length 29-027 50' 75' 11/2" Dia. 29-114 29-115 2" Dia. 29-117 29-118 29-056 HAND OPERATED VACUUM COMMERCIAL SPAWAND — Ideal for quick touch-up cleanings on pool steps, spas and other small bodies of water. With just a few easy hand-powered strokes debris is sucked into a built-in filter basket for easy removal. No hoses or electricity required. Includes interchangeable nozzles. 29-056 70 LEAF TRAP — Specifically designed to be used as a pre-filter for your vacuum or pump system. Leaf Trap captures large amounts of leaves, twigs, rocks, and other debris before it reaches your pump strainer basket. Features snap open and close lid, clear housing and large handle for ease of carrying. Includes 3’ of flexible vacuum hose and bag. 29-026 Leaf Trap, 11/2" 29-027 Leaf Trap, 2" 29-028 Repl. Standard mesh bag 29-029 Sand/silt bag DISCHARGE HOSE DISCHARGE HOSE — Vinyl collapsible discharge hose. Specify length. 29-14011⁄2", per ft. 29-145 2", per ft. www.lincolnaquatics.com Vacuum Accessories 29-160 29-150 DISCHARGE HOSE REEL VACUUM HOSE REELS PARAGON STAINLESS HOSE REEL — Portable stainless steel vacuum hose storage Reel. Holds up to 100' of 2" vacuum hose. Saves on deck space and prolongs the life of your vacuum hose. Holds 11⁄2" or 2" hose. 29-150 PORTABLE DISCHARGE HOSE REEL — Holds up to 85' of discharge hose. Holds both 11⁄2" and 2" discharge hose. 29-160 29-195 29-200 VACUUM HOSE END CONNECTOR — Female threads at one end. Plastic. 29-195 11⁄2" hose end connector 29-200 2" hose end connector VACUUM HOSE HANGER VACUUM HOSE HANGER — Cycolac, pair. 29-165 29-215 29-210 HOSE-TO-WALL FITTINGS 29-21011⁄2" male to 11⁄2" hose-PVC 29-215 2" male to 2" hose-PVC 29-170 29-165 VACUUM HOSE FITTINGS 29-155 VACUUM HOSE REEL — UV stabilized polyethylene hose storage reel. Lightweight and portable. Hose stays cleaner and free from tangles. Holds up to 50' of 11/2" hose. 29-155 VACUUM HOSE COUPLING — Female threads at both ends. Plastic. 29-170 11⁄2" hose coupling 29-175 2" hose coupling 29-180 29-157 VACUUM HOSE CARRIER HOSE HUGGER — Handy way to cope with vacuum hoses. Made of durable polypropylene and wide Hook & Loop closure. Holds up to 50' of 2" vacuum hose. 29-157 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 29-185 29-190 VACUUM HOSE INSERT COUPLING — 2" O.D. plastic. (Hose clamps extra.) 29-180 HOSE CLAMP — Stainless steel. 29-185 11⁄2" hose clamp 29-190 2" hose clamp 29-225 29-220 HOSE-TO-WALL SWIVEL FITTINGS 29-22011⁄2" male to 11⁄2" hose-CPB 29-225 2" male to 2" hose-CPB 29-230 QUICK CONNECT HOSE COUPLING — Ensures fast, positive, leak proof connections for your vacuum hose. Includes: polypropylene connectors (2) and stainless steel clamp. 29-230 Quick Connect hose coupling, 11⁄2" 29-235 Quick Connect hose coupling, 2" 71 Cleaning Accessories 30-107 30-005 30-035 30-045 30-050 30-065 30-083 CAM LOCK — For use with Dually Poles replacement internal cam lock. 30-106 Replacement large cam 30-107 Replacement cam plug 30-130 POLES STRAIGHT POLES — For use with brushes or life hook. Length ALGAE REMOVERS ALGAEGON ™ BLANKET — Kill algae with this new underwater Algaegon Blanket applicator. Allows concentrated granular algaecide or chlorine to be applied directly on the algae for long periods of time. For stubborn black algae, wire brush immediately before and after using application. Also helpful in bleaching out stubborn stains. Do not use on vinyl lined pools. 30-005 12" x 14", 1-pocket 30-010 24" x 39", 6-pocket 30-015 48" x 75", 12-pocket 12' 16' Length 6' - 12' 8' - 16' 12' - 24' 16' - 32' Aluminum • 30-050 30-055 30-060 Sections 2 x 8' 3 x 8' 30-045 30-046 Fiberglass 30-035 30-040 30-041 • Aluminum 30-075 30-080 QUICK SHIP TELESCOPIC POLES — Nylon twist-lock assembly secures sections in place. Quick ship poles are built in sections and can be shipped via UPS. 30-020 ALGEE-GON — Simply insert a 3" diameter TriChlor tablet into holder, attach to your cleaning pole and scrub on black algae spots. Use algae brush to sweep dead algae away. 30-020 Algee-gon 30-021 3" TriChlor tablets, 4.3 lb. (10) Length 6' - 12' 8' - 16' 9' - 31' Sections Aluminum Fiberglass 2 x 6' 2 x 8' 4 x 8' • • 30-084 30-035 30-040 • QUICK SHIP DUALLY POLES — New .042" wall thickness aluminum poles with dual lock assemblies with twice the locking capabilities for heavy duty jobs. Quick Ship Dually poles are built in sections and can be shipped via UPS. Length 8' - 16' 6' - 18' 8' - 24' Sections 2' - 8' 3' - 6' 3' - 8' 30-120 Fiberglass QUICK SHIP STRAIGHT POLES — .042" wall thickness aluminum pole for use with brushes or life hook. Quick ship poles are built in sections and can be shipped via UPS. 16' 24' Aluminum 30-081 30-082 30-083 30-125 30-110 30-115 30-135 DELRIN SPRING CLIP — Replaces nuts and bolts. Plastic spring for snap adapter handles. 3 per package. 30-110 BRASS WING NUT & BOLT SET — Set of 2 bolts and nuts for attaching vacuum heads and brushes to the end of pole. 30-115 SPEED POLE COUPLER — Attaches to your pole so you can quickly change to any vacuum head, brush or skimmer, without the necessity of using 2 bolts and nuts each time you change heads. Reduces the number of poles needed. 30-120 POLE CAPS — White polyethylene caps protect pole ends. 30-12511⁄4" POLE HANGERS POLE HANGERS — Holds 2 poles on wall or fence. Set of 2 hangers. 30-130 Plastic 30-135 Aluminum 30-025 STAIN REMOVER — An easy-to-use underwater applicator of muriatic acid that will remove rust, scale and other stains without the necessity of draining the pool. The Stain Remover enables you to apply undiluted muriatic acid to the submerged surface by siphoning acid from a gallon bottle to a cuplike applicator. 30-025 72 30-065 30-070 TELESCOPIC POLES — Features twist-lock connector for easy adjustment. Length STAIN REMOVER Aluminum 30-106 POLE PARTS & FITTINGS 30-105 TELESCOPIC TWIST-LOCK CONNECTOR Replacement Nylon twist-lock assembly for use with aluminum telescopic poles. 30-105 NOTE: Due to size restrictions from UPS, poles over 8' must be shipped via common carrier. Please call for freight estimate. 30-140 MISSING LINX POLE HANGERS — Plastic chain link fence pole hanger allows you to utilize your fence for easy pole storage. Holds one pole. Set of 2 hangers. 30-140 www.lincolnaquatics.com Cleaning Accessories STRAIGHT END WALL BRUSHES STRAIGHT END WALL BRUSH — Deluxe nylon bristles, plastic back with kwik-fit metal handle. 31-005 18" 31-010 24" 31-015 36" CURVED END WALL BRUSHES 31-086 SPECIALTY BRUSHES WALL WHALE — The Wall Whale creates a downward force, which keeps the brush firmly against the pool floor, with 10 times the force of a regular brush. Hinged Wall Whale vane eliminates drag on the upstroke and lifts the brush off the wall. Available complete with nylon bristle brushes or add a Wall Whale to your existing brush with the addition of the component kit. 31-086 Wall Whale with 24" brush 31-087 Wall Whale with 36" brush 31-088 Wall Whale Component Kit 31-071 ANGLED CORNER BRUSH — Angle design corner brush with synthetic bristles. Dualpurpose handle attaches to telescopic pole or male threaded pole. Ideal for those hard to reach areas. 31-071 CURVED END WALL BRUSH — Deluxe nylon bristles, plastic back with kwik-fit metal handle. 31-020 18" 31-025 24" 31-030 36" 31-090 ALGAE BRUSHES ALGAE BRUSHES — “Algae-fighter” brushes. Stainless steel bristles, plastic back with kwik-fit metal handle. 31-035 5" 31-040 9" 31-045 18" SWEEPEASE BRUSH — Patented design lets the water do the work for you. Easily sticks to the pool wall and floor as you push the brush. Airfoil design also makes it easier to pull brush back through the water. Fast and easy way to clean your pool, with 10 times the brushing power of a standard pool brush. Now brushing can be done efficiently, even when you're using only one hand. Quick release pole connection. 31-090 31-076 31-077 CORNER BRUSH — Perfect for cleaning hard to reach places. Staggered bristle pattern allows for better brushing action. Durable metal handle. Available in synthetic bristles or combination synthetic and stainless steel bristles. 31-076 Corner Brush, Synthetic 31-077 Corner Brush, Combination 31-070 TILE & ACID BRUSHES TILE & ACID BRUSHES — Tile & acid wash brushes with blue plastic bristles. 27⁄8" wide. Durable hardwood back with 5' pole. 31-050 5" 31-055 10" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 DUAL ACTION SCRUB BRUSH — Dual surface brush and double edge squeegee all-in-one cleaning tool. Ideal for decks, locker and shower areas. Stiff crimped plastic bristles, 10" solid plastic back, with 5' wood pole. 31-070 31-080 MINI SCRUB BRUSH — All purpose scrub brush with poly bristles set into molded hand grip. 31-080 73 Deck Cleaning Accessories 31-095 31-100 31-140 31-100 LEAF SKIMMERS & RAKES DELUXE SKIMMER & LEAF RAKE — Designed for heavy duty commercial use. Features plated steel handle, stainless steel rim and protective tubing to guard from wear and tear. Item 31-095 31-100 Style Skimmer Leaf Rake Pocket Depth CHAMPION™ LEAF RAKE — Commercial heavy duty 21" wide leaf rake with lip design that allows for easier pick up. Plastic rim and 21" deep net. Color coated aluminum handle. Wear panel helps extend the life of the mesh pocket on the leaf rake. Repair kit includes: plastic rim, 21" mesh net and v-clip. 31-135 Champion™ leaf rake, standard 31-140 Champion™ leaf rake with wear panel 31-145 Champion™ leaf rake repair kit 8" 10" 32-012 POOLSTONE CLEANING BLOCK — Pumicelike cleaning block made from recycled materials. Provides chemical-free, non-toxic cleaning for hard water, mildew, and rust stains. Safe for use on pool tile, concrete, gunite and stone. Starter Kit includes 1 block and EZ-grip plastic handle. Refill Pack contains 3 PoolStone cleaning blocks for cleaning by hand or for use with EZ-grip handle. Pole Attachment fits on standard cleaning pole ends. Item PoolStone 32-011 Pole Attachment Starter Kit 32-012 32-013 Refill Pack - 3 32-014 Large Block Block Size 91/2"H x 2"W x 2"D 2"H x 4"W x 3"D 2"H x 4"W x 3"D 3"H x 6"W x 3"D 31-101 32-010 32-005 POOL BLOK — A quick way to remove stains, rust, scale and algae deposits from ceramic tile and pool surfaces. Specially treated pumice stone is pH neutral so it can be used underwater. Optional aluminum handle fits larger Pool Blok pumice stone only. 31-102 DURAPRO SKIMMER & LEAF RAKE — An economical alternative to the Deluxe line of skimmers & leaf rakes with half the weight. Plated steel handle and rim with protective tubing. High Capacity model, with pocket stays to keep the pocket open, allowing debris to enter and empty easily. Item 31-101 31-102 31-103 Style Skimmer Leaf Rake High Capacity Leaf Rake Item 32-004 32-005 32-010 Pocket Depth 8" 10" 16" 32-026 32-017 Pool Blok Small Medium Handle Size 6" x 13/4" 6" x 3" x 3" 6" 32-016 32-027 POOL SURFACE CLEANERS 31-103 74 TELESCOPIC TILE SCRUBBER — Allows you to clean your pool or spa tile standing up. Anodized aluminum 41" telescopic pole extends to 70" length with vinyl hand grips. Durable 7" x 4" polyethylene scrub pad attaches to the pole with a pivoting head attachment which enables you to work on cleaning the tile line at varying angles. Replacement hand knob and pad allows you to put more pressure on the pad for trouble spots. 32-026 Telescopic tile scrubber 32-027 Replacement pad with hand knob 32-028 Replacement pivoting head 32-018 STAIN ERASER — Cleans rust, calcium, algae and miscellaneous stains on surfaces. Won't scratch or gouge surface. 32-016 Stain eraser 32-017 Spa eraser 32-018 R-Teez tile and grout eraser www.lincolnaquatics.com Deck Cleaning Accessories 32-058 CLEANING SYSTEMS WYSIWASH SPRAY SYSTEMS — Clean and disinfect using chlorine caplets and your water hose. Ideal for locker rooms, pool decks and general facility maintenance. Eliminates algae and bacteria all while washing dirt away. Proper dispensing of chemical is automatic. Simply connect the applicator to a hose and spray. Calcium Hypochlorite caplets last up to 3 hours. PORTABLE HOSE REEL 32-101 CHAMPION™ HOSE REEL — Industrial water hose reel with double handle and extra wide turf tires allows easier maneuverability on deck. Holds up to 150' of 5⁄8" hose. 32-101 Champion™ Hose Reel 32-052 WYSIWASH HAND SPRAYER — Hand Sprayer with ergonomic grip and convenient squeeze trigger. Unit has a trigger lock for consistent spray and less hand fatigue. Caplets ordered separately. 32-052 Wysiwash Hand Sprayer 32-058 Wysiwash Caplets, 9 caplets 32-053 WYSIWASH FCV HAND SPRAYER — New all-in-one Flow Control Valve (FCV) Hand Sprayer with adjustable flow rate. Unit has fewer parts for ease of use and requires less maintenance. Caplets ordered separately. 32-053 Wysiwash FCV Hand Sprayer 32-058 Wysiwash Caplets, 9 caplets WATER HOSE HEAVY DUTY WATER HOSE — Commercial grade 3 ⁄ 4 " I.D. rubber hose with brass connections. 32-105 50' hose 32-106 75' hose 32-107 100' hose TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 32-080 32-070 32-075 32-085 32-090 WATER NOZZLES 32-038 WATER BROOMS HEAVY DUTY WATER BROOM — Water conserving water broom uses less water than just hosing the deck with a hose nozzle. Quickly and efficiently cleans any paved surface in less time. The cleaning power comes from the brass nozzles that push the water ahead as it cleans, leaving fewer puddles behind on the surface. Heavy gauge steel construction with brass fittings and brass shut-off ball valve. Heavy gauge swivel casters provide easy maneuverability on the deck. 50 psi minimum water pressure required, except for 48" wide unit, which requires 80-100 psi water pressure. 32-037 5 nozzle, 24" wide 32-038 7 nozzle, 36" wide 32-039 10 nozzle, 48" wide WATER NOZZLE — Brass nozzles reduce wash down time and water consumption. Available in flat sheet spray pattern or fireman type nozzle for a concentrated stream of water at one spot. 32-070 Flat sheet nozzle, 25° angle 32-075 Flat sheet nozzle, 40° angle 32-080 Fireman type nozzle WATER SHUT-OFF PETCOCK — For back of nozzle. Allows one to shut off water at nozzle rather than at water line. 32-085 Brass 32-090 Plastic 32-060 DECK CLEANING ACCESSORIES SQUEEGEE — 36" wide with curved ends, moves large volume of water with greater water control. Non-marking gray blade can easily be replaced. Zinc plated, heavy duty stamped steel handle and iron frame with 5' wood pole. 32-060 Squeegee 32-066 Replacement 5' wood pole 32-056 32-051 WATER REMOVERS ROL-DRI® MASTER WATER REMOVER — Removes water easily from tennis courts, pool decks and patios. Non-deteriorating foam is molded directly onto the roller core for a seamless fit to ensure rapid, streakless drying. Complete with handle. 36” wide. 32-051Rol-Dri® Master Water Remover 32-056 Repl. Master Sponge & Roller 75 Underwater Lights 33-115 33-150 33-175 33-135 33-110 UNDERWATER LIGHTS AMERLITE LIGHTS — Incandescent underwater pool light. Available in 120 volt and 12 volt styles with stainless steel face ring. Niche ordered separately. Units with longer cord lengths are available — inquire. UL Listed. Cord Length 15' 50' 100' Niche - 3⁄4" Repl. Lens, 83⁄8" Lens Gasket, 83⁄8" Repl. Silicone Lens Gasket, 83⁄8" 120 V 300 W 33-100 33-106 33-108 33-110 33-210 33-230 120 V 500 W 33-115 33-121 33-123 33-110 33-210 33-230 12 V 300 W SUNLITE HALOGEN LIGHTS — Quartz halogen light uses less electricity than standard pool lights and produces bright light and is only 5.60" diameter. Perfect for spas and baby pools, where space is tight and the water depth is shallow. UL Listed. Cord Length 30' 50' 100' Niche - 3⁄4" 120 V 100 W 33-130 33-131 33-132 33-135 120 V 250 W 33-150 33-151 33-152 33-135 33-094 33-097 • 33-110 33-210 33-230 Cord Length 25' 50' 100' Repl. Lens, 71⁄2" Repl. Lens Gasket, 71⁄2" Repl. Silicone Lens Gasket, 71⁄2" 120 V 500 W 33-068 33-071 • 33-200 33-220 33-227 33-227 NOTE: All lights are to be installed only into the manufacturers matching niche. 76 PARAGON SLIMLITE POOL LIGHTS — Designed for fresh water, concrete pools. Bronze and copper construction with chrome plated reflector shell. Cast bronze grille has protective powder coating. Dual halogen bulb design light is 10" diameter and only 31/2" deep. Light is Niche ordered separately. Custom cord lengths available. 110 volt/ 500W. UL Listed. 33-155 13' cord 33-161 50' cord 33-160 26' cord 33-162 75' cord 33-163 Custom Cord Lengths 33-164 Repl. 250W Bulb (2 per light) 33-165 Niche - 3/4" 12 V 300 W 33-060 33-066 33-067 33-200 33-220 35' Niche - 3⁄4" Repl. Lens, 83⁄8" Repl. Lens Gasket, 83⁄8" Repl. Grid Gasket, 83⁄8" 120 V 300 W 33-169 33-180 33-215 33-235 33-240 33-225 LENS GASKETS 33-226 SILICONE LENS GASKETS — Replacement gaskets provide superior chemical resistance. 33-225 Amerlite repl. lens gasket 33-227 Swimquip repl. lens gasket 33-226 SpaBrite repl. lens gasket 120 V 500 W 33-175 33-180 33-215 33-235 33-240 33-480 LED POOL LIGHTS 33-160 33-060 Cord Length 33-420 33-225 33-225 33-225 SWIMQUIP LIGHTS — Incandescent underwater light with CPB face ring. Available in 120 volt and 12 volt models. Swimquip Niche is no longer available. Lights are for direct replacement only. UL Listed. HYDREL QUARTZ LIGHTS — Heavy duty cast bronze fixture with safety "electrogrid" design. Stainless steel niche, ordered separately. Custom cord lengths available. Available in 300W and 500W sizes. Includes low water cutoff. UL Listed. HYDREL LED POOL LIGHTS — White LED lights with either 18 LED array (60 watts) or 36 LED array (96 watts). White LED outputs of 3000K, 4100K, or 5300K. Custom cord lengths available. 120 volt. UL Listed. Cord Length 35' 35' 33-426 33-427 33-428 33-429 LED Array 3000K 4100K 5300K 18 33-420 33-421 33-422 36 33-423 33-424 33-425 Custom Cord Lengths Niche - 3/4" Repl. LED Engine Kit - 18 LED Repl. LED Engine Kit - 36 LED PARAGON SLIMLITE 5G POOL LIGHTS Energy efficient LED light is 10" diameter and only 31/2" deep. Direct replacement for existing 500W Slimlite incandescent fixtures. Uses 86% less energy than comparable incandescent fixture. Designed for fresh water, concrete pools. Bronze and copper construction with chrome plated reflector shell. Cast bronze grille has protective powder coating. Niche ordered separately. 110 volt/500W LED equivalent. UL Listed. 33-480 30' cord 33-481 50' cord 33-482 100' cord 33-483 150' cord 33-484 250' cord 33-490 Repl. 5G Engine Kit 33-165 Niche - 3/4" www.lincolnaquatics.com Underwater Lights & Accessories 33-750 LED POOL LIGHTS INTELLIBRITE WHITE LED LIGHTS — Uses less watts of power, yet produces illumination equivalent to incandescent lights. Superior lens geometry, with exclusive reflector design, creates a wider beam with more uniform light distribution. Replacement Light Engine Kit includes: LED light assembly, Uni-tension clamp, and lens gasket. Replacement Lens Kit includes: lens and lens gasket. Available in 120 volt and 12 volt styles. UL Listed. 40 WATT LED - EQUIVALENT TO 300 WATT Cord Length 30' 50' 100' 150' 33-870 120 volt 12 volt 33-750 33-770 33-755 33-775 33-760 33-780 33-765 33-785 Repl. Light Engine Kit 48 WATT LED - EQUIVALENT TO 400 WATT Cord Length 30' 50' 100' 150' 33-871 120 volt 12 volt 33-790 33-810 33-795 33-815 33-800 33-820 33-805 33-825 Repl. Light Engine Kit 55 WATT LED - EQUIVALENT TO 500 WATT Cord Length 30' 50' 100' 150' 33-872 120 volt 12 volt 33-830 33-850 33-835 33-855 33-840 33-860 33-845 33-865 Repl. Light Engine Kit 33-875 Replacement Lens/Gasket Kit 33-276 33-390 LED LIGHT BULBS PURE WHITE 2 LED LIGHT BULBS — Replacement LED bulbs offer ultrabright white LED light. Compatible with most standard medium base fixtures. Uses only 40 watts of power. Reduces energy consumption and maintenance, while providing brighter illumination than standard bulbs. Proprietary cooling system maximizes lamp life up to 50,000 hours. Available in 120 volt and 14 volt styles. 14 volt will work in 12 volt fixtures, but output will be slightly dimmer. Includes silicone lens gasket. Specify brand of light when ordering. Pool (up to 95˚) - 3 Year Warranty. Spa (up to 104˚) - 1 Year Warranty. Voltage 120 volt 14 volt Pool Up to 95˚ 33-276 33-277 Spa Style 33-520 PURE WHITE LED POOL LIGHTS — Stainless steel LED light fixture, for use in pools or spas. Used 80% less energy than similarly sized incandescent fixture. Available in 500 watt (58 watt LED) and 300 watt (39 watt LED) equivalent output fixtures in 120 volt and 12 volt styles. Niche ordered separately. 3 Year Warranty. ETL Listed. 300 Watt 500 Watt Cord Length 120 volt 12 volt 120 volt 12 volt 30' 50' 100' 150' Niche 33-610 33-615 33-620 33-625 33-110 33-630 33-635 33-640 33-645 33-110 33-520 33-525 33-530 33-535 33-110 33-540 33-545 33-550 33-555 33-110 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Reflector Flood Reflector Reflector Globe Globe Base HYDREL JUNCTION BOX — Cast bronze junction box for above deck or wall mounting. Can be drilled for 1/2", 3/4" or 1" sizes. Size: 75/8" L x 61/2" W x 47/16"D. UL listed. 33-320 Up to 104˚ 33-278 33-279 33-390 33-395 120 volt 33-675 33-685 33-695 12 volt 33-670 33-680 33-690 REPLACEMENT LIGHT BULBS Bulb Style JUNCTION BOXES Mini-Spa AMERBRITE LED LIGHT BULBS — The only UL listed LED replacement bulb for Amerlite incandescent fixtures. Uses only 34 to 51 watts of power. Includes: bulb, lens and lens gasket. Lens can be rotated 180 degrees to provide wide or narrow beam. Available in 300, 400, and 500 watt equivalent versions in 12 volt or 120 volt styles. 300 watt (34 watt LED) 400 watt (43 watt LED) 500 watt (51 watt LED) 33-320 33-315 JUNCTION BOXES — Cast bronze base with polycarbonate cover. UL listed. 33-315 Bronze with poly top, 3 x 3/4" ports 33-295 TRANSFORMERS TRANSFORMER — For use with low voltage lights. Converts line voltage from 120 volts to 12 volts. Waterproof enclosure. UL listed. 33-290 100 watt 33-295 300 watt 120 volt 12 volt 300W 300W 400W 500W Medium 33-244 • • • Cleated 33-245 • • • Mogul • 33-250 • 33-265 Medium • 33-255 • 33-270 Mogul • • • 33-275 Medium • • • 33-260 33-196 33-194 LIGHT ACCESSORIES ADAPTABLE LIGHT RING — Adapt your old niche to new style lights. Order to match brand fixture currently in use. 33-194 Purex light 33-195 Amerlite light LIGHT WEDGE — Holds pool light in when niche tab is stripped or broken. Fits all lights. 33-196 77 Electrical Accessories 33-340 TIMERS & CONTROLS 33-338 ENTRAPMENT PREVENTION STINGL SVRS SYSTEM — Patented "Safety Vacuum Release System" (SVRS), by Stingl. Certified and fully compliant with the VGB Pool and Spa Safety Act. Automatically shuts down the circulation pump and activates an audible alarm when a sudden change in vacuum is detected. Vacuum is monitored 128 times per second. Pump remains off until manually reset. Units include: NEMA 3R enclosure with back-lit LCD display, low vacuum sensor, fireman's switch output, auxiliary pump control, programmable filter cycle, display error readout, and power back-up, in case of power failure. Remote visual/audible alarm switch for poolside safety ordered separately. Directly operates pumps to 3 HP/20 amps. Larger horsepower, or 3 phase pumps, require purchase of external pump contactor. Specify 120 VAC or 240 VAC. Complies with ASME/ ANSI 112.19.17. 33-338 Stingl SVRS System 33-335 Stingl remote visual/audible alarm 33-344 VAC-ALERT SVRS SYSTEM — Safety Vacuum Release System (SVRS) reacts in less than one second to quickly release dangerous pump suction vacuum. Provides a critical layer of proection against body or limb entrapment. This totally mechanical, non-electric safety system is easy to install, adjust, and test. Available in 2 versions - Submerged - for below grade submerged suction installations, which provides pump start-up surge protection and Lift - for above grade suction lift installations, that allows flow to the pump when priming, for lifts up to 3.5 ft. Fail-safe design is constructed of engineered plastics and Type 316 stainless steel components for long life and reliability. Meets or exceeds the performance requirements of ASME/ANSI A112.19.17. 3 Year Limited Warranty. 33-343 Vac-Alert, Submerged 33-344 Vac-Alert, Lift 78 EMERGENCY SPA SHUT-OFF SYSTEM Spa side emergency shut-off switch turns off filter pump and spa jet pump instantly. Power center at the equipment site has status lights for pumps and audible alarm. 115V/230V. 33-340 33-341 SPA CONTROL SYSTEM — Remote spa jet switch with electronic count down timer (15 or 30 minutes) for spa users to activate. Also includes a spa side emergency shut-off switch which disables pumps instantly and filter pump time clock. 115V/230V. 33-341 33-345 LIGHTNING DETECTORS SKY SCAN LIGHTNING DETECTOR — Portable Electronic instrument can detect and track lightning up to 40 miles away. Audible tone and LED lights that track storms in miles away. 2 x 9 volt batteries required (not included). Protective soft case, 110 volt AC Adapter, and wall mount ordered separately. 33-345 Lightning detector 33-346 Protective case 33-347 110 volt AC adapter 33-348 Wall mount 33-015 33-005 UNDERWATER SPEAKER SYSTEM 33-280 33-285 SPRING WOUND TIMERS — Installs as switch in standard 21/2" deep, vertically installed, junction box. 33-280 15 minute timer 33-285 30 minute timer 27-130 27-135 GROUND FAULT INTERRUPTERS GROUND FAULT INTERRUPTERS — Available in two GFCI styles: user attachable which is wired on site and in-line plug in style. Rated for 18-12 gauge cords. UL listed. 27-130 In-line GFCI, 120 volt 27-131 In-line GFCI, 240 volt 27-135 User attachable, 120 volt 27-132 User attachable, In-Line GFCI, 110/220 volt UNDERWATER SPEAKER SYSTEM — Underwater speakers utilize patented design that produces the highest output/bandwidth. Provides music and voice communication for: synchronized swimming, competitive swimming, and scuba training. Portable System includes: 120 watt mixer/amplifier, PVC underwater speaker with 25' cord, protective cage and transformer. Permanent In-wall package allows PVC speaker to be permanently mounted into pool wall. Includes: stainless steel niche with stainless steel grille, speaker with 50' cable, and transformer. Install at 6' depth. Use 1 speaker per 1,500 sq. ft. at pool surface area. Optional air speaker ordered separately. Additional accessories available. 33-005 Speaker system - portable 33-010 Speaker with niche - permanent 33-015 Optional air speaker 33-020 Air speaker cord, 25 ft. 33-025 Air speaker cord, 50 ft. 33-010 www.lincolnaquatics.com Diving Stands 34-075 34-095 PARAGON DIVING STANDS Paragon Aquatics is known around the world as the premier manufacturer of world class commercial deck equipment. PARAFLYTE DIVING STANDS — Are a family of stands available in three different grades of materials, to meet varying needs and budgets. All stands come complete with flanged pedestal, railings, safety handrails, 15° sloping ladder, front anchors, rear anchors, and diving board rear swivel assembly. Diving board ordered separately. When ordering, specify brand and length of diving board to be used and pool deck-to-water level dimension. Ultraflyte, the top grade, uses 1.90" O.D. x .145" wall thickness stainless steel Type 304 tubing. Superflyte, the general purpose midgrade, uses 1.90" O.D. stainless steel type 304 tubing. Fulcrum supports and the base bar are .145" wall thickness. The ladder risers and rear legs utilize .109" wall thickness. All other tubular members utilize .065" wall thickness tubing. Topflyte, the economy grade, uses 1.90" O.D. x .065" wall thickness Type 304 stainless steel tubing, except on the flexural members which use .145" O.D. wall thickness tubing. Flanged pedestals are listed with plain pedestals also available — Inquire. NOTE: See pages 81-83 for diving boards, diving board accessories, and parts. See page 83 for replacement steps and hardware. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 34-080 34-100 Aquatics 2005 ONE© Paragon METER DIVING STANDS — Stands come in three grades, Ultraflyte, Superflyte, and Topflyte. Diving board ordered separately. Specify brand and length of diving board to be used and pool deck-to-water level dimension when ordering. 34-095 Ultraflyte - flanged rear mount 34-100 Ultraflyte - flanged side mount 34-105 Superflyte - flanged rear mount 34-110 Superflyte - flanged side mount 34-111 Topflyte - flanged rear mount 34-112 Topflyte - flanged side mount THREE METER DIVING STANDS — Stands come in three grades, Ultraflyte, Superflyte, and Topflyte. Diving board ordered separately. Specify brand and length of diving board to be used and pool deck-to-water level dimension when ordering. 34-075 Ultraflyte - flanged rear mount 34-080 Ultraflyte - flanged side mount 34-085 Superflyte - flanged rear mount 34-090 Superflyte - flanged side mount 34-091 Topflyte - flanged rear mount 34-092 Topflyte - flanged side mount 79 Diving Stands 34-035 DURAFIRM SHORT STANDS — Aluminum rear anchor assembly, fulcrum box and choice of stainless steel handrails. For mounting onto concrete platform. Custom handrails available and ordered separately. Anchors, Duraflex or Maxiflex diving boards ordered separately. Specify board length when ordering. 34-035 Double rails on two sides 34-050 Without handrails 34-055 Bronze deck anchors (set of 6) 36-140 Custom handrails 34-015 DURAFIRM DIVING STANDS Durafirm diving stands are designed for use with Duraflex and Maxiflex diving boards. Stands are constructed from aluminum for strength, rigidity, and long life. All Durafirm diving stands are now provided with new, replaceable 2-piece slip resistant stair treads. By far the most popular stands for competitive diving. 34-005 DURAFIRM ONE METER STANDS — Aluminum stand with adjustable fulcrum and double polished stainless steel handrails on both sides. Specify deck-to-water level when ordering. Anchors, Duraflex or Maxiflex diving boards ordered separately. 34-015 34-010 Bronze deck anchors (set of 8) 34-050 DURAFIRM THREE METER STAND — Aluminum stand with adjustable fulcrum and double polished stainless steel guard railings on two sides. Specify deck-to-water level when ordering. Anchors, Duraflex or Maxiflex diving boards ordered separately. 34-005 34-010 Bronze deck anchors (set of 8) NOTE: Durafirm Diving Stands and Duraflex Diving Boards can only be supplied to pools meeting FINA and local code safety standards. Measurement guides are required to be submitted to determine if your pool meets those standards. 34-125 34-115 S.R. SMITH DIVING STANDS STEEL DIVING STANDS — Powder coated steel diving stand. Each stand has beautiful sleek design with durable, double coated finish. Each stand includes pedestal and jig anchor assembly. Available in 1⁄2, 3⁄4, 1 meter heights and each stand is predrilled for optional stainless steel handrails. Diving board ordered separately. Item 34-015 80 34-115 34-120 34-125 34-130 34-135 34-140 34-145 Description 1/2 meter stand 3/4 meter stand 3/4 meter stand 1 meter stand 1 meter stand Handrail set Handrail set Board Size 10' 10' 12' 10' 12' 10' 12' www.lincolnaquatics.com Diving Boards 35-020 DIVING BOARDS FIBERGLASS DIVING BOARDS — Available in 2 different commercial grades. Swim Club Series boards are designed with a solid laminated wood core, which is reinforced at the fulcrum. Eureka Series boards have a solid laminated wood core, which is reinforced along its full length and width. Both style boards utilize an acrylic skin with hand-laid fiberglass and resin roving. Includes mounting hardware. Colors: marine blue, white, and tile blue. Board Length DURAFLEX DIVING BOARDS — Extruded aluminum construction with single-taper design. Includes 5⁄8" dia. anchor bolts. 35-00514' 35-01016' 10' 12' 14' 16' MAXIFLEX MODEL B DIVING BOARD — Extruded aluminum, dual-taper design with new reinforced board end. Slotted “cheeseboard” slots are installed to increase lift. Includes 5⁄8" dia. anchor bolts. 35-02016' Swim Club Series 35-024 35-025 35-029 35-034 Eureka Series • • 35-030 35-035 Marine Blue White NOTE: Durafirm Diving Stands and Duraflex Diving Boards can only be supplied to pools meeting FINA and local code safety standards. Measurement guides are required to be submitted to determine if your pool meets those standards. Tile Blue 35-045 35-020 NOTE: See pages 79 and 80 for diving stands and diving board accessories. See page 82 for diving stand anchors. See page 83 for replacement steps and hardware. OLYMPIAN ALUMINUM DIVING BOARD Proven “I beam” extrusions with welded end construction. Safe, non-slip surface that resists wear. 12' board is 18" wide and the 14' and 16' boards are 20" wide. Includes mounting hardware. Colors: marine blue, white or tile blue. 35-03910' 35-04514' 35-04012'35-05016' DURAFLEX BOARD FACTORY REFINISHING MAXIFLEX B BOARD TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 FACTORY REFINISHING — Duraflex or Maxiflex boards only. Board sent to factory, old finish stripped to the bare aluminum and refinished to original condition. Vinyl channels extra. Please note fulcrum location for correct replacement of channels. Board will be examined at factory to see if board warrants refinishing. 35-060 14' 35-065 16' 81 Diving Board Accessories & Anchors 35-185 DIVING STAND ANCHORS PARAGON DIVING STAND ANCHORS — Paragon Diving Stands include Anchor Bolt Assembly when originally purchased. The Flanged Stub Anchor or the Cage Anchor can be substituted as the anchor for the flanged pedestal for additional charge, both available in carbon steel or stainless steel. ANCHOR BOLT ASSEMBLY — Standard diving tower anchor. Includes template for accurate setting and alignment of flanged tower pedestal. 35-185 PLATFORM MATTING UNDERWATER WINDOWS PARAGON UNDERWATER WINDOWS — Rectangular and round styles. Installs in any poured concrete or gunite pool with plain, tile, or plaster finish. Stainless steel frame with 3 ply (3/8" thick each) tempered glass laminate or single thickness 11/4" Plexiglas. Round windows are constructed from powder coated cast bronze frames with 2 plies of 3/8" tempered glass or single thickness of 3/4" Plexiglas. Windows are pressure tested and factory sealed. Custom windows or windows designed for custom depths also available — inquire. Window Glass Opening Glazing 24" x 24" 24" x 36" 24" x 48" 24" x 60" 36" x 36" 36" x 48" 36" x 60" 18" dia. 35-220 35-230 35-240 35-250 35-260 35-270 35-280 35-290 Max Plexiglas Max Depth Glazing Depth 14' 6" 8' 6" 7' 0" 6' 3" 6' 6" 4' 3" 3' 6" 14' 6" 35-225 35-235 35-245 35-255 35-265 35-275 • 35-295 16' 6" 9' 3" 6' 6" 6' 0" 4' 9" 3' 0" • 8' 9" DIVETEX MATTING — Provides superior foot traction and consistent response. Vulcanized rubber with molded embossed surface, channels water away. 1/2" thick, in 2 different widths, and priced per square foot. Use adhesive to anchor matting in place. 35-300 3' wide 35-310 5' wide 35-316 Adhesive, 1.9 gallon CAGE ANCHOR — For installation on a beam or slab of any thickness greater than 6". Must be used when diving tower is to be supported on a framed slab. 35-188 Carbon steel 35-189 Stainless steel SAFETY PADDING SYSTEMS SOFTSIDE™ SAFETY PADS — Designed specifically for aquatic applications. Used under slide flumes, spray features, and diving boards. Durable PVC covered-safety foam padding system meets all CPSC guidelines and complies with fall-zone regulations. Foam is totally watertight and is formulated with biocides to resist mold and algae growth. Can be installed underwater or above waterline, either indoors or outdoors. Very easy to maintain. For existing facilities, padding is “tapered on grade” and for new facilities, padding is “flush with grade”. Includes mounting hardware. Padding material is colorfast and UV-stabilized to resist fading. Colors: white, light blue, Caribbean blue, or French blue. Available in 1/2" - 4" thick, with custom texture options. 2 Year Warranty. 35-320 SoftSide Safety Pad, 3' x 4' 35-321 SoftSide Safety Pad, 3' x 5' 35-322 SoftSide Safety Pad, 4' x 6' 35-323 SoftSide Safety Pad, 4' x 8' 35-324 SoftSide Safety Pad, custom Your Lincoln Representative can help you design the Soft-Water Landing System to best meet your needs. Inquire. 82 35-186 35-189 FLANGED STUB ANCHOR ASSEMBLY — For use when tower is supported by a foundation pad, on grade or in a framed beam, if it's at least 18" deep. 35-186 Carbon steel 35-187 Stainless steel REAR ANCHOR ASSEMBLY — Anchor for rear legs of Paragon diving stands. Two-piece heavy cast bronze with chrome plate upper flange. 37-025 34-010 34-055 DURAFIRM STAND ANCHORS — Cast bronze deck anchor for 1M and 3M stand, set of 8. Includes 1/2" x 5" bolts for positioning in cement and 5/8" x 1" bolts for layout positioning. Short stand anchors, set of six, same as 1M and 3M anchors, except does not include 5" bolt. For existing decks (1M and 3M stands) - Concrete threaded insert kit (set of 8) with epoxy. Available with or without epoxy dispenser. Stand anchor bolts purchased separately. 34-010 Deck anchors, set of 8 (1M & 3M) 34-055 Deck anchors, set of 6 (Short Stand) 34-065 Inserts w/disp., set of 8 (1M & 3M) 34-070 Inserts w/o disp., set of 8 (1M & 3M) 35-520 Anchor bolt, 5/8" x 13/4" 35-525 Anchor bolt, 5/8" x 2" 35-530 Anchor bolt, 5/8" x 21/2" 35-535 Anchor bolt, 5/8" x 3" www.lincolnaquatics.com Diving Board Parts & Accessories 35-190 DURAFIRM STAND PARTS GUARD RAIL PARTS 35-400 C107 Guard rail plug 35-405 C206 Rail bracket 35-105 C207 Stainless steel rail clamp 35-410 SF117 5/16"x1/2" S.S. rail clamp bolt 35-110 SF118 5/16"x5/8" S.S. rail clamp bolt 35-415 SF119 5/16"x3/4" S.S. rail clamp bolt 35-420 SF153 5/16"x7/8" S.S. rail clamp bolt FULCRUM PARTS 35-425 515 Rubber bumper 35-430 516 Anti rattle clamp 35-517 517 Roller block assembly 35-135 518 Slide bearings 35-140 521 Roller clamps 35-435 522 Tie plate assembly with bolts, nuts & washers 35-145 524 Roller bearings 35-440 526 Tie plate bolt w/nut & washers 35-150 528 Anti-rattle bolt with lock nut 35-445 532 Expansion pin 35-155 533 Roller clamp stud w/lock nut HINGE PARTS 35-115 C202 Hinge asmbly w/bolts & nuts 35-450 C202A Hinge (male) 35-455 C202B Hinge (female) 35-120 C203 Hinge pin 35-125 C209 Hinge nyliner 35-130 C210 Hinge “O” ring 35-460 SF103 3/8" x 1" rd. head aluminum bolt with nut 35-465 SF106 3/8" x 11/2" hex head aluminum hinge bolt 35-100 RUBBER CHANNELS & SHIMS 35-470 MP107 Shim set, round, 6 phenolic/12 plastic 35-475 MP108 Shim set, square, 4 each of 7 thicknesses 35-480 MP110 Rubber channel set, 6" with glue 35-100 MP112 Rubber channel set, 30" with glue 35-486 Glue kit with adapter PAINT & GREASE 35-490 MP105 Touch-up paint, 2 x 2 oz. bottles, buff 35-156 PM110 Grease gun 35-157 PM111 Grease NOTE: These are the most commonly ordered Durafirm parts. Inquire for the other Durafirm parts you may need. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 35-500 DURAFIRM STEP INSERT — Replaceable aluminum insert has non-skid texture like the Duraflex diving board surface. Includes replaceable insert and mounting hardware. 35-500 Replacement step insert only 35-505 Replacement ladder tread bolt with nut DIVING BOARD ACCESSORIES ANCHOR BOLTS — Includes: bolt with nut and washer. Priced as a set, each. Two sets required per board. Stainless steel. 35-085 5⁄8" x 5" 35-070 1⁄2" x 6" 35-090 5⁄8" x 31⁄2" 35-075 1⁄2" x 5" 35-080 1⁄2" x 4" DIVING BOARD ANCHORING KIT — Kit includes: two aluminum anchoring plates, two rubber pads, 51⁄2" bolts, nuts, and washers. 35-094 18" wide 35-095 20" wide PA R A G O N D E L U X E A D J U S TA B L E FULCRUMS — Cast bronze with chrome gear track and adjustable foot wheel. Calibrated with full view markings on gear track for competitive diving. Rubber fulcrum roller assembly has 24" adjusting range. Available in 2 sizes: 26" wide (center-to-center) for Paragon Rear Mount Stands and 30" wide for Paragon Side Mount Stands. Track length is 26" for both width fulcrums. Includes stainless mounting hardware. Replacement fulcrum roller assembly includes: axle assembly, rubber sleeve, and stainless gears. 35-190 26" adjustable fulcrum 35-191 30" adjustable fulcrum 35-195 Foot wheel only 35-200 26" fulcrum roller assembly 35-201 30" fulcrum roller assembly 35-205 PARAGON REAR SWIVELS — Includes pair of swivels and collars for Paragon Diving Stands. 35-205 Rear swivel, Duraflex 35-210 Rear swivel, Maxiflex 35-215 Rear swivel, all other boards 35-095 56-086 DIVING BOARD SAFETY SIGNS 35-180 FULCRUMS AND ACCESSORIES SPLIT FULCRUM COVER — Slips on easily over 11⁄2" or 2" O.D. pipe. For nonadjustable fulcrums. Silences and protects diving boards. 35-180 20" wide BOARD CLOSED SIGN — High visibility, free standing marker. Notifies your patrons that board is closed and not authorized for use. Folds flat for convenient storage. 56-086 NOTE: See page 103 for additional standing safety signs. 83 Ladders & Grab Rails 36-335 36-305 GRAB RAILS PARAGON ADJUSTABLE GRAB RAILS — Adjustable front leg provides additional strength and rigidity. Front leg is adjustable in field so it can set atop curbs or into gutters. Requires four anchor sockets, four escutcheons, and recessed steps as needed (extra). Style Adjustable 36-195 COMMERCIAL LADDERS PARAGON HEAVY DUTY CROSS BRACED LADDERS — Stainless steel cross braced ladders are designed especially for commercial use. Cross brace adds extra rigidity and strength. 1.90" O.D. tubing is available in three wall thickness, lighter duty .065" wall or heavier duty .109" wall & ultra duty .145" wall. Width of frame front to back is available in 24", 29" and 35" widths. Standard spacing between ladder rails is 19" (center-to-center of anchor). All ladders include cycolac non-skid steps and ladder bumpers. Requires two anchor sockets and escutcheons (extra). .065" 36-300 .109" 36-305 .145" 36-310 Style 2-step 3-step 4-step 5-step 29" WIDTH Style 2-step 3-step 4-step 5-step 35" WIDTH Style 2-step 3-step 4-step 5-step .065" .109" 36-150 36-195 36-225 36-255 36-155 36-200 36-230 36-260 .065" .109" .145" 36-160 36-035 36-045 36-055 36-165 36-005 36-015 36-025 36-170 36-010 36-020 36-030 .065" .109" .145" 36-180 36-210 36-240 36-270 .065" .109" 36-330 36-335 PARAGON LONGREACH ADJUSTABLE GRAB RAILS — Sized to fit extra wide gutter system in increasingly popular "fast-pool" designs. Specify "B" dimension when ordering. Custom widths can range from 3'0" - 4'6". Requires four anchor sockets, four escutcheons, and recessed steps as needed (extra). Style .065" .109" .145" Longreach Adjustable 36-315 36-320 36-325 36-350 CALIFORNIA GRAB RAILS — Extra-wide grab rails to clear wide gutters. Legs offset laterally to minimize deck width requirements. Front end dips downward for a shorter reach for low water level pools. Requires four anchor sockets, four escutcheons, and recessed steps as needed (extra). Style California .065" .109" 36-345 36-350 .145" S.R. Smith LLC Comme 36-355 Product Specif Commercial Ring Hand 36-185 36-215 36-245 36-275 26.72 1 R6.00 2 Ø1.625 3.63 3 24.00 36-070 PARAGON FIGURE 4 GRAB RAILS — Our most popular grab rails. For decks without unusual curbs or coping. Requires four anchor sockets, four escutcheons, and recessed steps as needed (extra). Style Figure 4 .065" 36-065 .109" 36-070 .145" 36-075 36-080 VIEW COMMERCIAL RING GRAB SIDE RAILS — Stainless steel 1.625" O.D. tubing x .065" wall thickness. Requires anchor kit, escutcheons, and recessed steps in pool wall (extra). 36-080 Commercial ring grab rails - pair 37-015 Double anchor socket assembly 37-020 Repl. wedge retrofit kit NOTE: 1.50" O.D. Stainless Steel Ladders and Grab Rails are available, inquire. Specification Number: Product Description: S.R. Smith Part Number: Revision: Written By: Approved By: Page 1 of 2 84 .145" 36-340 .145" 36-145 36-190 36-220 36-250 36-175 36-205 36-235 36-265 Style Pretzel Bend 36-320 CROSS BRACED LADDERS 24" WIDTH PRETZEL BEND GRAB RAILS — Requires the least amount of deck width with the narrowest profile as the legs are offset laterally instead of front to back. Requires four anchor sockets, four escutcheons, and recessed steps as needed (extra). SRS-602 Commercial Ring Handrails CRH-100 to CRH-100B-MG A T. Weil B. Bisceglia Scale: NTS Date: 05/29/03 Date: 05/29/03 Date: 05/30/03 Proprietary and confidential: The information contained in this specification is the sole property of S.R. Smith LLC. Any reproduction in part or whole without the written consent of S.R. Smith LLC is prohibited. www.lincolnaquatics.com Handrails & Railings 36-510 36-515 36-470 36-475 36-090 HANDRAILS PARAGON 2-BEND HANDRAILS — 2-Bend Handrails allow you to have safe access to your pool. Front leg requires underwater anchor socket. Stainless steel 1.90" O.D. tubing x .065", .109" and .145" wall thickness. Requires two anchor sockets and escutcheons (extra). 2-BEND HANDRAILS Size 48" 60" 72" .065" 36-085 36-090 36-095 .109" 36-086 36-091 36-096 36-120 PARAGON DECK-MOUNTED WELDED RAILS — Sloping handrail for pool entry steps provided safe entry and exit from the pool. Welded rail offers greater rigidity than standard handrails. Does not require underwater anchor socket. Stainless steel 1.90" O.D. x .065" wall thickness. Requires two anchors and escutcheons (extra). 36-120 .145" 36-087 36-092 36-097 ADA TRANSFER RAILS ADA TRANSFER RAILS — Allows users to independently access your pool or spa. Bent or straight rails with or without flanges are available in 12", 14", 16" and 18" lengths and are 5.75" high to meet ADA requirements. 1.50" O.D. x .120" wall thickness. Includes mounting hardware. ADA BENT TRANSFER RAILS Size 12" 14" 16" 18" With Flanges Without Flanges 36-450 36-460 36-470 36-480 36-455 36-465 36-475 36-485 ADA STRAIGHT TRANSFER RAILS Size 36-115 12" 14" 16" 18" With Flanges Without Flanges 36-490 36-500 36-510 36-520 36-495 36-505 36-515 36-525 PARAGON DECK-MOUNTED HORIZONTAL RAILS— Deck Mounted Rails allow you to have safe access to your pool without the need for an underwater anchor socket. Stainless steel 1.90" O.D. x .065" wall thickness. Requires two anchors and escutcheons (extra). 36-115 36-105 PARAGON 3-BEND HANDRAILS — 3-Bend Handrails feature a 18" horizontal transition to the sloping portion of the handrail. Handrail allows you to have safe access to your pool. Front leg requires underwater anchor socket. Stainless steel 1.90" O.D. tubing x .065", .109" and .145" wall thickness. Requires two anchors and escutcheons (extra). 3-BEND HANDRAILS Size 48" 60" 72" .065" 36-100 36-105 36-110 .109" 36-101 36-106 36-111 .145" 36-102 36-107 36-112 NOTE: 1.50" O.D. Stainless Steel Ladders and Grab Rails also available, inquire. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 36-435 ADA STAIR RAILS ADA 2-BEND STAIR RAILS — ADA Stair Rails are 34" high to meet ADA guidelines. 2-bend handrail is designed with an extended loop at the top of the rail to meet ADA requirements. 1.90" O.D. x .065 wall thickness. Requires two anchor sockets and escutcheons (extra). Size 48" 60" 72" .065" 36-430 36-435 36-440 36-140 CUSTOM LADDERS & RAILS PARAGON CUSTOM LADDERS/HANDRAILS Custom fabricated railings exclusively from Paragon Aquatics. We can help you with any facility needs with our design and engineering team. Available in our standard 1.90" O.D. or smaller 1.50" O.D. stainless steel tubing. 36-280 Custom Ladders 36-140 Custom Handrails 85 Handrail Accessories & Anchors 37-004 37-005 37-009 37-010 ANCHORS HANDRAIL COVERS KOOLGRIP HANDRAIL COVERS — Neoprene covers with zipper closure provides sure grip on rails when entering or exiting pool or spa. Material insulates rail surface against heat and cold. SureGrip hand area for slipresistance. 4' Koolgrips are 1.625" diameter for tight fit on ladders and single handrails. All others are 1.90" diameter. Install 6-8" above water line. Colors: Royal Blue, Indian Teal, and Desert Tan. 35-3354' 35-3406' PARAGON BRONZE ANCHOR SOCKET 4" deep anchor for 1.90" O.D. and smaller 1.50" O.D. rails. Fits all wall thickness stainless steel tubing. Includes wedge anchor. Description Bronze Anchor Socket Repl. Wedge Assembly 1.90" O.D. 1.50" O.D. 37-005 37-010 37-004 37-009 37-031 37-030 ESCUTCHEONS 37-035 37-040 ESCUTCHEONS — For covering anchor socket deck penetrations. Available in 1.90" O.D. and 1.50" O.D. tubing. Description Paragon Deluxe S.S. Paragon Stainless Steel Paragon CPB Round Stainless Steel 1.90" O.D. 1.50" O.D. 37-028 37-030 37-035 37-040 37-029 • • 37-031 37-045 35-3458' 35-35010' 37-045 Double Escutcheon, plastic, each 37-011 BRONZE ANCHOR SOCKET — 4" deep anchor for 1.90" O.D. x all wall thickness stainless steel tubing. Includes wedge anchor. 37-011 37-012 Replacement wedge assembly LADDER ACCESSORIES HANDRAIL STABILIZING PLUGS — Insert plug into end of handrail to provide permanent supporting surface for anchor to tighten onto. For use with 1.90" O.D. rails. 37-048 37-048 35-335 37-026 STAINLESS STEEL ANCHOR SOCKET — New Paragon 6" deep stainless steel anchor for 1.50" O.D. rails. Fits all wall thickness stainless steel tubing. Includes wedge anchor. Description Stainless Steel Anchor Repl. Wedge Assembly 3-182 STAINLESS STEEL CLEANERS METAL POLISHING SCRUBS — Remove tarnish and oxidation quickly and easily with convenient stainless steel scrubs. Exclusive formula polishes, brightens and protects. 3-182 Scrubs, 18 towel pack 3-183 Towels, 30 towel dispenser NOTE: See page 9 for additional stainless steel cleaners. 86 37-025 1.50" O.D. 37-026 37-009 37-021 PARAGON REAR ANCHOR ASSEMBLY Used to anchor rear legs of all Paragon diving stands. Two-piece heavy cast bronze with chrome plated upper flange. 37-025 PARAGON GUARD CHAIR PEDESTAL ANCHOR ASSEMBLY — Stainless steel anchor for Paragon permanent guard chairs only. 37-021 37-050 37-051 37-052 CRADLE HEAD BOLT ASSEMBLY — Stainless steel bolt, nut and washer for use with replacement ladder treads. Replacement bolt assembly must match ladder tread manufacturer for best fit. 37-050 Paragon, 23/4" L x 5/16" dia. 37-051 S.R. Smith, 21/2" L x 3/8" dia. 37-052 S.R. Smith, 31/4" L x 3/8" dia. 37-053 S.R. Smith, 23/4" L x 5/16" dia. 37-055 37-056 LADDER BUMPERS — Protects pool finish from damage by ladder end or wall goal end. Fits .145", .109" and .065" wall thickness. 37-055 Female Bumper, each 37-056 Male Bumper, each UNIVERSAL LADDER BUMPERS — Protects pool finish from damage by ladder end. Fits .065" wall thickness ladders only. 37-054 Universal Bumper 37-054 www.lincolnaquatics.com Steps & Chair Parts 37-085 37-130 37-080 REPLACEMENT GUARD SEATS 37-071 SAFETY LADDER TREADS 37-072 37-060 LADDER TREADS REPLACEMENT LADDER TREADS — For ladders, guard chairs/stands and diving stands. Measurements below indicate the overall width (O.D.) of the tread and the inside width (I.D.) for the distance between rails on the tread. All treads include cradle head bolt assembly. VERTICAL LADDER TREADS Item 37-060 Paragon 19" cycolac 37-071 S.R. Smith 20" HIP 37-072 S.R. Smith 20" Elite 37-085 Paragon 26" cycolac 183⁄16" 1915⁄16" 191⁄8" 251⁄4" SLOPING LADDER TREADS Item Description 37-065 Paragon 19" cycolac 37-073 S.R. Smith 20" Elite S.Q. 22" cycolac 37-080 37-090 Paragon 26" cycolac SAFETY STEP KIT — Convert your pool ladder into a safety ladder. Twice as wide as a conventional step. Extends to the pool wall giving added support to the feet. Side skirts are included preventing automatic pool cleaners from becoming entangled in the ladder. Kit includes: 8" wide by 19" long cycolac steps, side skirts, rubber bumpers and stainless steel hardware. 37-057 2 step kit 37-059 4 step kit 37-058 3 step kit37-061 5 step kit 37-122 PARAGON CUSHIONED GUARD SEAT Plastic seat with cushion for added comfort. Seat can be folded down to prevent UV damage to vinyl. Available so you can upgrade new Paragon lifeguard chairs with the cushioned seat or you can retrofit to existing Paragon lifeguard chairs in the field. 37-121 Cushioned Guard Seat, upgrade 37-122 Cushioned Guard Seat, retrofit Width O.D. I.D. Description PARAGON GUARD SEAT — Fiberglass guard seat with pre-drilled holes. Includes: stainless steel mounting bolts. 37-130 Paragon Guard Seat, turquoise 37-131 Paragon Guard Seat, white 17" 18" 18" 24" Width O.D. I.D. 183⁄16" 191⁄8" 217⁄8" 251⁄4" 17" 18" 20" 24" 37-110 37-105 RECESSED STEPS 37-120 PIT ACCESS STEPS LINCOLN POLYPRO PIT STEPS — Black polypropylene pit step with 1⁄2" steel reinforcing bar for new construction or add to your existing filter, surge or pump pit. Allows for safe and easy access with textured slip-resistant step and high visibility reflectors. Size: 151⁄4" wide. 37-120 37-125 PARAGON GUARD SEAT SWIVEL & PEDESTAL — Stainless steel swivel & pedestal assembly. Guard seat ordered separately. 37-125 38-044 FULLY-RECESSED STEPS — Fully recessed steps provide a flush finish for pool wall. Description Paragon frost proof white Paragon stainless steel Overall Width 171/2" 161/2" 37-110 37-115 SEMI-RECESSED STEPS — Cycolac semirecessed steps. Color: white. Description Pentair-cycolac white Overall Width 161/2" 38-047 Item Item 37-105 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 38-048 PARAGON GUARD CHAIR PARTS PARAGON GUARD CHAIR PARTS 38-044 Rubber base pad, each 38-047 Umbrella ring holder 38-048 Umbrella ring guide 37-135 37-137 S.R. SMITH REPLACEMENT GUARD SEAT Available as Replacement Seat and Swivel (bolt hole pattern is 51⁄4" square) or as Blank Replacement Seat only without pre-drilled bolt holes and swivel. Seat color: white. 37-135 S.R. Smith Seat with Swivel 37-136 S.R. Smith Seat, Blank 37-137 S.R. Smith Swivel, only 87 Guard Chairs 38-057 38-063 38-056 38-061 PLASTIC GUARD CHAIRS CHAMPIONTM GUARD CHAIRS — Recycled plastic guard chair won't rot, splinter or require paint. Ultra-smooth surface with contoured back, umbrella holder and cup holder. All stainless steel hardware. Four styles to choose from: the No Step Guard Chair, the Front Step Guard Chair which provides an easier approach to get in the chair and a comfortable footrest for your guard, the Side Step Guard Chair which allows you to place the chair closer to the pool edge, and the Front Ladder Guard Chair which has an easy access ladder for the guards. Specify color: white, green, sand or cedar. 3 Year Warranty. CHAMPION™ NO STEP GUARD CHAIRS Item 38-061 Seat Height 30" Overall Height 51" 38-058 Platform Kit 38-056 38-064 CHAMPION™ FRONT LADDER GUARD CHAIRS Item 38-064 38-063 Seat Height 50" 64" Overall Height 70" 85" 38-059 38-071 CHAMPION™ FRONT STEP GUARD CHAIRS CHAMPION™ SIDE STEP GUARD CHAIRS Item 38-072 38-071 88 Seat Height 50" 64" Overall Height 70" 85" Item Platform Kit 38-076 38-077 38-061 38-057 38-058 38-059 Seat Height 30" 40" 50" Overall Height 51" 61" 70" www.lincolnaquatics.com Guard Chairs 38-080 38-085 PORTABLE GUARD CHAIRS LINCOLN GUARD STATION — Director chair design with GUARD and white cross embroidered on rubber backed canvas. Forward pedestal allows guards to stand without leaving their station. Fluted PVC over aluminum frame construction. 31" seat height. Includes wheels for convenient transportation on deck. Optional storage box clips on either side of chair for holding guard supplies. 38-080 Lincoln Guard Station 38-085 Storage Box 38-035 PARAGON MOVABLE GUARD CHAIRS — Allows you to move chair to the most desirable life guarding location. .065" thickness stainless steel with cycolac steps. Semi-pneumatic front wheels. Includes rescue tube and umbrella holder. 38-034 Movable Guard Chair, 4' 38-035 Movable Guard Chair, 6' PARAGON MOVABLE CHAIR PARTS 37-090 Paragon 26" sloping tread, cycolac 38-041 Solid rubber wheel, 7", each 37-064 Paragon Guard Chair foot board 38-033 PARAGON ROVER GUARD CHAIR — The Rover Guard Chair is designed for pools where the lifeguard chair must be anchored yet still be capable of being moved to accommodate your facility needs. The rear legs are set into sockets anchored in the deck while the front legs have wheels for easy relocation of the guard stand. Includes: two anchors. 38-033 Paragon Rover Guard Chair, 6' ROVER GUARD CHAIR PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" slopping tread, cycolac 38-041 Solid rubber wheel, 7", each 37-069 Rover Guard Chair foot board 37-005 Bronze anchor socket 37-010 Replacement wedge assembly LINCOLN GUARD STATION PARTS 38-081 Replacement fabric seat/back 38-067 38-068 Size: 42" dia. footprint. Includes: rescue tube holder, umbrella holder and transport wheels. ALL TERRAIN GRIFF'S GUARD STATION Designed to work on any terrain with large pneumatic wheels, which lock or remove in seconds. Station provides front and rear access for quick emergency response. Features: cushioned swivel seat and zip-on safety grip covers. Optional railing powdercoat upgrade available. 38-067 All Terrain Griff's Guard Station, 4' 38-068 All Terrain Griff's Guard Station, 5' 38-069 All Terrain Griff's Guard Station, 6' 38-090 Powder-coat upgrade O-SERIES GUARD STAND PARTS 37-178 Repl. guard chair seat 37-056 Rubber leg cap, each 37-179 Rubber wheel, 4", each ALL TERRAIN GRIFF'S STATION PARTS 37-090 Paragon 26" slopping tread, cycolac 38-043 All Terrain Wheel, each 38-044 Rubber base pad, each 37-068 All Terrain Guard Chair foot board 38-042 Replacement zip-on safety covers 37-180 O-SERIES GUARD STAND — Innovative circular design allows for 360º view of facility. 37-175 O-Series Guard Stand, 30" ht. 37-180 O-Series Guard Stand, 42" ht. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 38-055 PARAGON PORTABLE GUARD CHAIRS — Lightweight chair with sloping front ladder allows easy access to fiberglass seat. .065" wall thickness stainless steel frame with angled legs gives extra stability. Rescue tube and umbrella holder not available with this guard chair. Optional wheel kit allows for easier movement around your pool deck. Item Model 38-050 38-055 38-060 2-Step 3-Step 4-Step Seat Height 3'10" 4'6" 6' Wheel Kit 38-051 38-052 38-053 PARAGON PORTABLE CHAIR PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" sloping tread, cycolac 37-055 Rubber leg cap, each 38-049 Plastic wheel, each 89 Guard Chairs 38-005 PERMANENT GUARD CHAIRS PARAGON OSHA GUARD CHAIR — Designed for usage that requires chairs to comply with federal OSHA regulations. Guard rails are 42" above the platform and extend to the front of the platform. Fiberglass swivel guard seat. Includes rescue tube and umbrella holder. Complete with pedestal anchor, rear anchors and escutcheons. 38-005 OSHA Guard Chair, 6' PARAGON OSHA CHAIR PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" sloping tread, cycolac 37-035 Paragon CPB escutcheon 37-063 Paragon Guard Chair foot board 38-025 PARAGON LADDER AT SIDES GUARD CHAIR — Two access ladders, one at each side, allow the lifeguard to dismount quickly and safely from either side. Provides additional security of unbroken surveillance during guard changes. Fiberglass swivel guard seat. Includes rescue tube and umbrella holder. Complete with pedestal anchor, ladder anchors and escutcheons. 38-025 Ladder at sides Guard Chair, 6' PARAGON LADDER AT SIDES PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" sloping tread, cycolac 37-035 Paragon CPB escutcheon 37-066 Paragon Guard Chair foot board 43-080 LIFEGUARD UMBRELLAS LIFEGUARD UMBRELLA — Heavy-duty vinyl umbrellas with bound valance. Two-piece aluminum pole with push button tilt allows user to position the umbrella so they can protect themselves from the sun. Size: 6' dia., with 7' H x 1½" dia. pole. Colors: red/white, navy/ white, royal blue/white, or hunter green/white. 43-080 43-090 CHAMPION™ LIFEGUARD UMBRELLAS Available with weather-resistant nylon fabric with vinyl laminate white trim or all vinyl fabric. Highly visible “LIFE GUARD” imprinted for easy identification of your Lifeguard stations. Size: 61/2' dia. with 71/2' H x 13/4" dia. pole with push button tilt. Color: red with white lettering. 43-090 Nylon, 61/2' dia. 43-091 Vinyl, 61/2' dia. 38-010 PARAGON PARAFLYTE GUARD CHAIRS — Ladder at rear with flared guard rails provides easy access to the platform. Horizontal rails provide protection and serve as arm rests. Ultraflyte available in .145" wall thickness stainless steel and Superflyte available in .065" wall thickness stainless steel. Fiberglass swivel guard seat. Includes rescue tube and umbrella holder. Complete with pedestal anchor, rear anchors and escutcheons. 38-010 Ultraflyte Guard Chair, 6' 38-015 Superflyte Guard Chair, 6' PARAGON PARAFLYTE CHAIR PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" sloping tread, cycolac 37-035 Paragon CPB escutcheon 37-067 Paragon Guard Chair foot board 90 38-031 PARAGON PARAFLYTE CLUB GUARD CHAIR — Acclaimed Paraflyte styling and quality. A single anchor at pedestal base supports the entire chair. The vertical access ladder requires less deck space and does not need separate anchors. Includes Pedestal Anchor. Rear anchors and escutcheon plates not required. 38-031 Paraflyte Club Guard Chair, 6' PARAGON PARAFLYTE CLUB CHAIR PARTS 37-065 Paragon 19" sloping tread, cycolac 37-067 Paragon Guard Chair foot board 43-084 WIND WARRIOR UMBRELLA — Protects from damaging UV rays and keeps guards 15° cooler. Vented mesh design lets wind pass through for added stability. Size: 61/2' dia. with 71/2' H x 11/4" dia. pole with push button tilt. Color: silver with blue or silver with green under canopy. Includes carry bag. 43-084 www.lincolnaquatics.com Guard Stands 37-162 38-065 GRIFF'S GUARD STATION — Wide front entry elevated viewing station provides easy access for Life Guards. Griff's Sun Shade that raises, tilts, and rotates for all day sun protection, ordered separately. Available in 7 colors – inquire. Model Model 37-156 3-Step 37-158 2-Step 37-162 1-Step Platform Size 48"W x 55"D x 70"T 38"W x 40"D x 58"T 38"W x 40"D x 38"T Seat Height 54" 42" 30" LOOKOUT CHAIR PARTS 37-085 Paragon 26" vertical tread, cycolac 37-055 Rubber leg cap, each 38-049 Plastic wheel, each Seat Ht. GRIFF'S GUARD STATION PARTS 37-055 Rubber leg cap, each 38-041 Solid rubber wheel, 7", each 38-131 Repl. Sun Shade canopy only GUARD STANDS Item Station Size (W x D x T) Flat 38-065 38-135 623/4" x 591/2" x 651/2" 42" Step 38-070 38-140 60" x 591/2" x 80" 42" Tall 38-075 38-145 97" x 61" x 104" 48" 37-156 PARAGON LOOKOUT CHAIRS — Designed for pools that do not require a full height chair, but want to separate guard from patrons. All Lookout chairs feature an elevated 360° swivel seat, for easy access. 40" x 38" slip resistant top. Wheels included on 2 and 3 step models for portability. Without Sun Shade Shade 37-164 LOOKOUT DUAL SIDE MOUNT CHAIR — Guard stand provides convenient access for lifeguards from both sides of the stand. Wheels on the front legs allow for easy relocation of the chair. Stainless steel construction with 48" x 48" fiberglass slip resistant top. Seat height is 54" from deck. Includes umbrella and rescue tube holder. 37-164 38-195 37-165 37-158 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 LOOKOUT PLATFORM CHAIR — Designed for busy aquatic centers and water parks. Allows for uninterrupted guard changes with sloping ladder on both sides of the stand. Stainless steel construction with 40" x 60" fiberglass slip resistant top. Seat height is 54" from deck. Includes umbrella and rescue tube holder. 37-165 GRIFF’S VISION GUARD STATION — Design minimizes deck space while maximizing the frontal edge of the guard station for increased lifeguard effectiveness. Dual access assures that swimmers are covered during shift changes. Includes: cushioned swivel seat, non-skid decking, umbrella holder and rescue tube/life ring holder. Available with or without adjustable shade structure. Vision Sun Shade that raises, tilts, and rotates, ordered separately. Available in 7 colors – inquire. Model 3-Step 2-Step 1-Step 38-205 Without Shade Station Size Seat Ht. 87"W x 50 /4"D 56" 38-190 87"W x 503/4"D 44" 38-195 813/4"W x 503/4"D 32" 38-200 Vision Sun Shade Structure, complete 3 91 Lifeguard Apparel WOMEN'S TYR ® GUARD SUITS – Suits feature an easy-to-see GUARD logo on front for quick identification. Women's GUARD suits are available in an assorted collection of styles. UPF 50+ Material: TYR ® Reversible one piece with cups: 88% polyester/12% spandex, fully lined, TYR® Solid Diamondfit: 80% nylon/20% extra life lycra. Specify size. 41-020 41-017 TYR® Reversible Suit 41-017 One Piece TYR® Solid Diamondfit Suit 41-015 One Piece 41-020 Two Piece 41-015 TYR® Female Guard Sizing Guide LIFEGUARD SUITS Clothing Size Reversible 1-Pc One Piece Size Two Piece Size Chest Waist Hips 41-005 MENS TYR® HYDROSHORT — Nylon shell with comfortable mesh liner. Side pockets and drawstring waist. GUARD logo on front left leg. 18" outseam. Specify size: S, M, LG, XL, or XXL. Color: red or navy. 41-005 41-025 2 • 28 • 28 24 30 4 • 30 XXS 30 25 32 6 XS 32 XS 32 26 34 8 S 34 S 34 27 36 10 M 36 M 36 29 40 12 L 38 L 38 30 42 14 XL 40 XL 40 32 44 16 • 42 • 42 33 46 41-070 LIFEGUARD SHIRTS TYR® GUARD T-SHIRTS — 60% cotton/40% 41-008 41-010 TYR CHALLENGER GUARD TRUNK — Sanded polyester with comfortable mesh liner. Side pockets. Velcro® closure back pocket and drawstring waist. GUARD logo on front left leg. 91/2" inseam. Specify size: S, M, LG, XL, or XXL. Color: red or navy. 41-010 ® 92 41-011 TYR AERO GUARD TRUNK — Soft sanded polyester material with mesh liner. Side pockets, Velcro® closure back pocket and drawstring waist. GUARD logo on front left leg. 91/2" inseam. Specify size: S, M, LG, XL, or XXL. Color: red or navy. 41-011 ® polyester T-Shirt with GUARD logo on front chest. Sizes: (Men's) S, M, L, XL, XXL; (Women's) XS, S, M, L, XL. 41-070TYR® Guard T-Shirt, Men's 41-060TYR® Guard T-Shirt, Women's TYR® ELEMENT GUARD SHIRT — TYR® long sleeve guard shirt protects from the sun's harmful effects, UPF 50+. With GUARD logo on front chest. Color: white. Specify size: XS, SM, M, LG, XL, or XXL. 41-025 Element Guard Shirt, Men's 41-030 Element Guard Shirt, Women's www.lincolnaquatics.com Lifeguard Apparel 41-351 LIFEGUARD HATS & VISORS TYR® GUARD CAP — Red 100% cotton with 41-145 LINCOLN GUARD SHIRTS — 100% cotton T-Shirt with GUARD screened on front. Specify size: M, L, or XL 41-145 GUARD embroidered on front. One size fits all. Color: red. 41-351 41-225 LIFEGUARD JACKETS GUARD PARKA — For those really cold days, full length, water resistant, red nylon shell Guard Parka. Heavyweight arctic fleece lining with drawstring hood, two-way zipper, reinforced seams and pile lined pockets. GUARD embroidered on back in 4" letters. Color: red with red fleece lining. Specify size: Adult (Men's chest size): XS (30"-32"), S (34"-36"), M (38"-40"), L (42"-44"), XL (46"-48"), XXL (50"), or XXXL (52"). 41-225 41-367 LINCOLN GUARD SHARK VISOR — Red cotton visor with adjustable Velcro closure. GUARD embroidered on front with Lincoln Guard Shark on side of headband. One size fits all. Color: red. 41-367 41-150 LINCOLN INSTRUCTOR T-SHIRT — 100% cotton T-Shirt with INSTRUCTOR screened on front. Color: white. Specify size: M, L, or XL. 41-150 41-200 LIFEGUARD JACKET — Nylon jacket with flannel lining. Drawstring bottom with snap front. LIFEGUARD flocking on back in 3" letters. Available in red or navy. Specify size: S, M, L, or XL. 41-200Red 41-220Navy TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 42-007 CLASSIC LIFEGUARD STRAW HAT — Woven straw hat with adjustable drawstring chin strap. Provides more sun protection due to tighter straw weave and broader rim. One size fits all. 42-007 93 Lifeguard Supplies 42-057 42-100 SUN PROTECTION 42-101 ROCKY MOUNTAIN SUNSCREEN — Protect your staff from the sun with FDA certified “Broad Spectrum” sunscreen. 2-year shelf life. Optional chrome wall bracket for ease of use. 42-100 Sunscreen Sport 30+ SPF, 1 gallon 42-101 Sunscreen Sport 50+ SPF, 1 gallon 42-102 Sunscreen Sport 70+ SPF, 1 gallon 42-105 Chrome wall bracket ROCKY MOUNTAIN LIP BALM — Alpine Ice menthol or Kiwi flavors. 42-170 LIFEGUARD FIRST RESPONDER KIT — Lifeguard Fanny Pack designed for the first responder. Kit includes: fanny pack, CPR mask, foil blanket, Lifeguard whistle, break-away neck lanyard and gloves. 42-057 First Responder Kit FIRST RESPONDER KIT SUPPLIES 42-046 Lifeguard Fanny Pack 48-041 CPR Mask 48-055 Latex gloves, (box of 100) 42-043 Disposable blanket 43-052 Lifeguard whistle 43-070 Break-a-way neck lanyard 42-009 SILHOUETTE DOLLS — Weighted full body silhouette dolls for underwater identification training. 1 adult and 1 child included. Dark brown on one side and light tan on the other. 42-009 64-033 42-010 RESCUE CAN RESCUE CAN — Hard plastic, high-visibility 64-035 LIFEGUARD TRAINING DIVING BRICK — For lifeguard training 42-046 LIFEGUARD FANNY PACKS LIFEGUARD FANNY PACK — Made to with- stand the rigorous use of lifeguards. Durable, tear-resistant nylon construction. Features heavy duty adjustable 45” waist strap and three water-resistant zipper pockets. Size: 7.25" x 4.5" x 3". Color: red. 42-046 42-044 LIFEGUARD FANNY PACK WITH STRAPS Same as the Lifeguard Fanny Pack with the addition of top straps which allows you to secure a water bottle to the top of the Lifeguard Fanny Pack. 42-044 NOTE: See pages 105 - 108 for spine boards and CPR training supplies. 94 or fun in the pool. Available in 2 styles - original black diving brick or new non-marking EasyGrip style in blue. 64-035 Diving Brick 64-033 Easy-Grip Diving Brick orange rescue can. Lightweight and durable, weighs only 3 lbs. 28" long. Includes: 2" Velcro shoulder strap and tow line. Stainless steel storage rack ordered separately. 42-010 Rescue Can 42-015 Rescue Can storage rack 42-048 LINCOLN KEY CHAIN LINCOLN RESCUE TUBE KEY CHAIN — Floating, rescue tube style keychain helps keep keys handy. 42-048 33-350 42-110 LIFEGUARD TRAINING MANIKIN — Lifeguard Training Manikin is an indispensable tool for those involved in the training and/ or testing of lifeguards. It is designed to approximate towing an average size person in the water. Weight dry: 18 lbs., and weight filled with water: approximately 180 lbs. 37" high. 42-110 PERSONAL LIGHTNING DETECTOR STRIKE ALERT LIGHTNING DETECTOR — Hand-held detector provides early warning of approaching lightning strikes from up to 40 miles away. Audible alarm with LED light has 4 distance warnings which activate when lightning is in range. 33-350 www.lincolnaquatics.com Lifeguard Supplies RESCUE TUBES 42-030 LINCOLN RESCUE TUBES — Vinyl-dipped Ensolite foam rescue tubes. 1" tow line extends completely through the tube with 2" adjustable shoulder strap for added comfort. Rounded edges on tube help prevent peeling of vinyl coating. Lincoln Rescue Tube includes Delrin buckle on end. Color: orange. Item 42-020 42-035 42-025 42-032 42-030 42-020 Description Dimensions Super Rescue Tube 50"x5.5"x3" Rescue Tube 39"x5.75"x3.5" MARINE RESCUE TUBES — Ensolite foam covered with heavy-duty vinyl. Poly tow line with 2" adjustable shoulder harness. Marine Rescue Tube includes a brass buckle and "D" ring. Color: red. Item 42-035 42-025 Description Super Rescue Tube Rescue Tube Dimensions 50"x6"x4" 40"x5"x31⁄4" GATOR RESCUE TUBES — Gator Rescue Tubes incorporate a mesh material that completely encases the foam before they are vinyl-dipped, creating a rugged, textured surface that will add to the life expectancy of your tubes. Gator Tubes feature 2" adjustable tow strap with Velcro closure. Gator Tubes feature a 2” adjustable tow strap with Velcro closure and a reach assist loop. Color: red. Item Description 42-032 Super Rescue Tube Rescue Tube 42-022 Dimensions 50"x51/2"x31/2" 40"x51/2"x31/2" 42-022 42-140 42-039 VINYL REPAIR KIT — Quick easy way to repair cracked rescue tubes and vinyl inflatables. Kit includes: one each of 3" x 12", 7 /8" x 7/8", and 13/8" x 13/8" clear self-adhesive patches. Trim to size as needed. 42-039 GATOR RESCUE TUBE SURFACE 42-040 RESCUE TUBE ACCESSORIES RESCUE TUBE COVER — Nylon covered neoprene sleeve to help protect your Rescue Tube or Super Rescue Tube. Will help your tubes last longer. 42-040 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 42-041 RESCUE WRAP™ — Nylon covered neoprene strap holder for rescue tube tow strap. Slip over any rescue tube to hold excess strap in place when not in use. Size: 8" x 4". 42-041 AQUATIC ALARM AQUATIC INCIDENT ALERT SYSTEM — The AIA System is an extended range incident alarm system. Used by Lifeguard staff to alert multiple areas of a facility of a situation that requires assistance. Includes: base unit, transmitter unit with antenna, receiver unit with antenna, and alarm siren. Remote SOS Sensors are placed on rescue tubes to detect submersion and will initiate alarm, ordered separately. Can accommodate multiple SOS inputs. Base unit can receive signal from sensors up to 150 ft. away. All components plug into AC outlets. Specify sensor colors: green or blue. Contact us for design assistance for multiple pool facilities. 42-138 Aquatic Incident Alert System 42-140 SOS Sensor 95 Lifeguard Supplies 42-075 42-080 ALUMINUM RESCUE POLES ALUMINUM RESCUE POLES — Heavy duty 42-047 RING BUOYS R I N G BUOYS — U.S. Coast Guard approved. Sof-Tex surface resists weather and temperature extremes. Color: white. 44-070 20" diameter 44-075 24" diameter 44-080 30" diameter RESCUE THROW BAG — 50' or 90' of 3⁄8" polypropylene rope stored in a nylon bag. Line and bag are thrown to victim. Bag is high visibility yellow with black “Rescue Bag” markings. 42-047 50' 42-049 90' extruded aluminum rescue pole with end caps. 42-070 16' with caps 42-075 12' with caps FIBERGLASS RESCUE POLES FIBERGLASS RESCUE POLES — Rigid fiberglass construction with UV protective coating to prevent splintering with age. Straight fiberglass with pole caps on ends. 42-079 16' with caps 42-080 12' with caps NOTE: Due to size restrictions from UPS, poles over 8' must be shipped via common carrier. Please call for freight estimate. 44-085 RING BUOY ACCESSORIES RING BUOY SAFETY STATION — Plastic protective cabinet with non-breakable polycarbonate window for convenient ring buoy mounting. Station encloses 20", 24", or 30" ring buoy, plus a 60' heaving line kit. Includes: cabinet and 60' heaving line kit. Ring buoy ordered separately. 44-084 20" 44-085 24" 44-08630" 42-050 RESCUE THROW ROPE — With either 30', 60', or 75' of 3⁄8" rope with “Foot Float” attached to hold rope. 42-055 30' 42-050 60' 42-051 75' 42-060 LIFE HOOKS LIFE HOOK — Sturdy anodized aluminum with 44-100 RING BUOY MOUNTING HOOK — Stainless steel hook with stainless steel screws. 44-100 double crook design. Available as Life Hook or Life Hook with 16' pole and attachments. 42-060 Life Hook 42-065 Life Hook with Pole 42-085 RESCUE BOARDS RESCUE BOARDS — Our HEAVING LINE KIT — Includes 1⁄4" heaving line, with foot float and aluminum mounting hook. 44-090 30' kit 44-095 60' kit 44-094 90' kit 96 Rescue Boards offer a perfect blend of light weight and durability. Soft Top Rescue Board - 10'L x 24"W x 3.25"D. Features honeycomb foam and wood core with EVA deck, gel coat bottom, 6 handles, safety flex skeg and 2 leash plugs. 19 lbs. Color: yellow. Rescue Board - 10'L x 22.5"W x 3.5"D. Features durable polyfoam deck with iFoam core, and sturdy plastic bottom. 20 lbs. Color: yellow. 42-085 Soft Top Rescue Board, 10' 42-088 Rescue Board, 9' www.lincolnaquatics.com Lifeguard Supplies 43-055 BATTERY POWERED MEGAPHONES WHISTLES BATTERY POWERED MEGAPHONES — Battery operated, solid state megaphone. All weather construction with push/pull amplifier. Available in 20 watt with 2,400' sound range, 16 watt with 1,800' sound range and 10 watt with 900' sound range. 43-019 20 watt megaphone 43-020 16 watt megaphone 43-025 10 watt megaphone ACME THUNDER WHISTLES — Heavy duty nickel-plated whistle. 43-055 PROTECTIVE TIP GUARD — Protective rubber mouth guard for the Acme Thunder whistle. Color: red or blue. 43-060 43-030 43-035 43-040 HAND HELD MEGAPHONES HAND HELD MEGAPHONES — White, high-density plastic megaphone with chrome mouth guard. Easy to handle and projects voice effectively. 25" and 19" sizes have chrome handle. 7" Hand Held Megaphone without handle. 43-030 25" 43-035 19" 43-040 7" 43-028 43-002 SPLASH-PROOF MEGAPHONE — Compact and lightweight. Features long lasting battery life, wide frequency range for enhanced audio quality and anti-bacterial treated mouthpiece. 10 watt megaphone. Audio range: 250 M. Whistle range: 315 M. Five Year Warranty. 43-002 MEGAPHONE MOUTHPIECE — Personal mouthpiece for hand held megaphone. Colors: green, red, royal blue, white, or yellow. 43-028 SAFETY HORN PORTABLE AIR HORN — Loud and clear sound signals guards and patrons. Plastic horn assists in directing sound. 62-060 Air Horn 62-065 Extra power can TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 43-045 43-075 43-052 PEALESS WHISTLES — Chambers are designed to self-clear when submerged in water. Easily heard over long distances. Available in two styles: original Fox 40 or new Lifeguard models. Colors: Fox 40 - red or blue. Lifeguard - red or black. 43-045 Fox 40 Whistle 43-052 Lifeguard Whistle LANYARDS & WRIST BANDS FLEX COIL WRIST BANDS — Bright flexible plastic coil wrist bands. Assorted colors. 43-075 43-065 43-070 43-072 2-WAY RADIO & ACCESSORIES WATERPROOF 2-WAY RADIO — Compact LANYARDS — Braided nylon lanyards. Colors: red, blue, white, black, green or yellow. 43-065 WATERPROOF FLOAT PACK — Waterproof plastic case that you can hear and speak through. Radio pack will also float if immersed in water when sealed. 43-043 Waterproof Float Pack, each LIFEGUARD LANYARD — "Lifeguard" lanyard provides additional identification for your guards. 43-072 43-042 62-060 43-060 43-043 design that can be in up to 1 meter of water for up to 30 minutes (headset cover must be closed). 4-Watt, 16 channels. 43-042 Waterproof Radio, each BREAK-AWAY NECK LANYARD — Corded neck lanyard with re-connecting closure. Break-Away feature increases guard safety during rescues. Assorted colors. 43-070 97 Life Vests & Life Jackets 44-040 ENSOLITE SAFETY VESTS — Type III Swim Vests. High quality durable Ensolite material with high gloss vinyl coating. Measure around chest and under arms for sizing. 44-035 Adult 44-016 Child 44-018 44-020 44-025 44-030 44-035 44-040 44-045 Adult Child • XXL (46"-48") • XL (43"-46") • Lg. (40"-43") Med. (37"-40") 44-050 Med. (26"-29") Sm. (34"-37") 44-055 Sm. (23"-24") XS (31"-34") 44-060 XS (21"-23") Youth 44-017 Infant Heads-up 44-003 SAFETY VESTS NYLON SAFETY VESTS — Type III Safety Vests with durable flotation foam. Bright nylon outer shell and three adjustable belts. Child's Safety Vest has adjustable leg strap. Headsup feature has rounded flotation collar with grab strap. Size Adult (oversize) Adult (over 90 lbs.) Youth (50-90 lbs.) Child (30-50 lbs.) Infant Heads-up (<30 lbs.) 98 Swim Vests 44-001 44-016 44-017 44-018 44-003 44-005 44-010 LIFE JACKETS LIFE JACKETS — Type II Life jackets, du- rable flotation foam and bright orange nylon outer shell. Adjustable belt for secure fit. Size Adult (over 90 lbs.) Youth (50-90 lbs.) Child (30-50 lbs.) 51-350 44-015 Life Jackets 44-005 44-010 44-015 VEST STORAGE VEST STORAGE CART — Helps keep your vests organized and allows them to dry properly. Durable PVC cart with high density plastic base and non-marking swivel casters. Six crossbars for hanging allows you to store up to 60-70 vests. Hangers not included. Size: 64" L x 30" W x 75.5" H. 51-350 www.lincolnaquatics.com Rope, Floats & Anchors 44-145 44-165 44-190 ROPE TWISTED ROPE — Polyethylene rope. Colors: blue/white, yellow or white. Color Blue/White Yellow White 1/4" 3/8" 1/2" BRAIDED ROPE — Polyethylene rope. Colors: blue/white, yellow or white. Color Blue/White Yellow White 1/4" 44-101 44-102 44-103 3/8" 44-119 44-121 44-109 1/2" WALL ANCHORS 44-140 POLYETHYLENE FLOATS — Colors: Solid red, blue, yellow, white, or combination of red and white or blue and white, specify. • 44-097 44-098 44-140 44-145 44-123 44-150 44-155 Item 44-120 ROPE HOOKS & CLAMPS CPB ROPE HOOKS — CPB two-piece sure grip rope hook. 44-123 3/8" 44-124 1/2" 44-125 3/4" 44-160 44-165 44-170 44-175 44-128 NYLON ROPE CLAMPS — For clamping rope ends together to make a loop. 44-126 3⁄8" 44-127 1⁄2" 44-128 3⁄4" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 3" x 5" 5" x 9" Float Keepers 3" x 5" 5" x 9" Lok-on Float 3" x 5" 5" x 9" 8" x 14" Rope-Lok 44-185 44-190 Handi-Lock Floats 3" x 5" 5" x 9" PARAGON HEAVY WALL ANCHOR — Machined brass insert with 5/8" CPB heavy eyebolt. 40-120 40-121 5⁄8" diameter heavy eyebolt Fits Rope 3 3 ⁄8" ⁄4" Fits Rope 3 3 ⁄8" ⁄4" Fits Rope 40-125 40-126 SAFETY LINE INSERT ANCHOR — For installation into existing pools. Complete with lead expansion anchor. 40-125 40-126 Replacement safety line eyebolt ⁄8" ⁄4" 1" Fits All Sizes 3 3 HANDI-LOCK FLOATS — Self-locking floats secure onto rope with a patented twist-lock design. Eliminates floats from moving on your rope. Colors: Alternating blue and white or red and white, specify. Item BRASS SWIVEL ROPE HOOK — Heavy duty, brass rope hook for 1/4" or 3⁄8" rope. 44-120 Polyethylene Float LOK-ON ROPE FLOATS — Tough plastic outer shell with solid core. Provides maximum durability. Use 1 Rope-lok per float to secure float in place. Colors: blue and white, yellow and white or red and white, specify. Item 44-124 44-160 44-185 FLOATS Item 44-125 40-120 40-121 3/4" 44-105 44-110 44-113 44-115 44-104 44-111 44-114 44-116 44-106 44-112 44-117 44-118 Fits Rope ⁄8" 3 ⁄4" 3 40-135 40-136 CUP ANCHORS PARAGON COMMERCIAL CUP ANCHORS Cast stainless steel cup anchor available with integral crossbar which eliminates loss of eyebolts or with removable triangular eyebolt. Size: 5" deep x 4" square face plate. 40-135 Cup anchor, crossbar style 40-136 Cup anchor, triangular eyebolt style 40-137 Replacement triangular eyebolt 44-130 40-140 SWIM AREA BUOYS SWIM AREA BUOYS — Identify swim areas EYEBOLTS on lakes and rivers with buoys and floats. Swim area buoys are visible 41" above water line. Other daymarks available. Size: 59" high x 12" can dia. x 13" base dia. Color: white. 44-130 Swim Area Buoy 40-145 40-150 40-121 40-137 REPLACEMENT EYEBOLTS 40-140 1⁄2" diameter eyebolt 40-145 5⁄8" diameter eyebolt 40-150 3⁄4" diameter eyebolt 40-121 5⁄8" diameter heavy eyebolt 40-137 Replacement triangular eyebolt 99 Safety Signs CPR You Can! Yes Perform Basic Life Suport for Adults and Children (Ages 1-8) CALL 911 If you are alone with a child victim, give two minutes of CPR before calling 911. Check the victim for unresponsiveness. If there is no response, have someone CALL 911 and return to the victim. In most locations, the emergency dispatcher can assist you with CPR instructions. For unresponsive children, the lone rescuer should perform 5 cycles (about 2 minutes of CPR before phoning 911). PUMP ADULT POSITION HEEL OF ONE HAND IN THE CENTER OF THE CHEST WITH SECOND HAND ON TOP CHILD POSITION HEEL OF ONE HAND IN THE CENTER OF THE CHEST WITH/WITHOUT SECOND HAND ON TOP ADULT FIRMLY PUSH DOWN AT LEAST 2 INCHES ON THE CHEST 30 TIMES CONTINUE WHEN IN A POOL OR SHALLOW WATER 1. From behind, wrap the arms around your victim's waist, placing the thumb side of the fist against the victim's abdomen. CHILD FIRMLY PUSH DOWN AT LEAST 1/3 TO 1/2 DEPTH OF CHEST 30 TIMES If the victim is not breathing normally, begin chest compressions. Push down on the chest at least 2 inches for adults and 1/3 to 1/2 depth of chest for children ages 1-8. Pump 30 times right between the nipples. Push hard and push fast by compressing the chest at a rate of at least 100/minute. Allow chest to recoil (return to normal position) completely after each compression. 45-330 First aid for Choking Children 1 - 8 years old 2. With the other hand, grab the fist and press into the abdomen with a quick upward thrust. WHEN THE VICTIM IS LYING ON THE GROUND 1. Place the victim on her back. Turn her face to one side to drain water from her mouth. 2. Begin CPR. Compression-to-ventilation ratio of 30:2 is recommended. GIVE TWO EFFECTIVE BREATHS IF UNABLE OR UNWILLING TO GIVE BREATHS CONTNUE TO GIVE COMPRESSION. CONTINUE WITH TWO BREATHS AND 30 PUMPS UNTIL HELP ARRIVES. NOTE: This ratio is the same for one-person and two-person CPR. In two-person CPR, the person pumping the chest stops while the other gives mouth-to-mouth breathing. If the adult or child is or becomes unresponsive, perform CPR. If you see an object in the throat or mouth, remove it. Basic Life Support for Infants (Less than 1 Year old) Shout and Tap Give 30 Compressions If no regular breathing, give 30 effective chest compressions at the rate of at least 100 per minute. Position your 3rd and 4th fingers in center of chest, just below nipple line. Press down about at least 1/3 to 1/2 the depth of the chest. Push hard and fast and allow chest to recoil completely. Shout and gently tap the infant on the shoulder. If there is no response, position the infant on his or her back. Open the Airway Open the airway by tilting head and lifting the chin. Do not tilt the head too far back. 911 or call... PARAMEDICS __________________________ 45-250 DO NOT SWIM ALONE DOCTOR ______________________________ FIRE DEPT. ____________________________ POLICE _______________________________ Training Courses CPR training courses are offered by the American Heart Association (for training courses near, you call 1-800-AHAUSA1), the American Red Cross, and by many local Fire Departments. Give 2 Breaths Repeat If the infant is NOT breathing regularly, give 2 small gentle breaths. Cover the infant's mouth and nose with your mouth. Each breath should be 1 second long. You should see the infant's chest rise with each breath. Definitions UNRESPONSIVENESS: During cardiac arrest, the heart stops pumping blood, the blood pressure falls to zero and the pulse disappears. Within 10 seconds of cardiac arrest the person loses consciousness and becomes unresponsive. Sometimes a person in cardiac arrest may make grunting, gasping or snoring type breathing sounds for a couple of minutes. DO NOT be confused by this abnormal type of breathing. Repeat with cycles of 2 breaths and 30 compressions. After two minutes of care, call 911 and continue giving breaths and compressions. A person in cardiac arrest may have abnormal breathing for a couple minutes. This is called "agonal respiration" and is the result of the brain's breathing center sending out signals even though circulation has ceased. The key point is that the abnormal breathing may sound like grunting, gasping or snoring. It disappears in 2 to 3 minutes. If you see this type of breathing, DO NOT delay CPR. The person desperately needs air and only you can provide it. COMPLICATIONS OF CPR: Vomiting is the most frequently encountered complication of CPR. If the victim starts to vomit, turn the head to the side and try to sweep out or wipe off the vomit. Continue with CPR. PUSHING ON THE CHEST: In general, the chest should be pushed down at least 1 1/2 to 2 inches. CHECKING THE PULSE: Sometimes you may hear a cracking sound. Do not be alarmed. The The pulse check is no longer taught or expected of laypersons. Instead, if you sound is caused by cartilage or ribs cracking. Even if this occurs, the see no signs of life (defined as breathing normally, coughing or moving), you damage is not serious. The risk of delaying CPR or not doing CPR is should begin to pump on the chest. Please note that the pulse check is still far greater than a broken rib. expected of health care providers. 45-025 RESCUE BREATHING AND CHOKING SIGN Features current American Red Cross CPR Guidelines. Size: 24" x 30". 45-025 English 45-026 Spanish 5330WS1824E 45-005 ABNORMAL BREATHING: Copyright © 2010 PUBLIC POOL RULES SIGN x 24". 45-005 — Size: 18" 45-255 45-375 45-240 45-410 FACILITY SAFETY SIGNS POOL SAFETY SIGNS (PSS) — Graphical symbol signs draw attention to core safety messages. Larger sizes available based on viewing distances. Indoor with non-glare texture material and Outdoor with weather durable material. Available in English and English/Spanish styles. See web site for additional sizes. Sign Indoor 45-010 45-017 WARNING: NO LIFEGUARD ON DUTY SIGN Size: 18" x 24". 45-017 Outdoor SPA RULES SIGN — Size: 18" x 24". 45-010 45-110 45-020 NO SWIMMING ALLOWED AFTER DARK SIGN — Size: 24" x 18". 45-020 PLEASE SHOWER BEFORE ENTERING POOL SIGN — Size: 12" x 18". 45-110 English Eng/Sp English Eng/Sp Safety Diamond Signs (15.5" x 15.5") Watch Your 45-200 45-285 45-240 45-325 Children No Diving 45-205 45-290 45-245 45-330 Wear Life 45-210 45-295 45-250 45-335 Jackets No Long Breath 45-215 45-300 45-255 45-340 Holding Entrance Pool Signs 4 Symbol (19.5" x 10") 45-365 45-385 45-375 45-395 3 Symbol (16" x 10") 45-370 45-390 45-380 45-400 45-095 No Lifeguard on Duty Signs (13" x 9.5") No Lifeguard 45-405 45-415 45-410 45-420 English/Spanish versions slightly larger in size. 45-032 45-021 WADING POOL NOT ATTENDED SIGN Size: 12" x 10". 45-021 100 — UNIVERSAL SAFETY SIGN — Pool/spa caution, no diving, pool/spa capacity, artificial respiration, 911, no lifeguard and pool/spa rules. California Compliant sign adds Emergency shut off, Diarrhea, and Keep Closed sign. 45-032 California Universal Sign, 41" x 48" 45-042 Universal Sign, 40" x 48" 45-100 45-111 POOL CAPACITY SIGN — Size: 12" x 18". 45-095 SPA CAPACITY SIGN — Size: 12" x 18". 45-100 TAKE A CLEANSING SHOWER SIGN — Size: 12" x 10". 45-111 www.lincolnaquatics.com Safety Signs 45-037 SWIM DIAPERS REQUIRED SIGN 12"x 10". 45-037 — Size: 45-038 HANDICAP LIFT AVAILABLE SIGN 12"x 10". 45-038 — Size: 45-035 WARNING SIGN FOR DIVERS — Size: 12"x 18". 45-035 45-121 DIARRHEA SAFETY SIGN 45-121 — Size: 18"x 12". LIFT IS NOT A TOY 45-034 NO DIVING ALLOWED SIGN — Size: 18"x 24". 45-023 SHALLOW WATER NO DIVING SIGN — Size: 18"x 24". 45-034 NO HYPERVENTILATION OR EXTENDED UNDERWATER SWIMMING IS ALLOWED. 5512WS1218E Copyright© 2011 Aquatic Technology Inc.® NO BREATH HOLDING SIGN 18". 45-022 — poolweb.com 7021WS1012E Copyright© 2000 Aquatic Technology Inc. SM poolsigns.com Aquatic Technology Inc.® poolweb.com 45-028 — Size: 10"x 12". 45-043 POOL/CLUB NEWS MESSAGE BOARD — Write your message and change as needed with dry erase markers, ordered separately. Size: 18" x 24" 45-043 Pool News Message Board 45-044 Club News Message Board 45-048 Marker kit, set of 3 with eraser 45-109 SPECTRUM AQUATIC LIFT AVAILABLE SIGN — Size: 8.5"x 11". 45-109 45-022 Size: 12"x 45-039 45-040 NO RUNNING SIGN 45-040 Copyright© 2012 LIFT IS NOT A TOY SIGN 45-028 7070WS1824E Size: FOR PATRONS NEEDING ASSISTED ACCESS ONLY! MESSAGE BOARD WARNING NO BREATH HOLDING — NOTICE KEEP OFF LIFT SIGN 12"x 10". 45-027 KEEP OFF POOL LIFT! POOL NEWS 45-023 45-027 — Size: 18"x 12". TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 FIRST AID STATION SIGN 45-039 45-041 — Size: 12"x 10". 45-033 — S.R. SMITH POOL/SPA LIFT AVAILABLE SIGN — Size: 9"x 12". 45-033 NO CELL PHONES ALLOWED SIGN Size: 12"x 18". 45-041 101 Safety Signs 45-105 — SWIMMING POOL CLOSED SIGN 12"x 18". 45-105 45-060 45-089 Size: EMERGENCY SIGNS EMERGENCY PHONE NUMBER W/FACILITY LOCATION SIGN — Size: 10"x 14". 45-089 45-070 45-103 KEEP CLOSED SIGN 45-103 — Size: 12"x 6". 45-047 NOTICE POOL CLOSE D F O R SEASO N TRESPASSE R S WI L L BE PROSEC U T E D 7909WS1812E Copyright© 2010 Aquatic Technology Inc.® poolweb.com EMERGENCY 911 SIGN 45-047 — Size: 12"x 6". 45-080 OSHA SIGNS — Size: 14" x 10". 45-060 Danger Acid 45-065 Danger Caustic 45-070 Danger Chlorine 45-075 Danger Chlorine Gas 45-080 Danger Chemical Storage 45-104 NOTICE POOL CLOSED FOR THE SEASON SIGN — Size: 12"x 18". 45-104 45-057 45-046 EMERGENCY SHUT-OFF SWITCH SIGN — Size: 12"x 9". 45-046 45-106 45-052 45-107 POOL/SPA CLOSED CHEMICALS IN USE SIGN — Size: 12" x 18". 45-106 Pool Closed Chemicals in Use 45-107 Spa Closed Chemicals in Use CHEMICAL SAFETY SIGNS NFPA SIGN — Based on the National Fire 45-058 EYE AND GLOVE PROTECTION SIGN Size: 12"x 10". 45-058 45-125 45-130 45-049 — Protection Association's code, provides identification of hazardous chemical storage areas. Panels are supplied blank, 4" vinyl letters/numbers complete your sign for your specific requirements. 45-049 NFPA sign, fiberglass, 11" 45-051 NFPA label, 10" 45-135 EMERGENCY RESPONSE SIGNS EMERGENCY EYEWASH SIGN 45-125 Emergency eyewash sign 45-130 Emergency drench hose sign EMERGENCY SPILL RESPONSE SIGN Size: 10" x 7". 45-135 102 — 45-055 CAUTION: CARBON DIOXIDE GAS — Size: 14" x 10". 45-055 NFPA VINYL LETTERS/NUMBERS 45-052 OXY 45-054 COR 45-053 ACID 45-056 ALK 45-057 (Numbers 0-4) www.lincolnaquatics.com Safety Signs 46-370 56-070 SWIM & SAFETY MARKERS SWIM & SAFETY MARKERS — Highly visible yellow plastic free-standing signs to mark the designated speed of your lap swimming lane. Safety identification markers also available. They’re lightweight, portable and fold-up for convenient storage. SAFETY MARKERS Item 56-086 56-087 56-069 56-067 56-094 56-088 56-101 56-102 56-089 56-063 56-103 56-104 56-105 56-071 Description Board Closed Slide Closed Pool Closed Spa Closed No Diving No Running Aquatic Fitness Class Swim Lessons Only Caution Wet Floor No Shoes on Deck Bulkhead Closed - Stay Off Aquatic Lift Available Ask for Assistance Caution Keep Off Blank sign only DECK SAFETY & WATER DEPTH SIGNS SAFE-T-SIGN™ DECK SIGNS — Slip resistant deck signs to communicate safety messages and water depths at your facility. UV stable specially designed graphic decals for long term indoor/outdoor use. Can be used in wet areas. Adheres to concrete and tile surfaces all while appearing like a painted surface. Installation is easy, start with a dry surface, sweep, peel and stick. Inquire for custom signs to fit your facilities specific needs. WATER DEPTH DECK SIGNS Item 46-500 46-505 46-510 46-515 46-520 46-525 Description Size (0-14) FT (0-9) 1/2 FT (0-12) IN (0-14) FT IN 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 46-510 46-500 SAFETY DECK SIGNS Item 46-350 46-355 46-360 46-361 46-365 46-370 46-375 46-380 46-385 46-390 46-395 46-530 46-535 46-540 46-545 46-550 46-555 Description Handicap Lift Available Please Inquire Keep Off! Aquatic Lift for Assisted Access Only! Warning Shallow Water No Diving Starting Platforms Are For Team Use Only Warning: No Breath Holding No Extended Underwater Breathing is Allowed Safety First — First Aid Station Caution Keep Off! Swim Diapers are Required for Children Who Are Not Toilet Trained Please Shower Before Entering Pool No Shoes on Deck Caution Slippery When Wet No Running International No Running No Diving International No Diving Shallow Water Deep Water Size 12" x 9" 12" x 9" 12" x 9" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 9" 12" x 18" 12" x 9" 12" x 9" 12" dia. 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" 6" x 6" CHEMICAL SAFETY DECK SIGNS Item 46-425 46-430 46-435 46-440 46-445 56-086 46-450 56-091 56-069 LAP SWIM MARKERS Item 56-085 56-092 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 56-070 56-075 56-080 56-085 56-090 56-091 56-092 56-093 56-101 46-455 46-460 46-465 Description Danger Chemical Storage Area Danger Chlorine Danger Acid Danger Carbon Dioxide Gas Danger Caustic Eye and Glove Protection Must be Worn When Handling Chemicals Emergency Spill Response Equipment Emergency Eyewash Station Emergency Drench Hose Size 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" x 18" 12" dia. 12" dia. Description Slow Medium Fast Lane Closed Adult Swim Only Lap Swim Only Circle Swim Only Warm-Up Lane Only 46-350 103 Signs & Depth Markers 46-155 46-160 46-165 CERAMIC DEPTH/SAFETY TILES DEPTH AND SAFETY TILES — White ce- ramic tile with black lettering. Smooth surface tiles are for vertical pool wall. Slip resistant tiles are for deck mounting. Priced per tile. Style Intl. No Diving Intl. No Running (0-14) FT (0- 9) 1/2 FT (0-12) IN (0-14) FT IN 46-085 Smooth 6" x 6" 46-155 46-156 46-160 46-161 46-165 46-166 46-167 46-168 Slip Resistant 6" x 6" 8" x 8" 46-181 46-186 46-182 46-184 46-183 46-187 46-188 46-189 46-090 46-215 VINYL DEPTH/SAFETY MARKERS VINYL DEPTH/SAFETY MARKERS — 6" x 6" vinyl stick-on depth and safety message markers have white background and black/red images. Markers are skid resistant for safe deck applications. Installation kit includes: roller, aerosol adhesive and tube of edge sealer. Order one installation kit for approximately 40 Depth/Safety Markers. Style (0-14) FT (0- 9) 1/2 FT (0-12) IN (0-14) FT IN No Running International No Running No Diving International No Diving Shallow Water Deep Water Installation Kit Slip Resistant 46-085 46-086 46-090 46-095 46-100 46-105 46-115 46-120 46-125 46-130 46-140 46-145 46-150 46-170 46-171 46-175 46-176 46-180 46-190 46-191 46-192 46-275 PLASTIC STICK-ON MARKERS PLASTIC STICK-ON POOL MARKERS — Designed for above water use. 41/4" x 53/4" plastic stick-on depth and safety message markers have white background and black/red images. Adheres to stainless steel, fiberglass or tile (must be at least 6" x 6" tiles). Thin profile is ideal for renovations. Easy installation with self adhesive back. Style (0-9) FT (0-9) IN (0-12) FT IN No Diving International No Diving Plastic Stick-On Tile 46-275 46-280 46-285 46-290 46-295 46-300 46-305 GLASS OVERLAY MARKERS GLASS OVERLAY POOL MARKERS — Perfect solution to worn off pool depth markers. Will install over your existing depth tiles. Rugged tempered glass overlay with beveled edges. Smooth surface 6" x 6" tile with a thin profile for your in-pool depth markings. Installation kit will install 10-15 overlays. Color: white background with black letters/numbers on clear tile. Style Intl. No Diving (0-14) FT (0- 9) 1/2 FT (0-12) IN (0-14) FT IN Installation Kit Glass Tile 46-205 46-210 46-215 46-220 46-225 46-230 46-235 46-240 2678 1⁄2 46-185 PLASTIC DEPTH MARKERS PLASTIC DEPTH MARKERS — A temporary 46-145 104 46-120 46-140 46-300 46-305 way to identify your pool depths. 4" black plastic with smooth finish attaches with adhesive. Mounts onto existing pool deck or tile. Specify 0-9 or 1⁄2. Adhesive not included. 46-185 Each number www.lincolnaquatics.com Rescue Equipment 47-002 SPINE BOARDS LINCOLN SPINE BOARD — Foam filled polyethylene construction with concave shape to minimize lateral movement. X-ray and MRI translucent. Lincoln Spine Board package includes: Lincoln Spine Board, Lincoln Head Immobilizer and Velcro body straps. Size: 72"L x 16"W x 2.25"H. 1,000 lb. weight capacity. 47-002 Lincoln Spine Board package 47-001 Lincoln Spine Board only 47-029 Spine Board mounting bracket 47-061 SPEEDBLOCKS ® HEAD IMMOBILIZER Reusable head immobilizer accommodates all head shapes. Handle lock and quick release lock ensures a proper fit for patients 2 years and up. Includes: 1 block set, universal base, 1 strap and pad replacement set. 47-061 Speedblocks® Head Immobilizer 47-062 Speedblocks® Repl. strap & pad set 47-028 47-040 47-020 CJ RESCUE 6 SPINE BOARD — High Density polyethylene spine board design allows for more water to flow through, making the board easier to stabilize in the water. Buoyancy is customizable with polyethylene foam rods, included. X-ray translucent. CJ Rescue 6 Spine Board package includes: CJ Rescue 6 Spine Board, "L" bracket head immobilizer with foam pads and Velcro strap, plus 4 Velcro body straps. Size" 78" L x 20" W. 500 lb. weight capacity. 47-020 CJ Rescue 6 Spine Board package 47-024 CJ Rescue 6 Head Bed 47-025 CJ Rescue 6 Velcro for Head Bed 47-016 CJ Spine Board Cover 47-026 CJ Rescue 6 Flotation Rods, set of 2 47-071 CJ 1000 Body Straps, set of 4 47-065 CJ Head Immobilizer, replacement 47-045 SPINE BOARD STRAPS VELCRO STRAPS — 2" x 29" long Velcro straps can be rolled up and fastened to board. Includes metal attaching loops. Each. 47-040 NYLON STRAPS — 2" x 61" orange nylon with quick release metal buckle. Each. 47-045 DISPOSABLE STRAPS — 2" x 84" disposable poly webbing with Fastex buckles. Colors: white, blue, orange, black, or olive. Specify. 47-028 Set of 6 straps and 3 buckles 47-015 CJ 1000 SPINE BOARD — Wood spine board with teflon runners insure smooth sliding transfers in and out of the pool. CJ 1000 Spine Board package includes: CJ 1000 Spine Board, “L” Bracket Head Immobilizer with foam pads and Velcro strap, and 4 Velcro body straps. Size: 78" L x 20" W. Optional cover protects top of board from the elements. Elastic bands hold cover on spine board for easy removal. 500 lb. weight capacity. 47-015 CJ 1000 Spine Board package 47-018 CJ 1000 Board Bumpers, set of 2 47-016 CJ Spine Board cover 47-071 CJ 1000 Body Straps, set of 4 47-017 CJ 1000 Board Runners, set of 2 47-071 CJ VELCRO STRAPS — 2" Velcro straps for CJ 1000 and CJ Rescue 6 spine boards. Set of 4 Body Straps: 30" (2), 28", 25". Set of 4 Body Strap Extenders add an additional 24" length. 47-071 CJ Body Straps, set of 4 47-072 CJ Strap Extenders, set of 4 47-065 47-055 HEAD IMMOBILIZERS LINCOLN HEAD IMMOBILIZER — Two Plastisol coated foam head supports with universal attachment base and two durable head straps. Fits all spine boards. Complete with head and chin straps with Velcro closures. 47-055 Lincoln Head Immobilizer TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 CJ “L” BRACKET HEAD IMMOBILIZER — Two piece “L” Bracket Head Immobilizer with foam padding. Available as a replacement for your CJ 1000 or CJ Rescue 6 Spine Board. Includes: “L” Bracket and Velcro strap. Adapt allows you to use on other manufacturers spine boards. Includes: “L” Bracket, Velcro strap and Velcro mounting for spine board. 47-065 CJ Head Immobilizer, replacement 47-070 CJ Head Immobilizer, adapt 47-047 10-POINT RESCUE STRAP — Provides versatility in the restraint and immobilization of your patient on a backboard. Color coded straps with carrying case. 47-047 105 Rescue Equipment 47-075 47-074 47-090 ADJUSTABLE COLLARS S T I F N E C K S E L E C T A D J U S TA B L E COLLAR — Adjustable collars assure the rescuer always has the appropriate collar at the patient's side. Sizing method is identical to the original Stifneck collar for simplified training. 47-074 Stifneck Adjustable Collar, Adult 47-075 Stifneck Adjustable Collar, Pediatric FIRST AID KITS FIRST AID KITS — Universal First Aid Kits designed to meet the needs of your aquatic facility. These First Aids Kits will treat up to the maximum capacity of people listed. Supplies for quick treatment of common injuries contained in a durable wall-mountable steel cabinet. Kits are easily transportable with cabinet handle. Item CERVICAL COLLARS STIFNECK CERVICAL COLLARS — Constructed of tough polyethylene with foam lining. Color coded for instant size identification. X-ray compatible. Stores flat or folded. Optional nylon fabric carrying bag with zipper closure, holds 10 Stifneck Cervical Collars. 47-076 Adult tall 47-077 Adult regular 47-078 Adult short 47-079 Adult no-neck 47-081Pediatric 47-082 Baby no-neck 47-083 Carrying bag 47-084 47-085 47-090 47-095 First Aid Kit Capacity 25 people 50 people 75 people 100 people Case Dimensions BLOODBORNE PATHOGEN RESPONSE KIT— Proper clean-up of blood and body fluids is essential for disposing of potentially infectious material. Includes: plastic case, gown, gloves, shoe covers, face mask with eye shield, absorbent beads, scraper, germicidal towelette and two red biohazard bags. Refill kit for Response Kit comes in sealed bag. 48-056 Bloodborne Pathogen Response Kit 48-059 Refill kit 101/2" x 5" x 21/2" 101/2" x 101/2" x 21/2" 101/2" x 151/2" x 21/2" 18" x 117/8" x 6" 48-066 48-073 48-055 47-085 LATEX GLOVES LATEX GLOVES — Pre-powdered, 10" long. Box of 100. Specify size: small, medium, large. 48-055 48-057 47-106 47-107 BLANKET — Wool emergency blankets. Standard model is a great all around blanket and Heavy-Duty model is our highest quality most durable blanket for all conditions. Size: 60” x 90”. Color: grey. 47-106 Standard blanket, 30% wool 47-107 Heavy-Duty blanket, 80% wool 106 INFECTION CONTROL PRODUCTS FLUID CONTROL SOLIDIFIER — Allows you to encapsulate feces, vomit, blood or other potentially hazardous waste. Sprinkle on affected area, hazard solidifies for easy and safe disposal. To be used on pool decks not in pool water. Size: 15 oz. 48-057 48-065 EMERGENCY OXYGEN UNIT — Portable Emergency Oxygen unit provides a fast and consistent delivery of oxygen in an emergency. Available in two model types: Variable Flow Rate model offers 12 click-stop flow rates for Lifeguards that are knowledgeable and practiced in administering supplemental first aid Emergency Oxygen. 6 & 12 Flow Rate model delivers 6-liters per minute (norm) or 12 liters per minute (high) for quick oxygen flow selection. Mask fits both adult and child. Units come ready to use with oxygen supply. Available in two sizes: 90-minute oxygen supply with wall mount see-thru plastic cabinet and 40-minute oxygen supply with SoftPac, which includes wall hook and shoulder strap. Replacement cylinders are refillable. Description 6 & 12 Flow Rate Variable Flow Rate Replacement Cylinder Replacement Mask 90 Minute 40 Minute Supply Supply 48-065 48-066 48-067 48-068 48-071 48-072 48-073 www.lincolnaquatics.com Rescue Equipment 48-046 RESPIRATORY CARE LAERDAL® POCKET MASK — Latex free pocket mask can be used on adult, child or infant. Available with or without oxygen attachment feature. Includes: mask, latex gloves, sanitary wipe and yellow plastic case. 48-046 Laerdal® Pocket Mask™ w/o oxygen 48-047 Laerdal® Pocket Mask™ with oxygen 48-043 Head Strap, Adjustable, pkg. of 10 48-048 Replacement one way valve 48-049 Replacement filter 47-100 47-110 MANUAL SUCTION DEVICE V-VAC MANUAL SUCTION DEVICE — Essential equipment for first responders, with the V-Vac you will be able to open and maintain a patients airway. Includes: 1 handle, 2 replacement cartridges. 47-110 V-Vac manual suction device 47-125 Replacement cartridge, each FIRST RESPONDER BAG FIRST RESPONDER BAG — Designed for optimal organization of your emergency supplies. Rugged nylon construction with internal and external pockets and tuck-away backpack harness. Color: red. 47-100 48-042 LAERDAL® PEDIATRIC POCKET MASK — Latex free pocket mask has been designed to address the different anatomical needs of the pediatric patient while providing the efficacy and protection for the rescuer. Includes: Pediatric Pocket Mask, gloves and wipes in soft pack with belt clip. 48-042 47-130 CPR TRAINING 48-050 48-051 48-052 THE BAG™ DISPOSABLE RESUSCITATORS Ergonomic design plus the convenience of a disposable unit. Includes: face mask, oxygen reservoir with connecting tube, Manometer port on Pediatric/Infant units only. 48-050 The Bag™ Resuscitator, Adult Mask 48-051 The Bag™ Resuscitator, Pediatric Mask 48-052 The Bag™ Resuscitator, Infant Mask TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 CPR PROMPT TRAINING MANIKINS — CPR Prompt rescue training manikins provide an affordable one-student-to-one-manikin training in CPR, AED use and the Heimlich maneuver. Proper head tilt/chin lift to open the airway, visible chest rise, anatomical landmarks and an audible compression clicker (adult/child only) to ensure proper technique. Infant manikin features new full body design. Lightweight and requires minimal cleaning with single use face shield/lung bags. Manikins feature Duracoat smooth skin finish for a longer life. Includes: insertion tool and case. Additional Face Shields/Lung Bags ordered separately. 3 Year Warranty. CPR PROMPT TRAINING MANIKINS Item Description 47-130 Manikin 7 pack 47-135 Adult/Child 5 pk Adult/Child 47-136 Single pack 47-140 Infant 5 pack Face Adult/ Infant Shield Child Lung Bags 5 5 2 • 50/20 50 1 • 10 • 5 50 CPR PROMPT ACCESSORIES Pack Size Adult/Child Face Shield/Lung Bag 10 pack 47-145 100 pack 47-155 Replacement Head 5 pack 47-165 Infant 47-150 47-160 47-170 107 Rescue Equipment 48-005 48-006 CPR TRAINING MANIKINS CPR TRAINING MANIKINS — CPR training manikins designed for a more realistic response to rescue maneuvers. Features life like head tilt and chin lift techniques. Airway obstruction and chest rise plus audible compression "clicker" confirms correct compressions. Little Anne and Little Junior feature one way valve and disposable airway system. Little Baby features disposable airway system only. Includes case that folds out to a training mat. Specify light or dark skin. Description Single Four Pack Little Anne Little Junior Baby Anne 48-006 48-008 48-011 48-007 48-009 48-012 Repl. Airways RESUSCI JR. WATER RESCUE MANIKIN Life-like CPR training junior manikin specially designed for child resuscitation and water rescue techniques. Includes: hard plastic case, training mat, water rescue kit, track suit, four junior faces, four junior airways, twelve manikin wipes and directions. 48-005 Resusci Jr. Water Rescue Manikin 48-005 24/pkg. 25/pkg. 96/pkg. 100/pkg. Little Anne 48-150 • • 48-155 Little Junior • • 48-160 48-165 Baby Anne 48-170 • • • 48-175 Manikin Face Shields 6 rolls of 36 ea. 48-013 AUTOMATIC EXTERNAL DEFIBRILLATOR PHILIPS HEARTSTART FRX AED — Cut cardiac arrest response time by having an AED at your facility. Daily, weekly and monthly selftests check readiness and use. AED Guides you through every step with clear, calm voice commands and descriptive visual icons. "Blue-I" button activates CPR coaching. Same set of pads can be used on adults and children. Energy reduced for infants/children with an easy to insert key. Includes: 1 set Smart Pads II, and long life battery (lasts up to 4 years). 5 Year Warranty on AED. Doctors prescription required for purchase. 48-013 Philips Heartstart FRx AED 48-014 Philips Heartstart Smart Pads II 48-015 Infant/child key 48-016 Training pads II 48-017 Replacement Training Pad II 48-018 Replacement battery 48-019 Carrying case, vinyl 48-190 48-009 48-012 108 WATER RESCUE MANIKIN — Adult and adolescent manikins are an excellent water rescue device for adding the shock of realism for your aquatic safety trainings. Available with optional CPR feature. As the manikins fill with water, they will sink up to the neck. To take them to the pool bottom, add five to ten pounds of weight (not supplied). Description Manikin Adult Adolescent 48-190 48-200 Manikin w/CPR 48-195 48-205 48-200 48-023 HEARTSTATION AED CABINET — Accommodates all AED's. Keyless alarm sounds when door is opened, which can be controlled inside or outside of cabinet. Molded side door handles with magnetic door latch. 20 gauge steel with powder coat finish and clear acrylic window. Color: white. Custom colors available. Size: 15" H x 14" W X 63/4"D. 48-023 www.lincolnaquatics.com Safety Equipment 49-010 49-005 WALL MOUNT EYE/FACE/BODY SPRAY HEAD — Allows user the ability to wash all parts of the face and body. Easy-to-use spray unit features a chrome plated squeeze lever for one-handed operation. Single spray head has automatic pop-off dust cover. Vacuum breaker is required on all hand held eye/face/ body spray units per local code, not included. Includes: wall bracket, 12' recoil hose and universal sign. 49-010 49-015 49-020 SELF-CONTAINED EYEWASH — Designed for first aid in locations without accessible plumbing. 16 gallon gravity-operated portable polyethylene eyewash station. Pull tray down for over 15 minutes of full flow at .4 GPM. Includes: wall mounting bracket. Bacteriostatic additive permits storage of water for up to 6 months without growth of bacteria. 49-015 Self-Contained Eyewash 49-020 Bacteriostatic additive, 5 oz. SHOWER & EYEWASH STATIONS SHOWER & EYEWASH STATION — Offers immediate first aid. Full body drench shower with choice of stainless steel or ABS plastic bowl. Easily activated by push flag or triangular pull handle. Stainless steel eyewash and ABS plastic eyewash offer optional foot treadle, and is ordered separately. Epoxy coating adds an additional layer of protection on all galvanized metal surfaces. Meets ANSI and OSHA requirements. Description Standard Stainless Steel ABS Plastic 49-005 49-006 Epoxy Coating SHOWER AND EYEWASH PARTS 49-001 Eyewash head assembly 49-002 Dust cover 49-003 Shower head 49-004 Pull handle 49-007 Optional foot treadle 49-012 49-014 49-026 49-058 49-059 WALL WASH STATIONS HAND-HELD WALL STATIONS — 49-017 PORTABLE EYEWASH TANK — Stainless steel pressurized eyewash tank with drench hose. Built-in carrying handles with flow control spray head assemblies for steady waterflow. Portable heated units maintain water temperature at an average of 75°. Eyewash Style 49-009 EYEWASH STATIONS WALL MOUNT EYEWASH WITH BOWL — Wall mount station with eye and face wash head assembly. Provides superior spray to the vulnerable nasal cavity when needed. Features ABS plastic 11” receptor. Includes: mesh in-line strainer to collect line debris, wall bracket and universal sign. 49-009 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Eyewash only Eyewash with drench hose Heated Eyewash Cart Provides immediate flushing until the injured person can be helped to a primary emergency device. Highly visible and readily available for emergency flushing and decontamination. Station includes: Eyesaline ® , sterile and buffered saline solution which last 36 months from manufacturing date. 49-026 Single Wall Wash Station, 32 oz. 49-024 Dual Wall Wash Station, 2 x 32 oz. 49-027 Repl. Saline solution, 32 oz. 5 10 15 Gallon Gallon Gallon 49-011 49-012 49-013 49-014 49-016 49-017 49-018 49-019 49-021 49-022 49-022 49-022 NOTE: Eyewash only units do not meet the full 15-minute flushing requirements and are intended for use as first aid treatment prior to reaching an approved shower and eyewash station. 49-024 109 Safety Equipment 49-060 49-033 CHEMICAL HANDLING PROTECTION RESPIRATORS — Dual cartridge system with low-profile design and a speech diaphragm for clear communication. Full Face Respirator features wide angle lens and ergonomic design. Includes adapter. Specify size: "comfort seal" (fits 99% of faces) small or extra large. Half-Mask Respirator leaves plenty of room for protective eyewear. Design features dual cartridges that are out of the line of sight. One-point adjustment for a quick secure fit. Specify size: small, small/medium, medium/ large or large. Filter cartridges ordered separately, 2 per pkg. 49-033 Full Face Respirator 49-046 Half-Mask Respirator 49-047 Liquid Chlorine/Muriatic Acid Filters 49-048 Calcium Hypochlorite Filters 49-049 D.E./Soda Ash/Bicarb/Caustic Soda Filters STANZOIL GLOVES — Chemical resistant multi-purpose gloves. Natural hand contour with non-slip grip provides superior feel. Duplex knit lined, neoprene construction. Specify size: S, M, L, XL. 49-060 49-15549-200 49-061 NEOX NEOPRENE GLOVES — Reinforced neoprene coating provides protection against chemicals. Fleece lining eliminates seams in working areas to prevent hand irritation. Natural curved hand for added comfort. 14". One size fits all. 49-061 49-190 DISPOSABLE COVERALLS — Disposable clothing features a yellow polyethylene film coating that repels water and moisture. Provides basic protection but should not function as your total chemical splash barrier. Ergonomically designed to be less restrictive for optimum comfort. Coveralls feature elastic wrists and ankles. Specify: S, M, L, XL. 49-155 DISPOSABLE ACCESSORIES — The same features as our disposable protective coveralls. Bib apron with extra long sewn ties, 28" x 36". Sleeve apron has elastic wrists and slips overhead and ties on back for convenient front body coverage. 52" length extends to top of ankle or can be cut to desired length. Sleeve protectors provide added arm and sleeve protection above gloves with elastic ends. High top shoe covers fit over both shoes and boots with elastic tops for snug fit. 161/2" high. 49-185 Bib Apron 49-190 Sleeve Apron 49-195 Sleeve Protectors, pkg. of 25 pairs 49-200 Shoe Covers, pkg. of 25 pairs 49-065 49-050 49-055 SAFETY GOGGLE — Soft vinyl goggle with molded vents to allow air in and keep splash out. Color: tinted green. 49-050 FULL FACE SHIELD — Protects against chemical splash from brow to underneath chin. Window measures 7" x 19". 49-055 110 SLEEVE PROTECTORS — Splash protection when working with acids and caustics. 49-062 APRON — Chemical resistant apron provides protection from chemical splash. Size: 35" x 45". 49-065 KNEE BOOTS — 15" PVC/Nitrile boots provides protection against chemicals. Cleated sole and steel toe. Size: men’s 6-13. 49-070 49-057 CHEMICAL SCOOP — Plastic 56 oz. scoop. 49-057 www.lincolnaquatics.com Safety Equipment 49-106 49-130 SAFETY STATIONS SDS INFORMATION CENTER — This SDS Compliance Center helps keep SDS documents organized and accessible to employees. Package includes: highly visible SDS sign, with SDS binder, and binder holder. Sign size: 20" H x 15" W. Color: white/red. 49-130 SPILL RESPONSE SPILL RESPONSE KIT — Complete Spill Response Kit from the Association of Pool & Spa Professionals (APSP). Available in nylon bag or hard plastic storage container. Includes: absorbent pads, absorbent socks, lab pillow, disposal bag with labels, personal protective equipment package and sweeper pan. 3 gallon spill capacity. 49-106 Spill Response Kit, nylon bag 49-107 Spill Response Kit, plastic container CHEMICAL SPILL CONTAINMENT SPILL BERM — Polyurethane boom forms a barrier to confine liquids. Helps protect your mechanical room equipment against damage from spills or leaking water. End connectors allow you to link booms together for larger areas. Size: 10' L x 4" W x 21⁄4" H. 49-087 10' Spill Berm 49-088 Connector 49-100 49-150 CONFINED SPACE SAFETY CENTER — Bold visible safety station for all your confined space materials. High-impact polystyrene message board. Includes: 25 carbonless entry permits, confined space binder and 2 - rescue handbooks. Size: 28"W x 32"H. 49-150 Confined Space Safety Center 49-151 Entry permits 49-152 Confined space binder 49-153 Entry Handbook 49-154 Rescue Handbook 49-087 DRAIN SEALS — Flexible polyethylene drain seal prevents contaminates from entering your drain. Molds to drain forming a tight seal. Cleans easily and is reusable. For best results mat should overlap at least 3" on all sides. 49-090 12" dia.49-096 24" x 24" 49-091 20" dia. 49-100 36" x 36" 49-095 18" x 18"49-105 48" x 48" 49-107 49-118 49-116 FLASHLIGHTS 49-108 CAUTION TAPE HEAVY DUTY CAUTION TAPE — Bold barricade tapes for long-term use. Mark hazards with durable tape, stands up to harsh conditions and won't sag in strong winds. Size: 3" x 1,000' roll. 49-108 Caution Do Not Enter 49-109 Caution Hazardous Material TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 49-134 SPILL KIT SIGN — Bold 3-way sign helps staff identify spill control supplies quickly in an emergency. Lightweight plastic signs allow for easy mounting. Size 14"H x 10"W. 49-134 49-112 MAG-LITE ® FLASHLIGHTS — Heavy-duty black anodized aluminum flashlights. "Spot to flood" adjustable beam, self cleaning rotating on-off switch and O-ring sealed for maximum water resistance. Available in incandescent or LED. Description Mini-mag 2 - "D" cell 3 - "C" cell LED 49-112 49-116 49-118 Incandescent 49-110 49-115 49-120 111 Racing Lane Lines 50-005 50-030 RACING LANE LINES COMPETITOR GOLD MEDAL LANE LINES 6" Gold Medal lane line is designed to provide the swimmer with the ultimate in wave quelling. The lane line has over 25% more reflective surface area than any other lane line on the market today. Includes LifeSpan+ additive for enhanced durability. The Competitor Gold Medal lane line has a large 6" diameter disc with donut floats strung on a vinyl-coated 3⁄16" stainless steel cable. Lanes are provided with Competitor take-up reels standard. 15 meter markers, for breakout, provided in contrasting color on each lane, upon request. Disk and donut colors: in any combination of red, white, blue, sky blue, navy blue, green, yellow, black, maroon, orange, Vegas gold, gray, or purple. All donut floats will be made to match disk color, unless specified differently. Special length lanes are available and are calculated by the foot, with lane hardware ordered separately. 50-004 60' 50-00575' 50-010 25 meter 50-015 50 meter 50-020 Special lengths - plus hardware 50-050 Lane line hardware COMPETITOR LANE LINES — 4" flow-through design allows the waves to be dispersed along the channel of revolving discs. Includes LifeSpan+ additive for enhanced durability. The lane line consists of a series of 4" diameter x 11⁄2" discs with donut floats strung on a vinyl-coated 3⁄16" stainless steel cable. Lanes are provided with Competitor take-up reels standard. 15 meter markers, for breakout, provided in contrasting color on each lane upon request. Disk and donut colors: in any combination of red, white, blue, sky blue, navy blue, green, yellow, black, maroon, orange, Vegas gold, gray, or purple. All donut floats will be made to match disk color, unless specified differently. Special length lanes are available and are calculated by the foot basis, with lane hardware ordered separately. 50-029 60' 50-03075' 50-035 25 meter 50-040 50 meter 50-045 Special lengths - plus hardware 50-050 Lane line hardware 112 COMPETITOR/GOLD MEDAL DISCONNECTS Convert from long course to short course, and back, with disconnect feature, utilizing stainless steel pin and bronze clevis. Lanes are provided with Competitor take-up reels standard. Disk and donut colors: in any combination of red, white, blue, sky blue, navy blue, green, yellow, black, maroon, orange, Vegas gold, gray, or purple. All donut floats will be made to match disk color, unless specified differently. Length 25m to 1-75' 50m to 1-75' 50m to 2-75' 50m to 1-75' and 1-25m 50m to 1-25m 7' Extension 14' Extension Gold Medal 6" Competitor 4" 50-060 50-062 50-065 50-075 50-077 50-080 50-070 50-085 50-071 50-120 50-125 50-086 50-110 50-115 NOTE: See page 138 for water polo course markers. Visit our website for Lane Line Configurator. www.lincolnaquatics.com Racing Lane Lines ANTI MINI LANES ANTI WAVE LANE LINES — Undulating shape of discs causes wave to be deflected downward, leaving no wake on either side. Available in 6" diameter Maximum or 43⁄4" diameter ForeRunner. Lanes come assembled on 1⁄8" stainless steel cable with "Supertensioner." Colors: any combination of red, white, yellow, green, orange, North Carolina blue, navy blue, dark blue, pink, purple, teal, gray, black, metallic silver, metallic gold, or maroon. 15 meter markers, for backstroke breakout, provided in contrasting color on each lane, upon request. Lane floats and Supertensioner also available in above colors. Specify lane, float, and Supertensioner colors when ordering. Inquire for custom colors. 3 Year Warranty. Length ANTI MAXIMUM LANES ANTI FORERUNNER LANES 50-360 50-315 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 60' 75' 25 meter 50 meter 50m w/1 Disconnect 50m w/2 Disconnects 7' extension 14' extension Special lengths plus hardware Lane hardware Custom colors Maximum Forerunner 6" 4.75" 50-355 50-360 50-365 50-370 50-375 50-380 50-385 50-390 50-310 50-315 50-320 50-325 50-326 50-327 50-345 50-350 50-395 50-330 50-335 50-340 50-335 50-340 50-130 ANTI MINI LANE LINES — Offers approximately 60% of the wave-quelling effect of Anti’s full-size lane line. Discs are 3" long x 21⁄2" diameter with corresponding colored donut float every 6 discs. Great for practice. Uses 3⁄8" rope and two stainless steel “S” hooks. Comes unassembled. Available in 17 colors. 3 Year Warranty. 50-129 60' 50-13075' 50-135 25 meter 50-140 50 meter 50-145 Special lengths 50-220 ANTI WAVE SUPERTENSIONER — The Supertensioner allows you to tighten and loosen your lanes, without the use of tools, by just twisting the tensioner body. Non corrosive tensioner body with threaded stainless rod and "s" hook. Will fit any manufacturers' lanes. Colors: red, green, blue, yellow, white, or black. Also available in other standard Anti Wave lane colors. Specify. 50-220 113 Lane Line Parts & Accessories 50-243 50-150 COMPETITOR LANE PARTS COMPETITOR MULTIPLE LANE LINE BRACKETS — For triple and double lane line hook-ups to achieve ideal racing conditions. Stainless steel. Set of two. 50-150 COMPETITOR BODY SEGMENT — Specify color. 50-200 COMPETITOR END SEGMENT — Specify color. 50-205 COMPETITOR DONUT FLOAT — Specify color. 50-210 COMPETITOR GOLD MEDAL SEGMENT — Specify color. 50-215 50-246 ANTI WAVE MAXIMUM DISC — Specify color. 50-246 ANTI WAVE FORERUNNER DISC — Specify color. 50-242 ANTI WAVE FLOAT — "Donut" float for Maximum, Forerunner and Mini lanes. Specify color. 50-243 ANTI WAVE MINI DISC — Specify color. 50-255 50-278 50-265 50-280 50-300 EXTENSION ”S” HOOKS COMPETITOR EXTENSION “S” HOOKS 50-265 2" 50-275 14" 50-270 8" 50-278 24" ANTI WAVE EXTENSION “S” HOOKS 50-2802" 50-295 14" 50-2853" 50-300 21" 50-290 8" COMPETITOR RATCHET TAKE-UP REEL 50-160 COMPETITOR RATCHET COVER 50-165 CUSTOM EXTENSION “S” HOOKS 50-305 COMPETITOR RATCHET WRENCH 50-170 PROTECTIVE CAP PROTECTIVE STAINLESS TILE CAP — Fits over waterline tile. Size: 23/8" x 6". 50-525 COMPETITOR 3⁄16" CABLE — Vinyl covered stainless steel cable. 50-175 50-180 50-185 COMPETITOR CABLE LOCK 50-180 COMPETITOR TENSION SPRING AND CABLE LOCK 50-185 COMPETITOR BRONZE CLEVIS disconnects, each. 50-190 — COMPETITOR STAINLESS STEEL PIN For disconnects. 50-195 50-190 114 For — 50-195 50-220 ANTI WAVE LANE PARTS ANTI WAVE SUPERTENSIONER — Will fit any manufacturer's lanes. Patented tensioning device allows you to safely tighten lanes without tools. Colors: red, green, blue, yellow, white or black. Additional colors available — inquire. Specify color. 50-220 ANTI WAVE STAINLESS STEEL 1⁄8" CABLE 50-240 50-261 LANE LINE SAVER LANE LINE SAVER — Fits over pool edge and guides the lane line to the reel. Protects lane line from needless wear and tear from impacting the edge of the pool. Works for both 4" and 6" diameter lanes. Molded fiberglass construction. Color: white. 50-261 www.lincolnaquatics.com Lane Line Storage Reels 51-005 51-010 LANE LINE STORAGE REELS COMPETITOR CLASSIC STOR-LANE REEL Newly redesigned with new transport handle and improved hardware design. Powder coated aluminum construction with PVC reel discs. Stores 525' of 4" lane lines and 300' of 6" lane lines. Size: 68" W x 46" D x 58" H. 51-005 51-010 Classic Stor-Lane Reel Cover 51-025 COMPETITOR ELITE STOR-LANE REEL — Powder coated aluminum construction with enclosed reel end panels for safety. Includes transport handle and 6" locking stainless casters. Stores 902' of 4" lanes and 492' of 6" lanes. Custom colors/logos available. Size: 83" W x 60" D x 71" H. 51-025 51-027 Custom Colors/Logos 51-026 Elite Stor-Lane Reel Cover 51-036 51-042 STORAGE REEL COVERS CHAMPION™ LANE REEL COVER — Heavy 51-040 PARAGON LANE STORAGE REELS — Constructed of stainless steel for long life. Choice of 5" zinc plated or 5" stainless steel locking casters. Storage Reel holds up to 540' of 4" lanes or 6" lanes up to 300'. Large Reel holds up to 720' of 4" lanes or 6" lanes up to 400'. 51-036 Lane Storage Reel 51-037 Lane Reel with S.S. Casters 51-038 Large Lane Reel 51-039 Large Lane Reel with S.S. Casters 51-040 Paragon Lane Reel Cover 51-034 Repl. zinc plated wheel kit, set of 4 51-035 Repl. stainless steel wheel kit, set of 4 duty storage reel covers for any brand of storage reel. 12 oz. per sq. yd. vinyl laminate material for long life. Protects your lane lines and lane storage reel from fading and damage caused by UV exposure. Specify brand of storage reel when ordering. Color: blue. 51-042 Lane Reel Cover, 48" x 67" 51-043 Large Lane Reel Cover, 54" x 83" 51-015 COMPETITOR REEL PARTS 51-020 51-033 ULTIMATE MAXI-SIZE STOREEL — By Anti Wave. Powder coated aluminum, with 6" diameter center spool. Extra wide 79" width allows storage of more lanes. Capacity: 6" lanes - 5-75', 4-25m, or 2-50m and 4" lanes - 8-75', 7-25m, or 3-50m. Ultimate Storeel cover ordered separately. 3 Year Warranty. 51-033 51-029 Ultimate Storeel Mesh Cover TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 XL LANE STORAGE REEL — Large capacity lane line storage reel has 25% more capacity than other reels. Storage capacity - 4" Lanes: up to 985' - 13x 75', 12x 25m, and 6x 50m. 6" Lanes: up to 575' - 7x 75', 7x 25m, and 3x 50m. Powder coated stainless steel with 5' diameter hand wheels and heavy duty, nonmarking, locking casters. Color: silver gray. XL Storage Reel cover ordered separately. 3 Year Warranty. 51-015 51-020 XL Storage Reel Cover COMPETITOR REEL DISC 51-045 COMPETITOR SPACER DISC 51-050 COMPETITOR REEL CORE 51-055 COMPETITOR RETENTION ROD — Set of 3. 51-060 COMPETITOR AXLE 51-065 COMPETITOR SWIVEL CASTER WITH BRAKE 51-075 115 Equipment Storage 62-085 62-086 51-080 EQUIPMENT STORAGE DECK STOR-A-WAY — Portable storage locker can be used indoors or outdoors. Heavy duty ABS plastic with UV stabilizer and rigid fiberglass base. Equipped with a full-height lockable door, self-draining shelves, interior door pocket storage, and ventilation holes for storing wet items. Mounted on 4 locking swivel casters. Size: 33" W x 31" D x 74" H. Color: blue. 51-080 EQUIPMENT TOTEMASTER — Great for storing your aquatic supplies. Available in 3 sizes: Original Totemaster - 31/2'L x 2'W x 3'H or Totemaster Mini - 21"L x 21"W x 30"H, both with single lid opening and Totemaster Plus - 5'L x 2'W x 3'H with dual lid opening and internal divider. Made with 3/16" powder coated steel wire with lockable lids and 4 locking swivel casters. Color: blue. 62-085 Equipment Totemaster 62-086 Totemaster Plus 62-087 Totemaster Mini 62-092 Repl. wheel kit - 4 casters & 4 inserts 51-150 51-090 51-165 51-090 STORAGE BENCHES — Fiberglass storage boxes with UV-resistant gel coat exterior. Includes: stainless steel hinge and cable stays with stainless lockable hasp. Optional items include: gas shocks, permanent dividers, removable shelves, side vents to allow ventilation, stainless steel handles, and set of 4 feet to raise bench off deck for cleaning and drainage. Color: white. Item 51-090 51-091 51-089 51-092 51-094 Dimensions (WxDxH) 85" x 20" x 18" 72" x 20" x 18" 60" x 20" x 18" 48" x 20" x 18" 71" x 22" x 241/4" STORAGE BENCH OPTIONS 51-105 Gas shocks, set of 2 51-095 Permanent dividers, each 51-096 Vent holes, each 51-097 Storage bench feet, set of 4 51-099 Stainless steel handles, pair 116 HEAVY DUTY STORAGE BENCHES — Aluminum frame with 1⁄2" thick composite plastic sides and plastic lumber top. Bench is provided with drainage holes for ventilation and rubber feet for a non-skid base that is safe on any surfaces. Rubber lid seal provides waterproof barrier and reduces noise when closing lid. Dual gas struts for ease of lid operation. Shipped fully assembled. Specify key lock or lock hasp (lock not included). Dividers, custom engraved logos, and sponsor panels available for additional charge. Color: blue, with white engraved letters. Custom colors for additional charge. Composite woodgrain benches also available. 5 Year Limited Warranty. Item 51-150 51-155 51-160 51-165 51-170 51-175 Size (Cu. Ft.) 10 14 14 19 21 29 Dimensions (HxWxD) 19.25" x 72" x 22" 19.25" x 96" x 22" 19.25" x 72" x 27.25" 19.25" x 96" x 27.25" 27.25" x 72" x 27.25" 27.25" x 96" x 27.25" HEAVY DUTY STORAGE BENCH OPTIONS 51-180 Custom Colors, per bench 51-185 Custom Engraving, per letter 51-190 Custom Logos, per logo 51-195 Dividers - 19.25"W x 22"D 51-200 Dividers - 19.25"W x 27.5"D 51-205 Dividers - 27.25"W x 27.5"D 51-086 51-085 ROLL AWAY BIN — Polyethylene storage bin with 4" casters. Ideal for storing your aquatic accessories and team supplies. 28" W x 42 3⁄4"L x 33" H. Optional Hinged Lid protects contents from the elements. Rugged 400 lb. capacity with metal caster frame underneath. Colors: white and black. Lid color: black only. 51-085 Roll Away Bin 51-086 Hinged Lid 51-125 FLOOR STORAGE HATCH FLOOR STORAGE HATCH — Aluminum floor storage hatch available with 1/4" diamond tread plate or smooth aluminum plate for 1 /8" in-fill of tile or carpet. Includes: stainless steel hinge, 11/2" threaded coupling to drain water run-off, slam latch, and removable key handle. Frame is epoxy coated for corrosion resistance. Hatch is counterbalanced and door automatically locks open at 90˚. 300 lbs./sq. ft. load capacity. Additional sizes and double door hatches also available. Size 24" x 24" 36" x 36" 48" x 48" Diamond Tread Recessed Plate 51-125 51-130 51-135 51-110 51-115 51-120 www.lincolnaquatics.com Starting Platforms WATER DEPTH Ruling Body Less than 4' NCAA USAS USMS NFHS FINA N/A No Starting Platform Equal to or more than 4' 30" MAX 20" - 291/2" L.C. 30" MAX S.C. 20" - 291/2" L.C. 30" MAX S.C. 30" MAX 4'6" or over only 20" - 291/2" L.C./S.C. *NOTE: These are minimum water depths and are subject to change. Please verify. PARAGON STARTING PLATFORMS TRACK START TOP SIZE 24" x 32" STANDARD TOP SIZE 20" x 24" Single Leg Dual Leg Single Leg Dual Leg PARAGON ANCHORS Single Leg Quickset Dual-Wedge Single Leg Paraflyte WATER DEPTH MEASURING SPECIFICATIONS FINA: 3 ft. 31⁄2 in. to 19 ft. 2 in. from pool wall NCAA: minimum 4 ft. throughout recommended USAS: 3 ft. 31⁄2 in. to 16 ft. 5 in. from pool wall USMS: 3 ft. 31⁄2 in. to 16 ft. 5 in. from pool wall NFHS: from pool wall to 16 ft. 5 in. NOTE: "B" dimension varies as indicated according to platform height, "A" dimension. Single Leg Long Reach Paraflyte Dual Leg Competitor Dual-Wedge PARAGON STARTING PLATFORMS PARAGON STARTING PLATFORMS — World renowned Paragon starting platforms are the standard by which all other platforms are compared. Made from the highest quality materials, Paragon starting platforms are designed to meet and exceed all ruling body standards for starting platforms. Platform Design Choices: When deciding which platform is right for you, start by determining: 1) What top size do I want? Choice of 20" x 24" Standard top or 24" x 32" Track Start top. 2) Which style platform do I want? Choice of Single Leg design or Dual Leg design. 3) Which style anchor do I want? Single leg designs have a choice of Quickset or Paraflyte anchors and Dual Leg designs utilize Competitor Dual Leg anchor. 52-010 Competitor Track Start — Side Mount Platform The Competitor style platforms utilize a twin legged design that slips in and out of the Competitor Dual Leg anchor assembly, with new Dual-Wedge design. Quickset style platforms utilize a single pedestal design that slips into single Quickset anchor socket, with new Dual-Wedge design and Taper Lock base. Paraflyte style platforms utilize a single pedestal design that is bolted into the Paraflyte anchor socket. Paragon platform designs listed above also come in two heights. Full Height and Low Height (Varsity). The platforms are also available in Standard and Long Reach styles, based on gutter design needs. When ordering platforms: 1) Determine maximum height of block above water surface according to the ruling body that governs your swim programs 2) Confirm the pool water depth at the block installation location. 3) Determine "A" dimension. This is the desired height of your platform over the water surface minus the deck-to-water level measurement. 4) Determine the "B" dimensions. Desired set back from the vertical pool wall. These dimensions vary according to the platform height and style you select. Care should be taken to insure the desired anchor installation location is clear of obstructions such as gutters, deck drains, diving stands, etc. Your Lincoln Representative can help you select the proper starting platform for your facility. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 52-031 Track Start Quickset — Rear Mount Platform NOTE: See page 135 for The Colorado Block by Paragon and Colorado Time Systems. 117 Starting Platforms FULL HEIGHT STARTING PLATFORMS 52-010 Competitor Track Start-Side Mount Platform STANDARD STARTING PLATFORMS PA R A G O N S TA N D A R D S TA R T I N G PLATFORMS — Up to 30" above water surface. All platforms utilize white sand finish polypropylene tops. Top sizes are: 20" x 24", except Track Start tops which are 24" x 32". Custom colored tops available for additional charge - inquire. Specify plain or numbered platforms when ordering. Platforms are provided with 10° sloping tops unless level tops are requested. Horizontal backstroke bars standard. Vertical backstroke bars (FINA) optional. Includes anchor. Item Platform Style Competitor 52-005 52-010 Comp. Track Start - Side Mt. 52-030 Comp. Track Start - Rear Mt. 52-031 Track Start QS - Rear Mt. 52-032 Track Start QS - Side Mt. Standard Quickset 52-015 Standard Paraflyte 52-020 "B" Dimension 18" 18", 24" 36" - 40"* 21" - 26" 21" - 26" 21" - 26" 21" - 26" Competitor Long Reach (20-291/2")52-025 Competitor Platform 52-005 Standard Quickset Platform 52-015 Standard Paraflyte Platform 52-020 Competitor Long Reach (30-40") 52-026 Quickset Long Reach 52-035 Paraflyte Long Reach 52-040 *NOTE: Models with 36" - 40" "B" dimensions utilize 10" high anchors. LONG REACH STARTING PLATFORMS 52-030 Competitor Track Start-Rear Mount Platform PARAGON LONG REACH STARTING PLATFORMS — Up to 30" above water surface. All platforms utilize white sand finish polypropylene tops. Top sizes are: 20" x 24", except Track Start tops which are 24" x 32". Custom colored tops available for additional charge. Long Reach style platforms are designed to span long distances due to special gutter configurations. Specify plain or numbered platforms when ordering. All platforms are provided with 10° sloping tops unless level tops are requested. Includes anchor. Item 52-032 Track Start Quickset-Side Mount Platform 118 Platform Style "B" Dimension 52-025 Competitor Long Reach 20" - 291⁄2" 52-026 Competitor Long Reach 30" - 40"* 52-030 Track Start Long Reach 36" - 40"* 341⁄2" 52-035 Quickset Long Reach 341⁄2" 52-040 Paraflyte Long Reach *NOTE: Models with 30" - 40" "B" dimensions utilize 10" high anchors. NOTE: See page 120 for platform anchors, platform top refinishing and accessories. www.lincolnaquatics.com Starting Platforms LOW HEIGHT STARTING PLATFORMS Varsity Competitor 52-045 Red Green Blue Varsity Long Reach Quickset Cranberry Black 52-050 Varsity Standard Quickset White 52-070 Yellow STARTING PLATFORM OPTIONS PARAGON PLATFORM COLORS — Add Varsity Long Reach Paraflyte Varsity Standard Paraflyte 52-055 VARSITY STARTING PLATFORMS PARAGON VARSITY PLATFORMS — Up to 18" above water surface. All platform tops are 20" x 24" polypropylene with sand finish. Custom colored tops available for additional charge. Specify plain or numbered platforms when ordering. Platforms provided with 10° sloping top unless level tops are requested. Includes: anchor, except Varsity Paraflyte platforms which were designed to retrofit to existing Paraflyte anchors. Rear mounting step extra. Item 52-045 52-050 52-055 52-060 52-065 Platform Style 52-075 VARSITY LONG REACH PLATFORMS PARAGON VARSITY LONG REACH PLATFORMS — Up to 18" above water surface. All platform tops are 20" x 24" polypropylene with new sand finish. Custom colored tops available for additional charge. Specify plain or numbered platforms when ordering. Platforms are provided with 10° sloping top unless level tops are requested. Includes Anchor. Rear mounting step extra. 52-070 Varsity Long Reach Quickset,341⁄2" 52-075 Varsity Long Reach Paraflyte,341⁄2" 52-080 Mounting step, Varsity Long Reach 52-110 PARAGON CUSTOM LOGOS — Add facility logos to your Competitor Track Start and Competitor style platform tops. The addition of your logo promotes your facility and gives your program a custom look. Supply facility logo artwork and PMS color requirements. 52-110 "B" Dimension Varsity Competitor 18" Varsity Std. Quickset 14,18,21,26" Varsity Std. Paraflyte 14,18,21,26" Mounting step, Varsity Competitor Mounting step, Varsity Standard NOTE: See page 117 regarding platform design descriptions, measurements, and ordering information. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 color to your new sand finish starting platform tops, steps, and pedestals. Color adds identity and is great for emphasizing team, facility, or school colors. Standard colors: blue, red, cranberry, green, black, yellow or your own PMS number color. Optional custom powder coating upgrade available for starting platform pedestals. Add-on charge to cost of platform. 52-105 Platform Colors - each 52-107 Pedestal Powder Coating - each NOTE: "B" Dimension varies as indicated according to platform height, "A" Dimension. NOTE: See page 120 for platform anchors, platform top refinishing and accessories. 119 Starting Platforms & Accessories 52-250 52-255 52-032 52-115 Competitor Dual-Wedge Anchor 52-145 Standard Paraflyte Anchor Track Start Quickset — Side Mount Platform TRACK START PLUS KITS TRACK START PLUS PLATFORM KIT — Adjustable, angled backplate and side hand grip kit can be added to your new and existing Track Start platforms. FINA, USA Swimming, NCAA, and NFHS approved. Optimizes the position of the swimmers rear leg, for a more powerful start. The 30° backplate assembly (9" x 24") mounts to side of platform top, is easily removable, and adjusts to five positions. Side hand grip kit can be purchased separately from the backplate kit. Available in stainless or black powder coat finish. Can be used with Colorado Time Systems RJP's. Available in white and a variety of optional sand top colors - inquire. Includes mounting hardware. 52-250 Adjustable Backplate Kit 52-255 Side Hand Grip Kit, set of 2, black 52-256 Side Hand Grip Kit, set of 2, stainless 52-260 Color Upgrade for Backplate 52-265 Powder Coat Upgrade for Side Hand Grip Kit 52-160 Long Reach Paraflyte Quickset Dual-Wedge Anchor PARAGON PLATFORM ANCHORS 52-164 PARAGON STARTING PLATFORM ANCHORS 52-115 Competitor Dual-Wedge anchor, 6" 53-110 Competitor cap only 52-131 Competitor Dual-Wedge anchor, 10" 52-117 Repl. Competitor wedge assembly 52-120 Repl. Competitor D-W anchor cover 52-140 Repl. Standard Quickset cap only 52-156 Quickset Dual-Wedge anchor 52-157 Repl. QS wedge assembly 52-158 Repl. QS Dual-Wedge anchor cover 52-145 Standard Paraflyte anchor 52-150 Repl. Standard Paraflyte cap only 52-155 Paraflyte Long Reach anchor PARAGON ANCHOR SHIMS 52-162 Competitor Anchor Shim, each 52-163 Quickset Anchor Shim, each 53-095 Socket Key 52-165 PLATFORM SAFETY ACCESSORIES PLATFORM SAFETY COVERS — Lightweight polyethylene covers prevent unauthorized use of platforms. Covers stack easily for storage. Includes bungee cord. Available to fit 24" x 32" or 20" x 24" platform top sizes. Color: orange. 52-165 24" x 20" 52-164 24" x 32" 52-111 TRACK START PLUS STS KIT— Side-to-Side (STS) Backplate kit mounts under platform top and is adjusted to achieve faster starts. FINA, USA Swimming, and NFHS approved. 9" x 10" polypropylene backplate slides to left or right push off position and can be easily removed for storage. For platforms with 20" x 24" tops only. Powder Coating and custom color backplates available for extra cost- inquire. Top Color: white. 52-160 BACKSTROKE START DEVICE CTS BACKSTROKE START DEVICE — By Colorado Time Systems. FINA Approved Anti-Slip backstroke start device for faster backstroke starts. Retractable 10 degree wedge mounts on any starting platform with adjustable straps. Automatically retracts after start. Compatible with most starting platforms and gutter configurations. 52-111 120 52-155 52-156 Before PLATFORM REFINISHING After PARAGON SAND TOP REFINISHING — Existing polypropylene tops can be refinished with new sand finish. Improves platform safety and looks. Color: white. Custom colors available for additional charge. 52-179 Paraflyte/Quickset refinish, w/step 52-180 Competitor refinish 52-185 Track Start refinish, w/side step 52-186 Track Start refinish, w/rear step 52-187 Varsity Long Reach refinish, w/2 step 52-188 Varsity Shortee refinish, w/o step CHAMPION™ PLATFORM SAFETY COVERS — 12 oz. vinyl laminated material. Includes warning about unauthorized use. Grommets underneath for anchoring cover. Place beach ball under cover to support material. Colors: royal blue or red. Specify. 52-166 24" x 20" 52-167 24" x 32" PLATFORM SAFETY LABELS — Be sure every starting block is labeled to advise users of proper racing dive technique. Set of 2 labels for labeling back and side of platform top. 52-170 REPLACEMENT HAND GRIP — For Paragon starting platforms. 52-171 52-170 www.lincolnaquatics.com Pennants & Stanchions 53-084 53-100 53-085 53-090 53-095 STANCHION ACCESSORIES STANCHION ANCHORS — Cast bronze or stainless steel anchors with cap for covering socket when stanchions are not in use. For use with 1.90" dia. stanchions. Socket key for removing cap ordered separately. 53-084 Bronze anchor with threaded cap 53-085 Bronze anchor w/tamper-proof cap 53-090 Stainless anchor with slip cap 53-095 Socket key 53-100 Spanner wrench key 53-106 Repl. bronze tamper-proof cap only 53-110 Repl. stainless slip cap only 53-111 Repl. bronze threaded cap only 53-020 BACKSTROKE PENNANTS CHAMPION™ BACKSTROKE PENNANTS Heavy duty backstroke pennants constructed of 12 oz. vinyl coated polyester. Triangular pennants, size: 12" x 18". Individual flags are strung onto 3⁄16" vinyl coated stainless steel cable with brass swivel hook on one end and ratchet take-up reel on other end. When ordering specify: number of pennants required; cable length needed between pennant stanchions or pennant anchoring points and hardware package for each pennant line. Hardware package includes: ratchet take-up reel, brass swivel hook and flag retainer clamps. Assembly required. Specify colors: navy blue, royal blue, medium blue, white, red, green, yellow, orange, purple, light gray, black, brown, and maroon. 53-020Champion™ backstroke pennants, each 50-175 Vinyl covered cable, per ft. 53-030 Hardware package, each 53-035 Custom lettering 44-120 Replacement brass swivel hook 50-160 Replacement ratchet reel BACKSTROKE PENNANTS — 12 oz. vinyl backstroke pennants with canvas header. Size: 12" x 18". Flags available in standard 50' length with additional 5' tie ends. Special tie end lengths and special lengths/colors available. Colors: navy blue, royal blue, medium blue, white, red, green, yellow, orange, purple, light gray, black, brown, and maroon. Quick Ship colors: red & white, blue & white, and green & white alternating. Inquire for custom lettering/numbering. 53-005 50' multi-color 53-006 50' Quick Ship 53-007 60' Quick Ship 53-008 75' Quick Ship 53-010 Special lengths /special colors 53-015 Custom lettering /numbering 53-006 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 53-067 53-115 STANCHION POSTS BACKSTROKE PENNANT STANCHIONS — 8' high stainless steel poles with end cap and welded u-hook to suspend pennants over the racing lanes. Anchors/poles are positioned 15 ft. from pool end for short course and 5 meters for long course configurations. Available in round tube and square tube styles. Four posts required. Stanchion only. Round Tube - Sliding collar with eyebolt and post anchor (round) ordered separately. Square Tube - Rope cleat welded to stanchion side wall. Post anchor (round) ordered separately. Item Style 53-055 53-060 53-065 53-067 Round Round Round Square Wall Thickness .065" wall .109" wall .145" wall .125" wall SLIDING COLLAR WITH EYEBOLT 53-115 53-116 Eyebolt only for sliding collar FALSE START ROPE FALSE START ROPE KIT — 3⁄8" white braid- ed polyethylene rope with two red floats which provide quick release for false starts. Includes all hardware for attaching false start rope to your stanchion posts. Standard rope kit length is 50'. Special lengths are available, specify. 53-120 50' 53-125 Special lengths Diameter 1.90" 1.90" 1.90" 1.90"/2.50" FALSE START STANCHIONS — 4'6" high round stainless steel tube capped at one end with a stainless steel closure plate and U-hook for recalling swimmers. Placed 36' from end of the pool. Two posts required. Stanchion only. Sliding collar with eyebolt and post anchor ordered separately. 53-070 4'6" x .065" wall 53-075 4'6" x .109" wall 53-080 4'6" x .145" wall NOTE: Your Lincoln Representative can assist you in designing your backstroke pennants. Material samples available upon request. CROWD CONTROL STANCHIONS CROWD CONTROL STANCHIONS — Light- weight polyethylene stanchions are designed for effective crowd control. Base is hollow so it can be filled with sand, gravel, or liquid for added weight. Stanchion stands 41" tall with 14" dia. base. 11⁄2" x 9' chain sections sold separately. Colors: white, yellow or black. 53-130 Crowd control stanchion, each 53-135 9' stanchion chain, each 121 Bulkheads PORTABLE BULKHEADS TURNMASTER PRO™ SWIM WALL — State FIBERGLASS BULKHEADS STARK FIBERGLASS BULKHEADS — The use of a Stark Fiberglass Bulkhead will transform your pool into a multi-use facility. The movable bulkhead is custom engineered to fit your existing pool or can be planned and designed into your new facility. With a movable bulkhead, you can increase pool usage and improve program flexibility. One piece, monolithic construction, creates a stronger bulkhead, which virtually eliminates the "trampoline effect" experienced on many metal or sectional bulkheads. Bulkheads can be fitted with timing systems, starting platforms, water polo goals, and stanchion anchors. Includes: racing lane targets, stainless steel lane line anchors, starting platform anchors and patented flotation system. Corrosion resistant fiberglass construction for superior strength and long lasting durability. Bulkhead is easily moved by two people after filling the flotation chambers with air. No wheels or runners required that could damage your facility. 100% flow-thru design, causes all wave action to pass through the bulkhead slots, which double as a handhold. Slip-resistant face and top. Complies with all competitive rules and regulatory authorities. Color: white with black lane targets. Custom colors available as required. 25 Year Warranty. 67-040 122 of the art portable bulkhead increases the use of your pool for training and swim programming, at the same time. Use for lap swim or for competitive swim training to practice turns, underwater streamlines, and race finishes. Also allows you to separate your pool, so you can simultaneously hold lesson programs, while you're open for lap swim. Individual lane bulkhead is made of chlorine resistant Vinyl Ester fiberglass, capable of withstanding the impact of race-speed turns. Simple for two people to install within minutes. Each TurnMaster Pro™ includes wheels for easy transport and storage. Mounts to lane lines. Available in varying sizes, based on lane width. Custom sizes available - inquire. 67-005 TurnMaster Pro™, 6'9" wide 67-008 TurnMaster Pro™, 8'2" wide www.lincolnaquatics.com Swim Training 54-114 54-043 54-004 54-002 KICKBOARDS CHAMPION™ KICKBOARDS — Sturdy foam kickboard will provide years of continued use. Smooth finish with contoured edges for better gripping. Junior kickboard is slightly softer for less stress on smaller swimmer's shoulders. Item Description Size TYR ® CATALYST 2 HAND PADDLES — Unique shape and strap configurations evenly distribute pressure while improving water feel and reducing shoulder stress. Specify size: XXS, XS, S, M, or L. 54-114 Color 54-044 PULL TRAINING CHAMPION™ PULL BUOYS — Sturdy foam Pull Buoy designed for developing upper body strength. Available in two sizes for various leg sizes. Item Champion™ 18" L x 111/2" W Blue 54-002 Kickboard Champion™ 14" L x 10" W Yellow 54-004 Junior Kickboard 54-043 54-044 Description Size Color Champion™ 93/8" L Blue/White Pull Buoy Champion™ 81/4" L Blue/Yellow Junior Pull Buoy 54-092 AGILITY PADDLES — Ergonomic design helps teach the correct palm positive hand position. Strapless design, which highlights incorrect technique by causing the paddle to fall off swimmers hand. Specify size: S, M or L. 54-092 54-041 TYR PULL FLOAT — Upper body training device available in standard Junior sizes. Soft EVA foam Description. Color: blue/white. ® 54-030 STREAMLINE™ TRAINING BOARD — Allows you to mimic the body's natural swimming position for less shoulder stress. Foam molded tracking channels on both sides help keep you in place. Specify color: blue or black. 54-030 Item HAND PADDLES SPEEDO ® HAND PADDLES — Used to improve and develop stroke technique while building upper body strength. Sizes are color specific for easier identification. Specify size: large, medium, or small. 54-090 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Size 95/8" L 83/4" L 54-092 54-125 54-090 Description TYR® Pull Float 54-041 ® TYR Junior Pull Float 54-042 54-130 SURGICAL TUBING SURGICAL TUBING — Roll of surgical tubing. Size: 50' roll length. Item Size Color For 54-125 1/4" x 1/16" Black Hans Paddles 54-126 3/16" x 1/16" Black Speedo®/TYR® Paddles 54-130 1/4" x 3/32" Natural Dry Land Training 54-045 SWIMMERS SAFETY SAFETY OAR™ — Protects young swimmers heads at the finish. Safety Oar is placed between swimmers head and the pool edge. 54-045 123 Swim Training UNDERWATER MP3 PLAYER NEPTUNE® UNDERWATER MP3 PLAYER — 54-109 UNDERWATER SWIM MIRROR CHAMPION™ SWIM MIRROR — Acrylic underwater swim mirror provides a clear reflection back to the swimmer for visual training feedback. Vinyl edge trim provides additional protection. 54-112 Champion™ Swim Mirror, 4'L x 4'W 54-109 Champion™ Swim Mirror, 2'L x 4'W Swim with crystal clear music without ear buds thanks to bone conduction audio transmission. 4 GB of storage (1,000 songs, 60 hours of music). Attaches to goggle straps, resting on the cheekbones. Includes: High contrast LED screen and rechargeable 8 hour lithium-ion battery. Waterproof to 10'. 54-200 54-155 RESISTANCE TRAINING STRECHCORDZ TRAINING — Dry land and 54-136 TECHNIQUE TRAINERS FOREARM FULCRUM — Promotes stroke refinement through muscle memory of proper hand, wrist, and forearm position. Versatile tool for all four strokes. Prevents shoulder stress without losing feel for the water. Size/Color: Senior (yellow) or Junior (blue). 54-135Junior 54-136Senior TRAINING SNORKELS TRAINING SNORKELS — Center 55-126 in water pull training systems for all levels of swimmers. 54-155 StrechCordz Longbelt, 20' 54-160 StrechCordz Shortbelt, 4' 54-165 StrechCordz with Paddles, 4' mount snorkel allows you to focus on body balance and head position by eliminating the rotation of the breathing cycle. Tube design Increases lung capacity. Available in two styles: Swimmers Snorkel: breathe easily and focus on stroke technique while you swim; Freestyle Snorkel: curved shape promotes optimal head position during freestyle. 55-126 Swimmers Snorkel 55-127 Freestyle Snorkel 54-104 PERFORMANCE MONITOR 54-108 FINIS TEMPO TRAINER PRO — Audible metronome pacing device. Use the beeps to set your ideal stroke rate. Features 3 adjustable modes and sync button. 54-108 124 55-127 SWIMSENSE™ PERFORMANCE MONITOR Make sense of your swim training by capturing in-depth performance information. Analyze workouts, review pace times, distance, laps, stroke count and calories burned. Distinguishes between strokes. Online viewing allows you to see history of training, performance charts, summary reports and workout logs. 54-104 www.lincolnaquatics.com Swim Training 55-092 55-095 TRAINING FINS TYR® FLEXFINS — Designed to increase leg strength and foot flexibility. Color coded by size for easy identification. Specify size: Men's: XXXS (12-1), XXS (1-3), XS (3-5), S (5-7), M (7-9), L (9-11), XL (11-13), or XXL (13+). 55-092 TYR® BURNER EBP TRAINING FIN — New short blade fin by TYR® for Elevated Body Position (EBP). Ultra soft high buoyancy rubber fin helps maintain proper body position while training. Perfect fin for race day cadence training. Color coded sizing. Men's: S (5-7), M (7-9), L (9-11), or XL (11-13). 55-095 55-042 55-086 SPEEDO® RUBBER FINS — Versatile long blade fin for training, teaching and recreation. Soft foot pocket for comfort and fit. Color coded by size: XXS (1-3), XS (3-4), S (5-6), M (7-8), L (8-9), XL (10-11), or XXL (12-13). 55-086 55-082 ZOOMERS ® GOLD TRAINING FIN — Redesigned short blade training fins are softer against the foot for improved comfort. Designed to train your legs for speed and endurance. Specify size: Men's: C (31/2-5), D (5-7), E (7-81/2), F (81/2-10), G (10-111/2), or H (111/2-13). 55-082 SEAL 2.0 SWIM MASK — Low profile contoured shape provides a 180° field of vision with no drag in water. Quick and easy strap adjustment. Special matte and smooth areas on the silicone skirt strengthen the seal and enhance comfort. Anti-fog and scratch resistant lens. Colors: clear lens: translucent/blue, white/red; or smoke lens: translucent/blue. 55-042 55-048 SEAL KID'S SWIM MASK — Designed for kids ages 4-12. Flexible frame and leak proof skirt keeps water out and comfort a priority. 180° field of vision, far more than the 70° field of vision with traditional goggles. Clear lens with colored frame. Specify frame color: clear, lime, blue, pink or red. 55-048 TYR ® CROSSBLADE TRAINING FIN — Multi-purpose training fin. Intermediate blade length combines the attributes of both short and long blade fins. Color coded by size for easy identification. Specify size: Men's: S (5-7), M (7-9), L (9-11), XL (11-13), or XXL (13-15). 55-094 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 55-077 Z2 ZOOMERS® FIN — Short blade training fin provides more propulsion with less effort. Engages legs and core muscles for a better workout. Specify size: Men's: C (41/2-5), D (51/2-7), E (7-81/2), F (81/2-10), G (10-111/2), H (111/2-13), or I (13-15). 55-077 55-048 125 Swim Training 55-021 SPEEDO® SWIM GOGGLES SPEEDO® HYDROSPEX GOGGLE — Out- standing performance with a high-tech look. One-piece flexible design. Anti-fog lenses with UV protection. Colors: clear, indigo, light blue, or smoke ice. 55-021 55-022 SPEEDO ® JR. HYDROSPEX ® CLASSIC GOGGLE — Smaller version of the Hydrospex goggle. Soft one-piece frame and split silicone strap. Colors: blue Hawaii, bright pink, silver ice, or smoke ice. 55-022 55-040 SPEEDO® SPRINT GOGGLE — The most popular racing goggle, smaller size is great for youths and adults. Colors: clear or smoke. 55-040 FINIS SWIM GOGGLES FINIS LIGHTNING GOGGLE — 55-010 Sleek lens and frame fused into one streamline piece to reduce drag. Ultra low profile design and soft gasket. Interchangeable nose bridge. Colors: silver/mirror, or blue/blue. 55-010 55-012 FINIS H2 JR. GOGGLE — Leak-proof frame with soft eye gasket for sensitive faces. Ideal for swimmers 4-12 years old. Colors: green/clear, blue/clear, or pink/aqua. 55-012 SWIM ACCESSORIES SPEEDO® SWIM CAPS — One size fits all. Assorted colors available. 56-095 Latex cap 56-100 Silicone cap 57-007 SPEEDO® LIQUID COMFORT NOSE CLIP — Lightweight flexible nylon frame fits the contour of the nose bridge. Soft TPR pads provide a tight fit. One size fits most. 57-007 LAXTO NOSE CLIP — Choice of synchronized swimmers. Flesh-colored, snug, comfortable fit. Specify small, medium or large. 57-010 VIEW SWIM GOGGLES VIEW SNIPER II GOGGLE — Updated racing style in-socket, anti-fog goggle. Colors: mirrored amber, mirrored blue, or mirrored black. 55-026 57-015 55-024 TYR® SWIM GOGGLES 55-034 TYR ® RACETECH GOGGLE — TYR's number one goggle. Universal goggle for competitive and recreational swimmers. Low profile design with split head strap. Colors: smoke, clear, or blue. 55-034 57-010 VIEW IMPREX GOGGLE — Provides the ideal fit for any user with minimum impressions on your face. Anti-fog lens. Colors: blue, black, green, or clear. 55-024 57-021 57-020 AQUABLOCK™ EARPLUGS — Flex stem and super-soft triple flange design, allow for a more customized fit. Increases sealing ability and improves comfort. 2 pair per case. 57-015 PILLOW SOFT® EARPLUGS — Moldable silicone ear putty easily conforms to the shape of the ear. Adult: 2 pair per case, clear. Kids: 6 pair per case, bright orange. 57-020 Pillow Soft® Earplugs, Adult 57-021 Pillow Soft® Earplugs, Kids 55-037 55-032 TYR ® FEMME T-72 PETITE T M GOGGLE Small compact design for smaller female and youth faces. Soft silicone gaskets, anti-fog and UV protection. Colors: clear/ice blue, or rose/ light pink. 55-032 126 AQUA SPHERE SWIM GOGGLES KAIMAN GOGGLES — Low-profile goggle with soft skirt makes a watertight seal every time. Fog resistant. Available in large for adults and small for adults/children. Specify colors: (Adult) amber lens/clear frame, blue lens/clear frame, or clear lens/blue frame. (Small Adult/ Child) blue lens/clear frame. 55-037 Kaiman goggle, adult 55-038 Kaiman goggle, small adult/child 54-170 DRY-OFF SPORT TOWEL — Personal sports towel by TYR® with super absorbing capabilities. Includes storage case. Size: 17" x 13". Color: blue. 54-170 www.lincolnaquatics.com Training Aids 55-130 55-135 LAP COUNTER LAP COUNTER — Display may be placed in the water, held or be self-standing on the deck. The numbers rotate on a vertical axis. Numbered to lap 69, with fluorescent last lap card. Plastic. Size: 14" x 14". Plastic handle adapter bracket allows easier placement of lap counter underwater. Lap counter and handle adapter bracket ordered separately. 55-130 Lap counter 55-134 Handle adapter bracket w/o pole 55-135 Handle adapter with 5' pole 56-005 56-010 LINCOLN TOT DOCK — Tot Dock provides shallow water for your instructors to work with tiny tots or those with special needs. Lightweight aluminum platforms weigh only 55 lbs. each. Includes: adjustable leg extensions (15"-19") with rubber caps to protect pool surface. Size: 7'6" x 3'. Optional rubber corner bumpers are available to be installed at pool site. Weighs 64 lbs. 56-005 Lincoln Tot Dock 56-010 Rubber corner bumpers, each 56-015 Leg extensions, set of 4 56-020 Stainless pin, set of 4 56-025 Rubber leg cap, each 56-030 56-037 56-030 55-135 55-130 55-134 LINCOLN SWIM TEACHING STATION — Provides shallow water for children's swim programs. Contrasting colors create a visible edge underwater for added safety. Powder coated aluminum frame with PVC reinforced aluminum rails remove easily with quick release pins for compact storage. PVC safety rail height 28". Standard leg height 12"-16". Extra tall leg height: 15"-19". Size: 60" x 38". Includes: 1-60" back rail and 1-38" side rail, and rail plugs. Optional back rail and side rails can be ordered separately to totally surround teaching platform. Weighs 53 lbs. 56-030 Lincoln Swim Station, standard 56-035 Lincoln Swim Station, extra tall 56-031 Standard leg extension, set 4 56-032 Extra tall leg extension,set 4 56-033 Stainless pin, set of 4 56-034 Rubber leg cap, set 4 56-036 Back rail, 60" 56-037 Side rail, 38" 56-038 Rail plugs, each 56-061 Rubber bumper, each 56-029 TEACHING PLATFORMS REVERSIBLE SWIM STATION — Build confidence quickly with the addition of an elevated swim station. Reversible platform provides different heights (14" & 20" above pool floor) for various age groups. Aluminum frame, non-skid plastic surface. Frame rails feature fluted 15/8" dia. non-skid PVC surface. Size: 32" x 54". Weighs 65 lbs. 56-029 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 56-060 ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT TEACHING PLATFORM — Provides a secure, elevated surface for your lesson programs. Stainless steel with non-skid cross-grooved sand textured deck. Legs are adjustable in 2" increments via quick release pin with five height positions. Platform places swimmers 18" - 26" above pool floor. Size: 60" x 30". Includes easy grip rails on 3 sides for added security. Weighs 175 lbs. 56-060 Adjustable Height Teaching Platform 56-061 Rubber bumper insert, each 127 Training Aids 44-003 56-051 SWIM TRAINING PLATFORM — Portable swim platform allows you to offer swim classes to younger patrons that require shallow water. Must be used with instructor’s supervision. PVC construction makes the platform lightweight for easily moving in and out of the pool. Includes perforated polypropylene decking with non-slip surface, weighted ballast legs, removable long rail and two removable side rails. Adjustable height legs from 16" – 21". Size: 60" long x 36" wide. Weight capacity: 300 lbs. Weighs 85 lbs. 56-051 Swim Training Platform 56-052 Replacement standard leg, 16" – 21", set of 4 56-053 Replacement extended leg, 18" – 24", set of 4 56-054 Replacement stainless pin, set of 4 56-059 Replacement leg cap, each CHILDREN'S SAFETY VEST HEADS-UP NYLON SAFETY VESTS — Type III Heads-up Safety Vests feature an adjustable belt, leg strap, and zipper front closure and rounded collar with grab strap. Color: red. 44-003 Infant Heads-up Vest, 30 lbs. NOTE: See page 98 for a full selection of Safety Vests and Life Jackets. 56-058 CHILDREN'S SWIM DIAPER CHILDREN'S SWIM DIAPER — Children's reusable swim diaper protects against accidents in the pool. 100% polyester, chlorine resistant. Assorted patterns and solid colors. Specify size: small (9-15 lbs.), medium (15-22 lbs.), or large (22-28 lbs.). 56-058 SWIM TEACHING FLOAT FLOATING ISLAND — Provides safe and fun learning environment for new swim lesson participants. EVA foam floats in water, allowing children to comfortably lie on top. Holes in island allow water to seep through so children can build confidence. Can be used as a learn-to-swim tool or for poolside fun. Children should be supervised at all times while using the Floating Island for learn-to-swim programs. Size: 50" W x 35" H x 1" D. 63-082 128 56-065 SWIM TRAINER SWIM TRAINER — For swim lessons or water exercise classes. 30" PVC bar with 7" floats. 56-065 www.lincolnaquatics.com Team Accessories 57-067 TEAM BAGS SPEEDO® PRO DUFFEL — Designed for the aquatic athlete. Features large main compartment with U-shaped zippered opening. Water resistant bottom, ventilated end caps for wet items, offset raised laptop sleeve, and adjustable padded shoulder strap. Size: 23" x 10" x 10". Colors: navy, black or royal blue. 57-067 57-069 H2O FITNESS BAG — This versatile nylon mesh bag is ideal for stowing and carrying all your HYDRO-FIT® gear. A handy front pocket holds your personal items. 20" high x 12" wide x 7" deep. 57-069 57-073 TYR® ALLIANCE TEAM BACKPACK II — Ideal for elite swimmers or for the recreational swimmer wanting to keep all their swim gear in one place. Designed specifically for swimmer's wet storage needs. Inquire for colors. 57-073 57-050 TEAM APPAREL TEAM PARKA — Full length, water repellent, nylon shell parka. Heavyweight arctic fleece lining with drawstring hood, two-way zipper, reinforced seams and deep pockets. Specify size: Adult (Men’s chest size): XS (34”-36”), S (38”-40”), M (42”-44”), L (46”-48”), XL (50”-52”), XXL (53”-55”), or XXXL (57”-59”). Youth: S, M, L, or XL. Inquire for shell and lining colors. Custom embroidered lettering available, inquire. 57-050 Adult Team Parka, S-XL 57-051 Adult Team Parka, XXL-XXXL 57-055 Youth Team Parka, S-XL 57-060 Embroidered lettering 57-075 TYR BIG MESH MUMMY BACKPACK Extra wide and extra deep to hold all of your training equipment. Separate front zipper compartment and water bottle holder. Shoulder strap allows you to take it all with you comfortably. Colors: black, royal or pink. 57-075 ® TEAM SUITS 54-175 SPEEDO MESH EQUIPMENT BAG — Nylon mesh bag with drawstring closure and ID tag. Size: 28" x 20". Colors: black, navy, red, Carolina blue, silver, pink, and neon lime. 54-175 ® TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 TEAM SUITS — Performance team suits by TYR ®, Speedo ®, and Dolfin. Designed specifically for each team sport whether it be competitive swimming, diving or water polo, we have the right suit for you! A wide variety of materials and color combinations are available to satisfy your team needs. Team quantity discounts available. 57-035 Competitive suits 57-040 Water polo suits 57-045 Diving suits 57-046 Custom team suits 129 Books & DVD's 57-106 57-140 BOOKS CERTIFIED POOL OPERATOR™ HANDBOOK A fundamental training and reference manual for all aquatic professionals. 57-140 CPO™ Handbook, English 57-139 CPO™ Handbook, Spanish 57-145 RECREATIONAL WATER ILLNESSES HANDBOOK — Comprehensive and detailed information about the control and prevention of RWI’s. 57-145 COACHING SWIMMING SUCCESSFULLY Provides details for teaching perfect techniques for all four strokes. Includes illustrated drills to refine stroke mechanics. 57-106 57-116 57-135 AQUATIC RISK MANAGEMENT HANDBOOK Learn how to identify, analyze and take steps to reduce or eliminate exposure to loss. Covers implementation of a risk management plan and an emergency response plan. 57-135 BELOW THE SURFACE — Comprehensive collection of administrative policies and procedures for how to run a successful sports club program. 57-116 57-137 CPO POOL MATH WORKBOOK — The Pool Math Workbook walks you through pool/spa math and technical calculations step-by-step. 57-137 CPO Pool Math™ Workbook, English 57-136 CPO Pool Math™ Workbook, Spanish ™ 57-141 AQUATIC FACILITY OPERATOR MANUAL Focuses on safety, risk management, organization and purchasing. Also covers basic chemistry, filtration, circulation and chemistry control. 57-141 57-144 57-143 AQUATIC PLAY FEATURE™ HANDBOOK Provides guidance on how to operate and manage facilities that have waterpark and spraypark type features. 57-144 COMPLETE SWIMMING POOL REFERENCE Complete pool management and operation resource guide. 57-143 130 BECOMING A CHAMPION WATER POLO PLAYER — By Kirk Everist. All American, Olympian, and National Champion Head Coach at UC Berkeley. This DVD series provides an excellent resource for developing water polo techniques. Purchase individually or as a set of 3 DVD's. 57-100 Becoming A Champion Player, set of 3 57-101 Offensive Techniques Skills & Drills 57-102 Defensive Techniques Skills & Drills 57-103 Offensive & Defensive Game Tactics 57-132 AQUATIC HANDBOOK FOR FITNESS Comprehensive swimming and water exercise program. Includes stroke drills, workouts and other special fitness topics. 57-132 www.lincolnaquatics.com Stopwatches 58-125 58-126 SPORTLINE STOPWATCHES SPORTLINE 220 — General purpose times single event, cumulative splits and captures 1-2 fast finishes. Color: black or yellow. 58-125 SPORTLINE 226 — Same functions as 220 except in the following "gel" translucent colors: ice blue, clear or green. 58-126 58-130 58-141 SPORTLINE ALPHA 410 — Times single event, cumulative splits and captures 1-2 fast finishes. Lighted display. Water resistant. Color: black. 58-130 SPORTLINE 480 — GripSkin outer shell creates slip-proof, shock-resistant, and watertight stopwatch timer. Features Time/Calendar Display, stopwatch timer to 1/100th of a second, split timer, and backlit display. Color: silver with red. 58-141 59-025 ACCUSPLIT AX602 — Professional memory series triple display 10 hour stopwatch. 100 dual split memory with running total that saves and recalls the first 100 splits, event/time-out function, and stroke rate. Color: black. 59-025 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 59-001 59-002 ACCUSPLIT STOPWATCHES ACCUSPLIT 601X — Economical "Pro Survivor" stopwatch for basic timing needs. Features: split timing, time/date functions. Standard colors: red, blue, black, yellow, or green. Translucent colors: lime, lemon, smoke, cherry, or aqua — Specify. 59-001 ACCUSPLIT AX605 — AX Pro Series Event/ Time-out stopwatch. Color: black. 59-002 59-005 59-010 ACCUSPLIT AX705— AX Pro Series Event/ time-out stopwatch with large 10 minute split lower display and full 10 hour upper display. Color: black. 59-005 ACCUSPLIT AX725 — AX Pro Memory Series stopwatch features Lap and Total Speed computations, 16 Dual Split memory, and 1-2 fast finish. Water Resistant case. Colors: black, blue, green, red or yellow. 59-010 58-145 ROBIC STOPWATCHES 58-155 58-160 ROBIC SC-707W — Dual lap/split to 1/1000 second. Lap counter to 99 laps, 100 dual split memory, and multi mode countdown timer. Water resistant. Color: black. 58-155 ROBIC SC-848W — Back light illuminates entire display. 300 dual split memory recall, lap counter to 999 laps, stroke rate calculator, and timing to 1/100 second. Water resistant. Color: grey. 58-160 58-165 ULTRAK STOPWATCHES ULTRAK 495 — The coaches favorite! 100 dual split, with continuous display of event time and ability to take splits in recall mode. Features stroke frequency with time and calendar. Water resistant - 5 year lithium battery. Colors: black or yellow. 5 Year Warranty. 58-165 58-150 ROBIC SC-500E — Single event watch. Start/ Stop/Reset buttons. Color: black. 58-145 ROBIC SC-505W — Lap, split, or event timer to 1/1000 second. Lap counter to 99-laps and 12 memory recall. Water resistant. Colors: black, red, yellow, blue, green, purple or orange. 58-150 58-170 SEIKO STOPWATCHES SEIKO S141 — Recall up to 300 split/lap times. Dual memory mode. Displays running cumulative or lap times. Measures strokes per minute. Waterproof - lithium battery. 3 Year Warranty. 58-170 131 Pace Clocks 59-304 DIGITAL PACE CLOCKS BASIC PACE CLOCK — By Colorado Time Systems. Four large 10" LED digits can be adjusted for indoor or outdoor use. Can be run as standalone pace clock, or set to run in a series of pace clocks, with synchronized time displays. Available standard or wireless. Wireless version can transmit and receive data wirelessly. Can be used with or without a controller. Portable Pace Clock/Shot Clock can run as standalone pace clock or set for Water Polo functionality. Shot clocks must be connected to game timer. Includes internal horn. Can be used with or without a controller. Ultimate Pace Clock Controller ordered separately. Available with red or amber digits - specify. Basic Pace Clock - 110 VAC only. Portable Pace Clock/Shot Clock - 110 VAC and battery powered. 59-301 Basic Pace Clock 59-304 Basic Pace Clock - wireless 59-302 Portable Pace Clock/Shot Clock 58-005 58-015 58-045 PACE CLOCKS COMPETITOR PACE CLOCKS — 31" diameter clock. Can be either wall mounted or secured to a roll away stand (sold separately). Available in a Battery version (C cell battery included) or an Electric version (110 volt) with 18 ft. power cord. On/off switch mounted on top of clock. Portable roll away stand is unassembled. Colors: white clock body with either white face with red and blue lettering or with black face with yellow and white lettering. Specify. 58-005 31" Pace Clock - electric 58-010 31" Pace Clock - battery 58-015 Portable Roll-away stand COMPETITOR PACE CLOCK PARTS - 31" Description Minute hand - black or blue Second hand - red or white Replacement Motor Replacement Lens - 31" Electric Battery 58-025 58-030 58-035 58-020 58-031 58-032 58-040 58-020 COMPETITOR PORTABLE PACE CLOCK — 15" diameter clock with integrated carry handle. Ideal for poolside deck use. Battery operated (1 AA battery included). Colors: Red or white clock housing with either white face with red and blue lettering or with black face with yellow and white lettering - specify. 58-045 PORTABLE PACE CLOCK PARTS - 15" 58-043 Repl. second hand - red or white 58-044 Repl. minute hand - black or blue 58-040 Repl. motor - battery 58-042 Repl. lens - 15" 58-210 KIEFER PACE CLOCKS — 36" diameter clock has best available visibility and complies with USA Swimming Technical Facilities Standards Rule 103.16 for viewable face size requirements. Polyethylene clock body with plastic clock face and protective lens. Red and black color hands for visibility around your pool. Available in two versions - Portable with stand and Wall Mount styles, battery or electric (110V). Colors: yellow, blue, or red. 58-200 Portable - battery 58-205 Portable - electric 58-210 Wall Mount - battery 58-215 Wall Mount - electric KIEFER PACE CLOCK PARTS 58-220 Repl. portable stand 58-225 Repl. lens - 36" 58-230 Repl. minute hand-battery 58-235 Repl. second hand - battery 58-240 Repl. minute hand - electric 58-245 Repl. second hand - electric 58-250 Repl. motor - battery 58-255 Repl. motor - electric DIGITAL PACE CLOCK OPTIONS 59-303 Wall Mount Kit 59-114 Tri Pod Kit 58-060 58-025 132 58-040 58-035 59-306 PRO PACE CLOCK/SHOT CLOCK — By Colorado Time Systems. Four large 10" LED digits can be adjusted for indoor or outdoor use. Pro Pace Clock offers enhanced functionality which includes 15 training modes to fine-tune skills and create customized workouts. Can be run as standalone pace clock or set for Water Polo Shot Clock functionality. Shot clocks must be connected to game timer. Includes internal horn. Available standard or wireless. Wireless version can transmit and receive data wirelessly. Can be used with or without a controller. Ultimate Pace Clock Controller ordered separately. Pro Pace Clocks can display additional information when connected to inputs from a System 5 or System 6 Timing System. Available with red or amber digits - specify. 110 VAC and battery powered. 59-306 Pro Pace Clock/Shot Clock 59-307 Pro Pace Clock/Shot Clock-wireless ACCUSPLIT PORTABLE PACE CLOCK — 15" diameter portable pace clock. Color: blue. 58-060 U LT I M AT E PA C E C L O C K CONTROLLER — By Colorado Time Systems. Pace Clock Controller allows you to program, operate and synchronize Basic Pace Clock/Shot Clock or Pro Pace Clock/Shot Clock. Features 32 character display console with 15 foot connector cable. Operates on 1-9 volt battery. 59-315 www.lincolnaquatics.com Starting Systems 59-110 59-096 STARTING SYSTEMS CHAMPIONSHIP START SYSTEM — By Colorado Time Systems. The Championship Start System is an excellent choice for larger aquatic facilities. The system can drive lane mounted speakers and also power Speedlights on RJP platforms (up to 12 lanes), for a visual starting signal. Each Championship Start System includes 3 separate microphone inputs (2 wired and an optional wireless input), independent volume control for each microphone input, and microphone volume that is independent of start tone volume. Also includes 360 degree strobe that flashes at start signal. Additional strobe lights can be added for remote strobe locations. The unit speaker can serve as a limited public address system, allowing you to make announcements at meets or at practice. Up to 2 additional speakers can be added for start system sound. Up to 12 additional 6 watt lane speakers can also be powered by the Championship Start System. Additional underwater speaker can be added for underwater recall and training options. 110 volt power for use in a fixed location and internal rechargeable gel-cell battery for portable use. Start system can be placed on a table top or, with optional kits, can be wall mounted to tripod mounted. Start System includes choice of 2 styles: wired microphone with 25' cable or wireless microphone that includes both wireless microphone and wired microphone with 25' cable. 59-095 Championship Start System, wired microphone 59-096 Championship Start System, wireless microphone TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 INFINITY STARTING SYSTEM — By Colorado Time Systems. Highly visible strobe light automatically flashes as the harmonic horn sounds. The Infinity Start System includes: start module, 40-watt corrosion resistant speaker, harmonic horn sound, start microphone and start button with recall capability, and internal gel-cell battery. Add a secondary 40-watt speaker and up to 2 additional microphones for referee and officials at the desk. The Infinity Start System interfaces with other CTS components. Can be used on table top or attached to tripod. Tripod sold separately. 59-110 Infinity Start System with wired microphone 59-110 59-115 STARTING SYSTEM ACCESSORIES Description Adjustable tripod 6 lane speaker cable harness 8 lane speaker cable harness 10 lane speaker cable harness 40 watt speaker with 6 ft. cable 40 watt speaker w/125 ft. cable Start jumper cable, 25 ft. Start jumper cable, 50 meter Speaker mounting kit Underwater speaker Wired microphone w/25' cable Wired microphone w/50' cable Wired microphone w/75' cable Wired microphone w/100' cable Wired microphone w/200' cable SWIMMING TIMING SYSTEM DIAGRAM TOUCH PAD SYSTEM DIAGRAM Champ Infinity Start Start 59-114 59-160 59-165 59-170 59-135 59-120 59-179 59-174 59-125 59-142 59-145 59-146 59-147 59-148 59-149 59-115 • • • • 59-120 59-180 59-175 59-125 • 59-145 59-146 59-147 59-148 59-149 133 Timing Systems 59-240 TIMING SYSTEMS 59-295 SPORTS TIMING SYSTEM — By Colorado Time Systems. The System 6 Timing System is designed to coordinate, with other CTS components, the incoming information from the start system, touchpads, relay judging platforms, backup buttons for swimming, and remote judging terminals for synchronized swimming and diving. The system sends information to scoreboards, meet management software, printers, water polo horns and shot clocks. Includes: swimming and diving programs with optional keyboard inserts and software for water polo, synchronized swimming, and pace clock. Large, 10'5" (diagonal) backlit color display with 3.5" floppy drive. Handles up to 12 lanes, supports unlimited splits, and dual meet scoring. Optional Sky-Fi wireless adapter allows you to connect to wireless pace clocks, shot clocks, and scoreboards. 110 volt with battery backup. 59-295 System 6 Timing System 59-300 Sky-Fi Wireless Adapter 59-245 TIMING SYSTEM TOUCH PADS TOUCH PADS — By Colorado Time Systems. Available in 60" and 78" widths with either Patented AquaGrip non-skid surface or regular non-skid surface. Gutter mount, all plastic construction. Incudes 10' cable with molded connector. Supply drawing of panels (if existing) and gutter mounting detail. Touch pad brackets ordered separately. Length 60''W x 22"H 78"W x 22"H 59-250 AquaGrip Regular Widths Surface Surface 59-230 59-235 66"-84" 59-240 59-245 84"-96" Touch Pad Bracket, each 59-255 59-455 59-525 DOLPHIN WIRELESS TIMING SYSTEM By Colorado Time Systems. New wireless stopwatch timing system allows for more accurate starting, timing and capture of meet times. Improves synchronization of all timers by clearing and starting all their watches simultaneously. Wireless communication to your laptop computer eliminates recording errors and improves the speed in running your meets. Systems designed for pools up to 10 lanes. Integrates with Hy-Tek Meet Manager. System includes: wireless stopwatches for each lane (up to 3 per lane), starter unit, base unit, carrying case, lanyards, and a spare watch. System requires: Hy-Tek Meet Manager, laptop, and horn start system. System 1 watch 2 watches 3 watches Configuration per lane per lane per lane 6 Lane 8 Lane 10 Lane 59-525 134 59-455 59-470 59-485 59-460 59-465 59-475 59-480 59-490 59-495 Dolphin LED Scoreboard Adapter TIMING SYSTEM ACCESSORIES DECK PLATES 59-361 Titanium - TDP200 WALL PLATES 59-435 Aluminum - WLAP-A DECK CABLES 59-380 6 lane cable - CH41-6 59-385 8 lane cable - CH41-8 59-390 10 lane cable - CH41-10 BACK-UP CABLE HARNESS 59-395 6 lane/3 button - CH41-6-3 59-400 8 lane/3 button - CH41-8-3 59-405 10 lane/3 button - CH41-10-3 CABLE HARNESS EXTENSION 59-410 CHE-41P-75 59-415 CHE-41-75 "Y" 59-420 CHE-41-50M 59-425 CHE-41-50M "Y" PUSH BUTTON 59-430 PB-6 WALL PLATES 59-440 Quick connect deck plate - DP-QC 59-445 Quick connect hub - QC HUB 59-450 Quick connect mounting kit - MKQC TOUCH PAD CADDY — By Colorado Time Systems. Protect your touch pad investment. Caddy accommodates up to 10 gutter touch pads. Aluminum construction with 4 casters. 59-255 59-060 RELAY JUDGING PLATFORMS RELAY JUDGING PLATFORM TOPS — Colorado Time System's RJP platform tops are the most accurate way to judge relay exchanges, within 1/100th of a second. Available in all standard platform top sizes. Mounts and removes easily with double straps. Speedlight™ strip gives green visual starting flash at the platform leading edge. Great for visually impaired or hearing impaired swimmers. Platform Top Size 24" x 32" 24" x 20" 20" x 20" Custom Logos RJP with Speedlights 59-060 59-070 59-080 59-085 59-094 RELAY JUDGING PLATFORM CADDY — By Colorado Time Systems. Your relay judging platforms are precision instruments that require protection. The RJP Caddy provides a convenient way to store, transport, and protect your RJP's, Champ Start, Quick Start, and cables. Accommodates up to 10 - RJP's, and is still narrow enough to fit through doorways. Available in 2 sizes, based on your platform top size. Aluminium frame with four swivel casters. 59-093 RJP Caddy, 24" x 20" tops 59-094 RJP Caddy, 24" x 32" tops www.lincolnaquatics.com Timing Systems & Scoreboards 59-290 59-293 SCOREBOARDS 59-265 THE COLORADO BLOCK™ THE COLORADO BLOCK™ — This starting block system incorporates Colorado Time Systems (CTS) technology and KDI Paragon Track Start Side Mount Starting Platform together, for the most technologically advanced starting platform available. The platform and the timing components are ordered together to assemble a complete system. The Colorado Block™ includes: Relay Judging Platform with Speedlights™, connection hub, block mounted horn, deck plate connector and sponsor panel. The Colorado Block™ is available in 2 side mount platform styles - the dual leg Competitor and the single leg Quickset. New sand and grooved finish poly top with 10° slope, lane numbering and deck anchor. Top size: 24" x 32". Custom colored tops available for additional charge - inquire. The Colorado Block™ is designed to work with your Colorado Time System. This new design block utilizes the Relay Judging Platform ™ (RJP) and is the most accurate way to judge relay exchanges. Your Colorado Time System analyzes input from the touch pads and the pressure sensitive RJP to accurately judge exchanges within 1/100th of a second. The LED Speedlights on the RJP top signal the athletes simultaneously with the starting system to create a fairer start and also to provide visual signals to hearing impaired swimmers. The starting horn is mounted underneath the platform top to provide audible start commands. Electronics deck plate is mounted underneath platform top to protect wiring connections. All electrical components are removable for dry, safe storage. Platform includes a side cover shroud that can incorporate artwork and graphic displays. Provide deck to water level dimensions when ordering. 59-265 The Colorado Block™ - Competitor 59-268 The Colorado Block™ - Quickset 59-268 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 SCOREBOARDS — By Colorado Time Systems. Indoor/Outdoor, wireless, LED Otter Scoreboards. Swimming - 6 Lane or 8 Lane Swimming versions or Water Polo - Home/ Guest/Period/TOL/Shot Time scoreboard or version that adds Exclusion section with Player/ Time data for both teams. Single line, indoor or outdoor wired scoreboards, available. Scoreboards use red LED digits. 59-290 LED Scoreboard - Swimming, 6 Ln 59-291 LED Scoreboard - Swimming, 8 Ln 59-292 LED Scoreboard - Water Polo 59-293 LED Scoreboard - WP, w/Exclusion 59-280 Single Line LED, Scorebrd, indoor 59-285 Single Line LED, Scorebrd, outdoor 59-291 59-292 SCOREBOARD ACCESSORIES 59-272 Scoreboard sponsor panel blank LED 59-275 Scoreboard caddy DATA CABLES Item 59-204 59-205 59-206 59-211 Cable Length 10' 25' 50' 100' Item 59-215 59-216 59-217 59-218 Cable Length 150' 200' 250' 300' WATER POLO SHOT CLOCKS 59-600 59-675 WATER POLO SCOREBOARD WAT E R P O L O S C O R E B O A R D — B y Colorado Time Systems. Wireless timing and scoring solution for Water Polo. Each Water Polo Scoreboard is designed with a powder coated aluminum enclosure with molded handle. Home/Guest Scores and Game Time in 10" LED digits, Period in 7" LED digits, and 2" LED dots for time outs left. Can be used indoor or outdoor. Integrated horn performs different shot and game tones. 2.4 GHz wireless operation. 115-230 VAC. Size: 6'W x 2.3'H x 4"D. Available in red, amber, or multi-color digits, specify. Use with Wireless Hand Held Controller or Wireless Table Top Controller, both with 1,000 ft. range, ordered separately. Water Polo Package 1 - includes Scoreboard, Hand Held Controller, 2 x Shot Clocks, Scoreboard Caddy with side and center trays for easy portability of Shot Clocks and Controller. Water Polo Package 2 - Same as Package 1, except includes 3 ft. stand in lieu of Scoreboard Caddy. 59-600 Water Polo Package 1 59-605 Water Polo Package 2 59-610 Wireless Table Top Controller upgrade to Package 1 or 2 WATER POLO DECK/SHOT CLOCKS — By Colorado Time Systems. The Water Polo Shot Clock is designed with a rugged molded polyethylene enclosure that is water and sun resistant. Each Deck/Shot Clock displays Shot Time in 10" LED digits and Game Time in 5" LED digits and can be used as a pace clock or time of day clock when not being used for competition. Integrated horn performs separate shot and game tones. Can be used on deck side as pace/time of day clock when not being used as Shot Clock for competition. Available with multi-color (amber - game/time of day and red - shot/pace clock), all red, or all amber LED digits, specify. Use the Wireless Hand Held Controller or Wireless Table Top Controller, both with 1,000 ft. range, ordered separately. Wireless Run-Stop-Reset control for use with Wireless Table Top Controller, ordered separately. Shot Clocks are compatible with CTS System 6 Sport Timer with wireless adapter - inquire. 2.4 GHz wireless operation. Battery or 115-230 volt power. Size: 32"H x 18.5"W x 12"D. Sold as a pair. 59-675 Water Polo/Deck Clock - pair 59-620 Wireless Hand Held Controller 59-625 Wireless Table Top Controller WATER POLO SCOREBOARD OPTIONS 59-615 Water Polo Scoreboard - battery 59-620 Wireless Hand Held Controller 59-622 Wireless Run-Stop-Reset Control 59-625 Wireless Table Top Controller 59-630 Scoreboard Caddy 59-635 Scoreboard Caddy, with Pneumatic wheels (outdoors) 59-640 Scoreboard Stand - 3 ft. 59-645 Scoreboard Legs - 3 in. 135 Water Polo Goals 60-045 60-115 WALL GOALS PARAGON STAINLESS STEEL WALL GOALS — Heavy duty goal frame is constructed from high quality stainless steel tubing. The goal fascia is made using a white FRP channel. Goal cages can be adjusted vertically to be set at regulation goal height. Goal arms fold flat against back of the cage for compact on-deck storage. Goals are completely assembled and furnished as a pair. Each pair of goals requires 4 anchor sockets and one pair of goal backings or goal nets, ordered separately. Goal nets (pair) are constructed using treated, water resistant mesh netting. Solid blue goal backings (pair) are constructed from heavy vinyl fabric with grommets on 10" centers on all perimeter edges. Designed to meet FINA, NCAA, NFHS and USA Water Polo Regulations. 60-045 Stainless steel wall goals - pair 60-050 Wall goal nets - pair 60-055 Wall goal backings - pair 60-096 WATER POLO GOAL BACKINGS GOAL BACKINGS — Heavy-duty vinyl fabric with grommets installed every 8" in hemmed edge. Available as single backing panel, single top panel, or set of 2 side panels. Specify brand of goal being used and specific dimensions required. Custom backing sizes available - inquire. Goal lacing is priced per lineal foot. Usually takes 200 ln. ft. to lace one goal. Specify color: royal blue, white, hunter green, black, or red. Custom logos available - inquire. 60-095 Goal backing, 46" x 118", each 60-096 Goal backing, 58" x 118", each 60-100 Custom backing 60-106 Goal top panel, 14" x 118", each 60-107 Goal side panels, 14" x 46", set of 2 60-110 Goal lacing, per ln. ft. 60-115 Custom Logos 53-084 53-100 60-005 WALL GOALS ANTI UNIVERSAL WALL GOALS — All metal parts are constructed of high quality powder coated aluminum for extra protection and durability. The net is made of tough polypropylene cord that is knotted at every intersection. Canvas goal backing is made of heavy-duty vulcanized material. Rear arms are fully adjustable to meet most existing deck anchor locations and goal can be adapted for varying deck-to-water level locations. Goals are unassembled and sold individually. Includes: goal frame, net, goal backing, and 2 stainless steel anchors. Additional stainless deck anchors ordered separately. Conforms with all national and international water polo goal specifications. 3 Year Warranty. 60-005 Anti Universal wall goal 60-060 Repl. wall goal net - each 60-010 Anti wall goal anchors, set of 2 60-070 Repl. wall goal backing - each 136 53-085 53-090 53-095 WALL GOAL ANCHORS WATER POLO GOAL ANCHORS — Anchors with cap for covering socket when goals are removed. Socket key ordered separately. Two anchors required per goal. 53-084 Bronze anchor with threaded cap 53-085 Bronze anchor with tamper-proof cap 53-090 Stainless anchor with cap 53-095 Socket key 53-100 Spanner wrench key 53-106 Repl. bronze tamper-proof cap only 53-110 Repl. stainless slip cap only 53-111 Repl. bronze threaded cap only 60-090 Wall goal bumpers, each www.lincolnaquatics.com Water Polo Goals FLOATING GOALS 60-155 ANTI FLOATING GOALS — Odyssey goals utilize powder coated aluminum bars and struts, with hand-laid fiberglass flotation panels. Club goals utilize one-piece welded upright/ crossbar assembly for the back brace, and for the rear struts. The Club goal also has its own, hand-laid, fiberglass flotation panels. Goal nets included. Two anchors and anchor ropes required per goal - ordered separately. Specify length of anchor ropes required. Anchor rope colors: red, yellow, blue, white, or combination of any two colors. 3 Year Warranty. 60-155 Odyssey floating goal 60-160 Club floating goal FLOATING GOAL REPLACEMENT PARTS Description Net Flotation set 60-150 60-120 Odyssey Goal Club Goal 60-124 60-124 60-127 60-128 Floating goal anchors - each Floating goal ropes - per ft. 61-035 61-005 RECREATIONAL GOALS LINCOLN AQUA GOAL — Official size deluxe goal made from 1.66" white PVC. 10' wide x 3' high x 3' deep. Includes netting. The Sniper, shooter’s training sieve ordered separately. 61-005 Lincoln Aqua Goal 61-010 Replacement netting, each 60-170 ANTI FOLDING WATER POLO GOALS Floating goals fold flat for easy storage. Splashball floating goal is 2/3 size (78" x 42") and the Official Splashball Goal. "Senior FlipFloat" floating goal is full competition size (118" x 42"). Powder-coated aluminum frame with fiberglass flotation panels. Includes net. Each goal sold separately. 3 Year Warranty. 60-165 Splashball folding goal 60-170 Senior FlipFloat folding goal ACCURACY TRAINER THE SNIPER — Shooter’s training aid for water polo. Sized to fit standard 10' x 3' water polo goal or Aqua Goal pictured above. Made from rugged, rot-resistant nylon cordura material. Oversized grommets and heavy-duty “S” hooks stand up to the mightiest of shots. Five, strategically located, 12" sniper holes help improve your shooting accuracy. 61-035 Sniper Accuracy Trainer 60-170 60-160 61-020 INFLATABLE GOALS 60-165 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 INFLATABLE WATER POLO GOALS — Portable inflatable water polo goals inflate in less than 4 minutes and store in a duffel bag. Constructed from heavy duty PVC with reinforced seams. Stands up to heavy play and is easily portable. Available in Full Size (10' x 3') and Junior (82" x 35") sizes. 61-020 Full size goal 61-025 Junior size goal 61-055 TRAINING AIDS MIKASA SHOT MAKER REBOUNDER — Training tool for developing shooting, passing, and receiving skills. Adjustable rear arm changes net angle. Constructed from UV and chlorine resistant materials. Can be used while in the water or on dry land. Size: 40" x 40". 61-055 137 Water Polo Training 62-045 WATER POLO CAPS 62-012 FINIS WATER POLO CAP SET — Fitted nylon-Lycra caps stretch and conform to any size head for comfort and durability. Cap set includes: 13 total caps - field caps numbered #2 - 12, plus 2 red goalie caps (#1 and 13). Extender cap set includes: 13 total caps field caps numbered #15 - 25, plus 2 red goalie caps (#14 and 26). Cap set colors: navy and white. Size: Adult. 62-012 Water polo cap set w/ear guards 62-013 Extender cap set w/ear guards 62-020 WATER POLO EAR GUARDS — Plastic ear guards available in blue, white or red. Specify. 62-020 Ear guards - pair 62-031 TURBO WATER POLO CAPS — Chlorine resistant PVT polyester material with ear guards and ties. Available in two cap styles - Turbo Standard water polo cap set with 17 field caps (#2-18), plus two red goalie caps (#1 and #1A). Set colors: black, white, navy, royal, green, or orange. Turbo Junior water polo cap set provides proper fit for 12 & U age group and includes 28 field caps (#2-15) in both blue and white colors, plus four red goalie caps (#1 and #13), two of each. Semi-custom water polo caps with custom school colors or Custom water polo cap with custom colors and team logos also available - inquire for available colors. 62-026 Standard set w/ear guards 62-031 Junior set w/ear guards 62-035 Semi-Custom cap w/ear guard, ea. 62-036 Custom cap w/ear guard, ea. 138 62-047 62-059 62-105 62-104 WATER POLO BALLS MIKASA WATER POLO BALLS Championship Series - 2 Year Warranty Premier Series - 1 Year Warranty Varsity Series - 1 Year Warranty Training Series - 3 Year Warranty Premier colors: yellow with alternating black, red, blue, or green panels. Specify. Ball Style Ruling Body FINA USAWP NCAA NFHS FINA Championship USAWP Color NFHS USAWP Premier Color NFHS USAWP Varsity NFHS Championship Training — Varsity Intermediate (14&U Girls/12&U Boys) (Size 3) Varsity Junior (10&U) (Size 2) Splashball (8&U) (Size 1) Men's Size 5 Women's Size 4 62-045 62-055 62-046 62-047 62-048 62-049 62-057 62-058 62-059 62-110 W6000 W6009 W6000W W6009W W5500 W5000 W5509 W5009 62-107 W3INT 62-105 W5008 62-104 W5007 62-100 62-101 Description 62-100 Men's 62-101 Women's 14&U Boys & Girls 62-102 62-103 CHAMPION™ SAFETY NETS — Water polo course safety divider nets protect swimmers and spectators in other areas of your pool, walkways, or grandstands. Custom length nets are constructed of heavy grade 4" braided polyester mesh. Each net is installed onto custom length stainless cable with hardware package (ordered separately), and are placed between existing backstroke stanchions or 10' net stanchion and anchors. Order stainless carabiners separately and space one carabiner every 2 ft. Specify length and height of net required and distance between stanchions. 61-040 Champion™ safety nets - custom 50-175 Vinyl covered cable, per ft. 53-030 Hardware package, each 53-050 Water polo net stanchion, 10' x .145" wall 61-039 Stainless carabiner W4000 W4009 (3.3 lbs.) (1.7 lbs.) KAP7 WATER POLO BALLS — Official Ball of the Collegiate Water Polo Association (CWPA). Inquire for available colors. Item SAFETY NETTING Intermediate 14&U Girls 12&U Boys Junior 10&U Boys & Girls Size #5 #4 Ruling Body NCAA CWPA NFHS AWP NCAA CWPA NFHS AWP #3 AWP #2 AWP WATER POLO LANES WATER POLO COURSE LANES — Custom lanes to identify water polo course and also anchor floating water polo goals. Lanes can be configured to identify course zones or in your school's colors. Specify: lengths, disc locations, and desired colors required for each lane. Competitor or Anti Wave lanes available in 4" or 6" diameter sizes. Hardware package ordered separately for each lane. Competitor Anti Wave Custom Lengths Disc. Custom Lengths (Dia.) Style Item Style Item Gold Medal 50-020 Competitor 50-045 Hardware 50-050 Package 6" 4" • Maximum 50-395 Forerunner 50-330 Hardware 50-335 Package WATER POLO COURSE DIMENSIONS FINA/USAWP Men's Field of Play Length - 20 meters to 30 meters Width - 10 meters to 20 meters Women's Field of Play Length - 20 meters to 25 meters Width - 10 meters to 20 meters www.lincolnaquatics.com Water Polo Accessories BALL ACCESSORIES 62-115 MIKASA HAND PUMP — Dual action hand pump with flexible hose. 62-115 TRAINING AIDS 62-117 MIKASA DOUBLE BARREL HAND PUMP 62-117 WATER POLO WEIGHT BELTS — Designed to improve your leg strength and improve your overall game conditioning. Soft durable neoprene casing with Velcro and buckle strapping for a secure and comfortable fit. 62-150 Red - 5 lbs. 62-155 Purple - 7.5 lbs. 62-160 Black - 10 lbs. 62-121 MIKASA DIGITAL AIR GAUGE — Gauge with bleeder valve to adjust ball air pressure. 62-121 62-085 EQUIPMENT HANDLING EQUIPMENT TOTEMASTER — Great for storing your aquatic supplies. Available in 3 sizes: Original Totemaster - 31/2'L x 2'W x 3'H or Totemaster Mini - 21"L x 21"W x 30"H, both with single lid opening and Totemaster Plus - 5'L x 2'W x 3'H with dual lid opening and internal divider. Made with 3/16" powder coated steel wire with lockable lids and 4 locking swivel casters. Color: blue 62-085 Equipment Totemaster 62-086 Totemaster Plus 62-087 Totemaster Mini 62-090 Totemaster Repl. wheels, each 62-091 Totemaster Repl. sleeve, each 62-092 Repl. wheel kit - 4 casters, 4 inserts 62-123 COACHING ACCESSORIES KAP7 DRY ERASE CLIPBOARD 62-123 62-060 62-070 62-135 62-140 MIKASA WATER POLO BALL BAG — Oversize vertical ball bag holds up to 16 water polo balls. Heavy duty nylon and mesh bag with shoulder strap. Size: 39"H x 151⁄2"W x 151⁄2"D. 62-135 MIKASA TRAVEL BALL BAG — Black nylon bag with mesh gusset holds up to 6 water polo balls. Size: 17"H x 261⁄2"W x 7"D. 62-140 GAME ACCESSORIES AIR HORN — Loud and clear sound signals players and coaches. Includes horn and one power can. 62-060 Air Horn 62-065 Extra power can BRASS BELL — 6" polished brass bell with mounting bracket. 62-070 62-095 62-130 WATER POLO MARKERS 61-062 FINA WATER POLO COURSE MARKERS — Heavy duty UV treated vinyl markers cover the complete 2 meter (red) and 2-5 meter (yellow) zones, not just the lines. Set covers all 4 sides of the pool. 61-062 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 61-080 STANDING WHITEBOARD — Anodized aluminum frame with swivel locking casters and reinforced bracing. Double sided whiteboard with steel lock clamps to lock board in preferred position and full length accessory tray. 61-075 3' x 4' 61-080 4' x 6' WATER POLO BALL BAG — Heavy duty, made from heavy nylon cord with drawstring. 32" x 36" size holds 8-12 balls. 62-095 WATER POLO CAP BAG — Nylon mesh. 54-175 WATER POLO CAP STRINGER — Holds up to two sets of caps. 62-130 139 Games 63-370 RockSolid™ Single Post 63-370 63-004 WATER BASKETBALL SPLASH & SLAM WATER BASKETBALL — State-of-the-art basketball set. Fiberglass backboard has a 2" overhang keeping the action in the pool. Adjustable height to 6' above water level. Break-away rim available in two styles: powder-coated stainless steel rim for the toughest conditions or a more economical powder-coated steel rim. Polyethylene base weighs 500 lbs. when filled with water. Includes water basketball. 63-004 Splash & Slam Water Basketball, s.s. 63-003 Repl. rim, powder-coated, s.s 63-011 Repl. rim, powder-coated, steel 63-010 Repl. Backboard 63-006 Splash-It Water Basketball, only 63-002 Repl. net 63-008 POOL SHOT WATER BASKETBALL — Pool side basketball goal is constructed of heavy UV-treated polyethylene. Three winged panels direct missed shots back into the pool. Backboard is adjustable from 36" to 43" above the pool deck. The water filled base weighs 400 lbs when filled with water. Size: 5' high x 53" x 43". Includes basketball. 63-008 Pool Shot Water Basketball 63-009 Repl. water basketball only 140 SWIM N’ DUNK WATER BASKETBALL Competitive acrylic see-thru backboard regulation rim. Adds fun to your pool without blocking your view of what’s going on. To be used in water depths not greater than 42". Available in two styles: RockSolid™ Single Post - includes single post anchor and escutcheon and SealedSteel Dual Post includes two plastic anchors. Optional bronze anchors can be purchased separately for the SealedSteel Dual Post unit. Purchase additional anchors to create different anchoring locations around your pool if desired. 63-370 RockSolid™ Single Post 63-360 SealedSteel Dual Post SWIM N’ DUNK PARTS 63-375RockSolid™ Anchor only 63-380RockSolid™ Escutcheon, black vinyl 63-385RockSolid™ Anchor Safety cap 63-410 SealedSteel Plastic Anchors, pair 63-415 SealedSteel Bronze Anchors, pair 63-400 Repl. backboard 63-395 Repl. rim and net with hardware 63-390 Repl. basketball 63-360 WATER VOLLEYBALL Sealed Steel Dual Post 63-360 63-020 WATER VOLLEYBALL SET — 4'6" stainless steel posts with eyebolts to anchor 32' volleyball net. Includes: two 4'6" posts with sliding eyebolt collar, 32' net and water volleyball. Special length nets and deck anchors extra. 63-020 Water Volleyball set 63-024 Repl. 32' net 63-025 Special length nets 64-070 Repl. Squish Water Volleyball www.lincolnaquatics.com Games 64-041 64-042 64-037 AQUATIC GAMES RECREATIONAL UNDERWATER HOCKEY A great way to bring new programs to your facility. Plastic hockey sticks and pucks available in two colors. 64-041 Underwater hockey sticks, dozen 64-042 Recreational hockey puck, each 64-055 SUBMERGENCY — High tech underwater hide-and-seek dive game. Find and disarm Submergency before the time runs out and the LED lights flash. 3 depths - float, sink or suspend. Listen and locate by signals you can hear underwater. Requires 2 x AAA batteries (not included). 64-055 64-044 TOYPEDOS — Underwater torpedo game glides underwater up to 30'. Toypedo: simply glides underwater and Toypedo Revolution: tilted fins make it twist and turn in the water. Liquid inside spins and flows with eye-catching glitter. Assorted colors. Size: 111/2" L. 64-037 Toypedo, each 64-044 Toypedo Revolution, each 64-004 PRO-CHIP ISLAND GOLF™ — Portable floating practice target opens and closes with ease. Includes: 66" x 40" floating golf target, 12 golf balls, 12" x 24" chipping pad and moveable 18th hole flag. Golf club not included. 64-004 64-025 DOLPHIN SLALOM — Swim-through underwater game. Weighted anchors keep rings submerged. Course of three colorful rings. 64-025 64-027 HYDRO SUBSKATE — Learn to skate underwater. Strengthens abs, increases balance and flexibility all while having fun. Assorted colors. 64-027 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 64-043 DIVE N’ GLIDE SHARK — Shark moves through the water just like a real shark. Watch it dive through the deep, then glide to the surface. Swims up to 20' underwater. 64-043 64-036 TOYPEDO BANDITS — Half the size of the Toypedo but just as much fun. Brightly colored, numbered point values enhance game play. Doubles as a dive toy. Size: 5" L. 64-036 Toypedo Bandits, set of 4 64-036 141 Games 64-014 64-028 SQUIRTLES — Squeeze’em to fill’em, squeeze’em to squirt’em! Set of 3 includes: Fish, Pirate & Octopus. Size: 4" dia. 64-014 64-011 64-056 SQUID DISK — Toss the squid disk and watch the 360° water spraying action! 64-056 64-012 GEYSER GUYS — Water toys shoot a stream of water over 20 feet. Just squeeze, fill and squirt. A fun addition to your children's programs. 64-011 Douser Dolphin, 9" wide 64-012 Splashy Turtle, 71/2" wide 64-013 Geyser Whale, 9" wide 64-029 MR. RAY'S DIVE GAME — Catch the characters before they sink. Includes Mr. Ray and his 5 students featuring Dory and Nemo. 64-029 142 GOBBLE GOBBLE GUPPIES — Squeeze the trigger to open the Whale's mouth, then try to gobble all the guppies. Includes: one whale and five floating guppies. Sizes: Whale (7.25" wide) and Guppies (1.25" wide). 64-028 64-026 BATTLE REEF MICROS — These funky fish are guaranteed to get a grin. Small in size with a comically big bite. Pull-string power propels the fish forward. Size: 4.5" wide. Assorted colors. Sold each. 64-026 64-052 DORY HOP BALL — Skip Dory across the pool. Soft ball with flexible fins. 64-052 64-030 UFO DIVE DISCS — Underwater fun as numbered discs flutter slowly to the pool floor. Set of 6. Size: 4" dia. 64-030 64-054 SHARK FRENZY DIVE GAME — Underwater shark hunt search and retrieval game. Set of 3 sharks. Size: 7" wide. 64-054 www.lincolnaquatics.com Games 64-006 ANIMAL DIVE RINGS — Soft and flexible Dive Rings provide a fun toy all while being safe. Set of 4 colorful animal characters. Size: 6" dia. 64-006 64-009 DIVE ANIMALS — Dive animals are sure to provide additional fun at your pool. Soft and flexible. Set of 4 colorful animal characters. Size: 7" tall. 64-009 64-005 RELAY DIVE STICKS — Brightly colored, flexible dive sticks. Numbered point values enhance game play. Water weighted to lay safely on pool bottom. Set of 6. Size: 8" long. 64-005 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 64-053 EEL STICKS DIVE GAME — Wiggly eel underwater search and retrieval game. Includes: four colorful eels. Size: 103⁄8" long. 64-053 64-040 FISH STYX — Dive sticks wiggle and wriggle to the bottom of the pool. Super flexible diving fish. Set of 3. 64-040 DIVE CHARACTERS™ — Favorite Disney and Marvel characters bring play in and out of the pool. Soft and flexible design. 3 assorted characters per package: Set of Avengers, Frozen or Finding Dory Dive Characters™ specify. 64-019 64-032 DIVE PETS — Kids will have hours of fun diving in the pool to retrieve Dive Pets. Bright and colorful toys sink when tossed into the water. Assorted characters. Set of 4. Size: 3" - 31/2" dia. 64-032 143 Games 64-075 64-070 64-015 SQUISH WATER VOLLEYBALL — Mikasa water volleyball designed for aquatic use. Soft no sting pillow cover for optimum play. Size: 8". 64-070 64-074 64-076 HYDRO BALLS — Soft Neoprene covered balls designed for use on land or in the water. Assorted colorful patterns. 64-074 Hydro Basketball, 81/2" 64-075 Hydro Volleyball, 81/2" 64-076 Hydro Football, 91/4" 64-015 64-008 HYDRO FOAM DIVE TOYS STREAMERS — Foam ball with 11" fabric tail flutter to bottom - dive down and retrieve. 3 pack. 64-015 STIX — Soft foam dive sticks 7" in length. 4 pack. 64-008 64-078 TURBINE FOOTBALL — Neoprene Maximum grip football. Double-thick synthetic laces and molded construction delivers accurate flight with balance performance. Size: 91/4". 64-078 64-047 64-059 GEYSER FOOTBALL — Dunk the Geyser Football in water and throw. Sprays water in a 10' diameter pattern. Soft foam construction. Assorted colors. 64-059 Geyser Football, 81⁄2" 64-060 64-049 WATER PLAY BALLS SPLASH BOMBS — More fun than a water balloon. Sprays and splashes while you play. Sizes: Football, 6" and Splash Bomb, 31/2". 64-047 Skim N' Splash Football 64-049 Splash Bomb, pkg. of 2 144 63-006 SPLASH –IT WATER BASKETBALL — Let the games begin with a bright water basketball. Textured surface for easy grip. Size: 9 ¼” dia. 63-006 64-065 CHAMPION GRIP BALLS — Ultimate action grip ball for water fun. Wet or dry, they really grip. Assorted colors. 64-060 Champion™ Grip Ball, 7" 64-065 Champion™ Grip Football, 81⁄2" ™ www.lincolnaquatics.com Tubes & Noodles 63-276 WATER POLO TUBES WATER POLO TUBES — Special tubes without handles to interfere with your innertube water polo games. Heavy duty 30 gauge vinyl tubes with double welded outside seams. Smooth inner seams and recessed valve stem ensures comfort for every player. Size: 33" OD x 16" ID. Color: yellow or blue. 63-276 63-175 WATERPARK TUBES HEAVY DUTY WATER PARK TUBES — Our highest performance Water Park Tubes are built tough for commercial use and designed to last. Heavy-duty, 30 gauge vinyl tubes with double outside seams, strong inner gussets, and recessed inflation valves. Contoured handles provide a sure way to hang on. Available in clear and clear tinted blue, both which allow you to see through the tubes for increased safety on those busy days. Tube Size 42" Single 42" Double 48" Single 48" Double Tinted Blue 63-180 63-200 63-190 63-210 Clear 63-175 63-195 63-185 63-205 63-077 NOODLES WATER NOODLES — A great addition to your swim programs and exercise classes. Solid foam noodle lasts longer. Size: 58" L x 2 3⁄4" diameter. Colors: yellow or blue. 63-077 63-080 63-210 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 63-180 DELUXE NOODLES — Our best noodle, made exclusively for commercial pool use. Size: 62" long. Color: blue/green. 2 Year Warranty against delamination or splitting. 63-080 145 Foam Toys 63-095 63-150 FOAM MATS & TOYS AQUAFUN FOAM MATS & TOYS — Make your facility more popular and profitable with foam mats and toys. Entertaining shapes supply hours of fun for all ages. Closed cell high density foam will provide years of enjoyment. Item Style Duck Turtle Fish Sailboat Hippo Rectangle AQUAFUN FOAM TOYS Item Name 63-124 Canoe 63-150 63-151 Airplane The Ladder 63-119 Floating Tot Slide Super Bowl 63-120 63-121 The Mini-Boat The Wreck 63-122 Serpano 63-123 AQUAFUN PLAY MATS 63-085 63-090 63-095 63-096 63-100 63-105 63-121 Dimensions 36" x 36" 36" x 36" 36" x 36" 36" x 36" 36" x 72" 36" x 72" Dimensions 78" x 40" x 29" 36" 72" x 36" 40" x 60" 111/2' x 20" 76" x 26" includes 2 paddles 63" x 58" 77" x 39" 63-119 63-090 63-122 63-151 63-110 AQUAFUN WATER ROLLS Item 63-108 63-109 63-110 63-115 Style Flat Flat Round Round Dimensions 4' x 131/2" 8' x 131/2" 4' x 9" dia. 8' x 9" dia. 63-120 63-124 63-109 63-108 146 63-123 www.lincolnaquatics.com Boards, Floats & Mats 63-075 63-311 SWIM BOARDS ACTION HERO KICKBOARDS — Kids can race around the pool with their favorite Disney and Marvel characters. Assorted styles. Size: 16"L x 11"W. 63-311 Action Hero Kickboard, each 63-074 POOL FLOATS NEKDOODLE — New foam float allows you to relax and float comfortably in your pool. Universal size. Color: blue, yellow or red. 63-074 POOL FLOAT — Soft, Ensolite, closed-cell foam float finished with high gloss vinyl to assure maximum comfort. A large, full circle pillow headrest gives extra buoyancy to the head area. Honeycomb texture on one side, smooth on the other. Extra large size: 26" x 70" x 2". Colors: bahama blue, white, orange breeze, or kool lime green. 63-075 63-050 63-305 63-310 SEA LIFE BOARDS — Lifelike Manta Ray and Turtle shapes make learning to swim fun while building confidence in the water. Design provides multiple hand positions. Color: fuchsia, lime green, sea blue or yellow. 63-305 Manta Ray board, 23" 63-310 Turtle board, 17" WATER SLIDE MATS 63-073 SPRING FLOAT SUNSEAT — Comfortable "sit-up" style allows for free floating comfort. Inflates and deflates quickly with jet valve feature. Includes carry bag. 63-073 WATER SLIDE MATS — Foam slide mats are made of a dense closed cell foam material that is extremely durable. Smooth bottom is yellow and textured top is available in a variety of colors. Single piece of material, without laminations. Size: 22" x 48". Specify color: light blue, light purple, light green, pink or orange. 63-050 63-285 WATER ENTRY LANDING PAD 63-320 WATER TROTTER FLOAT WATER TROTTER — Race across the water on your own water horse. Solid foam construction. For ages 5 & up. Size: 44" L x 17" W x 16" D. Colors: bahama blue or Caribbean coral. 63-320 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 63-076 SPRING FLOAT KID'S BOAT — Spring float boat with contoured handles built just for kids. Assorted colors. Size: 43" x 241/2". 63-076 WATER ENTRY LANDING PAD — Versatile safety pad for water slide landings, wading pools and spray park use. UV stabilized foam pad is 1" thick with 1/4" fiberglass bottom. Installs permanently with stainless steel anchor bolts, included. Custom sizes available, inquire. Color: blue. 63-285 Water Entry Landing Pad, 3' x 5' 63-290 Water Entry Landing Pad, 4' x 6' 147 Inflatable Structures 63-078 INFLATABLES GIANT SWAN — The original, famous giant swan. Looks great in the pool and great fun to ride. Big enough for two to ride. Size: 75". 63-070 63-070 SEA-SAW ROCKER — Rock your world with loads of fun with the Sea-Saw Rocker. Size: 90" x 57" x 36". 63-078 63-125 63-069 LABYRINTH ISLAND — Big time fun for all to enjoy. Inflatable Labyrinth Island adds a new dimension to swimming pool island play. Size: 69" x 69" x 18". 63-069 63-072 AIR BLOWERS & PUMPS SHOCK ROCKER — Rockin and rollin with round bottom rocker. Outrageous fun! Seating for four. Color: green. Size: 72" diameter. 63-072 63-130 HEAVY-DUTY HAND-HELD BLOWERS — Provides rapid inflation/deflation for inflatables. Available in two sizes heavy-duty and standard for lighter duty requirements. 110 volt with 2 tapered adapters. 63-125 Heavy-duty hand-held blower 63-130 Hand-held blower 63-140 INNERTUBE REPAIR KITS REPAIR PATCH KITS — Ideal for repairing tears up to 1" length and holes up to 1/8" diameter. Package contains three 3" x 3" patches. No glue required and can be cut to the size needed for the repair. 63-140 63-071 FRUIT SLICE FUN ISLAND — Inflatable island in assorted colors: lemon yellow, lime green or citrus orange. Size: 60" diameter. 63-071 148 AIR SEAL — Special "no patch" liquid plastic actually melts the vinyl together. One drop will repair pinholes in 5 minutes. A cut can be repaired with several applications. Color: clear. 63-145 63-135 DUAL ACTION INFLATABLES PUMP — Hand operated pump, fills on both upwards and downwards strokes, for fast inflating or deflating. Assorted nozzles included. Use the light duty requirements only. 63-135 www.lincolnaquatics.com Inflatable Structures INFLATABLE STRUCTURES INFLATABLE STRUCTURES — Bring the action of outdoor water sports to your pool with the new Aquaglide ADVENTURE Series Inflatable’s. You can create custom challenge courses as expansive as your imagination with these compact, modular inflatables. Revitalize your programming with Olympic-style competitions, teen/family activity nights and summer camps. There are a wide variety of exciting structures to choose from to fit any budget. With the introduction of an inflatable you will increase attendance and in turn, will increase your revenues. Structures are designed to be used at supervised waterfront areas and in your pool depending on water depth and size of pool. Even the largest structures take a minimal amount of time to inflate and deflate. Inflatables come with anchor points so that they can be fixed to a desired location. Structures are connected using Interloc System™ and Quickstraps. Swimstep XL is used as mounting platform for larger structures. 66-250 Commercial sealed air inflatable structures are made from a tough, ripstop nylon mesh bonded between two layers of PVC, to allow extreme flexing and stretching. Ultraviolet inhibitors are used to prevent fading and breakdown when used outdoors. All seams and joints are welded together to insure airtightness and durability. Structures can be purchased individually or as a set. The Track 3 Challenge Course includes: Foxtrot, Swim Step (3), Sierra and Zulu Slide. Order bungee tether lines and hand-held blower separately. 66-250 66-265 INFLATABLE STRUCTURES Item Description Dimension 66-250 66-255 66-265 66-270 66-260 Track 3 Course FoxTrot Zulu Slide Sierra SwimStep XL 55'L x 78"W x 60"H 240"L x 78"W x 19"H 135"L x 78"W x 60"H 120"L x 96"W x 44"H 60"L x 78"W x 6"H 66-260 66-255 66-260 Minimum Maximum Water Capacity Depth 48" 48" 68" 57" 48" 21 6 1 5 2 INFLATABLE ACCESSORIES Item 66-110 66-290 66-295 Description Replacement patch kit, specify color Bungee tether line, 7' Bungee tether line, 10' TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 66-255 66-260 149 Water Sports & Paddle Boards SKWIM® WATER DISC GAME SKWIM ® WATER SPORT DISC GAME — The "original water-disk sport," gaining popularity worldwide. Played in shallow and deep waters, Skwim® is fast, interactive, and fun for all ages and abilities. Using a soft hydroplaning disk and propelled with PDF™ fins, players use teamwork and swimming skills to score on opponent's floating circular goal. Skwim® Sport Systems include: Skwim® goals and Skwim® game area boundaries with rack for convenient storage. Additional team gear required: Skwim® foam disc which provides fast hydroplaning at the surface of the water for an exciting game to watch and play, Skwim® PDF™ (positive drive fins) doubles the propulsion from your legs and feet with comfort and assurance, thus enabling the average swimmer to play for extended periods of time. Ergonomic footpocket with heel strap secures fin which allows the foot to flex naturally. PDF™ fins are color coded by size for easy identification. Skwim® competition headbands in red or blue for team identification. SKWIM ® SPORT SYSTEMS Item Description # of Goals # of Disks Pairs of Fins Headband Sets 65-450 Skwim® School/Club 2 12 40 2 - 12 packs 65-451 Skwim® Tournament 2 4 18 60 4 - 12 packs 65-452 Skwim Goals Skwim® Boundaries with rack, 35' x 75' 2 • • • • • • • 65-453 ® Floating Boundaries 2 - 35' 2 - 70' 4 - 35' 4 - 70' • 2 - 35' 2 - 70' SKWIM ® ACCESSORIES Item Description 65-490 STAND-UP PADDLE BOARDS TRAVERSE STAND-UP PADDLE BOARD – Stand-up paddle boards are a great way to incorporate a new water sport activity into your summer programs. High nose rocker, thick water shedding profile and forgiving sidewalls help board glide over waves. Size: 10'L x 36"W. Weight capacity: 300 lbs. Specify color: lime green or glacier blue. Paddle ordered separately. 65-490 Traverse Stand-Up Paddle Board 65-491 Stand Up Paddle 150 Size 8c - 1 1-3 65-460 Skwim® PDF Fins, Small 3-6 5-7 65-461 Skwim® PDF Fins, Medium 6 - 8 7-9 10 - 11 11 - 12 65-462 Skwim® PDF Fins, Large 12 - 13 65-463 Skwim® Disc - Competition 65-464 Skwim® Disc - Practice, 3 pack 65-465 Skwim® Disc - Practice, 6 pack 65-466 Skwim® Headbands, 12 - blue 65-467 Skwim® Headbands, 12 - red 65-493 IMPULSE STAND-UP PADDLE BOARD — Enjoy one of the fastest growing watersports. Paddle boards can add a new dimension to your aquatic programs. Composite board with a soft top and rigid bottom. Stable, responsive and wellbalanced for paddling. Size: 11'L x 32"W x 4.25"H. Paddle ordered separately. 65-493 Impulse Stand-Up Paddle Board 65-491 Stand Up Paddle www.lincolnaquatics.com Climbing Walls CRYSTAL CLEAR™ PANELS CLIMBING WALLS KERSPLASH™ POOL CLIMBING WALLS — Climbing increases fitness levels through development of strength, coordination, cardiovascular endurance and muscle endurance. It also provides participants with positive risk taking and creative problem solving. Kersplash™ Pool Climbing Walls are modular and can be made to fit any space and deck configuration. The 4' panels attach to a stainless steel frame allowing you to customize the height and width of the wall to meet your needs. Requires a foot print of: 35" of deck space, 4' of clearance behind the wall for a walkway, 5' to either side of your wall, and 10' drop zone which is the distance horizontally from the pool wall. Pool depth requirements vary by state. Check your local codes to ensure your configuration complies. Pool depth determines the height of the wall. Available in two panel styles, Kersplash™ Crystal Clear™ offers visibility to areas behind the wall and Kersplash™ Color makes a bold visual statement with brightly colored panels. Both styles are made from UV and chlorine resistant materials. Groperz™ Hand Hold colors: red, yellow and orange. Complete Poolside Climbing Package includes: Kersplash™ Panels, stainless steel structure, Groperz™ hand holds with stainless steel mounting hardware and Kersplash™ rules and guideline signs. Panel Style Crystal Clear™ Crystal Clear™ Color Color Section Height 12' 16' 12' 16' COLOR PANELS No Climb Zone 12’ 6” Climb Zone 9’ Climb Zone Water Line Water 1-Section 2-Section 3-Section 4-Section Depth 4' Wide 8' Wide 12' Wide 16' Wide 6' 9' 6' 9' 65-500 65-520 65-540 65-560 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 65-505 65-525 65-545 65-565 65-510 65-530 65-550 65-570 65-515 65-535 65-555 65-575 16’ High 65-520 12’ High Section 65-510 65-500 151 Water Slides 25' 2" WATER SLIDES POOL SLIDES - Add fun and excitement to your pool with a new Single, Double or Triple Flume Pool Slide. Slides are available in a variety of flume and stair configurations to ensure the best fit for your facility. Slide structure is made entirely of stainless steel for corrosion resistance. Large deck and stairs feature a non-slip fiberglass walking surface. Top deck is surrounded by clear UV-protected polycarbonate panels for enhanced safety and visibility. Handrails are 1.50" O.D. which provides easy gripping for all ages. As an additional safety feature, the stairs have a self-closing gate to deter unauthorized use. Heavy-duty roto-molded flumes are available in Standard Colors: yellow, red, purple, blue, sky blue, spring lime green, green, brown and beige. Eco Colors: (with higher recycled content): meadow (green with black flakes), earth (brown with black flakes) and stone (gray with black flakes). Slides install easily on new or existing decks. Slides comply with the Model Aquatic Health Code, International Building Code and the CPSC. Deck size: 6'L x 6'W x 4'8"H. Slide height: 6' to center of tube. Item Description 65-220 65-225 65-230 Single Flume Double Flume Triple Flume Platform Height 6' 6' 6' Deck Footprint 65-230 Triple Flume TRIPLE FLUME LAYOUT 65-225 Double Flume 25'2" L x 6' 3/16" W 25'2" L x 11' 1115/16" W 25'2" L x 17' 1111/16" W 65-220 Single Flume SINGLE FLUME LAYOUT OPTIONS 152 DOUBLE FLUME LAYOUT OPTIONS www.lincolnaquatics.com 8 7 65 16 " 7 66 16 " 3 77 8 " Water Slides 3 135 8 " Water Supply Location 7 20 16 " 5 58" Water Supply Location 1 30 2 " 5 15 16 " 3 30 4 " 13 11 16 " 13 19 16 " 65-405 1 31 16 " 11 10 16 " 5 15 16 " 3 64" 127.0" 90.0" 127.0" 65-405 90.0" 127.0" 65-410 1091/16" 943/4" 943/4" more swimmers VORTEX™ WATER SLIDES — With the addition of a water slide you will attract 249/16" to your facility. Our open or closed flume slides are available with a spiral staircase or with ladder 1 /16" /16" 1091existing 109decks. designs, so you can customize to3 fit your 3 application. Mounts to Rotomolded 94 /4" 94 /4" 943/4" 943/4" flume material with steel support frame. Accommodates sliders up to 325 lbs. Overall height: 9 109 /16" 9 9 24 /16" /16" 1/16" 10'7"H, Platform height: 7'6"H, Flume length: 19'.24Includes delivery system (up to 40 109and 1091/water 16" GPM). Slide fully complies with the CPSC Safety Standard for Swimming Pool Slides (16 CFR 1207). Specify flume or gray granite. /16" 109 9/16"colors: 109 9blue 1091/16" 1091/16" 1091/16" VORTEX™ WATER SLIDES Spiral Staircase Description Open Flume Closed Flume 65-415 65-405 1091/16" 20" 371/2" 1353/8" Ladder 65-410 65-400 943/4" 20" 371/2" 1353/8" 1353/8" 65-415 90.0" 249/16" 65-210 20" 371/2" 65-205 943/4" 109 9/16" 249/16" 1091/16" 109 9/16" 1091/16" 109 94 943/4" 109 9/16" 1091/16" 249/16" 1091/16" 1353/8" 1353/8" 1353/8" 65-210 PORTABLE WATER SLIDES PORTABLE WATER SLIDES — Increase pool attendance by bringing the fun back into your pool programs. 27" diameter polyethylene tube with steel frame and powder coated finish. Slides are moveable however, they are not intended to be moved on a daily basis due to their weight. Includes: wheels and lift kit to assist in moving the slide on your pool deck and deck shoes to protect from deck wear. Optional water activation hook-up ordered separately. Specify color of slide tube: blue or yellow. Frame colors: blue or red. PORTABLE WATER SLIDES Item Description Platform Height Foot Print (L x W) 65-205 65-210 Splash Seawave 3'9" 5'6" 12'3" x 2'10" 17'7" x 2'10" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Minimum Water Depth 3' 4' Slide Length 6' 11'6" 65-213 WATER SLIDE OPTIONS & PARTS Item 65-211 65-214 65-212 65-213 Description Optional Water Activation Hook-up Replacement Lift Kit Replacement Lift Kit Wheels, set of 4 Replacement Deck Shoes, set of 4 153 1091/16" 1091/16" Water Slides & Interactive Play 65-360 65-355 65-370 POLYETHYLENE WATER SLIDES POOLSIDE WATER SLIDES — An excellent way to increase revenues and add family participation at your facility. Unique design features polyethylene “ascent” platforms for climbing slide structure. Platform decks are located with 2' offsets, in a spiral design, slide for patrons to climb the structure. Optional Slide Staircases also available, inquire. Poolside Water Slides feature: 30" diameter double polyethylene flumes, with decks constructed of rotationally molded polyethylene, and polyethylene roof assembly, both made from UV resistant resins. 4' x 4' plastic climbing decks hold up to 800 lbs. each. Structure is constructed using 80 gauge X 1.90" OD aluminum structural tubing, that will not rust. Tuff Skin post padding covers all metal pipe components for safety. Includes structural Speed-Rail® aluminum fittings and stainless steel hardware. Each water slide flume requires a water source with 5-10 GPM of flow. Check local codes for bonding requirements in your area. Available in 30 different colors - inquire. 65-195 65-175 INTERACTIVE PLAY FEATURES INTERACTIVE PLAY FEATURES — A great addition to any leisure pool or splashpad. Stand-alone spray features create an interactive play experience for kids of all ages. Many other additional features are available, inquire. 65-175 5' Aqua Dome 65-180 7.5' Aqua Dome 65-185 Aqua Arch Bar 65-190 Aqua Spout 65-195 Bucket Dump - 5 65-200 Tipping Buckets POLYETHYLENE WATER SLIDES Item Description 65-350 Water Slide, 66' 65-355 Water Slide, 73' 65-360 Water Slide, 75' 65-365 Water Slide, 54' 65-370 Water Slide, 76' 65-375 Water Slide, 77.5' 154 Slide Flume Length 66' 73' 75' 54' 76' 77.5' Tower Height 18'10" 20'10" 20'10" 20'10" 22'11" 20'7" Deck Footprint (W X D) 23'2" x 18'8" 20'5" x 16'6" 16'10" x 22'6" 25'6" x 18'0" 29'9" x 18'1" 15'3" x 24'2" 65-185 www.lincolnaquatics.com Swimming Pool Coatings RAMUC POOL COATINGS RAMUC TYPE A-2 ENAMEL — New environmentally friendly chlorinated rubber pool paint. Topcoats and upgrades existing chlorinated rubber and synthetic rubber coating systems. Single component product with semi-gloss stain resistant finish. Excellent hiding and coverage on recoats. Coverage: 400 sq. ft. per gallon. 1 gallon Colors: white #311, dawn blue #328, monument gray #362, or black #321. 5 gallon Colors: white #311 or dawn blue #328. Clean up with xylene thinner. VOC Compliant in all states. 68-001 1 gallon can 68-002 5 gallon pail RAMUC TYPE DS — An acrylic emulsion-based paint for concrete or plaster finish pools. Particularly effective on pools where down time is critical. Matte finish. Coverage: 350 sq. ft. per gallon. Cleans up with soap and water. 1 gallon Colors: white #311, aquagreen #300, dawn blue #328, or black #321. 5 gallon Colors: white #311 or dawn blue #328. Trim Colors: royal blue #329 or dark blue #303. VOC Compliant in all states. 68-025 1 gallon can 68-027 5 gallon pail 68-028 1 gallon can - Trim colors RAMUC AQUALUSTER — Premium 1-part acrylic coating produces high gloss finish. Ideal for recoating existing pool coatings, and bare concrete or plaster finishes. Coverage: 450 sq. ft. per gallon. Cleans up with soap and water. 1 Gallon Colors: brilliant white #3011, aquagreen #300, dawn blue #328, or black #321. 5 gallon Colors: brilliant white #3011 or dawn blue #328 only. 1 Gallon Trim Colors: royal blue #329, dark blue #303, brick red #315, or monument gray #362. VOC Compliant in all states. 68-142 1 gallon can 68-144 1 gallon can - Trim colors 68-143 5 gallon pail - Brilliant white 68-146 5 gallon pail - Dawn blue RAMUC TYPE EP EPOXY — Two-component epoxy coating for concrete, plaster, and fiberglass pools. Coverage: 450 sq. ft. per gallon. Colors: white #311, aquagreen #300, dawn blue #328, monument gray #362, or black #321. Trim Colors: Royal blue #329, dark blue #332, or vermillion red #314. VOC Compliant in all states. 68-035 1 gallon kit 68-039 1 gallon kit - Trim colors RAMUC TYPE EP HI-BUILD EPOXY — Provides an alternative to plaster on sandblasted, rough concrete, or gunite surfaces. High solids epoxy provides a thick coating, up to 16 mils in two coats, for concrete, plaster, gunite, and fiberglass surfaces. Self-priming and compatible with other epoxy coatings. Coverage: 250 sq. ft. per kit. Colors: white #311, dawn blue #328, monument gray #362, beach beige #355, or black #321. VOC Compliant in all states. 68-041 2 gallon kit RAMUC THINNER — For Ramuc Type A-2 Enamel, Type EP, and Type EP HiBuild. 68-045 1 gallon can RAMUC CLEAN & PREP SOLUTION — Cleans, degreases, and removes mineral deposits on surfaces prior to painting. Bare Surfaces - mix 1 gal. in 2 gal. of water, cleans 400 sq. ft. Painted/Fiberglass Surfaces – mix 1 gal. in 5 gal. of water, cleans 600-800 sq. ft. Filter Elements – mix 1 gal. in 5 gal. of hot water. VOC Compliant. 68-044 1 gallon can TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 LIFEGUARD YOUR POOL — Apply Ramuc and Nelsonite pool coatings. Recognized as the leaders in swimming pool coatings. Used on more pools than any other paints. Painting your pool will enhance its beauty, protect the interior finish from damage due to improper water balance, make the pool easier to clean and harder for algae to adhere, and will increase safety by increasing water visibility. Revitalizes older pools by covering stained, rough and discolored surfaces. Protects new pool finishes by actually “rubber coating” the interior pool lining. Makes your pool sparkle and look like new with a “tile-like” painted finish. Easy to apply and easy to maintain. Ramuc Enamel and Nelsonite paints come in different formulations, depending on the type of surface the coating is being applied to. There are paints available for plaster, concrete, fiberglass, steel and aluminum pools. It is important when painting over an existing coating that you use the same type of paint that was applied before. Send 1" x 1" paint sample and we will have it analyzed for you to be sure. Convenient square footage calculators and painting instructions are available on our website. The Application Guide covers painting your pool surface, the supplies you will need to properly paint your pool or deck, surface preparation, filling expansion joints, mixing of components, and application guidelines. Factory color selection charts available for both Ramuc and Nelsonite coatings. Confirm state VOC compliance codes for type of coating to be applied. SQUARE FOOTAGE CALCULATIONS LENGTH X WIDTH = Bottom square footage. WIDTH X DEPTH OF SHALLOW END = Shallow end wall square footage. WIDTH X DEPTH OF DEEP END = Deep end wall square footage. LENGTH X AVERAGE POOL DEPTH X 2 = Two side wall square footage. Total all of the above results for the total square footage of your pool and divide by the square foot coverage of the coating you select. This determines the number of gallons required to apply each coat. For irregular pool shapes, contact your Lincoln Representative for assistance. Before After RAMUC POOL COATING COLORS Dawn Blue - #328 Royal Blue - #329 Dark Blue - #303 Aquagreen - #300 White - #311 Black - #321 NOTE: Colors shown may vary from actual coating color. 155 Swimming Pool Coatings 69-025 69-005 68-065 NELSONITE POOL COATINGS NELSONITE SPEEDCOTE 2000 — Waterbased, single-component paint for conditions that dictate "fast-in, fast-out" application. For concrete or plaster finishes. Cures in two days. Coverage: 300 sq. ft. per gallon. Colors: white, bahama blue, lake blue, or black. 68-060 1 gallon NELSONITE POOLPOXY II — High gloss, 2-part epoxy for concrete, plaster, fiberglass, and aluminum pools. 3-6 day cure time. Coverage: 275 sq. ft. per gallon. Colors: white, bahama blue, lake blue, or black. 68-065 1 gallon kit 68-070 1 gallon - Poolpoxy Primer NELSONITE POOLPOXY HI-BILD — 2-part, high solids epoxy, that can be applied in a single coat to a thickness of 10-12 mils. For concrete, plaster, fiberglass, and previously painted epoxy coated surfaces. To coat over chlorinated rubber coating you must first prime with Hi-Bild Primer. Color: off-white. Coverage: 150 sq. ft. gallon. Hi-Bild colors: white, bahama blue, lake blue, or vanishing edge gray. 68-090 Hi-Bild, 1 gallon kit 68-095 Hi-Bild Primer, 1 gallon kit NELSONITE SOLVENT — For use with CR Pool Paint, Poolpoxy II and Poolpoxy Primer. Solvent 175 is special VOC Compliant formulation for use in California. 68-080 Solvent 150, 1 gallon 68-081 Solvent 175, 1 gallon NELSONITE PREP A CLEANER — Liquid additive used to clean surfaces prior to painting. Prep A contains no phosphates, is biodegradable, and reduces muriatic acid fumes. For use on concrete, plaster, previously painted swimming pools, and concrete decks. Dosage: 5 ounces per gallon of acid/water solution. Coverage: approx. 100-150 sq. ft. per gallon. Inquire for acid formula instructions. 68-085 1 quart NELSONITE PAINT COLORS White Bahama Blue Vanishing Edge Gray Lake Blue Black NOTE: Colors shown may vary from actual coating color. 156 SLIP RESISTANT COATINGS SAFE STRIDE — Specially formulated water based acrylic, slip-resistant coating. Contains integrated grit which provides a tough antislip surface. Safe Stride insures traction, even on wet surfaces. Colors: black or gray. Safety yellow available for additional charge. Coverage: 100-125 sq. ft. per gallon. 69-005 1 gallon can 69-006 1 gallon can, safety yellow DECK COATINGS RAMUC ACRYLIC DECK PAINT TYPE ADC Water-based acrylic deck coating. Protects previously painted, unpainted and textured concrete pool decks and walking surfaces. Resists effect of weather, water, abrasion, and pool chemicals. Acrylic Deck Paint is formulated to upgrade Kool-Deck and coat concrete surfaces. Skid-Tex Additive provides a nonskid texture to the Acrylic Deck Paint, add 1 lb. Skid-Tex per gallon. Coverage: 300 sq. ft. per gallon. Apply with roller, brush, or spray. Dries to service within 24 hours. 1 gallon colors: whisper white #471, silver creek #466, cayman sand #469, or dune shadow #463. 5 gallon color: dune shadow #463 only. 69-025 1 gallon can 69-030 5 gallon pail 69-041 Skid-Tex Additive - 1 lb. can ACRYLIC DECK PAINT COLORS 69-015 SKID-NO-MORE — Rubberized, skid-resistant latex coating for metal, wood, fiberglass and concrete. Coverage: 40-60 sq. ft. per gallon. Colors: basic neutral gray with coloring agents for white, black, wave blue, dark green, or tropical red. Use four coloring agent tubes per gallon, or color as desired. Cleans up with water. 69-015 1 gallon can 69-020 Coloring agent Whisper White #471 Silver Creek #466 Dune Shadow Cayman Sand #463 #469 NOTE: Colors shown may vary from actual coating color. 69-050 DECK SEALER DECK-O-SHIELD SEALER — Water-based sealer for natural stone, concrete, and masonry surfaces. Treated surface will inhibit the penetration of salts into the surface, reducing whitening and staining. Surface appearance after application and complete drying is virtually unchanged. Brush or spray on. Coverage: 100 - 175 sq. ft. gallon. Allow 12-14 hours to dry. VOC Compliant. 69-190 1 gallon 69-195 5 gallon WATER RESISTANT COATINGS AQUATAPOXY COATING — Two component epoxy coating. Apply on damp or dry surfaces. Dries hard, durable and water resistant. Brush or roll on. Bonds to plaster, concrete, fiberglass, tile, metal and wood surfaces. May add sand to coating mix for slippery areas. Coverage: 160 sq. ft. per gallon at 10 mil thickness. Kits net 1 quart or 2 gallons. Thinner: acetone, MEK or xylene thinner. Color: white. Other available colors: tan, pool blue, black, gray, or green. 69-045 1 quart kit 69-050 2 gallon kit www.lincolnaquatics.com Specialty Compounds JOINT FILLERS 69-056 AQUATAPOXY THICK COATING — Solvent free, 100% solids epoxy coating. Designed to be applied on damp or dry surfaces. Formulated for broad range coverage and corrosion protection. Safe for potable water and swimming pools. Horizontal surface application can apply up to 125 mils per coat and vertical surface application up to 80 mils per coat. kits net 1 quart or 2 gallons. Thinner: Acetone, MEK, or Xylene. Color: white. 69-056 1 quart kit 69-057 2 gallon kit PLASTER REPAIR 69-095 POOL PLASTER REPAIR — Plaster surface repair kit. Waterproof cement compound is fast setting, stronger than concrete and can be applied underwater. 21⁄2 lbs. covers 32 cu. in. Color: white. 69-095 10# pail 69-100 69-105 ADHESIVES AND GROUT REPAIR 69-070 PATCHING COMPOUNDS POXY PUTTY — Thick putty cures underwater. Poxy Putty will bond on most any surface wet, dry, or underwater. Can be used to patch, seal, caulk, mend or fasten. 3-4 hour setup time cures in 24 hours. Coverage: 12 sq. ft. x 1 ⁄8" per 1⁄2 gallon kit. Color: white. 69-070 1⁄2 gallon kit QUICK FIX TILE ADHESIVE — 1-part silicone adhesive. Provides excellent adhesion to ceramic, masonry, wood, metal, fiberglass, and acrylic. Cures completely in 24 - 72 hours. Color: white. 69-100 10.3 oz. tube QUICK FIX TILE GROUT — 1-part silicone adhesive sealant, specially formulated for grouting ceramic tile. Requires no mixing and cleans up with soap and water. Mold and mildew resistant; remains flexible and will not fall out of joints. Colors: white, gray or tan. 69-105 10.3 oz. tube DECK-O-SEAL JOINT FILLER — Polyurethane sealant - for cracks and behind pool coping. Available in pre-mixed cartridges for vertical surfaces and 2-part pourable grade for horizontal surfaces. Colors: white, gray, tan or redwood. 69-110 11 oz. cartridge 69-115 96 oz. kit (pourable) 69-120 Squeeze bottle DECK-O-SEAL 125 — 2-part pourable, self leveling sealing compound. For high traffic areas and submerged pool floor locations. 25% firmer than regular Deck-O-Seal. Use 2-part P/G Primer for submerged expansion joints and on cracks of more than 1" for maximum adhesion. 1 quart is sufficient for 5-7 gallons of sealant. Colors: white, gray or tan. 69-118 94 oz. kit (pourable) 69-121 P/G Primer, quart kit DECK-O-SEAL GUN GRADE — 2-part sealing compound for underwater expansion joints and vertical pool walls. Apply with trowel or air operated caulking gun. Use with 2-part P/G Primer for submerged expansion joints and cracks of more than 1" for maximum adhesion. 1 quart is sufficient for 5-7 gallons of sealant. Colors: white, gray or tan. 69-116 96 oz. kit 69-121 P/G Primer, quart kit SIKAFLEX 221 SEALANT — One component adhesive sealant for underwater expansion joints or sealing around pool coping. Colors: white or gray. 69-085 10.3 oz. cartridge 69-220 SPECIALTY COMPOUNDS MAGIC LUBE — General purpose lubricant for use on pool equipment and fittings. 69-150 5 oz. tube 69-090 THORO WATERPLUG — A cement-base, quick set, hydraulic compound which instantly stops running water or seepage through masonry cracks while repairs are being made. Also, good for repairing tile and installing bolts, posts, and socket anchors for starting blocks. 1 lb. will fill 17 cu. in. 69-090 10 lb. can TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 69-135 FOAM SEALANT BACKER — Polyurethane backer rod for expansion joints and between coping and cement deck. 69-125 1⁄4" diameter x 50' long 69-130 1⁄2" diameter x 50' long 69-135 3⁄4" diameter x 50' long AQUAFLEX UNDERWATER SEALANT Underwater repair compound. Creates an invisible, waterproof seal around returns, drains, light niches, steps, and cracks. Apply underwater or above water. Super flexible, clear compound will bend and stretch and still maintain its bond. Starter kit includes: 1 - 50ml tube of Aquaflex clear sealant, 1 - dispensing gun and 1 - static mixer tips (5). Requires use of dispenser. 69-220 AquaFlex Starter Kit 69-200 AquaFlex Underwater Sealant, 50 ml 69-205 Dispenser for 50 ml cartridge 157 Locker Systems 70-255 1-Tier 4-Tier 6-Tier PLASTIC LOCKERS LENOX PLASTIC LOCKERS — Corrosion proof and unaffected by high humidity environments. ⁄8" solid plastic side panels with 1⁄2" doors and frames. Available in a variety of standard locker sizes and styles, with custom sizes available. Graffiti can easily be removed. Locker end panels ordered separately for stand alone lockers. Locker top panels ordered separately, inquire. Optional 3" base provides toe clearance and a finished look for the lockers, ordered separately. Many new colors available, inquire. All plastic locker parts and components carry a 20 Year Limited Warranty. Sloped Top 1-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 2-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 3-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 4-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 5-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 6-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 72" Tall 70-120 70-130 70-140 70-125 70-135 70-145 70-150 70-160 70-170 70-155 70-165 70-175 70-180 70-190 70-200 70-185 70-195 70-205 70-210 70-215 70-220 70-211 70-216 70-221 70-225 70-230 70-235 70-226 70-231 70-236 • • • 70-240 70-245 70-250 Sloped Top End Panels 12" D 15" D 18" D 158 3 60" Tall 60" Tall 70-386 70-387 70-388 72" Tall 70-386 70-387 70-388 70-285 3-Tier Flat Top 1-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 2-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 3-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 4-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 5-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D 6-Tier 12" W x 12" D 12" W x 15" D 12" W x 18" D Flat Top End Panels 12" D 15" D 18" D 60" Tall 72" Tall 70-255 70-265 70-275 70-260 70-270 70-280 70-285 70-295 70-305 70-290 70-300 70-310 70-315 70-325 70-335 70-320 70-330 70-340 70-345 70-350 70-355 70-346 70-351 70-356 70-360 70-365 70-370 70-361 70-366 70-371 • • • 70-375 70-380 70-385 60" Tall 70-391 70-392 70-393 72" Tall 70-391 70-392 70-393 70-255 70-391 LENOX ACCESSORIES 70-400 3" Base 70-405 Locker numbers 70-410 Clothing hooks 70-415 Custom logo 70-420 Mesh front door 70-425 Key lock 70-430 Built-in combination lock 70-435 Coin operated lock 70-620 LENOX PLASTIC BENCH LOCKER — Tough, functional and space efficient solid plastic bench locker designed for the wet aquatic environment. Will not corrode or delaminate. Many colors available, inquire. Size: 12" D x 20" H. 20 Year Limited Warranty. Item 70-620 70-625 70-630 70-635 Bench Length 3' 4' 5' 6' # of Openings 3 4 5 6 www.lincolnaquatics.com Locker Systems STORAGE CUBBY Cubby Size 60" Tall 72" Tall SECURITY LOCKERS SECURITY LOCKER SYSTEM — Statesman LENOX STORAGE CUBBY — Open storage 2-Tier lockers are made of steel and Ambassador solution to allow patrons to put their belongings 12" W x 12" D 70-450 70-455 lockers are made of stainless steel. 3-wide neatly in their place. Low maintenance storage 12" W x 15" D 70-460 70-465 lockers with 15 or 18 openings listed. Each units are available in either 60" or 72" heights 12" W x 18" D 70-470 70-475 unit must be wall mounted or installed backwith options from two-tier cubbies to six3-Tier to-back. Finished end panels for each end of tier units. The cubby is constructed of 3/8" 12" W x 12" D 70-480 70-485 locker runs, ordered separately. Overall height thick high density polyethylene dividers and 12" W x 15" D 70-490 70-495 is 72", with base 76". Available in 15 differ1 / 2 " thick frames. Ships fully assembled, 12" W x 18" D 70-500 70-505 ent colors and combinations of colors. Lock MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE 4-Tier MATERIAL MATERIAL SELECTION SELECTION GUIDE installation process is simply securingGUIDE the choices include: coin return, coin retained, 12" W x 12" D storage cubby to a wall. Flat top end panels 70-510 70-515 BRADLEYCORP.COM padlock hasp or key only, specify. BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM ® ® ® ELECTIONcover GUIDEwhite cubby MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE 12" W x 15" D 70-520 70-525 sides on exposed ends, MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE 70-530 70-535 ordered separately. Locker top panel provides MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE MATERIAL MATERIAL SELECTION SELECTION GUIDE GUIDE 12" W x 18" D Opening Size Statesman Ambassador BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM a finished look on top of Cubbies. ® ®® Optional ® 5-Tier BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM 15 Openings BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM 12" W x 12" D 70-540 70-545 sloped topMATERIAL or recessed base for toe clearance, 70-085 70-090 ®®GUIDE ® MATERIAL MATERIAL SELECTION SELECTION SELECTION GUIDE GUIDE ® MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE MATERIAL SELECTION GUIDE 12"Wx142/5"H x 18"D 12" W x 15" D 70-550 70-555 ordered separately. Available in 17 external 18 Openings BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM BRADLEYCORP.COM 12" W x 18" D 70-560 70-565 BRADLEYCORP.COM colors. All cubbySolid openings are BRADLEYCORP.COM 70-095 70-100 Solid Lockers Solid Plastic Plastic Lockers ®Plastic ®®®white. ®Lockers 12"Wx12"Hx18"D 6-Tier End panel, each 70-105 70-110 12" W x 12" D • 70-575 ic Lockers Solid Plastic Lockers Solid Plastic Lockers Solid Plastic Lockers 12" W xcolorS 15" D • 70-585 Whether you are an owner, Solid plaStic colorS Whether Whether you you are are anan owner, owner, Solid Solid plaStic plaStic colorS Solid Plastic Lockers Solid Plastic Lockers Solid Solid Plastic Plastic Lockers Lockers facility manager, or architect, facility facility manager, manager, oror architect, architect, 12" W x 18" D • 70-595 Lenox Lockers Lockers Lenox Lenox Lockers x Lockers Lenox Lenox Lockers Lenox Lockers Lockers Lenox Lenox Lockers Lenox LenoxLockers Lockers Lockers Lenox Lenox Lenox Lockers Lockers Lenox Lockers LenoxLockers Lockers you will appreciate the low you you will will appreciate appreciate the the low low Solid plaStic colorS Whether you are an owner, n owner, architect, the low high aesthetic ic. Solid plaStic colorS Whether you are an owner, Solid plaStic colorS Whether you are an owner, Solid plaStic colorS maintenance and high aesthetic maintenance maintenance and and high high aesthetic aesthetic Solid Solid Plastic Plastic Plastic Lockers Lockers Lockers ELECTION GUIDE Solid Solid Plastic Lockers facility manager, or architect,Flat Top End Panels facility manager, or architect, Solid Plastic Lockers facility manager, or architect, value of solid plastic. value value of of solid solid plastic. plastic. Whether you are an owner, Solid plaStic colorS Whether you are an owner, Solid plaStic colorS Whether Whether you you are are an owner, an owner, Solid Solid plaStic plaStic colorS colorS 60" Tall 72" Tall you will appreciate the low you will appreciate the low you will appreciate the low 12" D 70-391 70-391 facility manager, oror architect, facility manager, or architect, facility facility manager, manager, architect, or architect, BRADLEYCORP.COM Material Material Material maintenance and high aesthetic maintenance and high aesthetic maintenance and high aesthetic you will appreciate the low you will appreciate the low 15" D 70-392 70-392 you you will will appreciate appreciate the the low low plastic. Fabricated from an advanced Fabricated Fabricated from from an an advanced advanced value of solid Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk Buttermilk Beige Beige Black** Black** Bronze Bronze Burgundy Burgundy Buttermilk value of solid plastic. value of solid plastic. Whether Whether Whether you you are you an are are owner, an an owner, owner, Solid Solid Solid plaStic plaStic plaStic colorS colorS colorS maintenance and high aesthetic maintenance and high aesthetic Whether you are an owner, plaStic colorS maintenance maintenance and and high high aesthetic aesthetic SolidSolid Whether you are an owner, plaStic colorS (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) (S202) (S202) (S205) (M243) (M243) (S211) (S211) (M226) (M226) formula of high density formula formula ofof high high density density 18" D(S205) 70-393 70-393 facility facility facility manager, manager, manager, or architect, or or architect, architect, value of solid plastic. value of solid plastic. facility manager, or architect, 100% PrC R205 100% 100% PrCPrC R205 R205 value value of solid of (HDPE) solid plastic. plastic. Material facility manager, or(HDPE) architect, Material Material polyethylene with 30% polyethylene polyethylene (HDPE) with with 30% 30% you you will you appreciate will will appreciate appreciate the low the the low low you will appreciate the low n advanced Fabricated from an advanced will appreciate the low Fabricated from an advanced Fabricated from an advanced pre-consumer recycled material, Burgundy Beige pre-consumer pre-consumer recycled recycled material, material, Beigeyou Black** Bronze Buttermilk Black** Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk Material Material Material Material maintenance maintenance maintenance and and high and high aesthetic high aesthetic aesthetic maintenance and high aesthetic (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) nsity formula of high density (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) maintenance and high aesthetic formula of high density (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) formula of high density Lenox solid plastic lockers Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic plastic lockers lockers Fabricated from an advanced Fabricated from an advanced Fabricated Fabricated from from an advanced an advanced value value value ofvalue solid of of solid plastic. solid plastic. plastic. 100% PrC R205 100% PrC R205 Burgundy Black** Bronze Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk 100% PrC R205 Beige Beige 100% Black** Black** Bronze Bronze Burgundy Burgundy Buttermilk Buttermilk Buttermilk PrC R205 value of solid plastic. E) with 30% polyethylene of solid plastic. polyethylene (HDPE) with 30%(HDPE) with 30%Beige polyethylene (HDPE) with 30% offer the lowest maintenance offer offer the the lowest lowest maintenance maintenance (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) formula ofof high density formula of high density (S202) (S202) (S205) (S205) (M243) (M243) (S211) (S211) (M226) (M226) formula formula high of high density density ycled material, pre-consumer pre-consumer recycled material,recycled material, pre-consumer recycled material, and the highest durability. and and the the highest highest durability. durability. 100% PrC R205 100% PrC R205 100% 100% PrC R205 PrC R205 Material Material Material polyethylene (HDPE) with 30% polyethylene (HDPE) with 30% Material polyethylene polyethylene (HDPE) (HDPE) with with 30% 30% lockers Material lockers Lenox solid plastic Lenox solid plastic lockers Lenox solid plastic lockers With an odor absorption rate With With an an odor odor absorption absorption rate rate Fabricated Fabricated Fabricated from from an from advanced an an advanced advanced Beige Black Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk pre-consumer recycled material, pre-consumer recycled material, Fabricated from an advanced Beige Beige Beige Black** Black** Bronze Bronze Burgundy Burgundy Buttermilk Buttermilk Buttermilk pre-consumer pre-consumer recycled recycled material, material, Fabricated from an advanced Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk Beige Black** Black** Bronze BronzeBurgundy Burgundy Buttermilk aintenance offer the lowest maintenance offer the lowest maintenance offer the lowest maintenance of nearly zero, solid plastic ofof nearly nearly zero, zero, solid solid plastic plastic (S202) (S202) (S202) (S205) (S205) (S205) (M243) (M243) (M243) (S211) (S211) (S211) (M226) (M226) (M226) formula formula formula of high of of high density high density density (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) Lenox solid plastic lockers Lenox solid plastic lockers formula of high density Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic plastic lockers lockers (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) formula of high density Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Deep Blue Desert Desert Stone Dove Dove Stone Canyon Granite Granite Charcoal Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Blue Desert Stone Stone Dove Stone Stone rability. and the highest durability. Canyon and the highest durability. and the highest durability. 100% PrC 100% 100% R205 PrC PrC R205 R205Gray* is the perfect solution is is the the perfect perfect solution solution for forfor 100% PrC R205 polyethylene polyethylene polyethylene (HDPE) (HDPE) (HDPE) with with 30% with 30% 30% 100% PrC(S215) R205 offer the lowest maintenance offer the lowest maintenance polyethylene (HDPE) with 30% offer offer the the lowest lowest maintenance maintenance (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) polyethylene (HDPE) with 30% (M244) (M244) (S215) (S203) (S203) (S406) (S406) (S400) (S400) rption rate With an odor With an odor absorption rate absorption rate With anrecycled odor absorption rate highly humid or wet areas. highly highly humid humid oror wet wet areas. areas. pre-consumer pre-consumer pre-consumer recycled recycled material, material, material, 100% PoC M248 100% 100% PoC PoC M248 M248 and the highest durability. n owner, Solid plaStic colorS and the highest durability. pre-consumer recycled material, and and the the highest highest durability. durability. pre-consumer recycled material, d plastic ofplastic zero, solid plastic of nearly zero, solid plastic of nearly zero, solid Choose from solids or speckled Choose Choose from from solids solids ornearly or speckled speckled Lenox Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic solid plastic plastic lockers lockers lockers With an odor absorption rate r architect, With an odor absorption rate Lenox solid plastic lockers With With an odor an odor absorption rate rate Lenox solid plastic lockers Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desertfor Stone Dove Stone Canyon GraniteDeep Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Dove Desert Stone Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Blue Desert Stone Stone ion for isabsorption the perfect solution is the perfect solution for is the perfect solution for colors. Lenox solid plastic colors. colors. Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic plastic offer offer the offer lowest the the lowest lowest maintenance maintenance maintenance of nearly zero, solid plastic (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) e the low of nearly zero, solid plastic offer the lowest maintenance of nearly of nearly zero, zero, solid solid plastic plasticor wet areas. (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) offer the lowest maintenance t areas. highly humid highly humid or wet areas. highly humid or wet by areas. lockers are covered a 20lockers lockers are are covered covered by aby 20a for 20Canyon Charcoal Deep Desert 100% PoC M248 100% PoC M248 Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone and and the and highest the the highest highest durability. durability. durability. 100% PoC M248 Canyon Canyon Granite Granite Charcoal Charcoal Gray* Gray* Deep Deep Blue Blue Desert Desert Stone Stone Dove Dove Stone Stone 100% PoC M248 is the perfect solution for high aesthetic is the perfect solution and the highest durability. is the is the perfect perfect solution solution for for and the highest durability. s or speckled Choose from solids or speckled Choose from solids or speckled (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) Choose from solids or speckled year warranty against rust, year year warranty warranty against against rust, rust, (M244) (M244) (S215) (S215) (S203) (S203) (S406) (S406) (S400) (S400) With With an With odor an an odor absorption odor absorption absorption rate rate rate Granite Gray Blue Stone highly humid or wet areas. ic. highly humid or wet areas. With an odor absorption rate highly highly humid humid or wet or wet areas. areas. With an odor absorption rate 100% PoC M248 100% PoC M248 100% 100% PoC M248 PoC M248 plastic colors. Lenox solid plastic colors. Lenox solid plastic colors. Lenox solid plastic corrosion and delamination corrosion corrosion and and delamination delamination of of nearly of of nearly nearly zero, zero, solid zero, solid plastic solid plastic plastic Choose from solids oror speckled Choose from solids or speckled nearly zero, solid plastic Choose Choose from from solids solids speckled or speckled by a 20of nearly zero, solid plastic d by a 20lockers lockers are covered a are 20-covered lockers are covered byby a 20under normal use. under under normal normal use. use. Canyon Canyon Canyon Granite Granite Granite Charcoal Charcoal Charcoal Gray* Gray* Gray* Deep Deep Blue Deep Blue Blue Desert Desert Desert Stone Stone Stone Dove Dove Stone Dove Stone Stone Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone is the is perfect the the perfect perfect solution solution solution for for for Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone colors. Lenox solid plastic colors. Lenox solid plastic is is the perfect solution for colors. colors. Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic plastic against is the perfect solution for (M244) (M244) (M244) (S215) (S215) (S215) (S203) (S203) (S203) (S406) (S406) (S406) (S400) (S400) (S400) rust, year warranty rust, year warranty against rust, (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) year warranty against rust, nnst advanced (M244) (S215) (S203) (S406) (S400) highly highly highly humid humid humid or wet or or wet areas. wet areas. areas. Beige Black** Bronze Burgundy Buttermilk Gray Hunter Linen Moss Red lockers are covered by a 20lockers are covered by a 20Gray Gray Hunter Hunter Linen Linen Moss Moss Red Red highly humid or wet areas. lockers lockers areor are covered covered by aby 20a 20-delamination 100% PoC 100% 100% M248 PoC PoC M248 M248 highly humid wet areas. productS productS productS 100% PoC M248 mination corrosion and 100% PoC M248 corrosion and delamination corrosion and delamination (S202) (S205) (M243) (S211) (M226) nsity (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) (S200) (S200) (M239) (M239) (M242) (M242) (M228) (M228) (S214) (S214) Choose Choose Choose from from solids from solids solids or speckled or or speckled speckled year warranty against rust, year warranty against rust, Choose from solids or speckled year year warranty warranty against against rust, rust, Choose from orgear speckled Solid plastic lockers, gear Solid Solid plastic plastic lockers, lockers, gear 100% PrCsolids R205 under normal use. under normal use. under normal use. E) with 30% colors. colors. colors. Lenox Lenox Lenox solid solid plastic solid plastic plastic corrosion and delamination corrosion and delamination colors. Lenox solid plastic corrosion corrosion and and delamination delamination colors. Lenox solid plastic lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, lockers, lockers, XL-lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Z-lockers, Red Hunter Gray Linen Moss ycled material,70-540* lockers Gray Hunter Linen Moss Gray Hunter Linen Moss lockers lockers are covered are are covered covered by aby 20by aproductS a 2020GrayRed Hunter Linen Moss Red Gray Linen Moss Red under normal use. under normal use. lockers are covered by acubby 20under under normal normal use. use. lockers are covered by a 20productS productS bench lockers, cubby lockers bench bench lockers, lockers, cubby lockers lockers (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) lockers (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) year year warranty year warranty warranty against against against rust, rust, rust, year warranty against rust, s, gear Solid plastic lockers, gear year warranty against rust, Solid plastic lockers, gear Solid plastic lockers, gear and pedestal benches. and and pedestal pedestal benches. benches. Gray Hunter Linen Moss Red Gray Hunter Linen Moss Red Gray Gray Hunter Hunter Linen Linen Moss Moss Red Red productS aintenance productS productS productS corrosion corrosion corrosion and and delamination and delamination delamination corrosion and delamination , Z-lockers, lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) corrosion and delamination lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, (S200) (S200) (M239) (M239) (M242) (M242) (M228) (M228) (S214) (S214) lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Solid plastic lockers, gear rability. Solid plastic lockers, gear Solid Solid plastic plastic lockers, lockers, gear gear70-391 under under under normal normal normal use. use. use. applicationS applicationS applicationS under normal use. by lockers bench lockers, cubby lockers under normal use. bench lockers, cubby lockers bench lockers, cubby lockers lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, rption rate lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, lockers, lockers, XL-lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Educational institutions, Educational Educational institutions, institutions, hes. andZ-lockers, pedestal and pedestal benches. Gray Gray Gray Hunter Hunter Linen Linen Moss Moss Red Red Red and pedestal benches. Gray Hunter Linen Moss Red productS productS productS Gray Hunter Hunter Linen Linen Moss Moss Red *NOTE: Photo above consists of: 3 benches. each(S200) bench lockers, cubby lockers d plastic bench lockers, cubby lockers productS bench bench lockers, lockers, cubby cubby lockers lockers productS theme parks, stadiums, arenas, theme theme parks, parks, stadiums, stadiums, arenas, arenas, (S200) (S200) (M239) (M239) (M239) (M242) (M242) (M242) (M228) (M228) (M228) (S214) (S214) (S214) (S200) (M239) (M242) (M228) (S214) (S200) (M239) (M228) (S214) Dove Starry Toffee White Canyon Granite Charcoal Gray* Deep Blue Desert Stone Dove Stone Solid Solid plastic Solid plastic plastic lockers, lockers, lockers, gear gear gear Sky Blue Starry Night (M242) Toffee* White Sky Sky Blue Blue Starry Starry Night Night Toffee* Toffee* White White and pedestal benches. ion for and pedestal benches. Solid plastic lockers, gear and and pedestal pedestal benches. benches. applicationS Solid plastic lockers, gear applicationS applicationS health clubs, food service, health health clubs, clubs, food food service, service, 5-Tier Cubbies with Flat Top Panel (M244) (S215) (S203) and 2 (S406) (S400) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) (M237) (M237) (S225) (S225) (M227) (M227) (S201) (S201) lockers, lockers, lockers, XL-lockers, XL-lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Z-lockers, Z-lockers, ettions, areas. Stone Night 100% lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Educational institutions, lockers, XL-lockers, Z-lockers, Educational institutions, Educational institutions, waterparks, locker rooms, and waterparks, waterparks, locker locker rooms, rooms, and and 100% PoC M248 100% PoC M247 100% PoC PoC M247 M247 each 60" bench Flat Top End Panels. applicationS applicationS applicationS applicationS bench bench lockers, lockers, lockers, cubby cubby cubby lockers lockers lockers sums, or speckled bench lockers, cubby lockers arenas, theme parks, bench lockers, cubby lockers theme parks, stadiums, arenas,stadiums, arenas, theme parks, stadiums, arenas, any other high-traffic and/or any any other other high-traffic high-traffic and/or and/or Educational institutions, Educational institutions, Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White Educational Educational institutions, institutions, Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White and and pedestal and pedestal pedestal benches. benches. benches. plastic and pedestal benches. service, health clubs, food service, pedestal benches. health clubs, food service, health clubs, food service, high humidity or wet area. high high humidity humidity or or wet wet area. area. (M237)and (S225) (M227) (S201) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) theme parks, stadiums, arenas, theme parks, stadiums, arenas, theme theme parks, parks, stadiums, stadiums, arenas, arenas, drooms, by a 20and waterparks, locker rooms, and waterparks, locker rooms, and 100% PoC M247 100% PoC M247 Sky Blue Night Toffee* White waterparks, locker rooms, and Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White 100% PoC M247 Sky Blue Sky Blue Starry Starry Starry Night Night Toffee* Toffee* White White 100% PoC M247 applicationS applicationS applicationS health clubs, food service, health clubs, food service, applicationS health health clubs, clubs, food food service, service, applicationS nstand/or rust, (S225) (M227) (S201) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) ffic any other high-traffic and/or (M237) (M237) (M237) (S225) (S225) (M227) (M227) (S201) (S201) any other high-traffic and/or any other high-traffic and/or Educational Educational Educational institutions, institutions, institutions, waterparks, locker rooms, and waterparks, locker rooms, and Educational institutions, *Also Also available in 100% post* *waterparks, Also available available inlocker in 100% 100% postpostwaterparks, locker rooms, rooms, and and 100% PoC M247 100% PoC M247 Educational institutions, 100% 100% PoC M247 PoC M247 mination et area. high humidity or wet area. high humidity or wet area. high humidity or wet area. theme theme theme parks, parks, parks, stadiums, stadiums, stadiums, arenas, arenas, arenas, consumer (PoC) recycled content. consumer consumer (PoC) (PoC) recycled recycled content. content. any other high-traffic and/or any other high-traffic and/or theme parks, stadiums, arenas, any any other other high-traffic high-traffic and/or and/or theme parks, stadiums, arenas, SkySky Blue Sky Sky Blue Blue Starry Starry Night Starry Night Night Toffee* Toffee* Toffee* White White White Blue Starry Night Toffee* White Post-consumer colors available at an Post-consumer Post-consumer colors colors available available at at an an Sky Blue Starry Night Toffee* White health health health clubs, clubs, clubs, food food service, food service, service, high humidity oror wet area. high humidity or wet area. healthhealth clubs, food service, high high humidity humidity wet or wet area. area. clubs, food service, (M237) (M237) (M237) (S225) (S225) (S225) (M227) (M227) (M227) (S201) (S201) (S201) (M237) (S225) (M227) (S201) additional charge. additional additional charge. charge. (M237) Red (S225) (M227) (S201) Gray Hunter Linen Moss waterparks, waterparks, waterparks, locker locker rooms, rooms, and and and % post* and Also available 100% PoC 100% 100% M247 PoC PoC M247 M247 * locker Also available in 100% postwaterparks, locker rooms, * Also available inrooms, 100% post100% PoC M247 waterparks, locker rooms, and in 100% post100% PoC M247 x® Lockers Buttermilk (M226) D IS CO N TI N U ED TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 D I D SC DISC ON DISCO T D ISCONT INDU D D IS ON IN I E I CO NTIDUSCDD SC DIS IUSE O IS O DISCO N TIN D D C C N N N TI D UISEDO T O T ISCONT N ISECON IN N IN CDOIN IN U CD T U T U D NST U EDO N IN E IN E I TCIN E N TINU D U DDISC IONNU D TI UED EDD S O UTED N E I C U D DI SCONNTEIDNDU D D ED SC O TIN ISE IS I O NTIDNUISECDODISCO DDISSCO N INDU CD N C N I C N D TI D UISEDO T O T S O T IS N ISECON IN N IN CON IN CO U CD T U T U NT U EDO N IN E IN E TIN E N TI N TINU D U D INU D N TI UED ED UED U N E ED ED U D ED D IS CO N TI N U ED D IS CO N TI N U ED D IS CO N TI N U ED ic Lockers Dove Stone (S400) Red (S214) 159 Locker & Check Bag Systems 71-056 71-076 71-081 71-082 71-007 STATESMAN CHARGING LOCKER — Spacesaving secure storage for mobile technology devices. Allows guests to rent a locker and re-charge cell phones, iPods, iPads, laptops and cameras. Left column has three charging cords to accommodate: Android, iPhone 4 & iPhone 5 cell phones. Right column has 2 – 110 volt outlets. Locker contains a total of 12 openings. Powder-coated steel construction. Includes: mechanical key locks. Colors: Inquire Item 71-007 Opening Size (W x H x D) 12" x 12" x 18" Overall Size (W x H x D) 241/2" x 72" x18" CHECK BAG SYSTEMS CHECK BAG RACKS — Economical way to store your belongings on deck or in your pool area. Check bag racks are designed to minimize space, yet store as much as possible. Check bag racks are constructed entirely of 304 stainless steel. Each component piece is welded together. The complete rack is easily assembled on site with the provided slip joint connectors and self-tapping screws. Custom labels are provided for each bag location. Specify any numbering pattern from 1 to 999. Hook holds both the garment bag and ID pin in place. Polished stainless steel option available inquire. Casters are optional on floor models. Clothing check bags not included. Item 71-061 71-066 71-071 71-076 71-081 71-082 Type Bag Capacity CLOTHING CHECK BAGS UNIVERSAL CLOTHING CHECK BAGS — Long lasting plastic mesh material designed for heavy use. Standard bags feature one main pocket and two separate pockets for shoes and miscellaneous items. Deluxe bag includes a bar that allows pants to hang neatly. Bag size: 21"H x 18"W. Color: gray. 71-055 Standard clothing check bag 71-056 Deluxe clothing check bag Size (W x H x D) 2-Tier Wall 30 74" x 36" x 12'5" 3-Tier Wall 45 74" x 64" x 12'5" 2-Tier Floor 60 74" x 72" x 26" 3-Tier Floor 90 74" x 92" x 44" Casters - set of four Polished stainless steel option 71-055 71-005 MINI-CHECK LOCKER — Space saving solution for storing cell phones, keys and wallets. Locker contains a total of 14 customer compartments. Can be mounted to a wall or sit by front desk. Aluminum construction. Includes: removeable key locks. Colors: silver, bronze or gold. ® Item 71-005 160 Opening Size (W x H x D) 6" x 5" x 81/2" Overall Size (W x H x D) 217/8" x 281/2" x 81/2" 71-071 71-082 www.lincolnaquatics.com Checking Accessories 71-170 Combination Colors Solid Colors ONE-TIME-USE WRIST BANDS — Nontransferable adhesive closure wrist bands. Can be written on for quick identification. Specify color: neon yellow, lime green, orange, aqua, light blue or red. Box of 500. 71-170 71-085 71-090 IDENTIFICATION CHECK PINS CHECK PINS — 2" long. Specify numbers required. Package of 100. 71-085 Plain 71-090 Numbered 71-145 IDENTIFICATION WRIST BANDS ELASTIC WRIST BANDS — Assembled wrist bands with brass “S” hook. Colors: red, blue, green, white, black, orange or combination of one color and white. Package of 100. 71-145 71-125 IDENTIFICATION CHECK TAGS BRASS CHECK TAGS — 11⁄8" nickel-plated brass tag. Specify: round or octagonal. Specify numbers required. Package of 100. 71-120 Plain 71-125 Numbered 71-095 ANODIZED CHECK PINS — 2" long with colored anodized aluminum tabs in red, green, or gold. Specify numbers required. Package of 100. 71-095 Plain 71-100 Numbered 71-110 43-075 FLEX COIL WRIST BANDS — Bright flexible plastic coil wrist bands. Comfortable to wear around your wrist and allows for quick whistle response by guards. Assorted colors. 43-075 71-165 REUSABLE WRIST BANDS — Plastic, wave cut wrist bands with metal snap, allow you to reuse wrist bands. Ideal for check bag identification. Color: neon yellow, lime green, orange, light blue or red. Box of 100. 71-165 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 71-130 ANODIZED ALUMINUM CHECK TAGS — 11⁄8" aluminum. Specify: round or octagonal. Colors: silver, red, blue, green or gold. Specify numbers required. Package of 100. 71-130 Plain 71-135 Numbered 71-105 NUMBERING DIES STEEL NUMBERING DIES 71-105 3⁄16" letters (A-Z) 71-110 3⁄16" numbers (0-9) 71-115Anvil 71-140 PLASTIC CHECK TAGS — 11⁄8" plastic tags. Specify square or octagon. Colors: red, green, white, blue or black. Lettered and numbered in white or black. Custom logos available, inquire. Specify numbers required. Package of 100. 71-140 71-115 71-171 HAND COUNTER HAND COUNTER — Chrome plated hand counter with instant reset knob and finger grip. Counts up to 9999. 71-171 161 Locker Room Accessories 72-002 BATHROOM PARTITIONS BATHROOM PARTITIONS — Durable plastic Bradmar partitions are an excellent choice for public and wet areas. Solid plastic material won't warp or crack and is resistant to graffiti. Available in 13 colors. Partitions are available in four different styles: floor mounted overhead braced, floor braced, ceiling hung and floorto-ceiling. Other bathroom components are available, inquire. Plastic Bradmar material is warranted for 15 years. Your Lincoln Representative can help design your bathroom partition needs. 72-002 72-005 BABY CHANGING STATIONS KOALA BABY CHANGING STATIONS — Meets ADA requirements. Durable plastic construction installs with 4 bolts. Large concave bed with safety straps and bed liner dispenser. Child protection seat, for stall mounting, eliminates the danger of leaving baby unattended. Sanitary bed liners ordered separately. Specify color: cream or gray. 72-005 Horizontal baby changing station 72-010 Vertical baby changing station 72-015 Child protection seat 72-010 72-010 72-005 72-020 72-013 72-015 BABY CHANGING STATION ACCESSORIES 72-011 Replacement strap set, horizontal 72-012 Replacement strap set, vertical 72-013 Koala Baby changing station decal 72-014 Baby changing station sign 72-020 Sanitary bed liners, case of 500 71-185 STAINLESS STEEL MIRRORS STAINLESS STEEL MIRRORS — Stainless steel unbreakable mirror can be installed with four tamper resistant mounting screws. 71-185 18" x 36" 71-190 24" x 36" 162 72-015 72-014 www.lincolnaquatics.com Locker Room Accessories 72-086 72-081 HAND DRYERS 72-125 ENERGY EFFICIENT HAND DRYERS Fast drying and energy efficient surface mounted hand dryers. Available in two models: SMARTdri™: 10 second drying time, 3-speed motor and control on/off heating options. 120 volt (208/230 volt also available). SLIMdri™: ADA Compliant ultra compact design, 15 second drying time and on/off heat control. 110-120/208/220-240 volt motors. Color: white painted steel. 72-130 Item SCALES PHYSICIAN & TRAINER SCALE — Eye level beam scale is compact, sturdy, accurate, and easy to read. 500 lb. capacity with height rod. 72-125 CLINICAL DIAL SCALE — Automatic precision dial scale. Easy-to-read dial with 320 pound capacity. Colors: white or beige. 72-130 72-081 72-086 Description SMARTdri SLIMdri Watts 1200-800-400 950 Warranty 5 yr. 10 yr. 72-100 SWIMSUIT WATER REMOVERS SUITMATE SWIMSUIT WATER EXTRACTOR Perfect solution to wet swimsuit problems. Operates without heat; 100% safe for all swimsuit materials. Spin dries to remove 95% of suit water. Includes a self timer and will shut off after eight seconds. Rust-free stainless steel and plastic construction. 115 volt with built-in GFI. Wall mounted. 1 Year Limited Warranty. 72-100 72-091 ELECTRIC HAND DRYER — High power 80 second drying cycle, low sound, and swivel nozzle. 115 volt listed (208/230 volt also available). Color: white painted steel. 72-076 Item 72-091 Description AirStyle Watts 1100 Warranty 10 yr. SHOWER SEATS MOLDED PLASTIC SHOWER SEAT — Stainless steel frame with plastic seat which contains Microban ® to help fight against bacteria. Folds to vertical position when not in use. Meets ADA requirements. Seat available as left or right mount. Weight limit is 250 lbs. Size: 33" wide x 22" deep x 31⁄4" thick. 72-076 Molded Plastic Shower seat, left 72-077 Molded Plastic Shower seat, right 72-100 72-093 72-078 REVERSIBLE SHOWER SEAT — Folding plastic laminate shower seat is made of 5/16" Melamine which secures to a stainless steel frame. Support leg locks seat securely in place. Meets ADA requirements. Seat can be used as left or right mount. Weight limit is 400 lbs. Size: 341/2" wide x 22" deep x 1/2" thick. Color: white, silver gray and sand. 72-078 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 VERTICAL HAND DRYER — Ultra quiet, high speed hands-in style, vertical hand dryer. Operates automatically with 10-12 second dry time. Includes: HEPA filter system, wide hand drying cavity, and antimicrobial technology. Dedicated water collection reservoir prevents water from collecting on the floor. Surface mounts with simple mounting bracket. Polarized plug for easy installation. 110-120 volt. High impact ABS material. Colors: white or silver. Specify. 72-093 72-105 SWIMSUIT WRINGER — Streamline design, white enamel finish. Clamp mounting only. 72-105 163 Floor Coverings FLOORING TILES 73-005 DRI-DEK FLOORING TILES — Interlocking floor tiles that snap together for easy installation. Patented design allows dirt and water to flow through the self-draining surface. Provides dry, anti-skid surface for showers, locker rooms, pools, spas or saunas. Colors: royal blue, green, yellow, teal, red, black, burgundy, gray, almond or white. Size: 12" x 12" x 9⁄16". 10 Year Limited Warranty. 73-005 Dri-Dek tiles, each 73-010 Sloped edging 73-015 Edging corners 73-059 73-041 PRO-DEK™ FLOORING TILES — Comfort dome surface provides unsurpassed comfort. Tile design allows air and water to pass through quickly and easily. Interlocking tiles with antibacterial additive. Colors: pacific blue, sunset red, rainforest green, storm black, dolphin gray, or seashell beige. Size: 12" x 12" x 7⁄16". 73-041 Pro-Dek™ tiles, each 73-042 Sloped edging, male 73-043 Sloped edging, female 73-044 Edging corners, each 73-016 WAVE™ FLEXIBLE FLOORING TILES Exclusive "wave design" creates distinctive style for wet areas. Open grid, broad slat design allows you to easily roll-up flooring tiles for cleaning. Features fungus and anti-bacterial inhibitors. Circular embossing is comfortable on your feet while providing additional slip resistance. Colors: ocean blue, light blue or gray. Size: 13" x 13" x 5⁄8". Case of 27 tiles. Sloped edging available in ocean blue only. 73-016 Wave™ flexible flooring tiles, case 73-017 Sloped edging AQUATIC MATTING — Comfortable soft texture PVC surface reduces slippage under wet conditions. High Traffic Matting features heavy density design for added durability and Lightweight Matting is ideal for locker rooms and walkways. Colors: blue, gray, sandstone or hunter green. High Traffic additional colors: chocolate brown or black. 3 Year Limited Warranty. Roll Size 2' W x 25' L 3' W x 25' L 6' W x 25' L Lightweight 1/4" Thick 73-053 73-056 73-058 High Traffic 3/8" Thick 73-054 73-057 73-059 73-041 73-056 FLOORING ACCESSORIES AQUATIC MATTING ACCESSORIES — Seam Adhesive, Seam Accelerator, and Seam Backing Strip permanently welds Aquatic Matting together. Coverage: 100 lineal ft. Ordered separately. Item 73-020 MATEFLEX III FLOORING TILES — Rubber/ polypropylene tiles provide a dry and skidresistant surface for high traffic areas. Tiles are UV-stabilized and have fungus and mildew inhibitors. Snap-lock tiles assemble together easily. Colors: light blue, dark blue, green, forest green, white, yellow, terra cotta, sand, brown, orange, gray or black. Size: 12" x 12" x 1⁄2". 10 Year Limited Warranty. 73-020 Mateflex III tiles, each 73-025 Sloped edging, male 73-030 Sloped edging, female 73-035 Edging corners 164 73-060 Description 73-061 Pro Fix 240 Seam Adhesive 73-062 Pro Fix 241 Seam Accelerator 73-063 Seam Backing Strip, 100' FLOORING ROLLS SAFETY WALK MATTING — Designed specifically for wet areas. "Z" pattern provides slip-resistant footing in barefoot traffic areas. Easy to clean. Resistant to chemicals and mildew. Recommended for indoor use. Colors: blue or wheat. 73-060 3' x 20' roll NOTE: See page 75 for WYSIWASH Cleaning Systems. 73-058 www.lincolnaquatics.com Floor Coverings 73-130 AQUA COMFORT MATTING — Designed for hard-wearing indoor/outdoor use with the added benefit of comfort that is ideal for bare foot areas. Wide-spaced grid design takes large volumes of water and quickly channels it away to maintain a stable surface for standing and walking. Built with antibacterial/antifungal protection for less maintenance. Matting is flexible and easily cuts to fit any application. Vinyl edging strip provide flexible ramping of the perimeter, attaches with cold welding paste for permanent bond, included. Matting colors: oxford blue, ocean blue, charcoal gray, forest green, mulberry red, white, or buff. Joining strips used to link lengths together. Color: dark gray. Side-to-side clips are used to join rolls together. Color: dark gray or black. 73-126 Aqua Comfort matting, 2' x 33' 73-127 Aqua Comfort matting, 3' x 33' 73-128 Aqua Comfort matting, 4' x 33' 73-129 Vinyl edging, 2" x 33' 73-124 Joining strips, 8'2" 73-123 Side-to-side clips, pkg. of 10 EXERCISE MATS COMFORTGYM PRO MAT — Contains 89% air, providing maximum comfort and protection while you exercise. Comfortgym Pro Mat is 1/2" thick and offers optimum exercise surface area. Anti-bacterial protection improves hygiene and a soft aroma which reduces odors. Waterproof and stain resistant, making them easy to clean and maintain. Includes "O" rings for hanging. Size: 2' x 41/2' x 1/2" thick. Specify color: black, orange, gray, blue or red. 73-130 1-9 mats 73-135 10+ mats SAFETY STRIPS 73-090 PRE-CUT SAFETY STRIPS — Medium texture peel-and-stick safety strips combat slippery areas. Primer and edge sealer add extra bonding power. Primer coverage: 35 sq. ft. per quart. Edge sealer tube seals 135 lineal feet of edging. Color: black. 73-090 3⁄4" x 24", pkg. of 50 73-095 6" x 24", pkg. of 50 73-10051⁄2" x 51⁄2", pkg. of 50 73-120 Primer, quart 73-125 Edge sealer tube, 5 oz. 73-140 COMFORTGYM PRO WALL HANGER — ComfortGym Wall Hanger allows you to save valuable space by storing up to 10 ComfortGym mats. 73-140 73-127 VINYL RUNNER 73-075 CORRUGATED VINYL RUNNER — 1⁄8" thick vinyl runner is ideal for heavy traffic areas and in locker rooms. Easy to sweep and maintain. Colors: brown or black. 73-075 24" wide, per ft. 73-080 36" wide, per ft. 73-085 48" wide, per ft. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 73-095 INSTRUCTORS DECK MAT — Elevate your workout by adding the ultimate deck mat with a proven, innovative design that's ADA compliant. Will not trap debris, cleans easily, resists stains and dirt and is inherently antimicrobial. Ergonomically engineered and medically proven to provide unsurpassed comfort, safety, relief, and support while you stand/exercise. Non-skid top & bottom with non-trip beveled edge that will never curl or delaminate. 7 Year Warranty. Colors: black, brown or gray. 83-350 72" x 30" x 5⁄8" 83-355 48" x 26" x 5⁄8" 165 Outdoor Furniture We have over 50 years experience in the outdoor furniture industry. Let us recommend styles and brands that have been proven to stand up to commercial use. All furniture listed below has been carefully screened and was selected because of its styling, durability, ease of handling, and pricing. Pricing represents the manufacturers wholesale price. Additional discounts may apply depending on manufacturer and quantity ordered. We invite you to contact us so we can review the various brands and styles that are available. Our representatives are knowledgeable about which products work the best in specific applications and they would be happy to review your needs with you. TROPITONE FURNITURE Tropitone is the leader in the casual furniture industry. Tropitone continually produces the most innovative furniture designs while maintaining comfort, style and dependability. All of Tropitone’s frames are made of extruded aluminum for strength and then welded, using full circumference welds. Each weld is then buffed to eliminate any rough edges. Frames are powder-coated after a three-stage, pre-wash system to completely encapsulate and seal the frame. Tropitone finishes are second to none. Virgin vinyl strapping with built-in mildew inhibitors and ultraviolet stabilizers are then used to complete the product. All Tropitone contract furniture is backed by a 5 Year Warranty. Experience the Tropitone difference! 74-015 74-025 74-020 74-025 74-095 74-100 74-015 TROPI-KAI BY TROPITONE — All aluminum frame with powder-coated finish. Tropitone’s most popular combination for club use. Tropi-Kai is stackable, distinctive, and durable. Available in 8 strap colors and 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. 74-015 Stacking brunch chair 74-020 Stacking sand chair 74-025 Stacking chaise lounge LA SCALA BY TROPITONE — Classic Mediterranean style chair and chaise lounge. Aluminum frame with powder coated finish. Chairs and chaise lounge stack for ease of storage. Available in 8 strap colors and 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. 74-095 Stacking dining chair 74-100 Stacking chaise lounge 166 Your Lincoln Representative can help you select the furniture styles and designs that are most suitable for your application. We can also provide you with frame color and fabric samples to help select the best choices for your facility. All Tropitone contract furniture is covered by a 5 Year factory Warranty. www.lincolnaquatics.com Outdoor Furniture KAHANA BY TROPITONE — All-aluminum frames with vinyl strapping. Clean, classic design that is specifically designed for commercial use. Chairs and chaise lounges stack for ease of storage. Available in 8 strap colors and 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. 75-010 Stacking club chair 75-015 Stacking dining chair 75-020 Stacking chaise lounge 75-020 75-015 74-040 75-010 74-055 MILLENNIA EZ-SPAN BY TROPITONE — Utilizes original "ribbon" style EZ-Span straps. These revolutionary straps allow for easy vinyl strap replacement. Straps can be changed in 3 easy steps. Available in 8 strap colors and 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. 74-040 Stacking dining chair 74-045 Sled base dining chair 74-055 Stacking chaise lounge 74-060 Stacking sand chair 74-065 Bar stool EZ-Span Strap System 74-070 74-085 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 74-045 74-065 74-080 MILLENNIA EZ-SPAN BY TROPITONE — Utilizes new "wave" style EZ-Span straps. These revolutionary straps allow for easy vinyl strap replacement. Straps can be changed in 3 easy steps. Available in 8 strap colors and 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. 74-070 Stacking dining chair 74-075 Sled base dining chair 74-080 Stacking chaise lounge 74-085 Stacking sand chair 74-090 Bar stool Tropitone tables and umbrellas with matching fabrics are also available for each style of furniture. See pages 174 and 175 for umbrellas and bases. 167 Outdoor Furniture 75-135 TROPITONE TABLES ACRYLIC TABLES BY TROPITONE — Aluminum frame tables with rugged acrylic table tops. Dining tables are available with or without umbrella holes pre-drilled in table top. Available in 15 frame colors. Additional charge for Premium finishes. Umbrellas and umbrella bases ordered separately. ...... 75-125 42" round table 75-130 42" round table, with umbrella hole 75-135 48" round table 75-140 48 round table, with umbrella hole 75-145 16" round tea table 75-150 20" round tea table 75-210 75-205 75-150 NOTE: Additional Tropitone table top finishes and styles available - inquire. LIDO CROSSWEAVE BY WINSTON — Commercial grade, aluminum frame is powder coated for durability. Lido furniture is stackable and available in standard frame finishes and vinyl strap color configurations - inquire. 75-205 Nesting game chair 75-210 Nesting sand chair 75-220 Nesting chaise lounge 75-215 Bar stool (non-nesting) 75-215 75-220 75-240 WINSTON FURNITURE MILAN STRAP BY WINSTON — Commercial grade, aluminum frame is powder coated for durability. Milan furniture is stackable and available in standard frame finishes and vinyl strap color configurations - inquire. 75-240 Nesting game chair 75-245 Nesting sand chair 75-250 Nesting chaise lounge 75-255 Bar stool (non-nesting) 168 WINSTON TABLES 75-250 75-245 75-275 WINSTON CASUAL TABLES — Commercial grade, aluminum frame with acrylic top. Dining tables and bar table include umbrella hole but can be deleted if not required. Tables are available with standard frame colors - inquire. 75-270 18" round side table - 19" high 75-275 42" round dining table 75-280 48" round dining table 75-285 36" round bar table - 42" high www.lincolnaquatics.com Outdoor Furniture 75-060 75-104 75-107 75-116 75-107 75-115 FURNITURE CLEANERS FURNITURE RESTORERS — Cleaner removes dirt and oils from vinyl straps, resin, vinyl coated cushions and umbrellas, acrylic or canvas. Gard removes and resists oxidation on frames and table tops. Adieu Mildew Remover helps cushions resist mold and mildew. 75-060 One for all Cleaner, 16 oz. 75-065 One for all Gard, 16 oz. 75-075 Adieu Mildew Remover, 16 oz. 75-107 75-106 75-110 75-102 RESIN FURNITURE GROSFILLEX RESIN FURNITURE — Designed for comfort and durability. All items stack for easy storage. Slip-on Bahia cushions can be added to Bahia lounges for increased comfort. Bahia Cushion colors: royal blue, turquoise, fern green, spa blue, taupe, beige, or white. Belize Sling chair colors: blue, khaki, spa blue, or fern green. Calypso Sling fabric colors: blue, fern green, sky blue, turquoise, taupe or orange. All frame colors: white. Other color choices available for additional cost - inquire. Ordered in master pack units only. Item Description Pack Size Chairs Pacific Fanback armchair 4 75-102 Pacific Fanback armchair 16 75-103 75-104 Belize folding sling mid-back chair 2 Chaise Lounges 6 75-107 Bahia 4 position chaise lounge 75-108 Bahia 4 position chaise lounge 18 Bahia lounge cushion 6 75-106 2 75-120 Calypso sling chaise lounge 12 75-121 Calypso sling chaise lounge Tables Bahia low table, 16" square 1 75-110 1 75-115 Ibiza pedestal table, 46" round 75-116 Aquaba pedestal table, 48" round 1 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 75-120 RECYCLED PLASTIC FURNITURE ADIRONDACK FURNITURE — Classic style made from 100% recycled plastic. Will never rot, peel, crack or splinter. Stainless hardware. Salt water resistant, stores outdoors year round. Contoured seats and back. Table size: 21” H x 20” W x 19” D. Colors: white, cedar or green. 75-080 Adirondack chair 75-085 Adirondack ottoman 75-090 Adirondack rocker 75-095 Adirondack table 75-100 Adirondack sand chair 75-100 75-095 75-085 75-080 75-090 169 Picnic Tables 76-086 PLASTIC PICNIC TABLES PLASTIC PICNIC TABLE — Classic 6' picnic table designed for rugged outdoor use. Recycled plastic lumber construction gives the appearance of wood without the maintenance. Top color: cedar. Base color: brown, green or black. 76-086 76-210 EXPANDED STEEL TABLES 76-087 CHILDRENS PLASTIC PICNIC TABLE — Built especially for children up to age 10. Superior design prevents tipping even when seats are unbalanced. Durable and longlasting plastic lumber is ideal for outdoor use. 48" long picnic table top color: cedar. Base color: brown, green or black. 76-087 ULTRASITE™ PICNIC TABLES — Expanded steel tables feature premium UV protected Thermoplastic Coating. Superior adhesion ensures a smooth, shiny finish. If needed, coating is easily repaired in the field. Available in Diamond and Perforated metal plank styles. Portable and/or surface mount. Heavy-Duty tubular frames with stainless steel hardware. Picnic Tables: 23/8" dia. tubing. Round and Square Tables: 15/8" dia. tubing. Inquire for frame and seat colors. Style Size Rectangle Rectangle Rectangle Square Octagon Round 6' 8' 10' 46" 46" 46" Standard Diamond 76-200 76-210 76-230 76-250 76-270 76-290 76-265 76-088 HEX PLASTIC PICNIC TABLE — Unique hexagonal table features an easy walk-through design. High durability, low maintenance and weather resistance makes this table ideal for any setting. 100% recycled plastic lumber construction Top color: cedar. Base color: brown, green or black. 76-088 170 76-290 Perforated 76-205 76-215 76-235 76-255 76-275 76-295 ADA-Single Sided Diamond • 76-220 76-240 76-260 76-280 76-300 Perforated • 76-225 76-245 76-265 76-285 76-305 76-255 DIAMOND PATTERN PERFORATED PATTERN 76-270 www.lincolnaquatics.com Benches 77-535 77-545 STEEL BENCHES SAVANNAH BENCH — Premium Collection site bench is comfortable and stylish. UV protected thermoplastic coating provides years of use. 2" x 2" square tube frame bolts together. Bench back design options: Bow Back or Slat Back. Available in portable and surface mount styles. Seat width: 15". Seat height: 18". Inquire for frame and seat colors. 77-360 EXPANDED STEEL BENCHES ULTRASITE™ BENCHES — Expanded steel benches feature premium, UV protected,Thermoplastic Coating. Superior adhesion ensures a smooth, shiny finish. If needed, coating is easily repaired in the field. Extra deep seats are 15" wide for added comfort. Portable Bench seat height: 18”. Available in Diamond and Perforated metal plank styles. Mounting options are Portable, Surface Mount or Wall Mount. All stainless steel hardware. Inquire for frame and seat colors. HEAVY-DUTY BENCHES WITH BACK Style 6' 8' 10' Diamond 6' Bench Style Bow Back Slat Back 8' Diamond 6' 77-535 77-545 77-660 8' Perforated HEAVY-DUTY BENCHES WITHOUT BACK 6' 4' 77-530 77-540 77-190 Portable 77-350 77-360 77-370 77-355 77-365 Surface 77-375 77-385 77-395 77-380 77-390 Wall 77-400 77-410 77-420 77-405 77-415 Style Bench Length 10' 6' 8' Perforated Portable 77-450 77-460 77-470 77-455 77-465 Surface 77-475 77-485 77-495 77-480 77-490 Wall 77-500 77-510 77-520 77-505 77-515 77-195 RECYCLED PLASTIC BENCHES PARKPLACE BENCHES — Distinctive 6' recycled plastic lumber bench provides years of maintenance free use. Seat width: 15". Seat height: 18”. Inquire for colors. 77-190 Parkplace Bench with back, 6' 77-195 Parkplace Bench without back, 6' VICTORIA FLAT BENCH — Rounded edges and a gently curved seat provides comfortable seating. Powder-coated aluminum frame with stainless steel fasteners and all weather recycled plastic lumber. Seat width: 20". Seat height: 17". Surface mount hardware ordered separately. Inquire for frame and slat colors. 77-655 Victoria Bench, 48" 77-660 Victoria Bench, 60" 77-665 Victoria Bench, 72" 77-670 Victoria Bench, 96" 77-675 Victoria Surface Mount Hardware Bench Style Bench Length 48" 60" 72" 96" Victoria Flat 77-575 77-580 77-585 77-590 Surface Mount Hardware 77-595 77-200 77-490 77-205 77-505 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 BOARDWALK BENCHES — Recycled plastic lumber designed for your outdoor seating needs. Seat width: 15". Seat height: 18". Inquire for colors. 77-200 Boardwalk Bench with back, 6' 77-205 Boardwalk Bench without back, 6' 77-320 BACKLESS BENCHES — Rugged recycled plastic benches built for comfort and convenience. Extra wide 19" top to handle busy locker rooms and create more changing space. Ideal for locker room, tennis court or aquatic center. Seat width: 19". Seat height: 17". Specify color: white, green, sand or cedar. 77-315 Backless bench, 70" 77-320 Backless bench, 47" 171 Benches 77-054 77-585 PLASTIC BENCHES LENOX PEDESTAL BENCHES — Aluminum pedestals with durable high density polyethylene bench will not rust or delaminate. Size: 11/2" thick x 91/2" wide. Colors: white, black, beige, deep blue, gray, charcoal gray, burgundy, teal, black speckle, desert stone or dove stone. 77-0513' 77-0546' 77-0524' 77-0567' 77-0535' 77-0578' COURTSIDE BENCHES — High density polyurethane treated with UV and mildew inhibitors. Sturdy legs can be bolted to any hard surface for permanent installation. Seat width: 15". Seat height: 17". Colors: white or forest green. 77-580 Courtside bench, 4' 77-585 Courtside bench, 5' 77-265 FIBERGLASS BENCHES 77-270 FIBERGLASS EASY STACK BENCHES — Fiberglass stackable bench is the perfect choice if you need additional seating around the pool or in the locker room. Dimensions: 18" high x 15" seat width. Colors: yellow, light blue navy blue, white, red, or black. Custom logo, lettering available, inquire. 77-260 Easy Stack Bench, 48" 77-265 Easy Stack Bench, 72" 77-270 Custom logo/lettering 77-630 MONTEGO LOCKER BENCHES — This bench is ideal for locker rooms, pool decks and anywhere you need extra space to get ready. Lightweight highpolymer vinyl material with leg guards for added stability and to protect your floor. Available in 14" seat width and extra wide 20" seat width. Seat height: 17". Colors: white or beige. Bench Width 14" 20" 172 Color White Beige White Beige 77-610 Bench Length 48" 77-595 77-610 77-625 77-640 60" 77-600 77-615 77-630 77-645 72" 77-605 77-620 77-635 77-650 TEAK BENCHES TEAK BENCHES — Solid teak construction. Supreme hardwood - noted for its high oil content, rich color and exceptional durability. Teak never requires sanding or restaining, saving in your annual maintenance costs. 76-090 Teak bench, 4' 76-095 Teak bench, 5' 76-100 Teak bench, 6' 76-105 Teak chair www.lincolnaquatics.com Bleachers, Tables & Grills 77-095 BANQUET TABLES ULTRA-LIGHT BANQUET TABLES — High strength aluminum construction of AluLITE banquet tables won’t dent, crack, warp, or split apart due to age, heat or moisture. Tables can hold up to 1,600 lbs. and are 50% lighter than most conventional tables. 8' table weighs 44 lbs. and 6' table weighs 35 lbs. 30" width. Table top finishes: silver, walnut, desert tan, or salt/ pepper. Leg color: mineral bronze. 77-0958' 77-1006' 77-075 ALUMINUM BLEACHERS ALUMINUM BLEACHERS — Heavy duty 2" x 12" seat planks and 2" x 10" foot planks are constructed from extruded aluminum. All welded frame is hot dip galvanized. All bleachers have 6" seat rise with first row seat height at 12". Meets UBC 97 standards. 3 and 4 row bleachers do not require guard rails. 5 row bleachers include gray powder coated guard rail system. Item 77-070 77-071 77-072 77-073 77-075 77-076 Length Rows 15' 21' 15' 21' 15' 21' 3 3 4 4 5 5 Seating Capacity 30 42 40 56 50 70 Top Seat Height PORTABLE BLEACHERS 24" 24" 30" 30" 36" 36" 77-079 TIP AND ROLL BLEACHERS — 3 row extruded aluminum frame with new double plank foot board. Non-marring 5” casters and rubber foot pads. Guard rails not required since top seat height is only 29". Available in standard aluminum finish for non-pool indoor use or anodized aluminum finish with stainless steel hardware for indoor/outdoor pool use. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 77-105 OUTDOOR GRILL Aluminum 77-079 77-080 77-083 77-085 Anodized Aluminum 77-081 77-082 77-084 77-086 Length 71/2' 15' 21' 24' Seating Capacity 15 30 42 48 PEDESTAL GRILL — 280 square inch cooking surface with 4 adjustable cooking levels. 3 ⁄16" steel firebox will rotate 360 degrees for convenience. Finish is a non-toxic rust resistant black paint. Support post is 23⁄8" galvanized iron pipe. 77-105 Pedestal grill 173 Umbrellas 78-063 GROSFILLEX MARKET UMBRELLAS — Octagon market umbrellas available in 7 ft. and 9 ft. diameter sizes. Includes: 2 piece, 11/2" diameter wooden pole, wood finial top and solution dyed acrylic fabric with wind vent. Umbrella base ordered separately. Available colors: forest green, khaki, sand, white, pesto, pacific blue, burgundy, or terra cotta. 78-063 7 ft. 78-064 9 ft. 78-011 78-365 78-011 UMBRELLAS TROPITONE UMBRELLAS — Available in the complete array of A, B, and C grade Tropitone fabrics. The contract umbrella is 71⁄2' in diameter with a manual lift mechanism and push button tilt. Umbrellas have 11⁄2" diameter aluminum pole. Umbrella base ordered separately. Umbrella 7 ⁄2' Contract 1 "A" Fabric 78-011 "B" Fabric 78-012 78-011 174 "C" Fabric 78-013 MARKET UMBRELLAS PORTOFINO II MARKET UMBRELLAS — Premium quality hexagon shaped market umbrella. Available in 6', 7', 8, and 9' diameter sizes. The Portofino II umbrella uses a 11/2" diameter center pole, with 1/2" x 7/8" extruded aluminum arms, with reinforcements in upper arm and lower arm. Umbrella with 98" standard pole height and manual lift. Pulley Lift umbrellas also available at additional cost. Umbrella includes aluminum frame and center pole, umbrella cover with wind vent, reinforced pocket corners and finial top. Can be used as either free standing or in-table umbrella. Umbrella base ordered separately. Available in 3 grades of fabrics - "B" grade, "C" grade, and "D" grade. Fabric grade selected for umbrella determines final price of umbrella - Inquire. Frame and center pole available in all standard Tropitone finishes. Umbrella "B" Fabric "C" Fabric "D" Fabric 6' 7' 8' 9' 78-350 78-355 78-360 78-365 78-351 78-356 78-361 78-366 78-352 78-357 78-362 78-367 78-040 FIBERGLASS MARKET UMBRELLAS — Patented fiberglass pole with solid fiberglass ribs and frame allows the umbrella to handle high wind conditions. Low maintenance versus wood market umbrellas. These six rib hexagonal umbrellas are available in 81/2', 9' and 11' dia. sizes with 1/2" or 3/4" dia. ribs. Includes marine grade Sunbrella fabrics with vent. Premium Sunbrella colors available for additional charge. 11/2" one-piece center pole with manual lift and pin insert. Standard market umbrella includes: 11/2" dia. center pole with 1/2" dia. ribs. Pole colors: white, black, wood grain, or champagne. Rib Colors: white, black, teakwood brown, or champagne. Premier market umbrella includes: 11/2" dia. center pole with 3/4" dia. ribs. Center pole and rib colors: white, black, or champagne. Wood Grain market umbrella includes: 11/2" dia. center pole with 3/4" dia. ribs in wood grain color only. Finial ball on top to match frame color. Umbrella base ordered separately. 3 Year Warranty. Item Model Size Pole Dia. Rib Dia. 78-040 Standard 8.5 ft. Premier 9 ft. 78-041 Premier 11 ft. 78-042 78-043 Wood Grain 9 ft. 78-044 Wood Grain 11 ft. 11/2" 11/2" 11/2" 11/2" 11/2" /2" /4" 3 /4" 3 /4" 3 /4" 1 3 www.lincolnaquatics.com Umbrellas & Accessories 78-075 UMBRELLA BASES PLASTIC UMBRELLA SHELL — Use with umbrella table only. Plastic base weighs 50 lbs. Colors: black or taupe. 78-075 FIBERGLASS MARKET UMBRELLAS — Acrylic fabric with wind vent, 1/2" diameter fiberglass ribs, and 1.50" dia. aluminum center pole. Pole height is 104". Heavy gauge resin parts with pulley-lift system. Umbrella base ordered separately. Frame colors: black, bronze, white, woodgrain, or silver. Available in 22 fabric colors - inquire. 78-80071/2' octagon 78-81561/2' square 78-805 9' octagon 78-82071/2' square 78-810 11' octagon CLASSIC SHADE UMBRELLAS FUNBRELLA SHADE UMBRELLAS — Giant, permanent umbrellas are designed to be resistant to inclement weather and to provide shade in areas where there is none. Internal cable and winch system with removable crank handle for easy lifting. Includes: 4" diameter aluminum pole, aluminum frame, fabric top and one piece ground sleeve. Available in 3 styles: Classic, Palm, and Shark. Sunbrella fabrics available in solid colors or alternating colors. FUNBRELLA SHADE UMBRELLAS Size 12' Dia. 20' Dia. COMMERCIAL ALUMINUM UMBRELLAS Acrylic fabric with wind vent and 1/8" square aluminum ribs. Heavy gauge pulley-lift system with 104" center pole height. Umbrella base ordered separately. Frame color: silver mist. Available in 22 fabric colors - inquire. 78-85071/2' octagon 78-86561/2' square 78-855 9' octagon 78-87071/2' square 78-860 11' octagon 78-120 Style Classic 78-115 78-120 Palm • 78-121 Shark 78-117 78-122 REPLACEMENT FUNBRELLA COVERS 12' Dia. • 78-092 78-093 20' Dia. 78-094 78-095 78-096 78-090 78-105 STEEL PLATE UMBRELLA BASES — Low profile steel plate provides appropriate weight and counter balance for large market umbrellas. Pre-drilled holes allow bases to be bolted down. Square plate styles provide increased stability. Used with 11⁄2" diameter umbrella poles. Available with 9" high sleeve for in-table use or 15" high sleeve for free-standing applications. Available in 15 Tropitone colors. Up charge for premium finish colors. Steel Umbrella Base 20" round 24" round 24" square 9" High 78-090 78-100 78-105 15" Free Standing • 78-101 78-106 Wt. 55 60 80 78-077 78-085 SHARK78-122 ECLIPSE CANTILEVER UMBRELLAS — Heavy duty cantilever umbrella design allows you to have shade without center pole being in the way. Anodized aluminum frame and ribs. Umbrella swivels 360 degrees. Folds into compact vertical position and can be removed for seasonal storage. In-ground anchor for concrete installation or base plate for surface mount ordered separately. Frame color: silver mist. Available in 22 fabric colors- inquire. 78-890 10' sq.78-900 In-ground anchor 78-895 13' oct.78-905 Base plate anchor TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 PALM78-121 GROSFILLEX PORTABLE UMBRELLA BASE 84 lb. cement filled umbrella base with wheels. 16" high sleeve that is adjustable for 1" to 2" poles. Colors: bronze, white, or sand. 78-077 TROPITONE IN-GROUND SLEEVE — Securely anchors umbrellas in deck or lawn areas. Requires use of a concrete footing for anchor security. Includes: threaded anchor cap and sleeve with drilled collar for lock or bolt installation (lock or bolt not included). Order umbrellas with 12" extra length on center pole to compensate for depth of anchor. 78-08511/2" diameter sleeve 78-086 2" diameter sleeve 78-08721/2" diameter sleeve 175 Shade Structures ULTRASHADE SHADE STRUCTURES — Engineered to withstand wind gusts of up to 90 mph with fabric in place and up to 150 mph with fabric removed. Powder coated steel frames are pre-galvanized for long term corrosion resistance. Aircraft quality galvanized cables provide fabric tension and fabric anchorage. Fabrics are mildew and rot resistant and will maintain their color in all weather conditions. Seams are with Gore Tenara UV stabilized thread. Provides 97% UV blockage and 91% shade resulting in temperature reductions of up to 30 degrees. Mesh shade fabric provides free airflow, allowing hot air to escape from under the structure. Available in standard structure styles listed below. Additional styles, sizes, and eave heights available - inquire. 10 Year Warranty. HIP RECTANGLE SHADE STRUCTURES Item 78-400 78-405 78-410 78-415 78-420 78-425 78-430 78-435 78-440 78-445 78-450 Size 8' x 10' 10' x 18' 12' x 20' 16' x 20' 18' x 24' 20' x 25' 30' x 40' 20' x 25' 20' x 30' 20' x 40' 30' x 40' Eave Height 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. SQUARE SHADE STRUCTURES Item 78-500 78-505 78-510 78-515 78-520 78-525 78-530 78-535 78-540 78-545 78-550 78-555 78-560 78-565 Size 10' x 10' 12' x 12' 14' x 14' 16' x 16' 18' x 18' 20' x 20' 30' x 30' 10' x 10' 12' x 12' 14' x 14' 16' x 16' 18' x 18' 20' x 20' 30' x 30' Eave Height 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 8 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. 10 ft. Hip Rectangular Square Standard Cantilever Triangle Sail Hip Double Dome Double Cantilever Dome T-Cantilever Multiple Sails PORTABLE SHELTERS 78-130 176 PORTABLE SHELTERS — Sets up in less than 60 seconds. Aluminum telescoping legs extend and snap into place. No tools required. Folds compactly for easy storage. Excellent for swim meets, tennis matches, and parties. Side walls, clear panels, carrying bags, and custom lettering optional. Red, blue, black, white, and custom colors available. 78-125 8' x 8' 78-130 10' x 10' 78-135 10' x 15' 78-140 10' x 20' 78-130 www.lincolnaquatics.com Outdoor Accessories HAMMOCKS OUTDOOR MISTING SYSTEM OUTDOOR MISTING SYSTEM — 6 nozzle mist kit provides 12' of mist coverage and assembles in minutes. Can cool hot areas as much as 20° and is expandable up to 150'. System operates best with water pressure above 40 PSI. Maintenance kit with in-line filter, auto drain valve, nozzle cleaner, and brush ordered separately. 78-185 Outdoor misting system, 6 nozzle 78-190 Slip-Lok fitting with nozzle, pkg. of 3 78-195 Tubing sections, 2' 78-200 Hanging clamps, 3⁄8", pkg. of 5 78-205 Maintenance kit 78-171 OUTDOOR PATIO HEATERS — Portable radiant patio heater heats a 10' to 15' diameter circle. 40,000 BTU heat output. Heater will run up to 15 hours on standard 20 lb. propane cylinder. Self contained "Piezo" ignition. Heaters include automatic safety tip-over device. Base cover allows propane cylinder to be hidden from view. Available in commercial grade stainless steel. Size: 90" high with 34" dia. aluminum reflector top. Includes: regulator, hose, and wheel kit for portability. 20 lb. propane cylinder (not included). UL Listed and CSA Approved. 78-171 Stainless patio heater, propane 78-150 PAWLEY’S ISLAND ROPE HAMMOCKS — 54" x 82" hammock body size, 100% cotton twill rope with oak staves. 34" x 16" pillow and steel hammock stand ordered separately. Stand and pillow color: forest green. 78-150 Pawley's Island Rope hammock 78-155 Deluxe hammock pillow 78-160 Steel hammock stand 79-105 ASH TRAYS AND STANDS DURAMOLD SAND URNS — Rugged polyethylene base with chrome bowl. Size: 111⁄2" dia. x 191⁄2" H. Color: Black with chrome bowl. 79-105 78-185 78-175 OUTDOOR HEATING SYSTEMS TABLE TOP HEATER — Portable table top radiant heater heats up to 7' diameter circle. Adjustable heat output from 7,000 - 11,000 BTU, will run up to 3 hours. Fully integral Piezo ignition control valve with stainless steel weighted base. ODS safety pilot and automatic safety tip-over device. Size: 36" high with 14" dia. base and 21" dia. aluminum reflector top. Operates on 16.4 oz. propane cylinder (not included). UL Listed and CSA approved. 78-175 Table top heater, propane TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 VERSA HEAT RADIANT HEATERS — Creates circular heating zone which allows you to provide spot heat where you want it. 1,500 watt unit has 71/2 ft. mounting height and produces heat to 6' diameter circle. 3,000 watt unit has 11 ft. mounting height and produces heat to 81/2' diameter circle. Available as wall mount units, portable unit with stand, or portable pedestal unit. Low cost to operate. Allows you to warm people and not buildings. Will increase temperature by 15 degrees and is not affected by wind. Great for divers, kids in lessons, and anywhere people complain of being cold. Electric. Natural gas/LP units also available. 78-220 Versa Heat Wall Mount, 1500 watt 78-225 Versa Heat Wall Mount, 3000 watt 78-230 Versa Heat Wall Mounting Kit 78-235 Versa Heat Portable, 1500 watt 78-240 Versa Heat Pedestal, 1500 watt 79-185 79-195 79-175 ULTRA SMOKE STOP — Polyethylene smoking receptacle with galvanized steel pail, catches all cigarettes and is easily cleaned. Colors: Santa Fe - Cactus green with terra cotta base. Classic - beige or gray. Size: 41" H x 14" Diameter. 79-175 Ultra Smoke Stop - Santa Fe 79-185 Ultra Smoke Stop - Classic Beige 79-195 Ultra Smoke Stop - Classic Gray 177 Trash Containers RECYCLED PLASTIC TRASH CONTAINERS 79-110 HEX WASTE RECEPTACLE — Recycled plastic lumber in hexagonal shape dresses up your old 55 gallon drums. Use for indoor or outdoor locations. Size: 34" H x 31" dia. Ships fully assembled. Colors: cedar/green or cedar/brown. 79-110 Hex waste receptacle 79-130 RECYCLING CENTER — Offers easiest way to accommodate recycling. Available as 2 barrel, 3 barrel, or 4 barrel units. Ships fully assembled with cedar, gray, or hunter green recycled plastic lumber slats, and brown post with white/green or beige/green signs. Specify signage needs: Plastic, Trash, Paper, Cans, Glass or others as required. 79-125 Recycling Center, 2 barrel 79-130 Recycling Center, 3 barrel 79-135 Recycling Center, 4 barrel 79-075 79-080 GLUTTON TRASH CONTAINER — Rugged polyethylene base and plastic top available with or without doors. 56 gallon capacity. Size: 251⁄2" W x 223⁄4" D x 311⁄8" H. Base colors: brown and cream; top colors: brown and red. 79-075 56 gallon base 79-080 Hooded top with doors 79-085 Hooded top without doors SLANT TOP RECEPTACLE — Recycled plastic lumber slats with granite textured molded top. Includes hinged lid, locks, and heavy duty liner. Choice of recycling graphics: Trash, Plastic Bottles, Aluminum Cans, or Paper. Colors: Oatmeal or Gray Granite. Choice of 12 different slat colors. Fully assembled. Also available as a Recycling Center - inquire 79-122 Slant top receptacle 178 STEEL TRASH CONTAINERS 79-097 POLYETHYLENE TRASH CONTAINERS 79-122 79-145 AMERICANA WASTE RECEPTACLES — Rugged receptacle constructed of 2" welded steel slats. Available in 2 sizes: 24 gallon 251⁄2" H x 251⁄2" dia. and 36 gallon - 321⁄2" H x 29" dia. Includes: Removable leakproof rigid plastic liner, 4 leg levelers for uneven surfaces, and cable secured top. Anchoring kit ordered separately. Colors: black or architectural bronze. 79-140 Waste receptacle, 24 gallon 79-145 Waste receptacle, 36 gallon 79-150 Americana anchoring kit 79-120 ROUND WASTE RECEPTACLE — Recycled plastic lumber will function indoors or outdoors. Completely assembled with dome lid, durable and reusable woven polypropylene fabric liner, and anchoring brackets. Size: 36" H x 18" dia. Slat Colors: cedar, gray or hunter green. Lid Colors: hunter green or black. 79-120 Round receptacle with dome lid LANDMARK SERIES TRASH CONTAINER Large opening funnels refuse into container and out of view. Hood is hinged and includes a stay open trap for easy access to rigid liner. Container color: Sable. Size: 26" square x 301⁄2" H (35 gal.) Includes Rigid Liner. Aggregate panels ordered separately. Panel Colors: Brownstone, Riverrock, and Coral. 79-155 35 gallon 79-160 Aggregate panels, set of 4 79-165 Rigid liner for 35 gallon MARSHAL TRASH CONTAINERS — Rugged polyethylene base and top combines good looks and fire safety. Factory Mutual and California State Fire Marshal approved for fire safety. 15 gallon size: 153⁄8" dia. x 361⁄2" high. 25 gallon size: 18" dia. x 42" high. Rigid liner ordered separately. Colors: beige, brown, and cream. 79-096 15 gallon 79-097 25 gallon 79-098 Rigid liner, 15 gallon 79-099 Rigid liner, 25 gallon 79-205 79-210 79-220 79-225 EXPANDED STEEL TRASH CONTAINERS EXPANDED STEEL TRASH CONTAINERS — Patented TopCoat process adds brilliant color, enhances durability, and reduces maintenance. Plastisol coating resists fading and staining for years of maintenance free use. Available in 2 sizes: 32 gal. and 22 gal., with expanded metal flat tops. Replaceable black plastic liners ordered separately. Available in 11 standard colors-inquire. 79-205 32 gal. receptacle, 30" x 24" 79-210 32 gal. flat top, 21/8" x 25" 79-215 32 gal. plastic liner, 27" x 213/8" 79-220 22 gal. receptacle, 26" x 21" 79-225 22 gal. flat top, 2" x 22" 79-230 22 gal. plastic liner, 221/2" x 191/32" www.lincolnaquatics.com Specialty Equipment 80-010 80-001 CLOCKS & THERMOMETERS LINCOLN WALL CLOCK — Durable plastic lens with high impact case features easy to read numbers. 12" diameter. AA battery not included. 80-001 AIR THERMOMETER — Bold face, wallmounted 18" air thermometer. Easy-to-read black numbers on white face. Plastic lens with aluminum case. Temperature range -60° to 120°F. 80-010 80-120 PING PONG ACCESSORIES 80-005 BOLD-FACE CLOCK — Wall-mounted, 18" battery-operated quartz clock. White face with bold black numbers makes it easy to read from a distance. Plastic lens with aluminum case. AA battery not included. 80-005 PING PONG BALL DISPENSER — A convenient way to make Ping Pong balls available all day long, without interruptions. .25¢ slot holds 144 balls. Allows you to generate income for your facility. Balls not included. 80-120 Ping Pong ball dispenser 80-125 Dispenser stand, 27" 80-130 Dispenser globe 80-135 Extra key for dispenser 80-107 CORNILLEAU TABLE TENNIS TABLES — Designed for commercial use. Anti-glare table top will resist the blows from table tennis rackets and remain colorfast in all weather conditions. Galvanized steel frame with resincoated galvanized steel legs for increased stability. Racket and ball storage and 6" double wheel casters for easy mobility. Folding units allow for playback position for individual practice. Sport Series folding table includes a polyester net with tension and height adjustment. Pro Series tables are available in folding and stationary styles and feature a permanent tamper-proof steel net. Optional polyester cover protects table when not in use. Specify color: Sport - blue or grey. Pro - blue. Item Description Style Cover 80-105 Sport 250 Outdoor Folding 80-109 Folding 80-109 80-106 Pro 540 Outdoor • 80-107 Pro 510 Outdoor Stationary Tacteo 30 paddles, each 80-110 80-106 80-090 PING PONG TABLES 80-006 EASEL CLOCK — Collapsible and portable for convenient placement anywhere. Features a large 18" atomic clock and recycled plastic frame. AA battery not included. Specify color: green/white, black/white, tan/green or white/ green. 80-006 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 PING PONG TABLE — The last Ping Pong Table you will ever have to buy. Fiberglass coated honeycomb core top with 11⁄4" diameter 14 gauge galvanized steel frame. For rugged public use. Almost indestructible. Can leave outside in any weather. Table conveniently folds up and wheels around for easy storage. One side also can fold up for individual playback. Nylon net with holders included. 80-090 Ping Pong Table 80-091 Replacement swivel casters, each 80-105 179 Specialty Equipment 57-180 57-185 80-025 VOLLEYBALL NETS — Rubberized 24 thread nylon. 1⁄4" manila rope, 2" vinyl top binding. 80-025 27' x 3' 80-030 30' x 3' 80-035 32' x 3' NETS BADMINTON NETS — 100% nylon net 1" square mesh, 2" top binding of vinyl coated nylon for good vision. 80-040 20' x 21⁄2' 80-045 21' x 21⁄2' 57-175 57-185 OUTDOOR DISPLAY BOARD OUTDOOR DISPLAY BOARD — Weatherproof recycled plastic exterior outdoor display message board is a great way to let your patrons know what's going on at your facility. Cork display area allows for flexibility of keeping information up to date. Available in three sizes to best fit your facility needs. Please note that exterior dimension is slightly larger than interior dimension listed. Sign can easily be mounted on a building or wall. Outdoor display board has many optional features to fit your facility needs. Fence attachment kit allows you to attach sign to any chain-link fence. Post attachment kit includes: 2' x 8' recycled plastic posts and hardware. Custom facility header sign available in one or two lines of text. Sliding door lock keeps your postings safe and secure. Colors: white, light brown, dark green or black. Item 57-175 57-180 57-181 Description Small Medium Large Size 20.5"W x 22.5"H 44.5"W x 22.5"H 44-5"W x 29.5"H Outdoor Display Board Options 57-185 57-190 57-195 57-200 57-205 80-050 TENNIS NETS — Commercial grade, 3mm braided polyester netting. 42' x 31⁄2'. 22 oz. nylon top-binding with 47' galvanized aircraft cable. 80-050 Custom Sign, One Line Custom Sign, Two Lines Sliding Door Lock Fence Attachment Kit Post Attachment Kit 80-175 SAFETY FENCING MESH SAFETY FENCING — A convenient way to help keep kids from getting access to your pool. Poly-coated open-weave, mildewresistant, black mesh fabric, offers high tensile strength and UV stability. Won't rip, stretch or fade. Features reliable self-closing, selflatching gate with powerful magnet. 30" wide gate is key lockable. Installation is based on a tensioning system with anchors that are drilled into deck. Fence rolls up for easy storage when not in use. Available in either 41/2' or 5' heights. Fiberglass poles are 10% lighter than aluminum poles. Aluminum poles are the strongest poles available. Sections are 10' long with 30" pole spacing for additional security. Includes installation hardware. Gate available in aluminum only, ordered separately. Section 57-181 180 57-190 Fiberglass Pole 41/2'H 5'H 10' Long 80-175 80-180 Self-Latching Gate, 30" wide Aluminum Pole 41/2'H 5'H 80-185 80-190 80-195 80-200 80-055 80-060 TENNIS ACCESSORIES WINDSCREEN — Sun and windscreen made of polypropylene which will not shrink. Finished with edging, rope and grommets every 12" on all four sides. Optional horizontal center tape with grommets every 12" provides additional tie down protection. Hog ring attachments are used to secure windscreen to the fence. 1 lb. covers 100 square feet of windscreen. Open mesh allows for more light and wind to pass through than the solid closed mesh version. Windscreen is 6' high. 80-055 Open mesh 80-060 Closed mesh 80-065 Center tape with grommets 80-070 Wind vent 80-075 Hog rings (per lb.) www.lincolnaquatics.com Specialty Equipment 80-220 POOL SHOWER — Stainless steel free standing showers are ideal for public facilities. ADA compliant. Installs on any outdoor surface. Connects to 1/2" water supply line. Includes anchor bolts. Available with hot and cold valve or cold water only valve. 6" CPB shower head. 82" H. 80-230 80-202 Style Shower Only Hose Bib Hose Bib & Foot Shower Hose Bib & Drinking Fountain 80-201 80-250 80-240 Cold Water Hot & Cold Water 80-295 • 80-280 80-285 80-290 80-300 • • OUTDOOR SHOWERS 80-203 WATER STATIONS WATER BOTTLE FILLER STATIONS — Designed to be a convenient station to refill reusable water bottles with filtered water. Polyester powder coat finish, aluminum gravity filler spout, push-button valve and replaceable inline water filter. Available in two styles: Single Pedestal with optional surface mounting plate for new construction and Wall Mount with optional support with mounting plate (recommended). Chiller not included. Colors: inquire. Style Water Bottle Filler Station Support w/ Mounting Plate Mounting Plate Replacement Filter Single Pedestal Wall Single with Mounted Pedestal Drinking Fountain 80-201 80-202 80-203 • • 80-204 80-205 80-205 • 80-206 80-206 80-206 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 OUTDOOR SHOWERS — Versatile outdoor showers offer various combinations of shower, foot shower, and wheel chair accessible showers to best fit your facility needs. Designed for recreational areas, beaches or water parks. The outdoor shower helps maintain a cleaner facility and provide user comfort. Column is a one piece steel pipe with powder coat finish. Timer controlled water control valves. Available in bury in-ground or surface mount styles. Optional hose bib available in three styles: compression type for easy access to hose, key type hose bib for access with those who have key only, or compression type hose bib with vandal-proof locking cover. Inquire for stainless steel option. Color: blue. Style Shower/Foot Shower Dual Shower/Foot Shower Shower/Foot Shower Wheelchair Accessible Shower/Foot Shower Drinking Fountain 80-260 80-265 80-270 Surface InMount Ground 80-220 80-230 80-225 80-235 80-240 80-245 80-250 80-255 Hose Bib Option Styles Compression type Key type Locking cover w/recessed hose bib DECK ENCLOSURES SHOWER/CHANGING ENCLOSURES — Modular shower or changing enclosure for pool side use. Pre-assembled vinyl panels, powder coated aluminum frame hardware. Keyed aluminum latch with dead bolt. Easy to assemble. Color: (frame) white; (panels & door) white or tan. Shower ordered separately. Style With Floor With Floor & Roof 80-345 80-350 80-355 Double Options 80-320 80-330 Single 80-325 80-335 Corner Bench Free Standing Bench Towel Bar 181 Aquatic Accessibility 81-070 81-721 PORTABLE AQUATIC LIFTS PAL PORTABLE AQUATIC LIFT — Completely portable, free-standing PAL is the perfect accessory for any commercial aquatic facility. Maximum deck-to-water level distance is 12". In addition to the standard configuration, the PAL lift is also available in Hi/Lo and Spa versions. 240º rotation ensures a safe transfer. Powder coated stainless steel and aluminum construction. Powered by a 24-volt rechargeable battery. Available with Standard LiftOperator intelligent control or LiftOperator with activation key to prevent unauthorized use of lift. Includes: Anchor Secure-it Kit which allows the lift to be fixed to the deck without the need for bonding, battery charger, battery cover, waterproof remote, foot rest and seat belt. Lifting capacity: 300 lbs. ADA Compliant. Model PAL Portable Aquatic Lift PAL Portable Aquatic Lift with armrests PAL Kit with cover & spineboard attachment PAL Calif. package with cover, spineboard attachment and armrest assembly PAL Spa PAL Hi/Lo PAL Hi/Low with armrests Lift Operator Deck-toSet Lift with Water Back Operator Activation Level Key 81-043 81-720 16"-24" 0" 81-721 81-728 16"-24" 0" 81-726 81-727 16"-24" 0" 81-226 81-729 16"-24" 0" 81-229 81-225 81-723 81-725 81-722 81-724 16"-24" 16"-28" 16"-28" 0" 0" 0" PORTABLE ASPEN/FREEDOM AQUATIC LIFT — Small footprint Portable Aquatic Lift for facilities with in-ground pools or spas. 6 points of contact with pool deck for added stability when in use. Optional Locking Anchor Retrofit Kit anchors your lift securely to the deck for ADA Compliance, ordered separately. Both lifts include: battery, battery charger and seat belt. Portable Aspen Lift includes: (2) 5-button remotes, adjustable swing out foot rest, removable armrests and padded head rest. Locking anchor for ADA compliance ordered separately. Portable Freedom Lift includes (1) 5-button remote and stationary foot rest. ADA Compliant. Item Model 81-070 81-071 Portable Aspen Portable Freedom Set Back 6"-22" 6"-22" Item 81-074 81-074 Description Lift Cover Armrest Assembly Head Rest Pad Seat Belt Battery Battery Charger 5- Button Remote ADA Lift Available Sign 81-068 81-073 81-015 81-039 81-308 81-307 81-077 45-109 PAL 2 AQUATIC LIFT — Portable Aquatic Lift 2 (PAL 2) places the Lift Operator intelligent control and battery on the mast. Powder coated stainless steel and aluminum construction. Available with Standard LiftOperator intelligent control or LiftOperator with activation key to prevent unauthorized use of lift. Includes: Anchor Secure-it Kit which allows the lift to be fixed to the deck without the need for bonding, battery charger, battery cover, waterproof remote, foot rest and seat belt. Lifting capacity: 300 lbs. Color: gray mist. ADA Compliant. Lift Operator PAL 2 Aquatic Lift 81-740 PAL 2 Aquatic Lift with armrests 81-742 182 12" max. 12" max. Locking Anchor Kit PORTABLE ASPEN/FREEDOM AQUATIC LIFT OPTIONS Model 81-742 Deck-toWater Level Lift Operator Set with Back Activation Key 81-741 81-743 16"-24" 16"-24" Deck-toWater Level 0" 0" NOTE: Set-back dimensions on this page reflect a 0" deck-to-water level dimension. Set-backs will vary according to your actual deck-to-water level height. Visit www.lincolnaquatics.com for a pool lift set-back chart. www.lincolnaquatics.com Aquatic Accessibility Splash Lifts Splash Lift 81-220 81-750 Splash Lift with 81-751 81-752 armrests Splash Kit with 81-222 81-763 cover and caddy Splash Calif. Pkg. with cover, 81-223 81-765 caddy and armrests Splash Spa Lifts Splash Spa 81-756 81-757 Spa with armrests 81-758 81-759 Splash Hi/Lo Lifts Splash Hi/Lo 81-221 81-753 Hi/Lo with armrests 81-754 81-755 Splash Extended Reach Lifts Splash Extended 81-231 81-760 Reach (ER) Splash ER with 81-761 81-762 armrests Splash ER Kit with 81-766 81-767 cover and caddy Splash ER Calif. Pkg. with cover, 81-768 81-769 caddy and armrests Splash ER Hi/Lo 81-232 81-770 Splash ER Hi/Lo 81-771 81-772 with armrests 16" - 29" 16" - 29" 16" - 29" 16" - 29" 16" - 29" 16" - 29" 16" - 34" 16" - 34" 16" - 46" 16" - 46" 16" - 46" 16" - 46" 16" - 50" 16" - 50" TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 aXs Lift aXs Lift with armrests aXs Lift with caddy aXs Lift with armrests and caddy Set Back Lift Operator with Activation Key Lift Operator AXS AQUATIC LIFT — A low profile aquatic lift. Maximum deck-to-water level distance is 8". 360° rotation ensures a safe transfer area. Powder coated stainless steel and aluminum construction. Powered by a 24-volt rechargeable battery. LiftOperator Intelligent Control System available in two styles: standard or with activation key to prevent unauthorized use of lift. Includes stainless steel locking deck anchor, with cap, charger, seat belt and battery cover. Lifting capacity: 300 lbs. ADA Compliant. 81-275 81-285 16" - 25" 81-272 81-273 16" - 25" 81-286 81-287 16" - 25" Set Back 81-272 Description Set Back Lift Operator w/ Activation Key Description Lift Operator SPLASH AQUATIC LIFT — Maximum deckto-water level distance is 12". The Splash lift is also available in Hi/Lo, Spa and Extended Reach versions. 359° rotation ensures a safe transfer area. Powder coated stainless steel and aluminum construction. Powered by a 24-volt rechargeable battery. LiftOperator Intelligent Control System available in two styles: standard or with activation key to prevent unauthorized use of lift. Includes stainless steel locking deck anchor with cap, charger, seat belt, and battery cover. Lifting capacity: Splash Aquatic Lifts 400 lbs., Splash Extended Reach versions 300 lbs. ADA Compliant. Lift Operator 81-751 SEMI-PORTABLE LIFTS 81-783 ML300 AQUATIC LIFT — New economical aquatic lift that is ideal for a wide range of pool applications. Maximum deck-towater level distance is 8". Right or left side mounting allows for versatile location on the deck. Powder coated stainless steel and aluminum construction. Powered by a 24-volt rechargeable battery. Includes Lift Operator Intelligent Control System, 4 anchor bolts with inserts, anchor jig, seat belt and battery cover. Lifting capacity 300 lbs. ADA Compliant. 81-781 12.5" - 17" 81-782 12.5" - 17" 81-783 12.5" - 17" 81-784 12.5" - 17" Description ML300 ML300 without anchor ML300 with armrest ML300 with armrest without anchor 81-288 81-289 16" - 25" S.R. SMITH LIFT PARTS Description Secure-It-Kit Locking anchor with cap Locking anchor cap only Flush deck anchor kit Lift Cover, operable position Mast Cover Battery Cover Seat Cover Lift Caddy Armrest assembly Foot rest without hardware Foot rest with hardware Spine board attachment Stability vest Seat belt SR Smith pool/spa lift available sign PAL/PAL 2 Splash 81-230 • • • 81-040 • 81-227 81-264 • 81-235 81-240 81-241 81-245 81-250 81-255 45-033 81-233 81-270 81-271 • 81-040 81-260 81-228 81-264 81-265 81-235 81-240 81-241 81-245 81-250 81-255 45-033 aXs • 81-270 81-271 • 81-294 • 81-279 81-264 81-278 81-276 • • 81-245 81-250 81-284 45-033 MultiLIFT • • • 81-816 81-817 • 81-813 81-264 • 81-235 81-240 81-241 • 81-250 81-255 45-033 NOTE: Set-back dimensions on this page reflect a 0" deck-to-water level dimension. Set-backs will vary according to your deck-to-water level height. Visit www.lincolnaquatics.com for a pool lift set-back chart. 183 Aquatic Accessibility 81-065 Aspen 81-067 Freedom Anchor Set Deck-toKit Back Water Level • incl. 6"-22" 6"-22" 12" 12" ASPEN/FREEDOM AQUATIC LIFT OPTIONS Item 81-073 81-015 81-039 81-308 81-307 81-077 81-068 81-069 81-061 81-050 81-075 45-109 184 Description Armrest Assembly Head Rest Pad Seat Belt Battery Battery Charger 5-Button Remote Lift Cover Lift Transport Cart Stainless Steel 1.90" I.D. Adapter Fitting Aspen/Freedom Anchor Locking Anchor Retrofit Kit ADA Lift Available Sign • • • • Anchor Set Deck-toKit Back Water Level Traveler II 81-314 6"-33" XRC 500 12" TRAVELER II XRC 500 LIFT OPTIONS Item 81-015 81-039 81-078 81-079 81-308 81-307 81-077 81-310 81-312 81-314 81-316 81-315 45-109 Description Head Rest Pad Seat Belt Spineboard Attachment Wheelchair Attachment Battery Battery Charger 5-Button Remote Lift Cover Lift Transport Cart Bronze Anchor Kit, 1.90" I.D. with Cap and Key Anchor Cap and Key Locking Anchor Retrofit Kit ADA Lift Available Sign Visit www.lincolnaquatics.com for additional Aquatic Lift parts and accessories. 81-900 RANGER POOL LIFT — Ideal for lighter duty needs. Low profile design and smaller foot print for tight deck spaces. Includes: dual flip-up arms; removable and adjustable foot rest. Accessory upgrade pack includes: extra battery, control box, head rest, chest strap, lift cover and transport cart. ADA Compliant. Item Ranger Pool Lift Model w/ Anchor 350 incl. 4-19" w/o Anchor 350 • 4-19" Accessory • • • 81-903 Upgrade Pack 81-900 81-901 Deck-toWater Level Model 81-300 Model Set Back Item Item Bolt Down Anchor ASPEN/FREEDOM AQUATIC LIFTS — Designed for in-ground and above ground pools and spas. Anchor is 2 3/8" I.D. Optional stainless steel adapter allows lift to be installed into existing 1.90" I.D. anchors. Both lifts include: battery, battery charger and seat belt. Aspen Lift includes: (2) 5-button remotes, adjustable swing out foot rest, removable armrest and padded head rest. Anchor ordered separately. Freedom Lift includes: (1) 5-button remote, stationary foot rest and anchor. ADA Compliant. Weight Limit (in lbs.) 81-067 w/ Anchor 375 incl. 12"-36" w/o Anchor 375 • 12"-36" Accessory • • • 81-865 Upgrade Pack • • 81-863 Transport Cart • 81-855 81-856 Deck-toWater Level 81-300 TRAVELER II XRC500 AQUATIC LIFT Accommodates heavier lifting needs. Designed for in-ground pools and spas. Traveler Lift includes: battery, charger, (2) 5-button remotes, adjustable swing-out foot rest, removable armrest, padded head rest, stabilizer bar and seat belt. Transport cart helps maneuver lift on pool deck. Anchor kit includes: 6" anchor socket, cover and key, ordered separately. Lifting capacity: 500 lbs. ADA Compliant. Scout Pool Lift Model Set Back Item 6" Anchor 81-065 Weight Limit (in lbs.) SCOUT 2 AQUATIC LIFT — Designed to be used in retro-fit applications. Eliminates the need for anchor installation utilizing almost any existing 1.9" I.D. x 6" deep anchor. Includes: dual flipup arms, seat belt, removable, adjustable foot rest and secondary locking anchor. Accessory upgrade pack includes: battery, head rest, chest strap and cover. ADA Compliant. 9" 9" • www.lincolnaquatics.com Aquatic Accessibility 81-280 81-830 81-308 81-264 81-040 AQUATIC LIFT PARTS S.R. SMITH AQUATIC LIFT PARTS Description Covers Lift Cover, operable position Lift Cover, mast Seat Cover Battery Cover Hand Held Controllers 2-button hand controller 4-button hand controller Lift Operator™ Control Systems 2-button without activation key 4-button without activation key 4-button with activation key Activation keys, set of 4 Battery Lift Operator Battery Linak Battery (old style, prior to 2012) Charger Lift Operator Charger Linak Charger (old style) PAL PAL2 Splash aXs ML300 81-040 • 81-264 81-227 81-040 • 81-264 • 81-040 81-260 81-264 • 81-294 • 81-264 81-279 81-817 • 81-264 81-813 • 81-280 • 81-280 • 81-280 • 81-280 81-282 • • 81-830 81-835 81-840 • 81-830 81-835 81-840 • 81-830 81-835 81-840 • 81-830 81-835 81-840 81-820 • • • 81-209 81-215 81-209 • 81-209 81-215 81-209 81-215 81-209 • 81-836 81-218 81-836 • 81-836 81-218 81-836 81-218 81-836 • AQUATIC LIFT MAINTENANCE SPECTRA-CLEAN™ STAINLESS STEEL CLEANER — Periodic passivation is required to ensure the corrosion resistance of stainless steel products. Application will help prevent corrosion in the future. Available in three stages for weekly maintenance and varying levels of corrosion. Item Description Size Treatment 3-330 System 1 1-22 oz. bottles 3-335 System 2 1 gallon 3-340 System 3 1 gallon Weekly Treatment Mid-range corrosion Severe corrosion SPECTRUM AQUATIC LIFT PARTS Covers Remote Battery Charger Description Portable Aspen/Freedom Semi-Protable Aspen/Freedom Traveler Lift cover 81-072 81-068 81-310 5-button remote 81-077 81-077 81-077 Battery 81-308 81-308 81-308 Plug-in charger 81-307 81-307 81-307 AQUA CREEK AQUATIC LIFT PARTS Description Covers Lift cover Actuator cover Remotes 2-button remote 4-button remote Battery Battery Charger Charger Scout Ranger 81-862 • 81-906 81-914 • 81-859 81-912 • 81-910 81-910 81-911 81-911 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 SOLAR CHARGERS 81-951 81-950 PREMIER RUST INHIBITOR — Inhibits rust and corrosion on metal surfaces. Protects gears for optimum lift performance. 81-951 AQUATIC LIFT GREASE — Preventative maintenance of your aquatic lift battery contacts helps extend the life of your battery. 1/3 oz. tube. 81-950 AQUA CREEK SOLAR CHARGERS — Solar charging station insures your Aqua Creek lift is ready to go with a full charge by providing a steady stream of low voltage power to your lift battery. Extends battery life and eliminates the need to remove your battery daily for charging. Works with Pro, Ranger, Scout, Revolution, and Patriot pool lifts. 81-920 Pro/Ranger solar charger 81-925 Scout/Revolution/Titan solar charger 81-930 Patriot solar charger 185 Aquatic Accessibility 81-152 ADA COMPLIANT LADDERS ADA EASY STAIRS — Fiberglass construction with white non-conductive handrails. Smooth finish with non-skid painted steps for safe and secure footing. Can easily be removed with stair dolly, included. No anchors or bonding required. ADA Easy Stair is ordered based on pool floor to top of pool deck height dimension. Number listed in parenthesis reflects that measurement. Replacement white edging kit includes: 35 ft. of edging and adhesive. Weight capacity 300 lbs. Specify color: medium blue (shown), light blue or yellow. ADA Compliant. 81-152 ADA Easy Stair, 5-step (38"-47") 81-153 ADA Easy Stair, 6-step (48"-57") 81-155 Skid-No-More paint, quart 81-160 Replacement white edging kit 81-166 Replacement ADA Dolly 81-170 Replacement wheel, each 81-475 AQUA STEP ADA 24" LADDERS — Features: 24" wide stairs, shielded treads, extended handrails and 600 lb. weight capacity. Includes: deck anchors and bolts. Specify desired riser height 5", 6.5" 7", 7.5", 8" or 8.5". Safety Side Guard option, set of 2 side panels, ordered separately with new ladder. Limited Lifetime Warranty on frame. Meets the new ADAAG Guidelines. 81-465 Aqua Step ADA 24", 4-Step 81-470 Aqua Step ADA 24", 5-Step 81-475 Aqua Step ADA 24", 6-Step 81-480 Aqua Step ADA 24", 7-Step 81-485 Aqua Step ADA 24", 8-Step 81-185 Safety Side Guard Option, set of 2 Custom Platform AQUA STEP REPLACEMENT PARTS 81-190 Custom platform 81-202 Shielded ADA tread, 24" 81-191 Shielded tread, 30" 81-194 Replacement ADA tread, 24" 81-199 Replacement tread, 30" 81-200 Replacement safety strips, each 81-205 Replacement anchor bolts, set of 2 81-210 Replacement hand knobs, set of 2 81-492 BOZEMAN ADA THERAPY LADDERS — Allows you to provide a gentle sloping means of access into your pool for those who require a little extra help. Each ladder is custom designed for your facility needs. Includes: 1.50" dia. handrails, 4" wheels for ease of transport and poly netting provided under the stairs and sides to avoid entrapment. Weight capacity 400 lbs. Requires 2 deck anchors, ordered separately. ADA Compliant. 81-490 ADA Ladder, 3-step 81-491 ADA Ladder, 4-step 81-492 ADA Ladder, 5-step 81-493 ADA Ladder, 6-step 81-020 Compression anchor, 1.50" ID 81-021 Compression anchor cap 81-038 Spanner wrench 81-023 Anchor cap removal key 186 Safety Side Guards AQUA STEP SAFETY SIDE GUARD — Can be added to your existing Aqua Step Ladder or purchased as replacement part. Prevents swimming under ladder. Sold as each panel. 4-5-Step 81-195 6-Step 81-196 7-Step 81-197 8-Step 81-198 81-178 THERAPY LADDERS AQUA STEP ELITE LADDERS — High density polyethylene ladder is lightweight yet designed for commercial use. Extra wide treads allow pool users to enter and exit the water without the need to go backwards. Handrails are aluminum reinforced fluted PVC. Quick release mounting system allows the step to easily be detached from the pool deck. For some gutter applications a custom deck platform may be required to ensure a proper fit. Pool steps are custom fit to the dimensions of your pool. Measurement Guides are required to assure a proper fit. Visit our web site for a Measurement Guide or call to have one e-mailed to you. 2 Year Warranty. 81-400 81-191 81-195 AQUA STEP 30" LADDERS — Features 30" wide stairs with a 300 lb. weight capacity. Specify desired riser height: 5", 6.5", 7.5", 8.5", 9" or 9.5". Safety Side Guard option, set of 2 side panels, ordered separately with new ladder. Includes: deck anchors and bolts. 2 Year Warranty. 81-173 Aqua Step 30", 4-Step 81-178 Aqua Step 30", 5-Step 81-182 Aqua Step 30", 6-Step 81-189 Aqua Step 30", 7-Step 81-193 Aqua Step 30", 8-Step 81-185 Safety Side Guard Option, set of 2 AQUA STEP HD 30" LADDERS — Features 30" wide stairs with a 450 lb. weight capacity. Specify desired riser height: 5", 6.5", 7.5", 8.5", 9" or 9.5". Safety Side Guard option, set of 2 side panels, ordered separately with new ladder. Includes: deck anchors and bolts. Limited Lifetime Warranty on frame. 81-380 Aqua Step 30", 4-Step 81-400 Aqua Step 30", 5-Step 81-420 Aqua Step 30", 6-Step 81-440 Aqua Step 30", 7-Step 81-460 Aqua Step 30", 8-Step 81-185 Safety Side Guard Option, set of 2 www.lincolnaquatics.com Aquatic Accessibility WATER WHEELCHAIRS 82-029 ALL TERRAIN WHEELCHAIRS MOBI-CHAIR FLOATING WHEELCHAIR Floating rolling beach wheelchair provides a seamless transition from the sidewalk to the beach and into the water. Aluminum frame and stainless steel parts with flotation wheels and armrest for stability. Specify armrest color: blue, orange or yellow. Weight capacity: 300 lbs. 82-029 MOBILE AQUATIC CHAIR — MAC chair was built specifically for use in aquatic environments with a powder coated stainless steel frame to resist corrosion and two swing away armrests for easy transfers. Rigid roto-molded plastic seat aids in user transfers by providing a stable platform that can be used for transfer support. Front and rear stabilizer wheels eliminate the tendency of a chair to pitch forward or back while going down/up the ramp. Designed for water or shower use. Includes seat belt. Weight capacity: 300 lbs. 82-010 82-010 82-030 ALL TERRAIN WHEELCHAIR — Advanced technology "balloon tires" roll easily over sand and rough terrain. Features stainless steel construction, Ballistic Nylon seat/back and 360º rotating swivel front tires. Includes: seat belt, 3-position foot rest, wheel lock, left and right armrests that swivel for easy transfers. Weight capacity: 325 lbs. Ballistic Nylon seat/back available in turquoise or royal blue, specify. Tires are available in gray only. Chair weighs only 37 lbs. 82-030 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 82-015 SPLASH AQUATIC CHAIR — PVC aquatic wheelchair designed for commercial use. Features extended base for increased stability. Splash Aquatic Chair has stationary arms. Splash Plus Aquatic Chair has swing-away arms. 82-015 Splash Aquatic Chair 82-016 Splash Plus Aquatic Chair 82-021 AQUA CHAIR — Provides independent accessibility for disabled individuals in and around water. PVC design allows you to furnish a wheelchair specifically for "wet" areas at your facility. All stainless steel fasteners supply additional strength and durability. Removable swing arm allows for easier transfer to and from the wheelchair. Recommended weight limit is 350 lbs. Includes: flip-up foot rest, wheels with stainless steel rims and locking brakes and swing arm assembly. 82-021 Aqua Chair 82-023 Safety belt 82-024 Shoulder harness with safety belt 82-025 Replacement 7" front wheel, each 187 Water Exercise Equipment 82-160 82-135 WATER EXERCISE EQUIPMENT TIDALWAVE POOL BIKE — Adjustable resistance settings, make it easy to adjust bike to your capabilities and exercise levels. Multiple bikes can be used for in water exercise classes. Tension knob is located near seat post, so you can adjust fitness level while you are riding the bike. Includes: adjustable seat column, adjustable handlebars, collapsible frame for easy storage, and scratch resistant wheels for ease in transporting the bike. Recommended pool depth is 3 ft. to 5 ft. deep. Optional semi-recumbent seat or sport seat ordered separately. Stainless steel frame with powder coat finish. Standard colors: yellow, green, or pink. Additional non-standard colors available for orders of 10 or more. Bike weighs only 55 pounds. Weight capacity: 300 pounds. Size: 541/2" L x 211/2" Wx 533/4" H. 82-135 Tidalwave Pool Bike 82-140 Tidalwave Semi-Recumbent Seat 82-145 Tidalwave Sport Seat 82-120 WATER RIDER POOL BIKES — Lightweight and easy-to-use bikes have adjustable seats and handlebars to accommodate different patrons. The height can also be adjusted to varying pool depths. Bikes can be used barefoot if desired. Brushed stainless steel frame is built to withstand harsh pool environments. Water Rider 3 - designed for moderate biking exercise. Ultra-light design weighs only 36 pounds. Water Rider 4 - has unique paddle system giving users the ability to adjust bike to 4 different resistance levels. Water Rider 5 - gives rider the most adjustability with knob control for resistance level. 82-120 Water Rider 3 82-121 Water Rider 4 82-122 Water Rider 5 188 82-165 DECK SOUND SYSTEMS 82-100 AQUA JOGGER — Weightless training with virtually no impact to the joints. Can be used for both aqua walking and aqua running. Lightweight and easy to move with scratch resistant wheels. Can be used barefoot, if desired. 100% stainless steel frame with anticorrosion treatment. 82-100 DYNAMO DECKSIDE PA SYSTEM — All in one deckside unit that does it all. Ideal for aqua aerobic classes up to 20 people. Includes: built-in 16-channel UHF wireless microphone system, dry headset, marine-grade coated body pack transmitter, rechargeable battery, and additional inputs for microphones, iPods and other MP3 players. Up to 4 hours of continuous use per charge. Protective travel bag ordered separately. Not designed for in water use. Specify headset color: black, blue, red or yellow. 82-160 Dynamo Deckside PA System 82-165 Dynamo travel bag 82-170 Dynamo replacement headset 82-175 Dynamo replacement battery 82-036 THERAPY PARALLEL BARS PARALLEL BARS — Enables you to transform your pool into a therapeutic rehabilitation area. A perfect addition to your therapeutic programming equipment. Designed to be used either in your pool or in your therapy room. Rubber sleeves help stabilize the bars on all types of floor surfaces. Light weight and portable for easy handling. Straddle bars are adjustable with stainless steel quick release pins. Adjustable in 1" increments from 28" to 40". 1.66" x 1.09 wall thickness with satin finish. 6' Therapy Bar weighs 65 lbs. and 8' Therapy Bar weighs 75 lbs. 21" distance between handrails. 82-036 Therapy parallel bar, 6' 82-037 Therapy parallel bar, 8' 82-105 BELT PAK VOICE AMPLIFIER — Deck side instruction just got easier with a self-contained voice amplifier. Front fanny pack style projects voice directly to your audience. Designed for small group instruction, up to 10 students. The Belt Pak is not intended for in water use. Size: 7"W x 3"H x 2.5"D. Includes headset. 5 watts. Uses 6 AA batteries, not included. 82-105 Belt Pak Voice Amplifier 82-110 Replacement wireless headset www.lincolnaquatics.com Water Exercise Gear Ric Frazier Productions 83-030 AQUAJOGGER DELTA BELLS — Triangular shape allows you to choose your workout level. Active Bell (light resistance) ideal for elderly or arthritis patients. Delta Bell (medium resistance) ideal for beginning to intermediate fitness levels. Delta Bell Pro (maximum resistance) for more advanced fitness levels. 83-031 Active Bell, pair 83-030 Delta Bell, pair 83-029 Delta Bell Pro, pair ® AQUAJOGGER® EXERCISE GEAR AQUAJOGGER® BUOYANCY BELTS — Increase aerobic endurance and muscle tone with impact-free water exercise. Soft EVA closed-cell foam hugs the body for comfort, maximum buoyancy and durability. AquaJogger® Classic is the most popular belt for average shaped women. AquaJogger® Shape is ideal for pregnancy, lower back pain and full figures. AquaJogger® Fit for shorter waisted women. AquaJogger® Pro for average shaped men. AquaJogger® Shape Pro for wider waisted men. AquaJogger® Active foam is slightly firmer, with simpler styling and an excellent value. AquaJogger® Junior is for kids 4-10 years old. AquaJogger Classic Pro Fit Active Junior Shape Shape Pro Blue 83-005 83-010 • 83-015 83-020 83-024 83-019 HYDRO-FIT ® COMFORT CUFFS — Comfort cuffs provide cushioned ankle comfort and additional flotation volume. Pair. 83-050 Purple 83-006 • 83-012 • 83-023 • • 83-035 AQUA RUNNERS — Designed to be used in deep water in conjunction with your AquaJogger® buoyancy belt. Soft EVA foam construction. One size fits all. Color: blue. Pair. 83-035 83-038 83-005 AQUAJOGGER® REPLACEMENT BELT — Replacement black elastic waistband with buckle for the AquaJogger® buoyancy belt. 83-026 36" (Junior) 83-02854" 83-02748" 83-050 83-045 HYDRO-FIT ® FITNESS CUFFS — For deep and shallow water workouts. Classic Cuffs feature a quick-release buckle closure for an extra firm fit. New Easy-Close Cuffs are easier to put on and adjust while providing a wider range of fitting options. 83-045 Classic Cuffs, pair 83-046 Easy-Close Cuffs, pair HYDRO-FIT® EXERCISE GEAR HYDRO-FIT® WAVE BUOYANCY BELT — Contour shape balances buoyancy evenly around your body enhancing correct posture and alignment. Soft EVA foam forms to your body. Waist Size Small (up to 32") Medium (33" - 38") Large (39" - 54") Classic Easy-Close Quick Velcro-Like Release Belt Closure 83-037 83-038 83-039 83-056 83-055 83-054 HYDRO-FIT® HAND BUOYS — Three sizes for progressive levels of buoyancy and resistance for upper body conditioning. Colors: white with green (mini), black (regular) or purple (jumbo). Includes: 1 pair hand buoys with instruction guide. 83-054 Hand buoys, mini (2" thick) 83-055 Hand buoys, regular (23/4" thick) 83-056 Hand buoys, jumbo (31/2" thick) 83-270 83-275 83-280 HYDRO-FIT® WAVE REPLACEMENT BELT Replacement black elastic waistband for the Hydro-Fit® Wave Belt. AQUAJOGGER® HITCH — 5' elastic nylon cord with clip attaches to the back of the AquaJogger® belt and the side of the pool for a stationary workout. 83-025 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Size Small Medium Large Classic Quick Easy-Close Release Belt Velcro-Like Closure 83-041 83-042 83-043 83-285 83-290 83-295 83-060 HYDRO-FIT SPORTS THERAPY BARBELL Barbell provides stable and secure buoyancy for a variety of aquatic activities. 83-060 ® 189 Water Exercise Gear 83-065 HYDRO-FIT® WAVE WEB PRO — Enhance the natural resistance of the water for effective upper body conditioning. Specify size: S, M, L or XL. 83-065 Hydro-Fit® Wave Web Pro 83-085 83-072 83-084 HYDRO-FIT® RACK SYSTEMS — Lightweight, storage rack holds 18 complete sets of HydroFit® workout gear. Available with two equipment system options: Buoyancy/Resistance Cuffs and hand buoys, or with Wave Belts and hand buoys. Assembly required. HYDRO-FIT® NOODLE STORAGE CART — Two wheeled lightweight cart holds up to 24 noodles. Complete Noodle Storage System includes cart and 20 noodles. Cart also can be ordered without noodles. Size: 38" H x 28" W x 16" D. Ships partially assembled. 83-072 Complete Noodle Storage System 83-073 Noodle Storage Cart Only 83-070 Replacement mesh bag 83-069 Repl. cart/rack wheels, pair SYSTEM COMPONENTS Ric Frazier Productions 83-071 HYDRO-FIT NOODLE — Provides stability, support and increased resistance for water exercise. Size: 3" x 54" 83-071 System Buoyancy/ Wave Rack Quantity Resistance Cuffs Belts Cover System 18 83-085 83-084 83-086 ® 83-086 83-067 HYDRO-FIT® NOODLE STORAGE CADDY Attaches to either end of your Hydro-Fit® System Storage Rack. Drawstring cord allows you to tighten mesh caddy as needed, stowing up to 20 Hydro-Fit Noodles. 83-067 83-315 HYDRO-FIT® HAND BUOY STORAGE RACK Protects your equipment by keeping hand buoys off the pool deck and organized. Specify hand buoy size being used: mini (2" thick), regular (23/4" thick) or jumbo (31/2" thick). Holds 24 pairs of hand buoys. Assembly required. Hand Buoy Quantity 24 pair 190 Hand Buoy Rack 83-315 Storage Rack Cover 83-330 83-066 HYDRO-FIT WAVE WEB STORAGE CADDY Attaches to either end of your Hydro-Fit® System Storage Rack. 20 individual mesh pockets keep your Wave Webs organized. 83-066 ® 83-068 HYDRO-FIT ® ALL PURPOSE STORAGE CADDY — Mesh storage bag provides one convenient place to store extra equipment. Drawstring closure stows contents securely. 83-068 www.lincolnaquatics.com Water Exercise Gear 83-156 83-088 HYDRO-FIT GEAR BAG — Nylon mesh duffel bags for stowing and carrying multiple sets of Hydro-Fit® gear. 83-087 Instructor bag, 15" H x 36" W x 15" D 83-088 Facility bag, 20" H x 36" W x 15" D ® 83-155 AQUALOGIX EXERCISE GEAR AQUALOGIX WATER EXERCISE GEAR — “Omni directional drag resistance” in the water provides a superior low impact workout. Design delivers a fast eccentric stretch and concentric contraction which triggers maximum athletic workout. Specify resistance level - Cardio Bells: All Purpose (black), High Speed (green), or Max Resistance (blue). Blades: High Speed (green) or Max Resistance (blue), and Total Package: which includes one each of the following - All Purpose Bells, High Speed Bells, Max Resistance Bells, High Speed Blades and Max Resistance Blades. 83-155 AquaLogix Cardio Bells, pair 83-156 AquaLogix Blades, pair 83-157 AquaLogix Total Package 83-089 HYDRO-FIT® NOODLE BAG — Nylon mesh duffel bag with full-length zipper and comfortable shoulder straps. Holds 20 noodles. Size: 15"H x 54"W x 15"D. 83-089 83-107 83-106 WATER EXERCISE GEAR AQUA POWER SWIM WEIGHTS — Vinyl coated steel weights can be removed or added to neoprene cover, so you can increase weight as needed. Velcro fastener. Arm: 16 x 4 oz. weights. Ankle: 16 x 5 oz. weights. Platform size: 24" x 16". Platform height: adjustable from 5.5" to 7.5". 83-106 Swim weights, arm, 4 lb. set 83-107 Swim weights, ankle, 5 lb. set 83-092 INSTRUCTORS DECK MAT DECK MAT — Soft mat designed to provide added stability and wet traction for slippery pool decks. Mat's porous construction keeps your teaching area dry and slip resistant. Size: 3' x 5'. 83-092 83-092 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 83-090 HYDRO-TONE AQUATIC EXERCISE GEAR HYDRO-TONE SYSTEM — The Hydro-Tone System uses a combination of Hydro-Boots and Hydro-Bells to give you a total body workout. All muscle groups are used with its three dimensional resistance design. The degree of resistance depends on the force applied by the user. Hydro-Tone Complete System includes: 1 pair boots, 1 pair bells, 1 video, instructional charts and mesh carrying bag. Also available individually; Hydro-Boots with lower body video, and Hydro-Bells with upper body video. Pair. 83-090 Hydro-Tone Complete system 83-095 Hydro-Boots 83-100 Hydro-Bells 83-124 AQUATIC EXERCISE STEP — Stable exercise step is made of high impact plastic with an antislip surface. Excellent for both dry land and water aerobic exercises. Platform size: 24" x 16" with adjustable platform height of 5.5" to 7.5". 83-124 191 Water Exercise Gear 83-240 AQUA VERSA-TUBE — Enhance your aquatic workout with our chlorine-resistant exercise tubing that is designed for use in the pool. Contoured handles provide a secure grip in the water. Three color coded bands with different resistance levels. 83-240 Light strength 83-245 Medium strength 83-250 Heavy strength 83-245 83-098 TYR® AQUATIC RESISTANCE GLOVES — Neoprene webbed glove creates additional resistance in the water. Ideal for an upper body workout, without overloading shoulder muscles. Rubberized palm with wrist closure for comfortable fit. Size: S, M or L. Color: black/blue 83-098 AQUAFLEX BODY BAR — Flexible and buoyant body bar. Helps develop flexibility, balance and muscular srength. Heavier weight provides more resistance. 48"L. 83-255 AquaFLEX Body Bar, 10 lb. 83-256 AquaFLEX Body Bar, 20 lb. 83-257 AquaFLEX Body Bar, 30 lb. EXERCISE BALLS — Balls can be used on your pool deck or in the water for your aquatic exercise programs. Heavy grade plastic with ribbed exterior for better gripping. Inflates with a hand pump, ordered separately. 64-079 Exercise Ball, 45 cm/18", yellow 64-080 Exercise Ball, 55 cm/22", red 64-085 Exercise Ball, 65 cm/26", green 64-086 Exercise Ball, 75 cm/30", blue 64-087 Exercise Ball, 85 cm/34", silver ELITE POWER MED-BALL — Synthetic rubber shell with hollow core which allows the balls to bounce. Textured surface for improved grip. Helps develop hand, arm, and upper torso strength and coordination. Balls are color coordinated by weight. Med-Ball Tree holds up to 5 balls. Black tubular steel construction. Item 83-205 83-210 83-215 83-220 83-225 83-230 83-235 Weight 2 lb. 4 lb. 6 lb. 8 lb. 10 lb. 12 lb. Diameter 8" 8" 9" 9" 10" 10" Med-Ball Tree Color Yellow Green Blue Orange Red Purple DRY LAND TRAINING 83-110 WAT E R FA N F I T N E S S PA D D L E S — System builds upper body strength through the accommodating resistance of water. Adjustable vents allow you to increase or decrease resistance during exercise. Pair. 83-110 192 VERSA-LOOPS — Closed loop 2" wide bands fits around the upper or lower legs so you can exercise the muscles of hips and legs. 12" long is ideal for short, limited movements and 22" long provides for greater range of motion exercises. Three color coded bands with different resistance levels. Length 12" 22" Light (Green) 83-116 83-121 Medium (Red) 83-117 • Heavy (Blue) 83-118 • www.lincolnaquatics.com Adapted Aquatics 83-140 ADAPTED AQUATICS EQUIPMENT WATER WALKER STABILITY BAR — New stability bar with flat paddle foam ends helps maintain balance and equilibrium during walking exercises in the pool. Oval bar provides a secure grip. Helpful for individuals with arthritis, stroke recovery or general rehabilitation needs. 5' long. 83-140 83-199 WET VEST AIR COLLAR — Provides flotation support for the head and neck in horizontal and vertical positions in the water. Neoprene cover with adjustable Velcro straps. Air Collar has an inflatable bladder. 83-199 WET WRAP AQUATIC CLOTHING — Works like a wet suit but has the benefit of a wrap around design to adjust to fit all body types. Allows full range of motion for arms and shoulders. Ideal for children's and senior programs, instructors and aquatic exercise classes. Combine Wet Wrap with Wet Shorts as needed for additional warmth. Made of durable neoprene. Sizes: Men's; S, S-long, M, L, XL. Women's; S, M, M-long, L, XL. Children's; S, S-long, M, Mlong. Inquire for additional sizing information. Inquire for Wet Wrap colors. Wet Wrap Wet Shorts BODYFIT CLIP — Helps float the head comfortably above the water. Fully adjustable for a full range of head sizes and second strap provides secure fit around the neck. 83-115 Men's 82-065 82-080 Women's Children's 82-070 82-085 83-175 Ric Frazier Productions 82-050 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 82-070 AQUATIC CLOTHING Style 83-115 83-130 HEAD FLOAT — Now therapy is made easier for individuals with reflex domination. No need to support the head manually, hands are free. Superb cushioning design allows the head to rest without pressure on the spinal column, encouraging neutral positioning. Independence for everyone within the aquatic environment makes this a truly valuable aid. 83-120 Small, 20-30 lbs. 83-125 Medium, 40-50 lbs. 83-130 Large, 60-175 lbs. 82-075 WET VEST II — The Wet Vest II fits a wider range of body sizes due to its adjustable fit. An ideal training, rehabilitation and therapy aid for your aquatic programming groups. Neoprene flotation vest holds you upright in the water and allows you to duplicate any land activity while suspended in the water. A great overall body workout with no impact to your joints. Specify size: Youth: small (up to 80 lbs.), Adult: medium (80-185 lbs.), large (185-250 lbs.), extra large (250-350 lbs.). 82-045 Wet Vest II, Youth 82-050 Wet Vest II, Adult medium 82-055 Wet Vest II, Adult large 82-060 Wet Vest II, Adult extra large ADULT & YOUTH SWIM DIAPERS 82-075 82-090 83-195 SWIM DIAPERS — Reusable adult and youth swim diapers are best worn under a regular swim suit. Designed to contain a regular bowel movement and protect from embarrassing pool accidents. Machine washable. Color: white. Specify size: Adult: small (28"-30"), medium (32"-34"), large (36"-38"), extra large (40"-42"). Youth: 4/5 (38-46 lbs.), 6/7 (47-57 lbs.), 8/9 (58-72 lbs.), 10/11 (73-85 lbs.), 12/13 (89-96 lbs.), 14/15 (97-110 lbs.). 83-175 Adult Swim Diaper 83-195 Youth Swim Diaper NOTE: See page 128 for children's swim diapers. 193 Pool Covers POOL AND SPA COVERS INSULATED FLOATING POOL COVERS — Save 60-70% of your heating costs by using an insulated floating pool cover. Reduces water evaporation, chemical loss, energy costs, and will help keep your pool cleaner. Payback on most covers is less than one year. Each pool cover is custom designed and fitted to your pool dimensions and is priced per square foot. The pool cover material varies by thread count in the polyethylene fabric. Each material gains bursting strength and abrasion resistance as the thread count increases. The 1212 hemmed edge is used for indoor pools and spas, or 1 piece outdoor covers. The 1212 weighted edge is used on outdoor pools to help prevent wind lift. 1010 STD COVERS - 3 YEAR WARRANTY Cover Size Hemmed Weighted 1-299 sq. ft. 84-011 84-016 300-999 sq. ft. 84-012 84-017 1,000-1,999 sq. ft. 84-013 84-018 2,000-2,999 sq. ft. 84-014 84-019 3,000+ sq. ft. 84-015 84-020 1212 DLX COVERS - 5 YEAR (PRO-RATA) Cover Size 1-299 sq. ft. 300-999 sq. ft. 1,000-1,999 sq. ft. 2,000-2,999 sq. ft. 3,000+ sq. ft. 1014 RS COVERS - 4 YEAR WARRANTY Edge Style Item Panel Surcharge 84-280 84-285 84-001 84-002 84-003 84-004 84-005 Weighted 84-006 84-007 84-008 84-009 84-010 84-250 Weighted 89' - 94' Edge Style Cover Size Hemmed 1-299 sq. ft. 300-999 sq. ft. 1,000-1,999 sq. ft. 2,000-2,999 sq. ft. 3,000+ sq. ft. XL Panel Length 83' - 88' Hemmed 1-299 sq. ft. 84-115 84-140 300-999 sq. ft. 84-120 84-145 1,000-1,999 sq. ft. 84-125 84-150 2,000-2,999 sq. ft. 84-130 84-155 3,000+ sq. ft. 84-135 84-160 1214 XL COVERS - 5 YEAR WARRANTY Edge Style Hemmed Edge Style Cover Size 84-025 SOLAR POOL COVERS — Polyethylene floating pool cover is an economical way to cover your pool. Highly buoyant, air-filled bubble material provides insulation for the pool surface and prevents heat loss through evaporation. Solar covers reduce heating costs up to 70% and are the most cost efficient investment you can make. Solar covers work on indoor and outdoor pools. When left on in sunlight, a solar cover will add as much as 10 degrees to an unheated pool. Blanket panels can be ordered in any length, but must be ordered in even widths. Panels can be easily trimmed to size when placed on pool. Solar cover material: 13 mil. thickness. Color: clear/translucent. Warranty: 7 Year Warranty (3 Years Full). 84-025 Commercial Solar Cover, per sq. ft. 84-165 84-170 84-175 84-180 84-185 Weighted 84-190 84-195 84-200 84-205 84-210 SOLAR POOL COVER XW Panel Width 95'+ 19' - 20' 21' - 22' 84-255 84-260 84-265 84-270 Ladder/hand rail cut outs, each Rounded corners, each 23'+ 84-275 NOTE: See page 196 and 197 for storage reels and pool cover accessories. 194 www.lincolnaquatics.com Pool & Spa Covers 84-110 84-100 LIQUID POOL COVERS 84-045 SAFETY COVERS SAFETY COVERS — Custom-tailored to fit any size or shape pool. Poly mesh material is strong, but lightweight. Allows water to flow through, but not leaves or debris. Great for winterizing your pool. Also protects your pool from unlawful entry and liability exposure. Patented anchoring system uses concrete anchors and stainless steel straps to keep the cover tight and keep heavy objects out of pool. Dimensional drawing of your pool, required for quotation. 84-045 Safety cover 84-046 Replacement pop-up anchors 84-047 Replacement screw-type anchors 84-048 Allen wrench 84-049 Replacement stainless spring HEATSAVR LIQUID POOL COVER — Reduces heat loss and evaporation from any pool. New patented technology offers an alternative to conventional pool and spa covers or can be used in conjunction with them to increase your savings. Will save energy and water costs in every pool, even while the pool is in use. Will also reduce evaporation and humidity on indoor pools. Will not affect your pool chemistry. Completely safe, non-toxic, and biodegradeable. Can be fed manually or continuously fed with automatic metering system. 115 VAC. Daily dosage: 1-2 oz. per 400 sq. ft. 84-100 4 liter bottle (140 oz.) 84-110 Automatic metering system INSULATED SPA COVERS INSULATED FLOATING SPA COVER — Heavy duty "Ultra" material with hemmed edges. Custom cut to your spa. Submit drawing with handrail locations indicated. Material color: blue top and black bottom. 1 Year Warranty. 84-061 1-299 sq. ft. 84-062 300+ sq. ft. BEFORE LIQUID POOL COVER Double Reinforced Folding Hinge Commercial Quality Double Strong Piping Tear Free Padded Handle Marine Grade Vinyl Commercial Quality Stitching Perimeter Apron 3 Mil. Plastic Tapered Foam Core Double-Ply Poly-Laminate 84-060 84-049 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 Sure-Loc Fastener Drain Grommet Dual Purpose Heat Seal Gasket Steel Reinforcement Commercial Grade Nylon Zipper AFTER LIQUID POOL COVER INSULATED SPA COVER — 4" to 2" tapered foam core for excellent insulation. Covered by a marine grade vinyl with mildew and UV inhibitors. Double reinforced center folding hinge for easy removal and storage. Steel reinforcement rib for strength and rigidity. Cover mounts on lip of spa or on coping. Floating cover can also be used on water surface to increase insulating capabilities. Available in 10 different colors. 84-060 Insulated spa cover 195 Commercial Storage Reels SINGLE STORAGE REEL — Height: 33"; Width: 28"; Length: 1' longer than winding tube length. JUNIOR STAINLESS STORAGE REELS — For smaller sized pool cover applications. Frame constructed with 1.75" OD x .120" wall thickness 304 stainless steel tubing. Winding tube is made with 4" OD x .120" wall thickness tubing. Includes: 12" hand crank, 2 screw jack brakes, and four 4" diameter stainless casters. Dimensions: 18"H x 24"D x winder length (L). Can hold up to 80 ln. ft. of insulating pool cover material. 10 Year Warranty. 85-250 8' 85-275 13' 85-255 9' 85-280 14' 85-260 10' 85-285 15' 85-265 11' 85-290 16' 85-270 12' DOUBLE STORAGE REEL — Height: 451⁄2"; Width: 451⁄2"; Length: 1' longer than winding tube length. WALL-MOUNTED REELS WALL-MOUNTED STORAGE REELS — Conserves deck space, by utilizing wall mounted reels for cover storage, on indoor facilities. Constructed of 304 stainless tubing. We can recommend and design a wall mounted storTRIPLE STORAGE REEL — Height: 451⁄2"; Width: 451⁄2"; Length: 1' longer than winding tube length. age reel system for your facility-inquire. 86-010 COMMERCIAL STORAGE REELS STAINLESS STEEL STORAGE REELS — Specifically designed for easy removal and storage of your insulating pool blanket. All-welded reels are constructed of 1.90" O.D. x .120" wall thickness tubing. Type 304 stainless steel. Each reel is supplied with two 24" diameter handwheels for safety and ease of handling. On multiple shaft reels, the handwheels can be moved to another shaft by means of a quick-release handwheel locking pin. The winding tube is constructed of 4" diameter Type 304 stainless steel, with three pool cover attaching straps on each tube. Each reel has two stainless steel screw jack brakes on each end for securely holding reel in place. Single reels provided with 4 - 950 lb. casters and double/triple reels come with 6 - 950 lb. casters. Determine which size reel to purchase by sizing it 1' wider than your widest pool cover panel. Available in 10' to 20' lengths in single, double or triple winding tube designs. Maximum capacity for each reel is 150 lineal feet per winding tube. 10 Year Warranty. Winding Tube Length 10' Storage Reel 11' Storage Reel 12' Storage Reel 13' Storage Reel 14' Storage Reel 15' Storage Reel 16' Storage Reel 17' Storage Reel 18' Storage Reel 19' Storage Reel 20' Storage Reel 196 Maximum Cover Width 9' 10' 11' 12' 13' 14' 15' 16' 17' 18' 19' Single 85-003 85-004 85-005 85-010 85-015 85-020 85-025 85-030 85-035 85-040 85-045 Double 85-048 85-049 85-050 85-055 85-060 85-065 85-070 85-075 85-080 85-085 85-090 Triple 85-093 85-094 85-095 85-100 85-105 85-110 85-115 85-120 85-125 85-130 85-135 STORAGE REEL COVERS CHAMPION™ STORAGE REEL COVERS — Protects pool covers from damaging sunlight while the covers are stored on commercial storage reels. Covers will fit any manufacturer's single, double or triple reel. Constructed with 12 oz./sq. yd. vinyl laminate fabric. Specify winder size and manufacturer when ordering. Storage Reel Size 10' - 13' 14' - 17' 18' - 20' Single 85-140 85-145 85-150 Double/Triple 85-155 85-160 85-165 www.lincolnaquatics.com Storage Reels & Accessories 85-170 85-360 MOTORIZED REEL SYSTEMS MOTORIZED REEL SYSTEMS — Can be mounted to existing reel or retro-fitted to an existing reel. Power Drive units - provide an electric gear motor (115 volt) on each shaft. Available for both portable reels or wall mounted reels. ThermGlide unit- is a self contained, battery operated, rechargeable Power Drive unit which has separate Power Head to attach to each shaft for winding. Can handle multiple reels. 60 minutes of battery life. Both motorized systems wind covers up and unwind cover back onto pool. 85-350 Power Drive- single reel 85-355 Power Drive- double reel 85-360 Power Drive- triple reel 85-365 Power Drive- wall mounted reel 85-370 ThermGlide- battery operated reel COMMERCIAL REEL PARTS SCREW JACK — Stainless steel holding device for new and existing reels. Unit mounts onto 41⁄2" x 4" caster pad. Stainless bolt set of (4) bolts, lock washers, and nuts ordered separately. 85-170 85-171 Screw Jack bolt set, 11⁄4" 85-172 Repl. screw jack pad with hardware 85-173 Repl. screw jack knob 85-174 MacBall style screw jack 85-230 85-370 POOL COVER STORAGE REELS 86-165 Single Reel 125 ft. 22 ft. 86-170 Single Reel 125 ft. 26 ft. 86-175 Double Reel 90 ft. 16 ft. 20 ft. 24 ft. 15 ft. TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 85-220 85-216 85-225 HAND WHEEL LOCKING PIN 85-200 Max. Max. Max. Item Description Ln. Ft. Reel Cover Number Shaft Width Width STAINLESS STEEL HAND CRANK — 12" stainless steel hand crank for 3⁄4" square or 1" round shaft end. 85-205 3/4" square hand crank 85-206 1" round hand crank 85-235 85-195 STAINLESS STEEL HAND WHEEL — 24" diameter hand wheel for Universal Reels. Also a convenient upgrade to other brands of reels that use hand cranks. Wheel comes with 1" diameter hub. 3⁄4" square shaft adapter and hand wheel locking pin ordered separately. 85-195 85-196 3⁄4" Square shaft adapter ELITE COMMERCIAL REELS — Heavy duty reels designed to store solar pool covers. Available in single shaft and double shaft styles. 36" high aluminum frame with white painted finish, stainless steel hardware, anodized aluminum winding tube, and 4" locking casters. 85-191 85-190 85-206 85-205 PILLOW BLOCK BEARING — Two bearings required per winding tube. Stainless bolt set of (2) bolts, flat washers, lock washers, and nuts ordered separately. 85-190 85-191 Bearing bolt set, 3" 85-208 SWIVEL CASTER — 6" diameter, 950 lb. caster with 2" wide tread. Stainless bolt set of (4) bolts, lock washers, and nuts ordered separately. 85-208 Stainless Steel Caster 85-211 Swivel Caster bolt set, 1" STAINLESS STEEL WINDING TUBES 85-175 12' to 14' 85-180 15' to 17' 85-185 18' to 20' 85-232 POOL COVER ATTACHING STRAP — For attaching cover to winding tube. 85-220 3' strap w/hardware (old style) 85-225 5'-15' strap w/hardware (old style) 85-226 8' strap w/slide 85-227 10'-15' strap w/slide POOL COVER DOWELS — Attaches cover to reel straps. 31⁄2" polyethylene tubing with rope. 85-230 PULL-IT PRO ATTACHMENT SYSTEM — Stainless steel Pull-it Pro toggles replace factory pool cover dowels. Attachment System kit includes: 3 x reel shaft clamps, 3 x "D" rings, and 3 x stainless toggles. One kit is installed on each winding tube, so each panel can be attached to reel. Panel toggles ordered separately. 85-232 Pull-it Pro toggle, stainless steel 85-233 Pull-it Pro Attachment System kit POOL COVER RETAINING STRAP — 8 ft. adjustable strap with buckle for securing pool cover on winding tube. 85-216 PULL ROPE ASSEMBLY — 100' x 1⁄4" braided poly rope with swivel snap. 85-235 POOL COVER ACCESSORIES INSULATING BLANKET REPAIR KIT — For insulated, floating, 3-ply cover, 1⁄ 8" thick. Includes: ThermCare tape (2" x 15' roll), 12 sq. ft. cover material and repair instructions. 84-065 84-068 ThermCare repair tape, 2" x 15' roll POOL COVER REPAIR TAPE — Repair tape for solar covers and insulating pool blankets. Easy to apply and UV resistant. 100' roll. 84-067 197 Index A B C ABOUT LINCOLN.......................................... 2-3 Acid brushes.................................................... 73 Acid sprayer..................................................... 42 ADA Compliance.............................. 85, 182-186 ADA Handrails................................................. 85 ADA Signs........................................ 97, 103, 185 Adaptable light rings........................................ 77 ADAPTED AQUATICS.................................. 193 Aeration system......................................... 54, 82 AFO Handbook.............................................. 130 Air blowers....................................................... 33 Air horn..................................................... 97, 139 Air relief valves................................................. 41 Alarm, Aquatic................................................. 95 Algae removers................................................ 72 Algaecides......................................................... 6 Aluminum poles......................................... 72, 96 Anchors, goal................................................. 136 Anchors, ladder and rail.................................. 86 Anchors, stanchion........................................ 121 Anchors, starting platform.............................. 120 Anchors, wall and cup..................................... 99 Anodes............................................................. 41 Anti-electrolysis ball......................................... 41 Anti-entrapment, grates and sumps........... 47-50 Apron............................................................. 110 Aqua Bike, underwater bike........................... 188 AQUATIC ACCESSIBILITY.................... 182-187 Aquatic clothing............................................. 193 Ashtrays and stands...................................... 177 Athlete’s foot fungicide and dispenser.......... 163 Automatic backwash controls..................... 36-37 Automatic external defibrillator (AED)............ 108 AUTOMATIC VACUUMS............................ 64-67 Automation, Chemtrol........................... 10-11, 37 Baby changing stations................................. 162 Badujet, swimjet systems................................. 33 Backpack....................................................... 129 Backstroke pennants and stanchions............ 121 Backwash valves, filter......................... 37, 39, 45 Bacteria test kit................................................ 60 Bags, team..................................................... 129 Ball bags........................................................ 139 Balls............................... 138, 140, 141, 144, 192 Ball valves.................................................. 11, 45 Banquet tables............................................... 173 Bases, umbrella............................................. 175 Basket racks.................................................. 159 Basketball, water............................................ 140 Baskets, skimmer....................................... 51, 74 Baskets, strainer....................................... 30 - 35 Bathroom partitions........................................ 162 BATTERY OPERATED VACUUMS................. 63 BBQ grill......................................................... 173 Bench, storage............................................... 116 BENCHES............................................... 171-172 Blankets......................................................... 106 BLEACHERS, TABLES, & GRILLS.............. 173 Bloodborne pathogen kit............................... 106 Blowers, air...................................................... 33 Blowers, hand held........................................ 148 Blowers, inflatable.......................................... 148 BOARDS, FLOATS & MATS......................... 147 BOOKS & DVD'S........................................... 130 BOOSTER PUMPS & AIR BLOWERS............ 33 Brominators...................................................... 16 Brushes............................................................ 73 Bubble covers................................................ 194 Bulbs................................................................ 77 Bulk chemical storage tanks....................... 27-28 Bulk CO2 storage tanks................................... 19 BULKHEADS................................................. 122 Bumpers, ladder...................................... 86, 136 Cable, lane line.............................................. 114 Caps, swim.................................................... 126 Caps, water polo............................................ 138 Carbon dioxide accessories............................ 19 Carbon dioxide detector.................................. 19 CARBON DIOXIDE SYSTEMS....................... 19 Cartridge, filter...................................... 39-40, 42 198 D Cartridge washers............................................ 42 Caution tape................................................... 111 Cervical collars.............................................. 106 Chalkboards................................................... 139 Chamois......................................................... 126 Changing stations, baby................................ 162 Check bags and racks................................... 160 Check pins and tags...................................... 161 Check valves.................................................... 46 CHECKING ACCESSORIES......................... 161 CHEMICAL CONTROL ACCESSORIES........ 11 CHEMICAL CONTROL SYSTEMS........... 10, 12 CHEMICAL FEED ACCESSORIES................. 26 CHEMICAL FEED PUMP PARTS.............. 20-25 CHEMICAL FEED PUMPS & ACCESSORIES..................................... 20-25 Chemical handling protection................. 109-110 Chemical spill containment...................... 28, 111 CHEMICAL STORAGE............................... 27-28 Chemical transfer pump.................................. 26 CHEMICALS................................................... 4-9 Chemistry controllers.................................. 10-12 Chemtrol controllers and parts............. 10-11, 37 Chlorinators, liquid................................ 16, 20-22 Chlorinators, Pulsar..................................... 13-14 Chlorinators, tablet................................. 13-14,16 CHLORINE GENERATORS & UV SYSTEMS.17 ChlorKing, chlorine generators & UV systems.17 Clarifiers.......................................................... 7-8 Cleaners, deck................................................... 9 Cleaners, filter.................................................... 9 Cleaners, furniture.......................................... 169 Cleaners, stainless steel...................... 9, 86, 185 Cleaners, surface............................................... 9 Cleaners, tile...................................................... 9 CLEANING ACCESSORIES...................... 72-73 Clear Deck Space Tape................................. 185 CLIMBING WALLS........................................ 151 Clocks, pace.................................................. 132 Clocks, wall and easel................................... 179 Clothing, protective........................................ 110 Coatings, deck............................................... 156 Coatings, slip resistant................................... 156 Coatings, swimming pool........................ 155-156 Colorado Time Systems.......................... 132-135 COMMERCIAL FILTER SYSTEMS............ 36-37 COMMERCIAL FILTER PARTS...................... 38 COMMERCIAL PUMPS & AIR BLOWERS............................................. 30-33 COMMERCIAL STORAGE REELS........ 196-197 Compound gauges.......................................... 41 CONTENTS....................................................... 1 Controller parts........................................... 10-12 Corrosion monitor............................................. 54 Covers, lane line reel..................................... 115 Covers, pool and spa.............................. 194-195 Covers, storage reel............................... 115, 196 CPO Handbook.............................................. 130 CPR masks............................................... 94, 107 CPR training.................................... 100, 107-108 Crowd control stanchions.............................. 121 Cup anchors.................................................... 99 D. E. grids........................................................ 42 Deck cleaners.................................................... 9 DECK CLEANING ACCESSORIES........... 74-75 Deck enclosure.............................................. 181 Deck paint...................................................... 156 Deck signs............................................. 103, 185 Defibrillator, automatic external..................... 108 Depth markers........................................ 103-104 Detectors, carbon dioxide............................... 19 Detectors, ozone.............................................. 17 Diaper, swim.......................................... 128, 193 Discharge hose................................................ 70 Disinfection, ultraviolet................................ 17-18 Display board, outdoor.................................. 180 Dive matting..................................................... 82 Dive rings....................................................... 143 DIVING ACCESSORIES & ANCHORS........... 82 Diving aeration system..................................... 82 DIVING BOARDS............................................ 81 E F G DIVING BOARD PARTS & ACCESSORIES..................................... 82-83 Diving brick...................................................... 94 Diving stand parts....................................... 82-83 DIVING STANDS........................................ 79-80 DRAINS & FITTINGS...................................... 50 Drinking fountain............................................ 181 Drum handling truck........................................ 26 Drum siphon pump.......................................... 26 Dry land training..................................... 123, 192 Dryers, hand and swimsuit............................ 163 Ear plugs & ear putty..................................... 126 Electrical..................................................... 76-78 Emergency Oxygen Unit................................ 106 ELECTRICAL ACCESSORIES....................... 78 Emergency shut-off switch............................... 78 ENERGY CONSERVATION............................. 55 Energy efficient lighting.............................. 76-77 Entrapment prevention.......................... 47-50, 78 Enzymes............................................................. 8 EQUIPMENT STORAGE............................... 116 Escutcheons.................................................... 86 Exercise ball................................................... 192 Exerciase bands............................................ 192 Exercise bike, underwater............................. 188 Exercise gear, water............................... 189-192 Exercise mats......................................... 165, 191 Exercise rails............................................ 85, 188 Expansion joint fillers..................................... 157 Eyebolts........................................................... 99 Eyewash stations........................................... 109 Face shield..................................................... 110 False start stanchions and recall rope........... 121 Fanny packs..................................................... 94 Fencing, safety............................................... 180 Fiberglass bulkheads..................................... 122 Fiberglass poles......................................... 72, 96 Fill spouts......................................................... 51 FILTER ACCESSORIES............................. 40-41 Filter cartridges..................................... 42, 67-68 Filter cleaners..................................................... 9 FILTER GRIDS & CARTRIDGES.................... 42 Filter grids & recovers...................................... 42 Filter media........................................................ 5 Filter parts............................................. 38, 40-42 Filter sand.......................................................... 5 FILTER SYSTEMS...................................... 36-40 Filter systems, cartridge.............................. 39-40 Filter systems, D. E..................................... 39-40 Filter systems, high rate sand............... 36-37, 39 Fins................................................................. 125 First aid kits.................................................... 106 First responder bag....................................... 107 First responder kit...................................... 94, 99 Fittings, pool................................................ 45-51 Flags, backstroke........................................... 121 Flashlights...................................................... 111 Flat sheet nozzles and water brooms.............. 75 Float valves...................................................... 44 Floating goals, water polo.............................. 137 Floating pool covers................................ 194-195 Floats.......................................................... 96, 99 FLOOR COVERINGS............................. 164-165 Floor inlets................................................... 49-50 FLOW CONTROL....................................... 43-44 FLOW METERS............................. 11, 23, 29, 43 Foam sealant backer..................................... 157 FOAM TOYS.................................................. 146 Footwear, protective...................................... 110 Fulcrums.......................................................... 83 Fume Scrubber................................................ 26 Funbrellas...................................................... 175 Funnel.............................................................. 26 Furniture cleaners.......................................... 169 Furniture, outdoor.................................... 166-176 GAMES................................................... 140-144 Gaskets, Light.................................................. 76 Gaskets, manhole....................................... 38-39 Gauges...................................................... 38, 41 Gloves, chemical handling............................ 110 www.lincolnaquatics.com Index H I Gloves, latex.................................................. 106 Goal backings, water polo............................. 136 Goggles, safety.............................................. 110 Goggles, swim........................................ 125-126 Grab rails.................................................... 84-85 Graffiti Remover............................................. 157 Grates, anti-entrapment.............................. 47-50 Grating, fiberglass........................................... 57 Grating, PVC............................................... 56-57 GRATING SYSTEMS.................................. 56-57 Grids, D.E., recovers and replacements......... 42 Grill, BBQ....................................................... 173 Ground fault interrupters............................ 70, 78 Guard chair parts............................................. 87 GUARD CHAIRS & STANDS..................... 88-91 Guard chairs, permanent................................. 90 Guard chairs, portable.......................... 88-89, 91 Guard hats and visors...................................... 93 Guard jackets................................................... 93 Guard seats..................................................... 87 Guard suits & shirts..................................... 92-93 Gutter drains......................................... 50, 56-57 HAIR & LINT STRAINERS..............30-32, 34-35 Hammocks..................................................... 177 Hand counter................................................. 161 Hand held instruments............................... 58, 61 Hand paddles................................................ 123 Hand dryers................................................... 163 Hand pump, air...................................... 139, 148 Hand pump, chemical..................................... 26 Hand trucks, drum........................................... 26 Handicapped ladders.................................... 186 Handicapped lifts.................................... 182-184 Handicapped wheel chairs............................ 187 HANDRAIL ACCESSORIES & ANCHORS..... 86 Handrail covers................................................ 86 HANDRAILS & RAILINGS.............................. 85 Handrails, custom............................................ 85 Hats and visors................................................ 93 Head immobilizers......................................... 105 Heater, patio.................................................. 177 Heater, pool................................................ 52-54 Heating, solar................................................... 55 HEATING SYSTEMS & ACCESSORIES... 52-55 HeatSavr Liquid Pool Cover........................... 195 Heaving line kit................................................. 96 Horn start system........................................... 133 Hose carts, vacuum......................................... 71 Hose carts, water............................................. 75 Hose fittings, vacuum...................................... 71 Hose, vacuum.................................................. 70 Hose, water...................................................... 75 Hydro-Fit water exercise gear................. 189-191 Hydrostatic relief valves................................... 49 Identification pins and tags............................ 161 Impellers, mixer................................................ 28 Infection control............................................. 106 Inflatable patch kit................................... 148-149 INFLATABLE STRUCTURES......... 145, 148-149 Inlets................................................................. 50 Innertubes...................................................... 145 Insulating pool blankets.......................... 194-195 Interactive Play Features................................ 154 J Joint filler........................................................ 157 KKeychain.......................................................... 94 L Kickboards..................................................... 123 Labels, chemical...................................... 26, 103 Labels, depth marker.............................. 103-104 Labels, safety.................... 26, 102-103, 120, 185 Labels, platform............................................. 120 Ladder treads, replacement......... 87, 89-91, 186 LADDERS & GRAB RAILS............................. 84 Ladders, therapy............................................ 186 LANE LINE PARTS & ACCESSORIES......... 114 Lane Line Saver............................................. 114 Lane line storage reel parts........................... 115 LANE LINE STORAGE REELS..................... 115 Lane lines and parts............................... 112-114 Lanyards.......................................................... 97 TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 M N O P Lap counters.................................................. 127 Lap swim markers.......................................... 103 Leaf Master...................................................... 70 Leaf skimmers and rakes................................. 74 LED lights......................................................... 77 Life hooks......................................................... 96 LIFE VESTS & LIFE JACKETS.............. 98, 128 LIFEGUARD APPAREL............................. 92-93 Lifeguard fanny pack....................................... 94 Lifeguard hats.................................................. 93 Lifeguard suits................................................. 92 LIFEGUARD SUPPLIES............................ 94-97 Lifeguard umbrella........................................... 90 LIFE VESTS & LIFE JACKETS...................... 98 Lifts, ADA Compliant............................... 182-184 Lifts, semi-portable and portable............ 182-184 Light bulbs....................................................... 77 Light gaskets.................................................... 76 Lightning detector...................................... 78, 94 Liquid chlorinators................................ 16, 20-22 Liquid chlorine pumps................................ 20-22 Liquid level sensor........................................... 28 Liquid pool cover........................................... 195 Locker accessories................................. 159-161 Locker benches.............................. 158, 171-172 LOCKER & CHECK BAG SYSTEMS........... 160 LOCKER ROOM ACCESSORIES.......... 162-163 LOCKER SYSTEMS............................... 158-160 Log Book, water test........................................ 61 MAIN DRAIN GRATES............................... 47-49 MAIN DRAIN SUMPS & FITTINGS................. 49 Manhole gaskets........................................ 38, 41 Manikins, rescue............................................ 108 Markers, water polo....................................... 139 Market umbrellas.................................... 174-175 Mask, CPR............................................... 94, 107 Mask, underwater.......................................... 125 Medicine Balls................................................ 192 Megaphones.................................................... 97 Message board.............................................. 180 Mirror, bathroom & underwater.............. 124, 162 Misting system............................................... 177 Mixer parts....................................................... 28 Mixers, slurry.................................................... 28 MSDS safety station....................................... 111 R Nets, tennis / volleyball / badminton...... 140, 180 Niches......................................................... 76-78 Non-skid coatings................................... 156-157 Non-skid flooring..................................... 164-165 Noodles.................................................. 145, 190 Nose clip........................................................ 126 Nozzles, wash down........................................ 75 OUTDOOR ACCESSORIES.......................... 177 Outdoor display board................................... 180 OUTDOOR FURNITURE........................ 166-169 Outdoor Showers........................................... 181 Oxygen system.............................................. 106 PACE CLOCKS............................................. 132 Paddle boards............................................... 150 Paint, non-skid........................................ 156-157 Paint, swimming pool.............................. 155-156 Palintest test kits.............................................. 58 Parallel bars................................................... 188 Parka, team.................................................... 129 Partitions, bathroom....................................... 162 Patch kits................................................. 148-149 Patching compounds..................................... 157 PENNANTS & STANCHIONS....................... 121 pH control....................................................... 4-5 Phosphate remover............................................ 6 PICNIC TABLES............................................ 170 Ping pong ball dispenser............................... 179 Ping pong tables............................................ 179 Pit access steps............................................... 87 Plaster repair.................................................. 157 Platform safety covers.................................... 120 Platform tops........................................... 120-121 Plumbing fittings.............................................. 46 Pocket testers............................................ 58, 61 S Pole parts and accessories............................. 72 Poles, cleaning........................................... 72, 74 Poles, rescue................................................... 96 POOL & SPA COVERS.......................... 194-195 Pool cover accessories.................................. 197 Pool cover storage reels......................... 196-197 Pool floats................................................ 145-147 Pool heaters................................................ 52-54 Pool heaters, electric....................................... 54 Pool lifts, semi-portable and portable..... 182-184 PORTABLE POOL CLEANERS...................... 68 Portable shelters............................................ 176 Power drive, storage reel............................... 197 Pressure gauges........................................ 38, 41 Probes, chemical control........................... 11, 12 ProMinent....................................... 12, 18, 20, 54 Propellers, mixer.............................................. 28 Protective clothing......................................... 110 Pull buoys and pull floats............................... 123 Pull training............................................. 123-124 Pulsar Acid Cleaner..................................... 4, 15 Pulsar booster pumps...................................... 15 PULSAR CHLORINATION SYSTEMS....... 13-14 PULSAR PARTS & ACCESSORIES.......... 14-15 Pulsar Plus Briquettes........................................ 4 Pulsar CRS................................................... 8, 14 Pumps, booster.......................................... 15, 33 Pumps, chemical feed................................ 20-22 Pumps, flooded suction................................... 32 Pumps, main circulation.............................. 30-32 Pumps, portable......................................... 33, 68 Pumps, self-priming.................................... 30-32 Pumps, submersible........................................ 33 PVC grating................................................. 56-57 RACING LANE LINES............................ 112-113 Racing lane parts........................................... 114 Radio, 2-way.................................................... 97 Rash guards..................................................... 92 Rebounder, water polo.................................. 137 Recessed steps............................................... 87 Recovers, D.E. grid.......................................... 42 Recycling center............................................ 178 Reducers, flanged........................................... 46 Repair kits, tubes.................................... 148-149 Rescue board.................................................. 96 Rescue can...................................................... 94 RESCUE EQUIPMENT........................... 105-108 Rescue poles................................................... 96 Rescue throw ropes......................................... 96 Rescue tube..................................................... 95 Rescue tube cover........................................... 95 Resin benches........................................ 170-172 Resin furniture................................................ 169 Resin guard chair............................................. 88 Respirators..................................................... 110 Resuscitation trainers.............................. 107-108 Resuscitators.......................................... 107-108 Ring buoys....................................................... 96 Rol-Dri water remover...................................... 75 Rope and rope hooks...................................... 99 ROPE, FLOATS & ANCHORS........................ 99 “S” hooks........................................................ 114 Saddle fitting.................................................... 46 Safety, chemical protection.................... 109-111 Safety covers, pool........................................ 195 Safety covers, starting platform..................... 120 SAFETY EQUIPMENT............................ 109-111 Safety fencing................................................ 180 Safety flooring......................................... 164-165 Safety labels, chemical storage tank............... 26 Safety labels, depth markers.................. 103-104 Safety labels, starting platform...................... 120 Safety markers, lap & swim............................ 103 Safety nets, water polo................................... 138 Safety Oar...................................................... 123 SAFETY SIGNS...................................... 100-103 Safety signs, diving board....................... 83, 103 Safety strips................................................... 165 Safety stations................................................ 111 Safety switch, pump suction............................ 78 199 Index Safety Vacuum Release System (SVRS).......... 78 Sani-Mist........................................................ 163 Sanitizers............................................................ 4 Scales, physician........................................... 163 Scoreboards, swimming................................ 135 Scoreboards, water polo........................ 135, 139 Secondary containment tanks.................... 27-28 Security check systems.......................... 158-160 Separation tanks.............................................. 40 Sequestering agents.......................................... 7 Service tools..................................................... 51 SHADE STRUCTURES AND UMBRELLAS..................................... 174-176 Shot clocks, water polo.......................... 132, 135 Shower enclosure.......................................... 181 Shower seat................................................... 163 Shower, outdoor............................................. 181 Sight glass, backwash............................... 38, 41 SIGNS & DEPTH MARKERS................. 100-104 Silhouette doll................................................... 94 SKIMMERS & TOOLS..................................... 51 Skimmers, leaf............................................ 70, 74 Skimmers, surface........................................... 51 SKWIM water disc game................................ 150 Slides, permanent................................... 152-154 Slides, portable.............................................. 153 Snorkel, training............................................. 124 Solar covers................................................... 194 Solar energy systems....................................... 55 Solenoid valves.............................. 11, 15, 19, 44 Sound systems................................... 78, 97, 188 Spa chemicals................................................... 8 Spa covers..................................................... 195 Spa, emergency shut off.................................. 78 SPECIALTY CHEMICALS.............................. 6-9 SPECIALTY COMPOUNDS........................... 157 SPECIALTY EQUIPMENT...................... 179-181 Spider strap................................................... 105 Spill containment, chemical........................... 111 Spill response kit............................................ 111 Spine boards, straps & hooks........................ 105 Stain removers........................................ 9, 72-75 Stainless steel cleaners....................... 9, 86, 185 Stanchion posts and anchors........................ 121 Stanchions, crowd control............................. 121 Stark filters and parts.................................. 36-38 Starting platform anchors............................... 120 Starting platform covers................................. 120 Starting platform tops.............................. 119-120 STARTING PLATFORMS & ACCESSORIES................................. 117-120 STARTING SYSTEMS................................... 133 Stenner chemical feed pumps......................... 22 Stenner feed pump parts............................ 23-25 STEPS & CHAIR PARTS................................. 87 Steps, guard chair................................ 87, 89-91 Steps, ladder.................................................... 87 Stingl Switch..................................................... 78 STOPWATCHES............................................ 131 Storage bench............................................... 116 Storage cubby............................................... 159 Storage reel covers, lane line........................ 115 Storage reel covers, pool cover..................... 196 Storage reel parts, lane line........................... 115 Storage reel parts, pool cover....................... 197 STORAGE REELS & ACCESSORIES.......... 197 Storage reels, lane line.................................. 115 Storage reels, pool cover........................ 196-197 Strainer baskets.......................................... 30-35 Strainers, hair and lint................................. 34-35 Strainers, line............................................. 11, 35 Straps, spine board....................................... 105 Suction fittings............................................. 47-51 Suitmate, swimsuit dryer................................ 163 Sump pumps.................................................... 33 Sumps......................................................... 48-49 Sun protection....................................... 90-94, 97 Sunscreen........................................................ 94 Surface cleaners..................................... 9, 72-75 Surgical tubing........................................ 123-124 Swim area buoys.............................................. 99 200 T U V Swim caps...................................................... 126 Swim diapers......................................... 128, 193 Swim jet systems.............................................. 33 Swim markers, lap and safety........................ 103 Swim masks................................................... 125 Swim mirrors.................................................. 124 Swim P3 player.............................................. 124 Swim pants............................................. 128, 193 SWIM TRAINING.................................... 123-126 SWIMMING POOL COATINGS.............. 155-156 Swimsuit, wringer and dryer.......................... 163 Swimsuits, team............................................. 129 Table tennis.................................................... 179 Tables, banquet............................................. 173 Tables, outdoor............................... 168-170, 173 Tables, picnic................................................. 170 Tanks, chemical storage............................. 27-28 Taylor test kits and reagents....................... 59-62 TDS meter............................................. 58, 60-61 TEAM ACCESSORIES.................................. 129 Team parkas, bags, and suits....................... 129 TEK™ carbon dioxide systems........................ 19 TEK™ Energy Smart, controller and monitor... 55 Tennis accessories........................................ 180 Tennis nets..................................................... 180 TERMS & CONDITIONS................................... 1 Test comparators............................................. 61 Test kit parts............................................... 58, 61 TEST KITS.................................................. 58-61 TEST REAGENTS................................ 58, 60-62 Test strips......................................................... 61 Therapy ladders............................................. 186 Therapy parallel bars..................................... 188 Thermometers, air.......................................... 179 Thermometers, in-line and water..................... 54 Thinner, paint.......................................... 155-156 Tile brushes...................................................... 73 Tile cleaners....................................................... 9 Tile scrubber............................................... 73-74 Tiles, depth and safety................................... 104 Timers, electrical........................................ 70, 78 Timers, vacuum................................................ 70 Timers, Water Polo................................. 132, 135 TIMING SYSTEMS................................. 134-135 TIMING SYSTEMS & SCOREBOARDS............................... 134-135 Tip-and-roll bleachers.................................... 173 Tools, service................................................... 51 Tot Dock teaching platforms................... 127-128 Touch pads.................................................... 134 Toys......................................................... 141-150 TRAINING AIDS..................................... 127-128 Transfer rail, ADA............................................. 85 TRASH CONTAINERS.................................. 178 Treadmill, underwater.................................... 188 Trench drain, PVC............................................ 57 Tropitone furniture................................... 166-168 T-shirts........................................................ 92-93 TUBES & NOODLES..................................... 145 Tubing, polyethylene, Tygon................. 14-15, 26 Tubing, surgical............................................. 123 Umbrella bases.............................................. 175 UMBRELLAS & SHADE STRUCTURES................................... 174-176 Umbrellas, lifeguard.................................... 90-91 Underwater exercise bike.............................. 188 Underwater hockey........................................ 141 UNDERWATER LIGHTS & ACCESSORIES..................................... 76-77 Underwater mirror.......................................... 124 Underwater speakers....................................... 78 Underwater teaching platforms.............. 127-128 Underwater treadmill...................................... 188 Underwater windows....................................... 82 USEFUL DATA....................... Inside back cover UV SYSTEMS............................................. 17-18 Vac-Alert SVRS................................................ 78 VACUUM ACCESSORIES.......................... 70-71 Vacuum carts................................................... 65 Vacuum gauges............................................... 41 W Vacuum head parts..................................... 69-70 VACUUM HEADS............................................ 69 Vacuum heads, water operated....................... 70 Vacuum hose................................................... 70 Vacuum hose reel............................................ 71 Vacuum limit switch......................................... 41 Vacuums, automatic................................... 64-67 Vacuums, battery operated............................. 63 Vacuums, hand operated........................... 63-68 Vacuums, portable........................................... 68 VALVES & PLUMBING FITTINGS............. 45-46 Valves, air relief................................................ 41 Valves, aluminum............................................. 45 Valves, check................................................... 46 Valves, float...................................................... 44 Valves, flow control..................................... 44-45 Valves, PVC...................................................... 45 Variable Frequency Drive (VFD)...................... 29 Venturi................................................... 14-16, 19 VENTURI & EROSION FEEDERS.................. 16 Vest, safety............................................... 98, 128 Vest, swim........................................ 98, 128, 193 Virginia Graeme Baker Act (VGB) Products................................................. 47-50 Visors............................................................... 93 Volleyball nets........................................ 140, 180 Volleyball, water............................................. 140 Wall anchors.................................................... 99 Wall clocks..................................................... 179 Wall fittings....................................................... 50 Wall mounted storage reel............................. 196 Wall mounting bracket....................... 20, 23, 105 Water basketball............................................ 140 Water broom.................................................... 75 Water exercise books.................................... 130 WATER EXERCISE EQUIPMENT................. 188 WATER EXERCISE GEAR..................... 189-192 Waterfall pump................................................. 31 Water games........................................... 140-151 Water hoses..................................................... 75 Water level controls.......................................... 44 Water park tubes............................................ 145 WATER POLO ACCESSORIES.................... 139 Water polo balls............................................. 138 Water polo caps............................................. 138 Water polo ear guards................................... 138 Water polo goal anchors................................ 136 WATER POLO GOALS........................... 136-137 Water polo manual, instruction...................... 130 Water polo markers................................. 138-139 Water polo rebounder.................................... 137 Water polo safety nets................................... 138 Water polo scoreboards................................ 135 Water polo shot clock............................ 132, 135 WATER POLO TRAINING............................. 138 Water removers................................................ 75 Water slide mats............................................ 147 WATER SLIDES & INTERACTIVE PLAY.................................................. 152-154 Water slides, inflatable................................... 149 Water slides, permanent......................... 152-154 Water slides, portable.................................... 153 WATER SPORTS & PADDLE BOARDS....... 150 Water test log book.......................................... 61 Water volleyball.............................................. 140 Weight belts, water polo................................ 139 Weirs, skimmer................................................. 51 Wheelchair, water.......................................... 187 Whistles and accessories................................ 97 Windows, underwater...................................... 82 Windscreens.................................................. 180 Winter covers................................................. 195 Winterizing plugs............................................. 51 Wrench, drum/carboy...................................... 26 Wringer, swimsuit........................................... 163 Wrist bands.............................................. 97, 161 Wysiwash......................................................... 75 ZZeobrite.............................................................. 5 Zoomers......................................................... 125 www.lincolnaquatics.com Useful Data Welcome to Lincoln! SWIMMING POOL CALCULATIONS WEIGHTS AND MEASURES One cubic foot of water contains 7.48 gallons. One cubic foot of water weighs 62.2 pounds. One gallon of water weighs 8.32 pounds. One gallon equals four quarts. One part per million (ppm) represents 8.32 pounds of chemical per million gallons of water. One pound psi equals 2.31 feet of head. One inch of mercury equals 1.13 feet of head. We appreciate the opportunity to serve you by meeting your commercial swimming pool equipment and aquatic supply needs. We are very aware there is one reason why we are one of the largest swimming pool equipment distributors in the country, and that reason is you. Since 1954, Lincoln has served commercial swimming pool operators like you. For over 60 years, our reputation has been built by our knowledgeable staff, by providing customers with prompt personal service, and by carrying the highest quality products available. In addition, it remains our goal to offer those products at the best prices anywhere, delivering you the best value available. METRIC EQUIVALENTS 1 meter = 39.37 inches 3.2808 feet 1.0936 yards 1 foot = .3048 meters 1 yard = .9144 meters 1 gallon = 3.785 liters 1 liter = .2642 gallons HIGH RATE SAND FILTERS — 15 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE POOLS Volume = Length x Width x Average Depth x 7.48 RAPID SAND FILTERS — 3 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. ROUND POOLS Volume = r2 x π (3.14) x Average Depth x 7.48 TO DETERMINE SQUARE FOOTAGE OF FILTER AREA REQUIRED: Pool gallonage ÷ 60 minutes ÷ Pool turnover rate (number of hours) ÷ Filtration rate (gpm per square foot of filter area) = Square foot filter area required. Customer satisfaction remains our top priority. Our knowledgeable staff is available to serve you and answer any questions you may have. We appreciate your business and pledge to do our best to meet your needs and exceed your expectations. IDEAL POOL CHEMICAL CONTROL CONTROL MIN. PPM IDEAL MAX. PPM Chlorine, Free Chlorine 1.0 1.5 3.0 1.5 2.0 4.0 Bromine 1.5 2.5 5.0 Sincerely, SATURATION INDEX = pH + TF + CF + AF - 12.1 TF CALCIUM HARDNESS EXPRESSED AS PPM CaC03 32 0.0 37 0.1 TEMP ºF pH 7.2 7.5 7.8 Total Alkalinity 60 120 200 Calcium Hardness 50 150 500 Cyanuric Acid 15 30 100 Dissolved Solids 0 200-1,000 1,500 NOTE: Check with your local Health Department for their water chemistry requirements in your area. NUMERICAL VALUES FOR FORMULA $8.00 WATER CHEMISTRY Chlorine with Cyanuric Acid We look forward to being your supplier now and in the future! Federal Supply Schedule Contract No. GS-07F-9449G Length x Width x Inches of water lost x .625 = Gallons of water PRE-COAT Continuous feed — .1 pounds per square foot of filter area. Non-continuous feed — .15 pounds per square foot of filter area. MAXIMUM COAT OF D.E. — Seven times the amount of pre-coat (for pressure D.E. filter). Call Toll Free (800 ) 223-5450 FAX ( 888 ) 680-2825 www.lincolnaquatics.com WATER LOSS DIATOMACEOUS EARTH FILTERS FILTER CYCLE — Add 2.5 pounds of D.E. per turnover for 100,000 gallon pool (continuous feed). Charles R. Luecker President & CEO AREA OF A CIRCLE Area = π r2 Area = 3.14 x r2 POOL GALLONAGES DIATOMACEOUS EARTH FILTERS — With continuous feed of D.E., 2.0 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. Due to space limitations and the technical nature of many of our products, it is not possible to have them all listed in this catalog. Please contact us for any specific products you desire. We will be happy to provide you with detailed literature and parts lists for each of the products we carry. AREA OF A SQUARE OR RECTANGLE Area = Length x Width FILTER SIZING CARTRIDGE FILTERS — .375 gallons per minute per square foot maximum. Our catalog contains the most comprehensive selection of high quality swimming pool equipment and aquatic supplies available in the industry today. We have organized our catalog in an easy-to-use format that will help you quickly locate the products you want. The Lincoln name is recognized around the world for providing customers with quality products and superior service at competitive prices. POOL SURFACE AREA CF TOTAL ALKALINITY EXPRESSED AS PPM CaC03 AF 5 0.3 5 0.7 25 1.0 25 1.4 PARTS PER MILLION CALCULATION 46 0.2 50 1.3 50 1.7 53 0.3 75 1.5 75 1.9 60 0.4 100 1.6 100 2.0 66 0.5 150 1.8 150 2.2 76 0.6 200 1.9 200 2.3 84 0.7 300 2.1 300 2.5 94 0.8 400 2.2 400 2.6 105 0.9 800 2.5 800 2.9 128 1.0 1,000 2.6 1,000 3.0 FOR 100% CHEMICAL STRENGTH Pool Volume (gallons) x 8.32 pounds per gallon 1,000,000 = Pounds for 1 ppm FOR LESS THAN 100% CHEMICAL STRENGTH P 1 pound of chlorine gas 1 gallon of liquid chlorine (sodium hypochlorite) 1.54 pounds of dry chlorine (calcium hypochlorite) 1.8 pounds of S.D.I.C. (sodium dichlor) SUPER CHLORINATION Super chlorination = 10 times the weight of the chloramines. SODA ASH — To maintain pH, add continuously 1.25 to 1.50 pounds of soda ash for each pound of chlorine gas used. Ideal soda ash solution is 3-6%, with a maximum solution of 12%. SOLUTION TANK FORMULA — Soda ash tank gallons x 8.32 Ibs. per gallon x desired soda ash solution percentage = pounds of soda ash for solution. INFORMATION RESOURCES Centers for Disease Control (CDC) — www.cdc.gov Model Aquatic Health Code (MAHC) www.cdc.gov/healthywater/swimming/pools/mahc National Swimming Pool Foundation — www.nspf.org TOLL FREE (800) 223-5450 California Dept. of Environmental Health www.cdph.ca.gov California Swimming Pool Regulations http://www.cdph.ca.gov/HealthInfo/EnvironHealth/Water/ Pages/CaliforniaPublicSwimmingPoolRequirements.aspx Commercial Swimming Pool Equipment ( 800 ) 223-5450 www.lincolnaquatics.com 2051 Commerce Avenue, Concord, CA 94520 USA ph (800) 223-5450 / fax (888) 680-2825 int’l (925) 687-9500 / fax (925) 680-2825 catalog 62 lincoln AQUATICS C omme rc ial Sw imming Pool Equipme nt C a talog